Руководство По Работам в Условиях Мастерских

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 780

COMPACT LOADER

WITH ACCESSORIES

SL65B

WORKSHOP MANUAL

IMPORTANT: The information contained in this manual are valid at printing time. As the Manufacturer
12602

continuously improves his products, some information may not be updated. In case of discrepancies, apply
to Sales and Service Department.

FIAT KOBELCO CONSTRUCTION MACHINERY S.p.A. - ENGINEERING -


PRINT 604.06.948.01
Edition 07-2002 - Printed in Italy
12602
TO THE READER

• This manual has been written for a skilled content, please contact:
technician, in order to give him the
information necessary to repair this FIAT KOBELCO CONSTRUCTOR
machine. MACHINERY S.p.A.
Strada Settimo, 323
- Read this manual carefully for correct San Mauro Torinese (TO)
information about repair procedures. 10099 ITALIA
PRODUCT SUPPORT
- For any question or comment, or in case DOCUMENTATION CENTER
you notice a mistake in this manual Fax. ++39 011 6877357

ADDITIONAL REFERENCE MANUALS

• In addition to this Workshop Manual, refer also


to the following:

- Operation and maintenance instruction


manual
- Spare parts catalog

DESCRIPTION OF THE COMPLETE


WORKSHOP MANUAL

• The complete repair manual consists of one maintenance standards, remove and install
volume: procedures, disassembly and assembly
procedures.
SL65B - Workshop Manual "Compact loader
with accessories" • The complete Workshop Manual for the
compact loader with accessories model
• “Compact loader with accessories" Workshop SL65B consist of the following volume
Manual contais the technical information identified by print number as shown
necessary for machine/engine service and herebelow:
repair, service equipment, information on
12602

VOLUME MACHINE TYPE PRINT No.


- Workshop Manual SL65B 604.06.948.01
"Compact loader with accessories"
AVOID ACCIDENTS

Most accidents, whether they occur in industry, on the farm, at home or


on the highway, are caused by the failure of some individuals to follow
simple and fundamental safety rules or precautions. For this reason
MOST ACCIDENTS CAN BE PREVENTED by recognising the real
cause and doing something about it before the accident occurs.
Regardless of the care used in the design and construction of any type
of equipment there are conditions that cannot be completely safeguarded
against without interfering with reasonable accessibility and efficient
operation.
Carefully read indications, cautions and safety warning quoted in the
“SAFETY RULES” section.
A careful operator is the best insurance against an accident.
The complete observance of one simple rule would prevent many
thousand serious injuries each year.
That rule is:
Never attempt to clean, oil or adjust a machine while it is in motion.

ATTENTION

On machines having hydraulically, mechanically and/or cable


controlled equipment (such as showels, loaders, dozers, scrapers
etc.) be certain the equipment is lowered to the ground before
servicing, adjusting and/or repairing.
If it is necessary to have the equipment partially or fully raised to
gain access to certain items, be sure the equipment is suitably
supported by means other than the hydraulic lift cylinders, cable
and/or mechanical device used for controlling the equipment.

COPYRIGHT BY FIAT KOBELCO CONSTRUCTOR MACHINERY S.p.A.


Product Support - Documentation Centre
12602

Strada di Settimo, 323 - S. Mauro T.SE (TO) ITALY

All rights reserved. Reproduction of text and illustrations in whole or in part, is


strictly prohibited.
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION

CONTENT

Section Description Page


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-2
About Improvements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-2
Company Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-3
Parts and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-3
Model Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-3
Precautionary Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-4
Safety Precaution Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-5
General Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-7
Machine Model and Serial Number Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-9
Engine Model and Serial Number Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-9
Hardware Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-10
Installation of Adjustable Fittings in Straight Thread O Ring Bosses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-12
Standard Torque Data for Hydraulic Tubes and Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-12
Pipe Thread Fitting Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-13
Lubricants and Coolants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-13
Sealants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-13
Properly Support a Raised Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-14
Properly Support Boom on Boom Lock Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-14
Raising Boom Without Hydraulic Oil Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-14
Raising Boom Without Battery Voltage (12V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-15
Reattaching Cylinders After Repair with Boom Resting on Boom Lock Pins . . . . . . . . 00-17
Major Unit Overhaul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-18
Cab and Boom Tilt Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-19
Craning the Skid Steer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-25
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-28
Specifications (Model SL65B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-29
Dimensions (Model SL65B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-32
2 INDEX

SECTION 10 – ENGINE

Chapter 1 – SL65B - 332T/JF


CONTENT

Section Description Page


10 000 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
SL65B Engine Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Engine Model and Serial Number Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
General Engine Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
General Engine Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10
Specifications Service Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Hardware Torque Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27
Turbocharger Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28
Engine Electrical Components - SL65B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29
10 001 10 Engine Removal By Tilting Cab and Boom Forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30
10 001 20 Mounting the Engine for Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
10 001 53 Engine Disassembly Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
Engine Component Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36
Cylinder Block, Pistons, Rings, Rods and Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45
Crankshaft, Main Bearings, and Flywheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-53
Camshaft and Timing Gear Train . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-59
Timing Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-62
Engine Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-66
10 400 Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70
10 402 30 Thermostat Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-71
10 402 10 Water Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-72
10 304 Lubrication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77
10 102 10 Oil Pan Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77
10 304 34 Oil Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-78
10 304 06 Oil Level Dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-81
Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82
10 210 21 Electric Lift Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82
10 218 34 Injectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90
10 218 34 Fuel Injector Overhaul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-92
10 210 21 Electric Lift Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-95
10 216 10 Fuel Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-97
INDEX 3

Air Intake and Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100


Exhaust Muffler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-102
Turbocharger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-103
Starting a Turbochargepd Engine After Installation of a Turbocharger . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-112
Engine Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-113
Operating the Engine After Overhaul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-116
Electrical Component Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-117
Adjust Belt Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-118
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-119
4 INDEX

SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES)

Chapter 1 – Gearboxes

CONTENT

Section Description Page


27 000 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-2
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-4
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-5
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-7
27 126 Gearboxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-8
Final Drive and Gearbox Fill/Check Plug (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-8
27 126 40 Gearbox Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-9
27 126 48 Gearbox Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-10
Gearbox Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-14
Gearbox Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-15
27 126 40 Gearbox Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-18
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-23
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox Removal - Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-23
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-28
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox Reassembly - Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-29
Start-Up Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-32
INDEX 5

SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION

Chapter 1 – Neutralizer, Pumps, Motors, Two-Speed

CONTENT

Section Description Page


29 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-4
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-4
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29 100 01 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-8
Low Power Through the Engine/Transmission System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-10
Hydrostatic Drive System Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-13
Hydrostatic System Oil Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-16
Hydrostatic Charge System Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-19
Hydrostatic Pump Case Drain Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-21
Hydrostatic Pump High Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-23
Hydrostatic Motor Case Drain Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-25
Hydraulic, Hydrostatic System Air Ingress Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-27
Hydrostatic and Charge Pumps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-29
Hydrostatic Pumps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-29
29 100 40 Hydrostatic Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-29
29 100 46 Hydrostatic and Charge Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-35
Hydrostatic Charge Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-36
Hydrostatic Charge Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-36
Hydrostatic Charge Pump Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-37
Hydrostatic Charge Pump Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-38
Hydrostatic Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-39
Hydrostatic Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-39
Hydrostatic Pump Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-44
Hydrostatic Pump Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-50
Hydrostatic Pump Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-57
Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-60
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-60
29 100 60 Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-60
29 100 66 Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-64
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-67
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-71
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-75
6 INDEX

Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-77


29 100 60 Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-77
29 100 66 Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-82
Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-86
Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-90
Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-96
29 134 Two Speed High/Low Range Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-99
29 134 20 Two Speed High/Low Control Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-101
Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-102
29 134 24 Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-103
Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-103
Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-104
29 134 Control Valve Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-105
29 134 30 Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-106
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-107
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-107
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-108
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-108
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-108
29 134 40 Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-109
Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-110
Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-111
Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-112
Two Speed Control Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-113
Hydraulic System Cleaning Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-114
Start-up Procedure After Rebuild (After Pump or Motor Replacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-117
29 100 Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-120
Hydrostatic System Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-120
Neutralizer Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-122
29 130 10 Neutralizer Assembly Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-122
Neutralizer Assembly Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-122
Neutralizer Assembly Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-123
Neutralizer Assembly Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-125
29 130 30 Control Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-128
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-129
INDEX 7

29 100 10 Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-129


Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-129
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-130
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-130
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-130
Left Control Handle With Boom Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-132
29 100 11 Left Control Handle With Boom Control Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-132
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-133
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-134
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-135
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-136
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-138
29 100 15 Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-138
29 100 15 Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-139
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-141
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-142
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-145
Control Linkage and Neutralizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-147
Control Linkage and Neutralizer Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-147
29 130 06 Drive Control Adjustment Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-148
SL65B Links and Arms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-149
29 130 06 SL65B Neutralizer Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-150
Control Lever Parallel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-151
SL65B Linkage and Control Lever Equal Movement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-151
Left Control Linkage Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-152
SL65B Straight Travel and Forward/Reverse Stop Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-152
SL65 BHigh/Low Range .Adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-155
8 INDEX

SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS

Chapter 1 – Parking Brake

CONTENT

Section Description Page


33 000 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-2
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-3
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-4
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-6
33 110 Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-7
Parking Brake Removal and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-8
33 110 Parking Brake Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-13
INDEX 9

SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Chapter 1 – Valves, Gear Pump, Cylinders, and Pedal Controls

CONTENT

Section Description Page


35 000 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-3
Hydraulic System Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-4
Boom Cylinder Pivot Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-6
Boom Cylinder Pivot Pin Location and Machine Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-6
Control Valve Power Beyond . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-7
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-8
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-11
Auxiliary Boom Hydraulics Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-15
Hydraulic System Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-17
Hydraulic System Oil Flow (Neutral Position) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-23
Control Valve - Bucket Spool Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-24
Control Valve - Boom Spool Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-25
Control Valve - Auxiliary Spool Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-26
Hydraulic System Oil Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-27
35 710 02 Main System Pressure Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-29
Checking Main System Pressure at Boom Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-32
Checking Main System Pressure at Bucket Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-33
Checking Main System Pressure at Auxiliary Boom Hydraulic Quick Couplers . . . . . 35-34
Boom Circuit Relief Valve Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-35
Gear Pump Flow Efficiency Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-37
Boom and Bucket Spool Lock Solenoid Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-40
Hydraulic, Hydrostatic System Air Ingress Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-42
Control Valve Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-44
35 724 50 Control Valve Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-45
35 724 54 Control Valve Disassembly and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-47
Control Valve Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-51
Control Valve Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-52
Control Valve Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-56
Hydraulic Pump Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-57
10 INDEX

35 710 10 Hydraulic Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-58


35 710 20 Hydraulic Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-60
Hydraulic Pump Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-61
Hydraulic Pump Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-63
Hydraulic Pump Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-66
Cylinders, Boom and Bucket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-69
35 710 10 Boom Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-70
35 730 18 Boom Cylinder Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-71
Boom Cylinder Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-73
Boom Cylinder Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-74
Boom Cylinder Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-76
35 730 10 Bucket Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-77
35 730 13 Bucket Cylinder Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-77
Bucket Cylinder Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-78
Bucket Cylinder Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-80
Bucket Cylinder Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-82
Pedal Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-83
35 724 16 Pedal Removal (With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-83
Pedal Inspection (With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-83
Pedal Reinstallation (With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-85
35 724 16 Pedal Removal (With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-88
Pedal Inspection (With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-89
Pedal Reinstallation (With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-90
35 300 Hydraulic Cooling, Filter, Reservoir System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-93
35 705 Filter System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-94
35 705 04 Filter Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-94
35 705 05 Base Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-94
Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-95
Oil Cooler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-96
35 300 10 Oil Cooler Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-96
Oil Cooler Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-96
35 300 Oil Reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-97
35 300 10 Oil Reservoir Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-98
Oil Reservoir Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-99
Oil Reservoir Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-100
Adapting Attachments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-101
INDEX 11

SECTION 37 – TOWING HOOKS AND BALLASTING

Chapter 1 – Rear Counter Weights

CONTENT

Section Description Page


37 140 10 Rear Counterweights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37-2
37 140 12 Rear Counterweight Support Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37-2

SECTION 39 – FRAMES

Chapter 1 – Lower Main, ROPS

CONTENT

Section Description Page


General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
ROPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
ROPS Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
90 152 46 ROPS Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
ROPS Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-9
12 INDEX

SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS

Chapter 1 – Axles

CONTENT

Section Description Page


44 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-2
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-4
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-5
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-7
44 106 Axles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-8
44 106 10 Axle Housing Assembly Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-8
44 106 16 Axle Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-9
Axle Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-11
Axle Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-12
Axle Housing Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-14
Final Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-16
44 106 48 Drive Chain and Sprocket Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-16
Final Drive Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-18
Final Drive Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-19
44 511 Tyres/Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-22
Tyre and Track Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-23

SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL

Chapter 1 – Heater/Defroster

CONTENT

Section Description Page


50 100 Heater/Defroster (Cab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-2
INDEX 13

SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

Chapter 1 – Advanced Warning System, Circuits, Alternator, and Starter

CONTENT

Section Description Page


55 000 General Electrical Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-6
Definition of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-7
Adapting Attachments Requiring 12V Electrical Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-9
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-14
Electrical Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-17
55 418 Advanced Warning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-21
Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-21
(EIC) Electronic Instrument Cluster Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-22
EIC Functional Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-23
Engine Preheat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-28
Automatic Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-28
Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-29
Broken Alternator/Water Pump Belt Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-31
Fuel Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-32
EIC Interlocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-32
EIC Lock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-33
EIC Engine Preheat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-34
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-35
Advanced Warning System (AWS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-38
EIC Board Self Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-39
Diagnostic and Setup Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-40
Arrow, Open Book, and Audible Alarm Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-42
Diagnostic Mode EIC Circuit Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-42
EIC Setup Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-46
Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC) and Starter Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-54
Blown Fuse Symptom and Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-54
Testing Other EIC Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-56
EIC Board Reading Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-59
EIC Board Claims Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-62
14 INDEX

Electrical Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-63


Seat Switch Circuit to EIC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-64
Seat Belt Switch Circuit to EIC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-65
Ignition Switch Circuit to EIC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-67
Cranking Circuit (Starter Motor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-68
“Service/Run” Switch in the “Run” Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-69
Cranking Circuit Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-70
Service/Run” Switch in the “Service” position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-71
Cranking Circuit Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-72
Start Relay Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-72
Start Relay Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-73
Start Relay Ground Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-74
Start Interlock Relay Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-74
Start Interlock Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-75
Start Interlock Ground Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-76
Start Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-76
55 100 Removal, Installation and Wiring of Electrical Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-77
Battery - SL65B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-78
55 301 40 Battery Removal - SL65B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-78
Battery Installation - SL65B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-78

55 418 10 EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Board Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-79


EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-80
EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Board Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-81
Ignition (Key) Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-81
55 201 10 Ignition (Key) Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-82
Ignition (Key) Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-82
Cab Fuse Panel Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-83
Cab Fuse Block and Panel Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-84
Cab Fuse Block and Panel Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-84
Service/Run Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-85
Service/Run Switch - Service Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-85
Service/Run Switch - Run Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-85
55 418 30 Service/Run Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
Service/Run Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
Seat and Seat Belt Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
55 201 15 Seat Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-87
Seat Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-87
Seat Belt Buckle and Switch Assembly Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-88
INDEX 15

Seat Belt Buckle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-88


Road Light and Work Light Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-88
55 404 20 Road Light and Work Light Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-89
Road Light and Work Light Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-89
Engine Fuse and Relay Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-90
Accessory Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Accessory Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Accessory Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Preheat Circuit Breaker Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
55 100 24 Preheat Circuit Breaker Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Preheat Circuit Breaker Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Start Interlock Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
55 100 34 Start Interlock Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-93
Start Interlock Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-93
Engine Fuse Panel Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-93
Engine Fuse Block Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-94
Engine Fuse Block Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-94
Alternator Excite Resistor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-95
55 301 16 Alternator Excite Resistor Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-96
Alternator Excite Resistor Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-95
Start Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-96
55 100 34 Start Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-96
Start Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-97
Preheat Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-97
55 100 34 Preheat Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Preheat Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Preheat Manifold Heater Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Preheat Manifold Heate Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Fuel System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-99
10 223 Fuel Shutoff Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-101
Fuel Shutoff Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-101
10 223 10 Replacement of Fuel Shutoff Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-102
Electric Lift Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-102
Electric Lift Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
Cold Advance Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
Cold Advance Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
55 414 14 Air Filter Restriction Indicator Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-104
Air Filter Restriction Indicator Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-104
55 414 10 Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-104
16 INDEX

Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-104


55 414 12 Engine Oil Pressure Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
Engine Oil Pressure Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
55 414 28 Hydrostatic Charge Pressure Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
Hydrostatic Charge Pressure Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
55 414 24 Hydraulic Oil Filter Restriction Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-106
Hydraulic Oil Filter Restriction Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-106
55 414 20 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Sender Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-106
Hydraulic Oil Temperature Sender Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-108
Boom/Bucket Control Valve Spool Lock Solenoids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-108
35 724 90 Boom/Bucket Control Valve Spool Lock Solenoids Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-108
Boom/Bucket Control Valve Spool Lock Solenoids Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-109
Wire Harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-110
55 100 74 Main Wire Harness Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-110
Main Wire Harness Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-115
55 404 Road/Work Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-119
55 301 Alternator (40 Amp Version) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-123
Charging Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-123
Alternator Service Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-125
Alternator System Testing and Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-125
Alternator Component Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-129
Alternator Overhaul Component Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-131
55 301 10 Alternator Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-131
55 301 12 Alternator Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-132
55 301 14 Alternator Component Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-133
Alternator Inspection and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-135
Alternator Resassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-136
Alternator Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-136
55 201 Starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-137
Starter Motor Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-139
55 201 50 Starter Motor Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-140
Starter Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-141
System Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-141
System Motor Current Draw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-142
Starter Motor Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-144
Starter Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-145
Starter Inspection and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-145
INDEX 17

SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER (BOOM AND MOUNTING PLATE)

Chapter 1 – Buckets

CONTENT

Section Description Page


82 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-2
Buckets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-2
82 100 77 Boom Lock Pins and Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-3
Boom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-3
82 100 70 Attachment Mounting Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-4
Boom and Cylinder Pivot Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-4
Boom and Cylinder Pivot Pin Location and Machine Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-4
Boom and Cylinder Pivot Pins Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-5
82 100 30 Pallet Fork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-6
82 100 20 Utility Fork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-7
82 100 12 Bucket Cutting Edge (Replacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-8
82 100 Bucket Latch Plate Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-9
82 100 Dirt Tooth Kit Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-12
Bucket Tooth Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-13
Boom Lock Pin/Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-15
82 100 77 Boom Lock Pin/Linkage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-15
Boom Lock Pin/Linkage Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-17
Boom, Upper and Lower Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-18
Boom, Upper and Lower Link Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-18
82 100 70 Front Boom Mounting Plate Pivot Hub Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-24 .
Boom, Upper and Lower Link Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-25
Attachment Mounting Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
82 100 70 Attachment Mounting Plate Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
Repair/Rebuild Mounting Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
82 100 74 Latch Lever and Pin Removal/Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
Attachment Mounting Plate Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-33
Checking Procedure for Buckets and Attachments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-38
Checking Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-40
Checking the Loader Faceplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-41
18 INDEX

SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES

Chapter 1 – Dealer Installed Options

CONTENT

Section Description Page


88 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-2
Adapting Attachments Requiring 12V Electrical Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-2
Hydraulic System Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-6
90 000 Arm Pads For Cab Side Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-8
90 000 Armrests for Deluxe Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-8
90 000 Forearm Rests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-9
55 000 Back-up Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-10
.
10 300 Block Heater (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-11
55 000 Electric Power Supply (12 Volt, 15 Amp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-13
10 254 Exhaust (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-14
10 254 Aspirator Precleaner Muffler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-14
35 000 High Flow Hydraulics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-15
High Flow Hydraulics Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-17
High Flow Hydraulics Component Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-19
High Flow Hydraulics Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-22
55 000 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-26
90 000 Shoulder Belt (Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-27
88 000 Slow-moving Vehicle (SMV) Sign Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-28
44 511 Tyres/Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-28
Tyre and Track Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-29
Bucket and Tyre Combination Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-31
55 000 Warning Light (Rotary Beacon) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-32
55 000 Warning Lights (Four-way Flashers/Turn Signal/Horn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-34
INDEX 19

SECTION 90 – PLATFORM, CAB, BODYWORK, AND DECALS

Chapter 1 – Cab and Seat

CONTENT

Section Description Page


General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-2
Seat and Seat Pan Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-2
90 152 Cab Inner Shell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-3
90 120 10 Seat Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-3
90 120 12 Seat Pan Support Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-3
Seat, Switch and Pan Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-5
Cab Inner Shell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-7
90 152 34 Cab Inner Shell Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-7
Cab Inner Shell Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-14
90 108 Safety Decals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-21
SPICER OFF-HIGHWAY
AXLE DIVISION
21199

7
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION

CONTENT

Section Description Page


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-2
About Improvements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-2
Company Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-3
Parts and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-3
Model Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-3
Precautionary Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-4
Safety Precaution Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-5
General Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-7
Machine Model and Serial Number Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-9
Engine Model and Serial Number Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-9
Hardware Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-10
Installation of Adjustable Fittings in Straight Thread O Ring Bosses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-12
Standard Torque Data for Hydraulic Tubes and Fittings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-12
Pipe Thread Fitting Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-13
Lubricants and Coolants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-13
Sealants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-13
Properly Support a Raised Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-14
Properly Support Boom on Boom Lock Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-14
Raising Boom Without Hydraulic Oil Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-14
Raising Boom Without Battery Voltage (12V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-15
Reattaching Cylinders After Repair with Boom Resting on Boom Lock Pins . . . . . . . . 00-17
Major Unit Overhaul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-18
Cab and Boom Tilt Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-19
Craning the Skid Steer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-25
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-28
Specifications (Model SL65B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-29
Dimensions (Model SL65B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 00-32
2 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

INTRODUCTION Your dealer is interested in your obtaining the most


This service manual provides the technical informa- from your investment and will be glad to answer any
tion needed to properly service and maintain the Mo- questions you may have about your skid steer. When
del SL65B skid steers. Use it in conjunction with major service is required, your dealer’s staff of
the operator’s manual which is supplied with the trained service technicians is ready to serve you.
skid steer. Keep both manuals available for ready When in need of parts, always order genuine service
reference. parts from your dealer. Be prepared to give your
The SL65B models have a two-speed hydro- dealer the model and serial number of the engine and
static motor system, which is a factory option. skid steer (the location of these numbers is described
later in this section). Record the serial numbers here.
Skid Steer Model
The SL65B skid steers are equipped with the 332T Skid Steer Serial Number
non-emissionized or the 332T/JF emissionized Engine Model
three-cylinder 60 net horsepower turbocharged en- Engine Serial Number
gine.
CAUTION
This symbol is used throughout this book whenever
your own personal safety is involved. Take time to be
Whenever working on equipment, left and right sides careful!
of the machine are determined by standing behind
the unit, looking in the direction of travel.
ABOUT IMPROVEMENTS
The easiest and least time-consuming removal, dis-
assembly, and reassembly procedure are detailed in is continually striving to improve its products. We
the manual. Modifying these procedures is not rec- must, therefore, reserve the right to make improve-
ommended. ments or changes when it becomes practical and
possible to do so, without incurring any obligation to
skid steers are designed with emphasis on safety for
make changes or additions to the equipment sold
operator protection. However, careless and negli-
previously.
gent operation can still result in serious injury to per-
sons or property. Be sure to read and follow all safety ALL SPECIFICATIONS ARE SUBJECT TO
instructions in this manual. CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE.
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 3

COMPANY POLICY
Company policy, which is one of continuous improvement, reserves the right to make changes in design and
specifications at any time without notice and without obligation to modify units previously built.
All data given in this book is subject to production variations. Dimensions and weights are approximate only and
the illustrations do not necessarily show skid steers in standard condition.

PARTS AND ACCESSORIES


Genuine parts and accessories have been specifically designed for machines.
We would like to point out that “NON GENUINE” parts and accessories have not been examined and released
by . The installation and or use of such products could have negative effects upon the design characteristics of
your machine and thereby affect its safety. is not liable for any damage caused by the use of “NON GENUINE”
parts and accessories.

MODEL CODES
The range of Skid Steers described in this manual is identified in the text by the engine horsepower Pferdestarke.
(PS). The skid steers listed below may not be available in all countries or markets.
ENGINE PS MODEL
332T/JF 60 SL65B
4 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

PRECAUTIONARY STATEMENTS DANGER


The word “DANGER” denotes a forbidden practice in
PERSONAL SAFETY connection with a serious hazard.
Throughout this manual and on machine decals, you
will find precautionary statements (“CAUTION”, Failure to follow the “CAUTION”, “WARNING”, and
“WARNING”, and “DANGER”) followed by specific “DANGER” instructions may result in serious bodily
instructions. These precautions are intended for the injury or death.
personal safety of you and those working with you.
Please take the time to read them. MACHINE SAFETY
CAUTION Additional precautionary statement “IMPORTANT”
The word “CAUTION” is used where a safe behavio- is followed by specific instructions. This statement is
ral practice according to operating and maintenance intended for machine safety.
instructions and common safety practices will protect IMPORTANT: The word “IMPORTANT” is used to in-
the operator and others from accident involvement. form the reader of something he needs to know to
prevent minor machine damage if a certain pro-
WARNING cedure is not followed.
The word “WARNING” denotes a potential or hidden
hazard which has a potential for serious injury. It is
used to warn operators and others to exercise every
appropriate means to avoid a surprise involvement
with machinery.
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 5

SAFETY PRECAUTION INFORMATION battery cable. This will shut off power to the
EIC and prevent damage to the EIC board or
CAUTION
blowing the 5-amp fuses if the board is
Unsafe operating practices and improper use of the accidentally grounded.
skid steer and its attachments on the part of the oper-
ator can result in injuries. Observe the following 16. If welding is required on the skid steer,
safety precautions at all times: disconnect the (–) negative ground cable.
1. For servicing, the skid steer should be on failure to disconnect the battery may result in
level terrain, engine stopped with the wheels damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument
blocked or the entire skid steer solidly Cluster) monitoring system and other electri-
supported with the wheels off the ground cal components.
before servicing any component of the
17. If welding is required on an attachment,
drivetrain.
remove the attachment from the skid steer.
2. For servicing under the operator’s seat, raise
18. Give complete and undivided attention to the
the seat and pan assembly up to the raised
job at hand so that complete control of the
latched position and securely latch.
skid steer is maintained at all times.
3. Do not operate the skid steer unless the seat
19. Drive slowly over rough ground and on
is latched in the operate position.
slopes; keep alert for holes, ditches and
4. Do not service the skid steer with a raised other irregularities that may cause the skid
boom unless the boom is resting on the steer to overturn.
boom lock pins.
20. Avoid steep hillside operation which could
5. Do not service the skid steer with the engine cause the skid steer to overturn.
running unless the skid steer is properly and
21. Never transport a loaded bucket at full height.
securely supported with all four wheels off
Operate the skid steer with the load as low as
the ground.
possible until it becomes necessary to raise
6. Use caution when servicing the unit around the boom to discharge the load into a truck,
moving parts. container, etc.

7. Do not tilt the boom and cab without proper 22. Reduce speed when turning so there is no
instruction. danger of the skid steer overturning.

8. Do not tilt the boom and cab without using 23. Never drive up or back up a hill or incline with
the proper cab tilting tool. a raised boom or the skid steer could over
turn.
9. Reinstall all shields removed for service.
24. Always look behind you before backing the
10. Never loosen any hydraulic connections skid steer.
before relieving the pressure in the hydraulic
system. 25. Maintain proper transmission oil level to
prevent loss of hydrostatic braking.
11. Wear eye protection such as goggles, etc.
26. Do not allow passengers to ride on the skid
12. Wear ear protection such as ear plugs, etc. steer at any time.
When you feel the noise level is uncomfort-
able. 27. Do not allow children to operate the skid
steer or ride on the skid steer at any time.
13. If any servicing or adjustments require the
battery to be disconnected, disconnect the 28. Do not allow anyone to operate the skid steer
(–) negative ground cable. without proper instruction. OSHA requires
that all operators be instructed on the proper
14. When servicing electrical components, dis- operation of the machine before they operate
connect the (–) negative ground cable. the unit.

15. If the electronic instrument cluster (EIC) 29. Do not operate the skid steer in any position
requires removal from the dash area or the other than while in the operator’s seat with
skid steer disconnect the (–) negative ground the seat belt securely fastened.
6 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

30. Before starting the engine, be sure that all 42. Never extend any part of the body outside of
operating controls are in neutral and the the operator’s area.
parking brake is engaged.
43. Always properly tie down the skid steer to a
31. Never operate the skid steer engine in a truck or trailer before transport.
closed building without adequate ventilation.
44. Make sure all bystanders are at a safe
32. Refuel the skid steer outdoors with the distance away from the skid steer before
engine shut off. Replace the fuel cap starting the engine.
securely. Use an approved fuel container. Do
not smoke when handling fuel. Avoid spilling 45. Do not allow anyone near the skid steer while
fuel. the engine is running and the skid steer is
operational.
33. After operating the engine, never touch the
muffler, exhaust pipe, engine or radiator until 46. When using the skid steer to crane objects,
they have had time to cool. do not allow any person to ride on objects
being craned.
34. Dress appropriately - wear relatively tight-fit-
ting clothing when operating the skid steer. 47. Do not use the skid steer as a work platform
Loose or torn clothing can catch in moving for supporting materials.
parts or controls.
48. Do not lift personnel or allow personnel to
35. Before servicing the skid steer or any of its work while standing in the bucket or on other
attached equipment, be sure that the attachments. This is not a man-lift.
attachments are lowered to the ground or
OSHA requirements now make it the
that the boom arms are supported by the
employer’s responsibility to fully instruct
boom lock pins.
each operator in the proper and safe
36. Do not work under overhangs, electric wires, operation of all operative equipment. Both
or where there is danger of a slide. employer and employee should thoroughly
familiarize themselves with the following
37. Wear an approved safety hat when operating sections.
the machine and while in any work area.

38. When driving the skid steer on a road or


CAUTION
highway, use warning lights or warning Some pictures in this manual show safety shields re-
devices as may be required by local or state moved or open to show parts being serviced or for
government regulations. Headlights, warn- clarity. All shields should be closed or replaced prior
ing lights and smv signs are available to operating the machine.
through your dealer.
DANGER
39. Keep the skid steer clean. do not allow trash,
debris or other articles to accumulate in the Fasten seat belt before starting engine!
cab, floor or foot control pedal area that may This skid steer is a very stable unit but it can be upset
hinder safe machine operation. if stopped suddenly when the bucket is raised and
loaded.
40. Never operate the skid steer with any of the Therefore, do not start the engine before securely
shielding removed. fastening the seat belt, and carry the load low.
41. Never operate the skid steer without win-
dows and/or screens in place.
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 7

GENERAL SAFETY INFORMATION If an accident occurs, see a doctor immediately. Any


fluid injected into the skin must be surgically removed
HANDLE FLUIDS SAFELY within a few hours or gangrene may result. Doctors
unfamiliar with this type of injury should reference a
When you work around fuel or other flammable ma- knowledgeable medical source.
terial, do not smoke, work near heaters or other fire
hazards.
AVOID HEATING NEAR PRESSURIZED FLUID
Do not store flammable material in open containers. LINES
Store flammable fluids away from fire hazards. Flammable spray can be generated by heating near
Do not incinerate or puncture pressurized con- pressurized fluid lines, resulting in severe burns to
tainers. yourself and bystanders.
Make sure machine is clean of trash, grease, oil, and Do not heat by welding, soldering, or using a torch
debris. near pressurized fluid lines.
Do not store oily rags; they can ignite and burn spon- Pressurized lines can be accidentally cut or dam-
taneously. aged when heat goes beyond the immediate flame
Keep a first aid kit and fire extinguisher handy. area.
Keep emergency numbers for doctors, ambulance
service, hospital, and fire department near your tele- USE CARE IN HANDLING AND SERVICING
phone. BATTERIES

Prevent Battery Explosions


Keep sparks, lighted matches, and open flame away
from the top of the battery. Battery gas can explode.
Never check battery charge by placing a metal object
across the posts. Use a voltmeter or hydrometer.
Do not charge a frozen battery; it may explode. Warm
the battery to 60° F (16° C).
WARNING
If any servicing or adjustments require the battery to
USE CARE AROUND HIGH-PRESSURE FLUID be disconnected, or welding is required on the skid
LINES steer, disconnect the (–) negative ground cable. Fail-
Escaping fluid under pressure can penetrate the skin ure to disconnect the battery may result in damage
causing serious injury. to the EIC (electronic instrument cluster) monitoring
Avoid the hazard by relieving pressure before dis- system and other electrical components.
connecting hydraulic or other lines.
Tighten all line connections before applying pres- WARNING
sure. If welding on an attachment is required, first remove
Check for leaks with a piece of cardboard. the attachment from the skid steer boom attaching
Protect hands and body from high-pressure fluids. plate.
8 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

WARNING move any attachment from the boom mounting plate.


If servicing requires the complete skid steer to be in
Engine starting with a booster battery requires ex-
the supported position, support all four wheels off the
treme care as batteries produce explosive gases.
ground using adequate jack stands or blocks.
The slightest spark can cause an explosion.
If servicing requires the engine to be operated, raise
Follow these safety tips:
the machine and properly support the unit with ad-
1. Always shield your eyes when charging or equate jack stands or blocking with all four wheels off
working near a battery. Always provide good the ground.
ventilation.
CAUTION
2. Cover the battery with a piece of carpet or Before servicing the skid steer or any of its attached
other heavy material. Do not remove the bat- equipment, be sure that the attachments are lowered
tery vent caps. to the ground or the boom arms are supported by the
boom lock pins.
3. Connect one cable to the (+) positive terminal
of the weak battery. Connect the other end of
the cable to the (+) positive terminal of the
stronger battery. USE PROPER TOOLS
Use tools appropriate for the job.
4. Connect the second cable to the (–) negative If tilting of the cab is required, use the proper tools
terminal of the stronger battery. and follow the procedure for tilting the cab in Section
5. Connect the remaining (–) negative cable end 1 of this manual.
to the engine block or starter ground termi-
nal. REVIEW SAFETY EQUIPMENT, SIGNS AND
SHIELDS
6. Reverse this procedure when disconnecting Replace missing or damaged safety decals.
the booster.
Reinstall all shielding removed for servicing.
Replace any damaged or missing shielding.
USE SAFE SERVICE PROCEDURES
CONTROLS
Operate unit and check machine functions for proper
Wear Protective Clothing
operation.
Do not wear loose clothing.
Check seat belt for proper operation, wear, and dam-
Wear close-fitting clothing. age - Replace as needed.
Wear safety glasses or face shield as required. Check operator restraint system - EIC for proper
Wear other safety equipment appropriate to the job. operation.
Wear earplugs or earmuffs as required. Check boom and bucket spool locks for proper oper-
ation.
SERVICE MACHINES SAFELY Check mechanical boom locks for proper operation.
Use caution when working around moving parts. Check parking brake for proper operation and adjust-
If servicing requires the boom to be in the raised posi- ment.
tion, support the boom on the boom locks and re-
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 9

MACHINE MODEL AND SERIAL NUMBER


LOCATION
The skid steer model and serial number tag is located
on the right front interior of the operator’s cab at 1.

F13724

1
ENGINE MODEL AND SERIAL NUMBER
LOCATION
The engine model is located on the left side of the
block at 1, and the engine serial number is located at
2.

2
For the tightening torques for reassembly, use the fol-
lowing hardware torque charts unless the torque is
specified in the instructions.
10 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

MINIMUM HARDWARE TIGHTENING TORQUES


IN FOOT POUNDS (NEWTON-METERS) FOR NORMAL ASSEMBLY APPLICATIONS

INCH HARDWARE AND LOCKNUTS


SAE GRADE 2 SAE GRADE 5 SAE GRADE 8 LOCKNUTS

NOMINAL UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED GR.B GR.C NOMINAL
SIZE or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr w/GR5 w/GR8 SIZE
PLATED PLATED PLATED BOLT BOLT
SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD

1/4 55* (6.2) 72* (8.1) 86* (9.7) 112* (13) 121* (14) 157* (18) 61* (6.9) 86* (9.8) 1/4
5/16 115* (13) 149* (17) 178* (20) 229* (26) 250* (28) 324* (37) 125* (14) 176* (20) 5/16
3/8 17 (23) 22 (30) 26 (35) 34 (46) 37 (50) 48 (65) 19 (26) 26 (35) 3/8
7/16 27 (37) 35 (47) 42 (57) 54 (73) 59 (80) 77 (104) 30 (41) 42 (57) 7/16
1/2 42 (57) 54 (73) 64 (87) 83 (113) 91 (123) 117 (159) 45 (61) 64 (88) 1/2
9/16 60 (81) 77 (104) 92 (125) 120 (163) 130 (176) 169 (229) 65 (88) 92 (125) 9/16
5/8 83 (112) 107 (145) 128 (174) 165 (224) 180 (244) 233 (316) 90 (122) 127 (172) 5/8
3/4 146 (198) 189 (256) 226 (306) 293 (397) 319 (432) 413 (560) 160 (217) 226 (306) 3/4
7/8 142 (193) 183 (248) 365 (495) 473 (641) 515 (698) 667 (904) 258 (350) 364 (494) 7/8
1 213 (289) 275 (373) 547 (742) 708 (960) 773 (1048) 1000 (1356) 386 (523) 545 (739) 1

NOTE: Torque values shown with * are inch pounds.


IDENTIFICATION
CAP SCREWS AND CARRIAGE BOLTS

SAE GRADE 2 SAE GRADE 5 SAE GRADE 8

REGULAR NUTS SAE GRADE 5 SAE GRADE 8


HEX NUTS HEX NUTS

LOCKNUTS

GRADE IDENTIFICATION GRADE IDENTIFICATION


GRADE A NO NOTCHES GRADE A NO MARKS
GRADE B ONE CIRCUMFERENTIAL NOTCH GRADE B THREE MARKS

GRADE C TWO CIRCUMFERENTIAL NOTCHES GRADE C SIX MARKS


MARKS NEED NOT BE LOCATED
AT CORNERS

GRADE A NO MARK
GRADE B LETTER B
GRADE C LETTER C
GRADE IDENTIFICATION
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 11

MINIMUM HARDWARE TIGHTENING TORQUES


IN FOOT POUNDS (NEWTON-METERS) FOR NORMAL ASSEMBLY APPLICATIONS

METRIC HARDWARE AND LOCKNUTS


CLASS 5.8 CLASS 8.8 CLASS 10.9 LOCKNUT
NOMINAL CL.8
SIZE UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED W/CL8.8
W/ZnCr W/ZnCr W/ZnCr BOLT

M4 15* (1.7) 19* (2.2) 23* (2.6) 30* (3.4) 33* (3.7) 42* (4.8) 16* (1.8)
M6 51* (5.8) 67* (7.6) 79* (8.9) 102* (12) 115* (13) 150* (17) 56* (6.3)
M8 124* (14) 159* (18) 195* (22) 248* (28) 274* (31) 354* (40) 133* (15)
M10 21 (28) 27 (36) 32 (43) 41 (56) 45 (61) 58 (79) 22 (30)
M12 36 (49) 46 (63) 55 (75) 72 (97) 79 (107) 102 (138) 39 (53)
M16 89 (121) 117 (158) 137 (186) 177 (240) 196 (266) 254 (344) 97 (131)
M20 175 (237) 226 (307) 277 (375) 358 (485) 383 (519) 495 (671) 195 (265)
M24 303 (411) 392 (531) 478 (648) 619 (839) 662 (897) 855 (1160) 338 (458)

NOTE: Torque values shown with * are inch pounds.


IDENTIFICATION
HEX CAP SCREW AND CARRIAGE BOLTS
CLASSES 5.6 AND UP

MANUFACTURER’S IDENTIFICATION

PROPERTY CLASS

HEX NUTS AND LOCKNUTS


CLASSES 05 AND UP

MANUFACTURER’S IDENTIFICATION

PROPERTY CLASS CLOCK MARKING


12 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

INSTALLATION OF ADJUSTABLE FIT-


TINGS IN STRAIGHT THREAD O RING
BOSSES
1. Lubricate the O ring by coating it with a light oil or
petroleum. Install the O ring in the groove adjac-
ent to the metal backup washer which is as-
sembled at the extreme end of the groove, 4.
2. Install the fitting into the SAE straight thread boss
until the metal backup washer contacts the face
of the boss, 5.
NOTE: Do not over tighten and distort the metal
backup washer.
3. Position the fitting by turning out (counterclock-
3
wise) up to a maximum of one turn. Holding the
pad of the fitting with a wrench, tighten the lock-
nut and washer against the face of the boss, 6.

STANDARD TORQUE DATA FOR HYDRAULIC TUBES AND FITTINGS


TUBE NUTS O RING BOSS PLUGS
FOR 37° FLARED FITTINGS ADJUSTABLE FITTING
LOCKNUTS, SWIVEL
JIC - 37° SEATS
TORQUE TORQUE
TUBING THREAD FOOT NEWTON FOOT NEWTON
SIZE OD SIZE POUNDS METERS POUNDS METERS
In. mm Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max.
4 1/4 6.4 7/16-20 9 12 12 16 6 10 8 14
5 5/16 7.9 1/2-20 12 15 16 20 10 15 14 20
6 3/8 9.5 9/16-18 21 24 29 33 15 20 20 27
8 1/2 12.7 3/4-18 35 40 47 54 25 30 34 41
10 5/8 15.9 7/8-14 53 53 72 79 35 40 47 54
12 3/4 19.1 1-1/16-12 77 82 104 111 60 70 81 95
14 7/8 22.2 1-3/16-12 90 100 122 136 70 80 95 109
16 1 25.4 1-5/16-12 110 120 149 163 80 90 108 122
20 1-1/4 31.8 1-5/8-12 140 150 190 204 95 115 129 158
24 1-1/2 38.1 1-7/8-12 160 175 217 237 120 140 163 190
32 2 50.8 2-1/2-12 225 240 305 325 250 300 339 407
These torques are not recommended for tubes of clean solvent or Loctite cleaner and apply hydraulic
1/2″ (12.7 mm) OD and larger with wall thickness of sealant Loctite no. 569 to the 37° flare and the
0.035″ (0.889 mm) or less. The torque is specified for threads.
0.035″ (0.889 mm) wall tubes on each application Install fitting and torque to specified torque, loosen
individually. fitting and retorque to specifications.
Before installing and torquing 37° flared fittings,
clean the face of the flare and threads with a
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 13

PIPE THREAD FITTING TORQUE Before installing and tightening pipe fittings, clean
the threads with a clean solvent or Loctite cleaner
Thread Size Torque (Maximum) and apply sealant Loctite no. 567 for all fittings includ-
1/8″ – 27 13 N⋅m (10 ft. lbs.) ing stainless steel or no. 565 for most metal fittings.
For high filtration/zero contamination systems use
1/4″ – 18 16 N⋅m (12 ft. lbs.) no. 545.
3/8″ – 14 22 N⋅m (16 ft. lbs.)
1/2″ – 14 41 N⋅m (30 ft. lbs.)
3/4″ – 14 54 N⋅m (40 ft. lbs.)

LUBRICANTS AND COOLANTS


Application Specification
Gearboxes, Final Drive chain SAE 80W 90
case
Hydraulic/Transmission API Service SH–CG4 10W-30
All lubrication fittings High viscosity lithium base grease
Engine API Service SH-CG4 10W-30
Refer to Operator’s Manual for
Temperature/Oil usage Chart
Cooling System Antitreeze/Water 50/50
Mixture (Ethylene Glycol)

SEALANTS
Description Typical Applications Strength Color
Thread Lock Small Low Purple
screws/hardware Medium Blue
Wicking Type Medium Green
Nuts & Bolts High Red
Thread Sealants Hydraulic/Pneumatic Non fouling
Pipe Sealant Controlled strength
Pipe Sealant High Temperature
Silicones Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Blue
Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Blue
Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Black
Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Black
14 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

PROPERLY SUPPORT A RAISED MACHINE


If servicing, neutral adjustment, final drive adjust-
ment or repairs require the machine to be raised, se-
curely support the machine with adequate jack
stands or blocks as shown.
Support the machine at 1, to the front of the final drive
cases and the rear at 2, making sure the supports are
on the flat area of the final drive cases.

4
PROPERLY SUPPORT BOOM ON BOOM
LOCK PINS
Before servicing the machine or any of its attached
equipment, be sure that the attachments are lowered
to the ground or the boom arms are supported by the
boom lock pins, 1.
If the boom is to be raised on boom lock pins, remove
any attachment. Opening a hydraulic line could
cause a mounted attachment to dump over unex-
pectedly.

5
RAISING BOOM WITHOUT HYDRAULIC OIL
FLOW
(Engine or Hydraulic System not functioning)
1. Remove any attachment from the boom
mounting plate.
2. Block the rear of the skid steer under the rear of
the final drive cases, 1, as shown. This will
prevent the front wheels from raising during
boom lifting.
1

19995748
6
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 15

3. Attach a fork lift or overhead hoist to the main


boom, 1, and lifting device, 2. Attach chain or
strap securely to prevent unhooking during boom
lifting.
CAUTION
Attach suitable chains or straps capable of handling
the weight of the boom, about 450 kg (1000 lbs.). At-
tach chains securely to prevent them from coming 2
loose during lifting of the boom. 1

19995749
7
4. With an Operator sitting in the Operator’s seat
with the seat belt buckled.
5. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position. Foot
controls, press the toe of the left foot pedal, boom
control, or hand controls, pivot the left hand con-
trol lever down, into the boom float position.
6. Slowly raise the boom above the boom lock pins,
1.
7. Operator sitting in seat, engage the boom lock 1
pins, 1.
8. Lower the boom and rest on the boom lock pins,
1.
19995750
9. Return the boom control to the “NEUTRAL” posi-
8
tion.
10. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
The operator must not leave the operator’s seat until
the boom is resting solidly on the boom lock pins. The
boom could drop suddenly if lifting devices should
fail.

RAISING BOOM WITHOUT BATTERY


VOLTAGE (12 VOLTS)
1. Remove any attachment from the boom mount-
ing plate.
2. Block the rear of the skid steer under the rear of
the final drive cases, 1, as shown. This will pre-
vent the front wheels from raising during boom
lifting.

19995748
9
16 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

3. Attach a fork lift or overhead hoist to the main


boom, 1, and lifting device, 2. Attach chain or
strap securely to prevent unhooking during boom
lifting.

CAUTION
Attach suitable chains or straps capable of handling
the weight of the boom, about 450 kg (1000 lbs.). At- 2
tach chains securely to prevent them from coming
loose during lifting of the boom. 1

19995749
10
4. Remove the rod end (top) pivot pins, 1, from both
cylinders. Remove retaining hardware, 2, from
pivot pin and boom.

2 1

19995751
11
5. Support the cylinders on the fenders, 1, as
shown.

1
19995752
12
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 17

6. With an Operator sitting in the Operator’s seat


with the seat belt buckled.
7. Slowly raise the boom above the boom lock pins,
1.
8. Operator sitting in seat, engage the boom lock
pins, 1.
9. Lower the boom and rest on the boom lock pins,
1.
CAUTION 1
The operator must not leave the operator’s seat until
the boom is resting solidly on the boom lock pins. The
boom could drop suddenly if lifting devices should 19995753
fail. 13

REATTACHING CYLINDERS AFTER


REPAIR WITH BOOM RESTING ON BOOM
LOCK PINS
1. Support the rod end of cylinders, 1, off the boom
upper links, 2, to align with main boom cylinder 3
pivot pin holes, 3.
2

1
19995754
14
2. Operator sitting in the Operator’s seat with seat
belt buckled.
3. Start the engine and hydraulically extend cylin-
der rods to align cylinder with pivot pin, 1. Stop
engine. 1
4. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position. Foot
controls, press the toe of the left foot pedal, boom
control, or hand controls, pivot the left hand con-
trol lever down, into the boom float position, turn
the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
5. If cylinder and boom are not properly aligned, use
a pry bar to align cylinder and boom.
19995755
15
18 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

6. Install pivot pin, 1, and secure with retaining


hardware, 2. Torque bolts to 38 Nm (28 ft. lbs.).
7. Start the engine and hydraulically extend the 1
second cylinder rod to align cylinder with pivot
pin. Stop engine.
8. If cylinder and boom are not properly aligned, sit
2
in the operator’s seat with seat buckled, turn the
ignition key to the “ON” position.
9. Move the boom control to the “DETENT (float)
position and turn the ignition key to the “OFF”
position.
10. Use a pry bar and align cylinder with boom and
install pivot pin, 1, and retaining hardware, 2, and 19995756
torque to 38 Nm (28 ft. lbs.). 16
MAJOR UNIT OVERHAUL
For a major hydrostatic component or engine repair,
the skid steer cab and boom assembly can be tilted
forward for easier access to the components area.
The skid steer is shown properly supported at 1, and
the cab tilted forward.
WARNING
Never attempt to tilt the skid steer cab without using
the proper tool and instructions. See more detail later
in this section of the manual and/or contact your
dealer.

17
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 19

CAB AND BOOM TILT PROCEDURE


The cab and boom assembly can be tilted forward for
easier access to the major skid steer hydrostatic
transmission or engine components. To tilt the cab,
the proper cab tilting tool must be used to insure a
safe operation and to prevent damage to theskid
steer frame, cab, and boom structure. Contact your
dealer for major service or repairs of the skid steer.
Using the proper cab tilting tool and following these
steps, the cab and boom can be tilted forward.
Cab Tilting Jack and Support Bracket
1 Jack and screw assembly
2 Lower jack support
3 Upper jack support 18
4 Spacer plate (not required)
1. Remove any attachment, bucket etc. from the
boom quick-attach plate.

3462-07r

19
2. Raise the boom and lower onto boom lockpins,
1.
– Raise boom above boom lockpins.
– Engage boom lockpins. 1
– Stop engine, turn ignition key to “OFF” posi-
tion.
– Turn ignition key to the “ON” position. 1
– Lower boom onto boom lockpins.
– Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.

3170-04
20
20 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

3. Jack up the skid steer and block it securely with


all four wheels off the ground, as shown. Position
the front blocks to the front of the final drive hous-
ings and the rear blocks to the rear of the flat area
of the final drive housing
WARNING
Never attempt to tilt the skid steer cab over unless the
skid steer is securely supported.

3410-15
21
4. Open the rear door, 1, raise and latch the top en-
gine shield, 2, in the raised position. 5
5. Remove engine side covers, 3. 2 1
3
6. Remove fenders, 4, rear fender supports, 6, right
and left sides.
7. Remove foam material, 5, from both sides.

4
6 3
19984624
22
8. Disconnect the battery, negative(-) cable, 1.

3171-08
23
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 21

9. Remove support rod hardware at 1. Remove air


cleaner canister support hardware at 2.
1

A5378-15
24
10. Allow the air cleaner canister assembly to rest on
the engine as shown at 1.
NOTE: If the unit is equipped with the cab heater, the
water supply lines to the heater core must be discon-
nected and capped.

1
A5378-14
25
11. Raise the seat and lock in the up position, 1.
Make sure the seat pan assembly is latched se-
curely.
12. Remove the front step shield, 2.
1
2

3409-16
26
22 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

13. Remove the cotter pins from the parking brake


linkage, unhook link rod, 1, and raise the parking
brake lever to the engaged position.

3410-03
27
14. Install the lower cab jack support, 1. Hook the
support over the end of the front left final drive
housing at and attach with a 1/2″ x 8″ cap screw, 2
2.
2

2541-07r
28
15. Install the upper cab jack support, 1. Pivot the re-
taining plate, 3, up behind the boom top link and 1
secure with 1/2″ x 1-1/4″ carriage bolt and 1/2″
wing nut. Install retaining bolt, 4, 1/2″ x 2-1/2″ cap
screw through side of cab with a large 1/2″ flat 3
washer, 1/2″ wing nut to the inside of cab and
tighten.
NOTE: Spacer, 2, is not required for the SL65B skid
steers.
4
2

3409-13
29
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 23

16. Install the jack assembly, 1, between the upper


and lower supports using two pins and retaining
clips.
1

2
3
3410-02
17. Loosen the front cab mounting bolts, 2, (one 30
each side) only enough to allow the bolt to rotate
in post and remove the rear front cab bolts, 3, one
each side.
CAUTION
Never remove the front cab bolts, 2, as these are the
pivot bolts during the cab tilting procedure. Removal
of these bolts could cause cab to fall, and may cause
injury and machine damage.

18. Remove the rear cab post bolts, 1, four each


side.
NOTE: If the rear bolts, 1, have spacers under the 1
bolt heads at 2, they must be reinstalled during reas- 1
sembly for proper bolt torquing.
CAUTION
Never loosen or remove any cab retaining hardware
before the jack assembly is installed.

2 2

19984332
31
19. Jack cab and boom assembly over with the
loader properly supported off the ground. Sup-
port the boom at 1, to support the boom and cab
to prevent tipping of the skid steer when heavy
components, engine, hydrostatic pumps etc. are
removed from the lower frame. Jack travel will
limit the travel of the cab assembly to prevent
over travel. Be sure all wire harnesses, hydraulic
hoses, and throttle cable clear any obstructions
during cab tilting.
1

3410-07
32
24 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

To return and secure the cab and boom assembly


safely, do the following:
3
1. Pull the hydrostat control handles forward and
hold in this position with rubber tie straps from the
handle to the front cab post.
2. Jack the cab and boom back into position.
3. Keep the wire harness, 1, and throttle cable, 2, in
position to prevent damage from setting the cab 1
on them.
CAUTION
Keep the wire harness from being damaged. A Dam-
aged wire harness could result in damage to the skid
2
3410-04
steer electrical components. 33

4. Pull the wire harness through the loop, 3.


5. Remove rubber tie straps from the hydrostatic
control handles.
6. Reinstall all cab support bolts front and rear.
NOTE: If spacers were installed under the rear cab
support bolts, 1, the spacers, 2, must be reinstalled 1
for proper torquing. 11
– Torque the rear bolts, 1, to 80 ft. lbs. (108
N·m), four bolts each side.
7. Reinstall the parking brake linkage, 2.
8. Position the throttle cable, 3, inside frame.

2 2

19984332
34
9. Torque the front bolts, 1, to 160 ft. lbs. (217 N·m).
10. Reinstall the foam, 2, fenders, 3, and front step
shield, 4.
WARNING
Never attempt to tilt the skid steer cab without proper 2
instructions and using the proper tool. See the ser-
vice manual and/or your dealer. 4
Never attempt to operate or move the skid steer with-
out first installing and properly tightening all cab re- 1
taining hardware.
1 3
CAUTION 3410-15
Reinstall all shields that were removed for servicing 35
and adjustment procedures.
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 25

11. Reattach the air cleaner canister to the ROPS


post at 2, and the support rod at 1.
IMPORTANT: Support the air cleaner assembly level 1
and tighten all attaching hardware.
12. Remove jack and supports. 2
13. Reconnect the battery cable.

36
CRANING THE SKID STEER
If the skid steer is inoperative and located in an area
where it cannot be loaded onto a truck or trailer, the
unit may be craned to load the unit.
To crane the loader, only use chain or cable with a
rated capacity to handle the weight of the model skid
steer being craned. Refer to the “Specifications” sec-
tion of the operator’s manual for the operating weight
of the model loader being craned. Use three chains,
minimum of 12′ (3.66 m) long, to prevent sharp
angles and damage to the loader cab, boom, and
lifting chains.

37
Remove any attachment except a standard bucket
from the loader boom attaching plate.
CAUTION
Do not lift any attachments on the loader mounting
plate that weigh 600 lbs. (272 kg) or more. lift such
attachments separately.

38
26 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

The rear lifting points are at the outside corners of the


loader, 1.

39
The front lifting point is located in the center of the
main frame, 1.

40
The lifting chains or cables must be minimum, 12′
(3.66 m). The lifting hook point must be minimum of
75″ (1.9 m) above the cab, 1, to prevent the chains
or cables from damaging the loader frame or cab.
WARNING
Always use properly rated lifting devices to prevent
personal injury or damage to the loader.

41
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 27

CAUTION
When craning (lifting or lowering) a skid steer, follow
these precautions: 6. Do not attach lifting devices to the loader
1. No riders (including the operator) in or on the boom or attachments attached to the boom
machine while lifting or lowering. mounting plate.

2. Do not lift any attachments on the loader 7. Make sure the loader boom is in the
boom mounting plate that weigh 600 lbs. (272 completely lowered position.
kg) or more. Lift such attachments separate-
8. Make sure that any attachment to be lifted on
ly.
the skid steer is securely fastened to the
3. Always use a chain, cable, etc. capable of loader boom mounting plate with the
safely hoisting the weight of the skid steer. over-center handles and pins fully engaged.
Pivot the attachment fully back.
4. Before hoisting the skid steer, always inspect
the lifting chain, cable, etc. and the lifting 9. Make sure that the engine is off and the
points on the main frame, to insure they are parking brake is engaged before lifting.
in good condition. if worn or damaged, do not
10. Keep bystanders away from the machine a
use.
safe distance while lifting.
5. Do not lift the skid steer with any frame-
mounted attachments such as a backhoe or
rear stabilizers.
28 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Number Order From Description SL65B
86590084 Cab Tilting Tool ***

Engine
FNH02136 OTC Valve Guide Ream kit *
FNH01301 OTC Rear Crank Shaft Seal Installer ***
FNH01442 OTC Cam Shaft Bearing Installation *
Tool and Handle
FNH01255
FNH09539 OTC Cam Shaft pulley, puller and *
FNH09212 OTC shaft protector
FNH09539 is also used to
remove water pump pulley
FNH02134 OTC Crank shaft timing gear puller *
FNH01237 OTC and adapter

FNH09210 OTC Front timing cover seal installer ***


FNH04572 OTC Water pump seal installation tool *
FNH08124 OTC Injector cleaner *

Hydraulic System
238 Bar (3500 Psi) Test Gauge OTC Main system pressure ***
Flow meter OTC Main system/Hydrostatic pumps ***
3/4″ –16 UNF Oring fitting Local Main system at Boom cylinder ***
1/2″ Quick coupler Main system at Auxiliary boom *
couplers
FNH22ESS95 OTC Hydraulic tank pressuring tool *
*Recommend Tool
***Essential Tool
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 29

SPECIFICATIONS
MODEL SL65B

MANUFACTURER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NEW HOLLAND


MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332T/JF Emissionized
CYLINDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
ASPIRATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TURBOCHARGED
CYCLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Stroke
BORE AND STROKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4″ X 4.2″(112x106.7)
DISPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 cu.in. (3.15L)
COMPRESSION RATIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.5 to 1
SPEEDS
-FAST (no load) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2350 to 2400 RPM
-IDLE (no load) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1000 to 1050 RPM
HORSEPOWER
(GROSS) MFG rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 @ 2200 RPM
(SAE NET) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 @ 2200 RPM
TORQUE (Mfg, rating) Gross . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 ft. lbs. (253 N·m)@1400RPM
VALVE CLEARANCE
Intake (cold). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.016″ (0.40 mm)
Exhaust (cold). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.017″ - 0.021″(0.43 - 0.53mm)
FIRING ORDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2-3
FUEL CONSUMPTION
(approximate at continuous full load) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 LPH (3.7 US. GPH)
IGNITION TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Compression
GRADEABILITY (Intermittent duty)
Left . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30°
Right . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30°
Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20°
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28°
FUEL SYSTEM
Type of fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diesel
Injector type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Direct
Cleaning system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Filter with water trap (DIESEL)
OIL TYPES - ENGINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . API SH/CG-4 SAE 10W-30
30 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

MODEL SL65B

CAPACITIES
Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5 US. qt. (14.7 L)
Cooling system pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . radiator cap 13 psi (89.5 kpa)
Engine crankcase w/filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 US. qt. (6.6L)
Fuel tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 US. Gal. (68 L)
Hydraulic system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3 US. Gal. (42.6 L)
Engine gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 US. qt. (1.32 L)
Common gearbox and final drive chain case (ea.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6 US. qt. (9.1 L)
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BCI PC31 - 12V 925 amps @ 0° F (-18° C)
Alternator capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 amps
Starter switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key start and relay
Ignition system protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuse 15 amps
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Pump - Make or type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gear pump
Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.5 US. GPM (70 LPM) @2350 RPM @1000 PSI (68 bar)
Optional high flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32.3 US. GPM (122.8 LPM) @ 2350 RPM @ 1000 PSI (68 bar)
Hydraulic system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3 US. gal. (42.6 L)
Hydraulic fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . API Service SH/CG4 10W-30
Control valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Spool Open Center
Main system relief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2500 PSI - 2600 PSI (170 - 176 bar)
Circuit relief - boom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3500 PSI (238 bar)
BOOM CYLINDERS
Double-acting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5″(6.4cm) Bore; 24.06″(61.1cm) Stroke
Raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 seconds
Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 seconds
BUCKET CYLINDERS
Double-acting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5″ (6.4 cm) Bore
Cycle time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6″(44.7cm) Stroke
Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 seconds
Curl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8 seconds
HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSIONS
Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable displacement piston type
Motor (with single speed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed displacement piston type
Motor (with 2-speed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable displacement piston type
Charge pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 - 300 PSI (17 - 20.4 bar)
Relief pressure (transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5000 PSI (344.7 bar)
Oil type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SAE 10W-30 API SH/CG4
TRAVEL SPEEDS - 12.00 X 16.5 Tyres
Low range - MAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2 MPH (11.6 KPH)
SL65B equipped with factory 2-speed
High range - MAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.4 MPH (18.3 KPH)
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 31

MODEL SL65B

TYRE SIZES AND INFLATION


Tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tyre Pressure
8.25 X 15 - CHEVRON TREAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 PSI (345 kPa)
8.25 X 15 - HST-HOLLOW SEGMENTED TYRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
12.00 X 16.5 - R4 CLEAT TREAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 X 16.5 HD 2000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 X 16.5 - HST-HOLLOW SEGMENTED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . N/A
BASIC WEIGHT
With 72″ (cm) Dirt & Foundry bucket, 175-lb. (79kg) operator, full fuel tank, battery, and 12.00 X 16.5 tyres
SL65B single speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7193 lbs. (3263 kg)
SL65B 2-speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7223 lbs. (3276 kg)
OPERATING CAPACITY
SAE Operating load capacity per SAE J732, J818, J742 Standard.
SL65B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2200 lbs. (999.9 kg) (Mfg. Rating)
2555 lbs. (1158.9 kg) (SAE Rating)*
*SAE Operating load rating Per J818 Specifications.
32 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1

42
DIMENSIONS - SL65B WITH 72, DIRT AND FOUNDRY BUCKET AND 12 X 16.5 TYRES - IN. (CM)

1 - OVERALL WIDTH w/BUCKET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71.7″ (182.1 cm)


2 - TURNING RADIUS - FRONT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82.75″ (210.2 cm)
3 - TURNING RADIUS - REAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.25″ (175.9 cm)
4 - WHEEL TREAD w/12 X 16.5 TYRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58.3″ (148.1 cm)
5 - OVERALL WIDTH w/12 X 16.5 TYRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73.2″ (185.9 cm)
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 33

43
DIMENSIONS - SL65B WITH 72, DIRT AND FOUNDRY BUCKET AND12 X 16.5 TYRES - IN. (CM)

1 - MAXIMUM OPERATING HEIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150.9″ (3083.3 cm)


2 - HEIGHT TO HINGE PIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124.6″ (316.5 cm)
3 - DUMP HEIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99.9″ (253.8 cm)
4 - DUMP ANGLE (MAX.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45.2°
5 - ROLLBACK FULLY RAISED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74.5°
6 - BOOM REACH TO PIVOT PIN (At max. reach) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.75″ (45.09 cm)
7 - DUMP REACH @ MAXIMUM HEIGHT @ 45 ANGLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32.5″ (82.6 cm)
DUMP REACH @ MAXIMUM REACH @ 45 ANGLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32.5″ (82.6 cm)
8 - OVERALL HEIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77″ (195.6 cm)
9 - ANGLE OF DEPARTURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28.4°
10- GROUND CLEARANCE
(CHAIN CASE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8″ (20.3 cm)
(BELLY PAN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.4″ (23.9 cm)
11- WHEELBASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47.8″ (121.4 cm)
12- OVERALL LENGTH LESS BUCKET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116.1″ (294.9 cm)
13- OVERALL LENGTH w/BUCKET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141″ (358.1 cm)
14- ROLL BACK ANGLE (BOOM DOWN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.4°
34 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 10 – ENGINE

Chapter 1 – SL65B - 332T/JF


CONTENT

Section Description Page


10 000 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
SL65B Engine Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Engine Model and Serial Number Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
General Engine Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
General Engine Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10
Specifications Service Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-19
Hardware Torque Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-26
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-27
Turbocharger Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28
Engine Electrical Components - SL65B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29
10 001 10 Engine Removal By Tilting Cab and Boom Forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30
10 001 20 Mounting the Engine for Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
10 001 53 Engine Disassembly Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-35
Engine Component Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36
Cylinder Block, Pistons, Rings, Rods and Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-45
Crankshaft, Main Bearings, and Flywheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-53
Camshaft and Timing Gear Train . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-59
Timing Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-62
Engine Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-66
10 400 Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70
10 402 30 Thermostat Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-71
10 402 10 Water Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-72
10 304 Lubrication System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77
10 102 10 Oil Pan Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-77
10 304 34 Oil Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-78
10 304 06 Oil Level Dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-81
Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82
10 210 21 Electric Lift Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-82
10 218 34 Injectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90
10 218 34 Fuel Injector Overhaul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-92
10 210 21 Electric Lift Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-95
10 216 10 Fuel Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-97
2 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Air Intake and Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100


Exhaust Muffler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-102
Turbocharger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-103
Starting a Turbochargepd Engine After Installation of a Turbocharger . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-112
Engine Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-113
Operating the Engine After Overhaul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-116
Electrical Component Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-117
Adjust Belt Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-118
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-119
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 3

Chapter 1 – SL65B - 332T/JF

Op. 10 000
Keep away from parts which turn during operation.
INTRODUCTION Note that fans cannot be seen clearly while the en-
gine is running.
This engine section has two parts to cover the two en-
gines. Refer to the chapter that pertains to the engine Do not run the engine with any safety guards re-
being serviced. moved.
Chapter 1 - SL65B 332T/JF engine (3-cylinder, Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine is
turbocharged) hot and the coolant is under pressure, as dangerous
hot coolant can be discharged.
Do not use salt water in the fresh water cooling sys-
tem or any other coolant which can cause corrosion.
Keep sparks or fire away from batteries (especially
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS during charge) or combustion can occur. The battery
CAUTION fluid can burn and is also dangerous to the skin and
Do not change the specification of the engine. especially the eyes.
Do not smoke when you put fuel in the tank. Disconnect the battery terminals before you make a
repair to the electrical system.
Clean away any fuel which has spilled and move ma-
terial which has fuel contamination to a safe place. Only one person must be in control of the engine.
Do not put fuel in the tank during engine operation Ensure the engine is only operated from the control
(unless absolutely necessary). panel or operator’s position.
Never clean, lubricate, or adjust the engine during If your skin comes into contact with high-pressure
operation (unless you have had the correct training fuel, get medical assistance immediately.
when extreme caution must be used to prevent in- Diesel fuel and used engine oils can cause skin dam-
jury). age to some persons. Use protection on the hands
Do not make any adjustments you do not under- (gloves or special skin protection solutions).
stand. Do not move equipment unless the brakes are in
Ensure the engine is not in a position to cause a con- good condition.
centration of toxic emissions. Ensure that the transmission drive control is in neu-
Persons in the area must be kept clear during engine tral position before the engine is started.
and equipment or vehicle operation. Do not use ether to start the engine.
Do not permit loose clothing or long hair near parts
which move.
4 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

SL65B ENGINE SERVICE

GENERAL ENGINE INFORMATION

ENGINE DESCRIPTION
The LS180 skid steer is equipped with a 332T/JF,
turbocharged diesel engine, 60 SAE net HP, 192
cubic inch displacement.
The 332T/JF series is a three-cylinder, four-stroke,
liquid-cooled and turbocharged diesel engine, de-
signed to provide fuel efficiency, quiet operation, and
durable performance. The engine features cross flow
cylinder heads with the inlet and exhaust manifolds
on opposite sides of the head. The combustion
chamber is formed in the crown of the piston. The pis-
ton has three compression rings and one oil control
ring, all located above the piston pin. The cylinder
head assembly incorporates the valves, valve
springs, and spring retainers. Valve guides are an
integral part of the cylinder head with replaceable
valve seats pressed into the valve ports.
ENGINE MODEL AND SERIAL NUMBER
LOCATION
The engine model number, serial number, date of
manufacture, and other important information are lo-
cated on the nameplate on the rear of the engine
valve cover.

19995962
1
CYLINDER HEAD AND VALVES
The cylinder head casting contains the following de-
tail:
Larger inlet ports, 2, feature a snail shell form
which swirls inducted air, improving the air/fuel
mixing and the resultant quality of combustion.
This design contributes to performance and fuel
efficiency.
The inlet valves, 4, and valve seats have a 29.5°
face angle and a 30° seat angle, respectively.
The exhaust valves and valve seats have a 44.5°
face angle and a 45° seat angle, respectively.
The turbocharged engine incorporates heavy-
duty rocker shafts. 2
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 5

3
CYLINDER BLOCK
The cylinder block of the turbocharged engine con-
tains oil jets, 1, fed from the main bearing journals to
provide under piston cooling and additional lubrica-
tion.

1
5

3 6

4 7

4
PISTONS AND CONNECTING RODS the combustion bowl. This configuration aids the
Effective with engine serial number 532563, a piston swirl of the incoming air from the cylinder head, im-
change was made. The early piston is fitted with proving fuel/air mixing.
three compression rings, 1, 2, and 3, and oil control The connecting rods are machined from high-
ring, 4, with expander. The later piston is fitted with strength forged steel. The big end bearings are re-
a keystone top compression ring, 5; a second com- newable, steel-backed, copper/lead alloy overlay
pression ring, 6; and an oil control ring, 7, with expan- with tin plating. The small end bearings are a press
der. Both pistons are of the “Mexican Hat” type, so fit plain bush of tin-backed lead/bronze.
called because of the raised section in the middle of
6 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

CRANKSHAFT AND MAIN BEARINGS The timing gears are lubricated by oil from the cam
The crankshaft is a chrome-molybdenum steel forg- follower chamber and the pressure lubricated cam-
ing, fully machined, static, and dynamically balanced shaft drive gear bushing.
with integral counterweights. All bearing surfaces are Cylinder walls, pistons, and piston pins are splash lu-
induction hardened. Axial location is maintained by bricated by the connecting rods and rotating crank-
thrust washers. The main journals run in replaceable shaft as well as by oil jets fed from the main bearing
steel-backed cast copper/lead alloy bearings. The journals.
front of the crankshaft is keyed. An intermittent flow of oil is directed to the valve
rocker arm shaft assembly via a drilled passage in
CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEAR TRAIN the cylinder block located vertically above the No. 1
The camshaft is made of forged steel and is induction camshaft bearing. This drilling aligns with a corre-
hardened. Friction bearings support the camshaft. sponding hole in the cylinder head. As the camshaft
The camshaft is lubricated by oil pressure from the turns, holes in the camshaft and camshaft bearing
main oil gallery. align and a regulated stream of oil is directed to the
cylinder head and on up the rocker arm shaft support
The timing gear train consists of three helical gears;
bolt to the rocker shaft. The oil flows from the shaft
the crankshaft gear (located by a woodruff key), the
through drilled holes in each rocker arm bushing to
idler gear, and the camshaft gear.
lubricate both ends of the arms. Excess oil flows
down the pushrods and assists in lubricating the cam
LUBRICATION SYSTEM followers before draining back into the pan through
Lubrication of the engine is maintained by a rotor- cored openings in the block.
type oil pump mounted at the base of the engine
block. The oil pump is driven from the camshaft and COOLING SYSTEM
draws oil from the engine sump through a wire mesh
A belt-driven centrifugal water pump circulates cool-
screen.
ant via the internal water passages. The coolant is
A spring-loaded relief valve in the pump body limits radiator-cooled and temperature controlled by a con-
the pressure in the system by directing excess oil ventional thermostat.
back to the intake side of the pump.
Oil passes from the pump to an external, throw-away, AIR INTAKE AND EXHAUST SYSTEM
spin on type filter incorporating a relief valve which
The air intake manifold is located on the left side of
permits oil to be bypassed if filter blockage occurs;
the engine. Its unique design provides accurate
therefore ensuring engine lubrication at all times.
alignment with the cylinder head ports, resulting in
Oil flows from the filter to the main oil gallery which maximum engine performance. The exhaust mani-
runs the length of the cylinder block and intersects fold, located on the right side of the engine, houses
the camshaft follower chambers. the turbocharger and muffler system.
The main gallery also supplies oil to the crankshaft
main bearings and to the connecting rod journals via FUEL SYSTEM
drillings in the crankshaft. Drilled passages from
A flange-mounted, Lucas CAV DP200 Series (em-
each main bearing direct oil to the camshaft bear-
missionized) fuel injection pump is mounted to the
ings.
cylinder block front thrust plate. The pump is oper-
The camshaft drive gear bushing is pressure lubri- ated by three helical gears; the crankshaft gear, idler
cated through a drilled passage from the front main gear, and the injection pump drive gear.
bearing. The gear has small oil passages machined
on both sides which allow the oil to escape.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 7

TURBOCHARGER Starting a turbocharged engine after an exten-


A turbocharged engine requires careful attention for sive period of non-use (four weeks or more).
proper operation. 1. Disconnect the electrical wire at the fuel injection
Normal everyday start-up and shutdown of a pump fuel shut off solenoid. Crank the engine
turbocharged engine: until oil pressure rises. Do not operate the starter
motor continuously more than 30 seconds. Allow
1. Set engine speed control at 1/3 to 1/2 position.
it to cool two minutes between attempts.
2. Start the engine and allow the engine to warm up
2. Reconnect the wire at the fuel shut off solenoid.
for one minute at approximately 1,000 RPM.
Start the engine and allow it to idle for one minute
NOTE: When temperatures are below freezing (three minutes in freezing weather).
(32F, 0C), do not exceed 1,500 RPM during the first
IMPORTANT: On every start-up, allow the engine to
three minutes after starting.
idle at approximately 1,000 RPM (1500 RPM max.)
3. After full-speed operation, run the engine at low for 60 seconds before operating at full load. After full-
idle speed for one minute before shutdown. load operation, operate the engine at low idle speed
for one minute (minimum) before shutdown.
8 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

GENERAL ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS - SL65B


Model SL65B

Engine Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332T/JF


Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-cylinder, 4-stroke, turbocharged diesel
Bore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111.8 mm (4.40″)
Stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106.7 mm (4.20″)
Displacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 L (192 cu. in.)
Compression Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.5:1
Firing Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 2 - 3
Horsepower
(Gross) MFG rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 @ 2200 RPM
(SAE NET) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 @ 2200 RPM
Torque
(Gross) MFG rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 N·m (187 ft. lbs.) @1400 RPM
Ignition Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Compression
Injection Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Distributor Type
Injection Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4235 - 4350 psi (292 - 300 bar)
Speeds
Fast (no load) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2350 to 2400 RPM
Idle (no load) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1050 to 1100 RPM
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Liquid with water pump and radiator
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.7 L (15.5 US. qt.)
Lubricating System
Oil Capacity (including filter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 L (6 US. qt.)
Electrical System
Starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12V
Alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12V, 45 amps
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12V, 925 amps @ - 18°C (0°F)
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 9

Model SL65B

Thermostat
Opening Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76°C (168°F)
Recommended Engine Fluids
Lubricating Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SAE 10W - 30 API SH/CG4
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Use clean, quality No. 1-D or No. 2-D fuel (ASTM D975).
Use No. 1-D if the ambient temperature is expected to be less
than 4°C (40°F) or if the loader is to be used at an altitude
exceeding 1524 m (5000′).
The sulfur content of the fuel should be no more than 0.5%.
The sediment and water content should not exceed 0.5%.
To prevent fuel flow problems in cold weather, use No. 1 - 2 diesel
fuel with a pour point of at least 10°F below the expected ambient
temperature.
Minimum cetane number is 40. Lower temperature or high
altitude operation may require the use of fuel with a higher cetane
number.
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . Clean soft water. Maximum antifreeze concentration 50% with 5% corrosion inhibitor
10 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

TROUBLESHOOTING - SL65B

ENGINE SYSTEM
PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION
Engine will crank but does not Faulty key switch Correct the connection and/or
start replace switch
Blown 5-amp electronic ignition Replace fuse
fuse (cab fuse panel)
Fuel solenoid not operating Check solenoid for battery voltage
and correct
Insufficient charging or complete Charge or replace battery
discharging of the battery
Lack of fuel Supply fuel
Air mixed in the fuel system Bleed the air
Clogged fuel filter Replace
Irregular and faulty fuel supply Repair in an authorized service
(injection pump trouble) shop
Improper viscosity of the Inspect and replace
lubricating oil
Clogged air cleaner Clean or replace
No compression Overhaul engine

Engine will not crank or start Seat belt not fastened Buckle seat belt
Faulty key switch Correct the connection or replace
the switch
Insufficient charging or complete Charge or replace battery
discharging of the battery
Blown 5-amp electronic battery Replace fuse
fuse (engine fuse panel)
Blown 15-amp key main fuse Replace fuse
(engine fuse panel)

Engine runs erratically Air mixed in the fuel system Bleed the air from the system
Uneven fuel injection (faulty fuel Repair at authorized shop
injection pump)
Clogged fuel filter Replace
Defective governor Check and correct
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 11

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Engine stops during operation EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Check and repair hydrostatic
shows fault with hydrostatic charge charge pressure
pressure
EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Check oil level and/or repair
shows fault with engine crankcase engine crankcase oil pressure
oil pressure
Lack of fuel in the tank Supply fuel and bleed air
Clogged fuel filter Replace
Air mixed in the fuel system Bleed the air
Faulty function of the engine Repair in a service shop

Engine overheats Lack of cooling water Supply water, inspect for leakage
and correct
Loose or slipping fan belt Remove oil, dust, etc. and tighten

Damaged fan belt Replace


Clogged radiator Flush the radiator
Clogged radiator fins Clean
Dust or scale clogged in the Flush the system
cooling water passage
Faulty thermostat Inspect or replace thermostat
Lack of lubricating oil Add oil
Overloading Decrease the load

Exhaust (white or blue) Excess engine oil Inspect and correct the level
smoke
Engine oil viscosity too low Inspect and replace the oil to
correct one
Faulty injection timing Too late: correct

Incorrect fuel grade Inspect and replace to correct


Exhaust dark grey smoke grade
Excessive injection Inspect and adjust (in a service
shop)
Overloading Reduce the load
Clogged air cleaner Clean

Broken lamp Replace lamp


Oil pressure lamp not turned
on (key switch “ON” with Broken wire between battery to the Correct it
engine not started) lamp
12 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Oil pressure lamp not turned Lack of engine oil Supply oil up to the specified level
off
Fault in the pressure switch Replace the switch
Oil leakage from the lubricating Inspect and retighten
system
Short-circuit between oil pressure Repair
lamp and pressure switch

Engine knocks Diluted or thin oil Drain and refill with specified oil
and replace filter. Determine
cause of dilution
Insufficient oil supply Check oil level and replenish as
necessary. Overhaul or replace
pump as necessary. Check that
oil pump filter is not clogged
Low engine oil pressure Overhaul pump or relief valve as
necessary
Excessive crankshaft end play Install new thrust bearing liner
Excessive flywheel or ring gear Skim flywheel or fit new ring gear
run-out
Excessive connecting rod or main Install new bearing inserts
bearing clearance
Bent or twisted connecting rods Replace connecting rods
Crankshaft journals out-of-round Grind crankshaft and fit undersize
bearing inserts
Excessive piston-to-cylinder bore Bore engine block and fit new
clearance pistons
Excessive piston ring clearance Fit new piston rings
Broken rings Fit new rings. Check bores and
pistons for damage
Excessive piston pin clearance Fit new piston pin and bushing
Piston pin retainer loose or Install new retainer. Check bore
missing and pistons for damage
Install new thrust plate
Excessive camshaft end play
Replace timing gear
Imperfections on timing gear teeth
Replace timing gear
Excessive timing gear backlash
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 13

AIR INTAKE SYSTEM - TURBOCHARGER


PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION
Turbocharger is sluggish in The sealed part of turbine wheel is Change oil (engine oil)
picking up speed heavily carboned, causing the
rotor to resist turning. Disassemble and clean
Incomplete fuel combustion due to Disassemble and clean
a faulty condition in the fuel
injection system. Check the injection system for
cause, and repair.

Excessive or abnormal A loose pipe connection at the Tighten and repair


vibration turbine or blower side or at the
bearing
Bearing failure causing the rotor to Disassemble and repair
run rough.
Turbine wheel or blower wheel has Disassemble and repair damaged
broken vanes caused by entry of parts
foreign objects
Loss of dynamic balance in the Disassemble and repair damaged
rotor parts

Dirty exhaust smoke A clogged element in the air


Not enough intake air cleaner, clean or replace element
Restricted air intake inlet. Open
inlet
Air leakage from a connection,
between turbocharger and intake
manifold. Check and repair
Gum or sludge formation in the
The turbocharger is not running turbine-side seal, causing the
freely turbocharger to resist turning,
Check the oil quality and change
Disassemble and clean
Seized bearings, disassemble
and clean
Disassemble and repair
Oil temperature too high, change
engine oil
Dynamic imbalance in the rotor,
clean and/or replace rotor parts
Turbine wheel or blower wheel
rubbing or broken. Disassemble
and repair (remove foreign
matter, if any, and check air
cleaner and engine to locate the
cause).
14 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Dirty exhaust smoke, (Cont.) Not enough exhaust gas pressure Gas leakage through a
connection on upstream side of
turbine. Check and repair
A large constriction in the exhaust
line, due to distorted gas
passages. Check and repair

White exhaust smoke Oil return pipe is clogged or Repair or replace the pipe
distorted, causing the lube oil to
leak into turbine and blower
Seal rings are abnormally worn or Disassemble and repair
broken due to worn-down bearings

Abnormally high oil Seal rings worn or broken due to


consumption worn bearings Disassemble and repair

Engine lacks output power Gas leakage in the exhaust line Check and repair
Air leakage in the blower outlet Check and repair
side, resulting in reduced boost
pressure
Clean or replace
A clogged element in the air
cleaner Disassemble and repair or
replace damaged parts
The turbocharger is internally
fouled with foreign matter or its
running parts are damaged
Abnormal running noise Disassemble and clean
Restrictions in exhaust gas
passage, particularly due to the
nozzle ring approaching a clogged
condition Disassemble and clean
Restrictions in the air outlet side of
the blower, causing the air to
surge at blower wheel when the
engine accelerates Disassemble and repair or
replace damaged parts
The casing is being rubbed by
turbine wheel or blower wheel
Repeated turbocharger Refer to “Important” decal to right
bearing failure of ignition switch
Improper operation
Change operating practices or
adjust engine idle RPM
Frequent stalling
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 15

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Worn turbocharger bearings, Inadequate pre-oiling following Pre oil turbocharger components
bores or journals turbocharger installation or engine
lubrication or engine lubrication
servicing
Contaminated or improper grade Inspect and replace with proper
of engine oil used in engine grade engine oil
Insufficient oil supplied to Inspect and clean oil feed lines
turbocharger due to oil lag
Restricted turbocharger oil feed Clean or replace
line
Replace
Plugged engine oil filter
Disassemble, inspect and clean
Abrasive wear due to material parts
lodged in turbocharger
Clean or replace
Seal leak at compressor end Dirty air cleaner
of turbocharger Inspect and retighten
Restricted duct between air
cleaner and turbocharger
Inspect and retighten
Leaks at engine intake manifold
Remove and clean line
Restricted turbocharger oil drain
line
Clean
Plugged engine crankcase
breather Inspect parts, replace as
necessary
Worn or damaged compressor
wheel (worn bearings, bores or
journals) Inspect piston rings. Replace as
necessary
Excessive piston blowby or high
internal crankcase pressure
Seal leaks at turbine end of Reduce oiling
turbocharger
Excessive pre-oiling Repair or replace line
Plugged engine crankcase Disassemble and clean
breather
Restricted turbocharger oil drain Inspect and replace parts as
line necessary.
Worn turbocharger bearings,
bearing bores, or shaft journals
16 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

ELECTRICAL SYSTEM - STARTER MOTOR


FAULT POSSIBLE
PROBLEM LOCATION CAUSES CORRECTION
Loader will not start Starter circuit Inoperative seat switch or Check seat switch, sit in
(Starter will not rotate) operator not sitting in seat seat
Seat belt not buckled Buckle seat belt
No power to ignition switch Check battery
Check 5 amp fuse in
engine fuse panel
No power to EIC Check seat switch, check
battery
Check 5amp fuse in engine
fuse panel
No power to starter Check ignition switch, EIC,
seat switch, seat belt, start
relay, battery
Check 15amp fuse in
engine fuse panel

Pinion fails to advance Wiring Open circuit, battery and Repair or replace
when key switch is switch terminal connec-
closed tions
Open circuit, fuse Replace fuse
Key switch No contact Repair or replace
Starter motor Sleeve bearing burnt out Repair or replace
Lever spring or shaft lever Replace
broken
Magnetic switch Magnetic switch plunger Repair or replace
movement defective or coil
open or shorted.

Starter motor rotates Starting motor Starter drive defective Replace


but no rotation
transmitted to engine Reduction gear damaged Replace

Motor rotates before Starting motor Lever spring weak, shift Replace
pinion meshes with lever damaged
ring gear
Slip ring defective Replace
Pinion teeth worn Replace
Pinion push out position Replace
defective
Engine Ring gear worn Replace
Starter solenoid Starter solenoid defective Replace
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 17

FAULT POSSIBLE
PROBLEM LOCATION CAUSES CORRECTION
Pinion meshes with Battery In discharged state Recharge or replace
ring gear but starting
motor fails to turn Wiring Line connecting starter Repair or replace
solenoid switch to battery
broken or defective ground.
Lead wire connecting starter Repair or replace
solenoid to motor tightened
improperly.
Starting motor Ball bearing locked Replace
Installation defective Reinstall
Brush worn Replace
Brush spring defective Replace
Commutator dirty Clean
Armature or field coil Repair or replace
defective
Field coil to brush Repair
connection defective
Starter solenoid Contact not touching Replace
properly
Contact contacting surface Replace
roughened

Starter motor fails to Key switch Switch defective Replace


stop after engine starts
and key switch is Starter solenoid Starter solenoid defective Replace
turned off

ELECTRICAL SYSTEM - ALTERNATOR


FAULT POSSIBLE
PROBLEM LOCATION CAUSES CORRECTION
No charging Wiring Loose connection, short Repair
circuit
Alternator Loose connection, no Repair or replace
ground, short circuit
Defective rectifier Replace
Loose connection of RF Replace
resistor
Regulator Defective regulator Replace
Loose connection of Repair or replace
alternator or regulator
18 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

FAULT POSSIBLE
PROBLEM LOCATION CAUSES CORRECTION
Insufficient charging Wiring Loose connection or short Repair
circuit
Alternator Loose drive belt Repair
Short in rotor coil Replace
Short in stator coil Replace
Defective rectifier Replace
Insufficient brush contact Repair or replace
Regulator Defective regulator Replace
Loose connection at Repair
alternator and regulator

Overcharge Battery Internal short Replace


Regulator Defective regulator Replace

Unstable charging Wiring Loose connection or open Repair or replace


circuit wire
Alternator Loose drive belt Repair
Short in rotor coil Replace
Short in stator coil Replace
Insufficient brush contact Repair or replace
Broken brush or spring Replace
Loose connections Repair
Regulator Defective regulator Replace
Loose connection at Repair or replace
alternator and regulator

Abnormal noise of Alternator Loose mounting hardware Repair


alternator
Defective bearings Repair or replace
Rotor core and stator in Replace
contact
Defective diode Replace
Short in stator coil Replace
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 19

SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE STANDARDS - SL65B
CYLINDER BLOCK

Taper of Cylinder Bore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 mm (0.001″) repair limit


0.127 mm (0.005″) wear limit
Cylinder Bore Out-of-Round . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.03 mm (0.0015″) repair limit
0.127 mm (0.005″) wear limit
Cylinder Bore Diameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111.778 - 111.841 mm (4.4007″ - 4.4032″)
Rear Oil Seal Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140.77 - 140.87 mm (5.542″ - 5.546″)
Block-to-Head Surface Flatness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.08 mm (0.003″) in any 152 mm (6″)
or 0.15 mm (0.006″) overall limit
CYLINDER HEAD

Valve Guide Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.469 - 9.487 mm (0.3728″ - 0.3735″)


Head-to-Block Surface Flatness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.08 mm (0.003″) in any 152 mm (6″)
or 0.15 mm (0.006″) overall limit
EXHAUST VALVES

Face Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44.15° - 44.30° Relative to Head of Valve


Stem Diameter
Standard: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.401 - 9.418 mm (0.3701″ - 0.3708″)
Oversize 0.076 mm (0.003″): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.477 - 9.495 mm (0.3731″ - 0.3738″)
Oversize 0.38 mm (0.015″): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.781 - 9.799 mm (0.3851″ - 0.3858″)
Oversize 0.76 mm (0.030″): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.163 - 10.180 mm (0.4001″ - 0.4008″)
Head Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38.23 - 38.48 mm (1.505″ - 1.515″)
Seat Width (minimum) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.79 mm (0.031″)
Stem-to-Guide Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.051 - 0.094 mm (0.0020″ - 0.0037″)
Lash Clearance (Cold) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.43 - 0.53 mm (0.017″ - 0.021″)
INTAKE VALVES

Face Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.15° - 29.30° Relative to Head of Valve


Stem Diameter
Standard: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.426 - 9.444 mm (0.3711″ - 0.3718″)
Oversize 0.076 mm (0.003″): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.502 - 9.520 mm (0.3741″ - 0.3748″)
Oversize 0.381 mm (0.01″): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.807 - 9.825 mm (0.3861″ - 0.3868″)
Oversize 0.762 mm (0.030″): . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.188 - 10.206 mm (0.4011″ - 0.4018″)
Head Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46.48 - 46.77 mm (1.832″ - 1.842″)
Seat Width (minimum) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.58 mm (0.062″)
Stem-to-Guide Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.069 mm (0.0010″ - 0.0027″)
Lash Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.36 - 0.46 mm (0.014″ - 0.018″)
20 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

VALVE SPRINGS

Number per Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1


Free Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54.6 mm (2.15″)
Load at 1.74″ Length (44.20 mm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27.7 - 31.3 kg (61 - 69 lbs.)
Load at 1.32″ Length (33.53 mm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57.8 - 63.1 kg (125 - 139 lbs.)

VALVE TIMING

Intake Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14° Before Top Dead Center


Intake Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38° After Bottom Dead Center
Exhaust Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41° Before Bottom Dead Center
Exhaust Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11° After Top Dead Center
VALVE INSERTS

Exhaust Valve Insert Intake Valve Seat Insert


Counterbore Diameter in Counterbore Diameter in
Insert Oversize Cylinder Head Cylinder Head
0.254 mm (0.010″) 40.82 - 40.84 mm 43.44 - 43.46 mm
(1.607″ - 1.608″) (1.907″ - 1.908″)
0.508 mm (0.020″) 41.07 - 41.10 mm 43.69 - 43.72 mm
(1.617″ - 1.618″) (1.917″ - 1.918″)
0.762 mm (0.030″) 41.33 - 41.36 mm 43.95 - 43.97 mm
(1.627″ - 1.628″) (1.927″ - 1.928″)
VALVE SEATS

Exhaust Valve Seat Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45.0° - 45.3°


Intake Valve Seat Angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30.0° - 30.3°
Interference Angle Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.30° - 1.15°
Face to Valve Seat Seat Runout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.038 mm (0.0015″) Total Indicator Reading Max.
Seat Width
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.13 - 2.69 mm (0.084″ - 0.106″)
Intake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.03 - 2.59 mm (0.080″ - 0.102″)
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 21

CAMSHAFT DRIVE GEAR

Number of Teeth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
End Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.28 mm (0.001″ - 0.011″)
Bushing Inside Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50.813 - 50.838 mm (2.005″ - 2.0015″)
Adapter Outside Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50.762 - 50.775 mm (1.9985″ - 1.9990″)
Backlash with Crankshaft Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.23 mm (0.001″ - 0.009″)
Backlash with Camshaft Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.23 mm (0.001″ - 0.009″)
Backlash with Fuel Injection Pump Drive Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.30 mm (0.001″ - 0.012″)
CAMSHAFT GEAR

Number of Teeth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Timing Gear Backlash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.08 - 0.20 mm (0.003″ - 0.008″)
ROCKER ARM SHAFT

Shaft Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25.40 - 25.43 mm (1.000″ - 1.001″)


Support Diameter
(Internal Diameter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25.45 - 25.50 mm (1.002″ - 1.004″)
ROCKER ARM

Inside Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25.48 - 25.50 mm (1.003″ - 1.004″)


TAPPETS

Clearance to Bore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.015 - 0.053 mm (0.0006″ - 0.0021″)


Tappet Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25.118 - 25.130 mm (0.9889″ - 0.9894″)
Tappet Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25.15 - 25.17 mm (0.990″ - 0.991″)
CAMSHAFT

Bearing Journal Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60.693 - 60.719 mm (2.3895″ - 2.3905″)


Bearing Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.076 mm (0.001″ - 0.003″)
End Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.18 mm (0.001″ - 0.007″)
CONNECTING RODS

Small End Bushing (Internal Diameter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38.108 - 38.115 mm (1.5003″ - 1.5006″)


Clearance Bushing-to-Piston Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.013 - 0.018 mm (0.0005″ - 0.0007″)
Side Float . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.18 - 0.33 mm (0.007″ - 0.013″)
Maximum Twist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.30 mm (0.012″)
Maximum Bend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.10 mm (0.004″)
22 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

PISTON PIN

Outside Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38.092 - 38.100 mm (1.4997″ - 1.5001″)


PISTONS

Skirt-to-Cylinder Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.162 - 0.196 mm (0.0064″ - 0.0077″)


Taper (Out-of-Round) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.063 - 0.127 mm (0.0025″ - 0.0050″)
Piston Pin Clearance at 21°C (70°F) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.0076 - 0.0127 mm (0.0003″ - 0.0005″)
Piston Crown to Block Face Height . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.288 - 0.58 mm (0.011″ - 0.023″)
PISTON RINGS

Type
Top Compression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keystone Tapered Sides-Barrel Faced
Second Compression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lower Side Internal Chamfer-Tapered Face
Oil Control Ring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Slotted with Expander Ring
Side Face Clearance to Ring Groove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.075 - 0.125 mm (0.00295″ - 0.00485″)
Ring Gap Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.40 - 0.90 mm (0.016″ - 0.036″)
CRANKSHAFT

Main Journal Diameter


Blue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85.631 - 85.644 mm (3.3713″ - 3.3718″)
Red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85.644 - 85.656 mm (3.3718″ - 3.3723″)
Main Journal Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36.96 - 37.21 mm (1.455″ - 1.465″)
Main Journal Wear Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.127 mm (0.005″) maximum
Main and Crankpin Fillet Radius . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.048 - 3.556 mm (0.12″ - 0.14″)
Thrust Bearing Journal Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.06 - 37.11 mm (1.459″ - 1.461″)
Intermediate Bearing Journal Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36.96 - 37.21 mm (1.455″ - 1.465″)
Rear Bearing Journal Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.97 - 38.48 mm1 (.495″ - 1.515″)
Crankpin Journal Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42.62 - 42.72 mm (1.678″ - 1.682″)
Crankpin Diameter
Blue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.840 - 69.850 mm (2.7496″ - 2.7500″)
Red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.850 - 69.860 mm (2.7500″ - 2.7504″)
End Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.10 - 0.20 mm (0.004″ - 0.008″)
Crankpin Out-of-Round . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.005 mm (0.0002″) Total Indicator Reading
Taper-Surface Parallel to Center Line of Main Journal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.005 mm (0.0002″)
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Journal Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122.12 - 122.28 mm (4.808″ - 4.814″)
Crankshaft Pulley Journal Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44.45 - 44.48 mm (1.750″ - 1.751″)
Crankshaft Timing Gear Journal Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46.23 - 46.25 mm (1.820″ - 1.821″)
Crankshaft Flange Runout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.038 mm (0.0015″) Max
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 23

CRANKSHAFT DRIVE GEAR

Number of Teeth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
MAIN BEARING

Bearing Length (except thrust bearing) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27.94 - 28.19 mm (1.10″ - 1.11″)


Bearing Length (thrust bearing) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39.91 - 39.96 mm (1.453″ - 1.455″)
MAIN BEARING IDENTIFICATION

Identifying Color Specified


Mark Code Material Wall Thickness Clearance
PV or G Red Copper Lead 3.162 - 3.175 mm 0.056 - 0.114 mm
(0.1245″ - 0.1250″) (0.0022″ - 0.0045″)
PV or G Blue Copper Lead 3.172 - 3.185 mm 0.056 - 0.114 mm
(0.1249″ - 0.1254″) (0.0022″ - 0.0045″)
G and AL Red Aluminum Tin 3.162 - 3.175 mm 0.056 - 0.114 mm
Alloy (0.1245″ - 0.1250″) (0.0022″ - 0.0045″)
G and AL Blue Aluminum Tin 3.172 - 3.185 mm 0.056 - 0.114 mm
Alloy (0.1249″ - 0.1254″) (0.0022″ - 0.0045″)
CRANKPIN BEARINGS

Bearing Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35.56 - 35.81 mm (1.40″ - 1.41″)


BEARING IDENTIFICATION

Identifying Color Specified


Mark Code Material Wall Thickness Clearance
PV or G Red Copper Lead 2.395 - 2.408 mm 0.043 - 0.096 mm
(0.0943″ - 0.0948″) (0.0017″ - 0.0038″)
PV or G Blue Copper Lead 2.405 - 2.418 mm 0.043 - 0.096 mm
(0.0947″ - 0.0952″) (0.0017″ - 0.0038″)
G and AL Red Aluminum Tin 2.390 - 2.403 mm 0.053 - 0.107 mm
Alloy (0.0941″ - 0.0946″) (0.0021″ - 0.0042″)
G and AL Blue Aluminum Tin 2.400 - 2.413 mm 0.053 - 0.107 mm
Alloy (0.0945″ - 0.0950″) (0.0021″ - 0.0042″)
CRANKSHAFT GRINDING

When grinding a crankshaft, the main and crankpin journal diameters should be reduced the same amount as
the undersize bearings used. The following dimensions apply. The rear end of the crankshaft should be located
on the 60° chamfer of the pilot bearing bore.
Undersize Bearing

Available Main Journal Diameters

0.051 mm (0.002″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85.580 - 85.583 mm (3.3693″ - 3.3698″)


0.254 mm (0.010″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85.390 - 85.402 mm (3.3618″ - 3.3623″)
0.508 mm (0.020″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85.136 - 85.148 mm (3.3518″ - 3.3523″)
0.762 mm (0.030″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84.882 - 84.894 mm (3.3418″ - 3.3423″)
1.016 mm (0.040″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84.628 - 84.640 mm (3.3318″ - 3.3323″)
24 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Crankpin Journal Diameters

0.051 mm (0.002″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.789 - 69.799 mm (2.7476″ - 2.7480″)


0.254 mm (0.010″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.956 - 69.606 mm (2.7400″ - 2.7404″)
0.508 mm (0.020″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.342 - 69.352 mm (2.7300″ - 2.7304″)
0.762 mm (0.030″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69.088 - 69.098 mm (2.7200″ - 2.7204″)
1.016 mm (0.040″) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68.834 - 68.844 mm (2.7100″ - 2.7104″)
FLYWHEEL

Runout of Clutch Face . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.127 mm (0.005″)


Ring Gear Runout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.64 mm (0.025″)
OIL PUMP

Rotor Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.15 mm (0.001″ - 0.006″)


Rotor-to-Pump Housing Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.15 - 0.28 mm (0.006″ - 0.011″)
Rotor End Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.089 mm (0.001″ - 0.0035″)
Relief Valve Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 - 4.8 bar (60 - 70 PSI)
(4.2 - 4.9 kg/cm2) at 2000 RPM
Relief Valve Spring Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27.2 mm (1.07″) under 4.85 kg - 5.4 kg (10.7 lb. - 11.9 lb.) load

ENGINE OIL SPECIFICATIONS

Engine Oil &


API Filter Change
Temperature Oil Viscosity and Type Classification Period (hours)
- 40°F - +30°F SAE 5W SH-CG4 100
- 20°F - +60°F SAE 5W - 30 SH-CG4 100
- 10°F - +120°F SAE 10W - 30 SH-CG4 100
When using diesel fuel with sulphur content between 0.5% and 1.0% use only oils listed above but reduce the
oil and filter change period to every 50 hours.

When using diesel fuel with sulphur content between 1.0% and 1.3% use only oils listed above but reduce the
oil and filter change period to every 25 hours.

Use of diesel fuel with a sulphur content above 1.3% is not recommended.
THERMOSTAT

Opening Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76°C (168°F)


SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 25

WATER PUMP

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Centrifugal
Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V-belt
Drive Belt Deflection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 mm (0.375″) midway between pulleys
with a force of 1 kg (2 lbs.) applied
COOLING FLUID

Use an antifreeze that meets ESE-M97B - 18C/D or SSM - 97B - 9101A specifications. Mix with an equal amount
of clean water. Add Inhibitor, FW - 15, to the mixture to yield a 5% concentration.
FUEL INJECTOR SPECIFICATIONS

Needle valve opening pressure 227 bar (3381 PSI)


Nozzle retaining nut 48 N·m (35 ft. lbs.)
FUEL INJECTION PUMP SPECIFICATIONS

Rotation (looking on drive end) Clockwise


Governor type Mechanical all - speed
Governor link length 54 mm ± 0.3 mm
Governor link length 41.5 mm ± 0.5 mm
Governor arm Outer hole
Diameter and no. of plungers 4 x 7.0 mm
Drive arrangement Standard with supported shaft
Advance type Automatic speed
Solenoid shutoff device 12 volts
26 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

MINIMUM HARDWARE TIGHTENING TORQUES


IN FOOT POUNDS (NEWTON-METERS) FOR NORMAL ASSEMBLY APPLICATIONS

INCH HARDWARE AND LOCKNUTS


SAE GRADE 2 SAE GRADE 5 SAE GRADE 8 LOCKNUTS

NOMINAL UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED GR.B GR.C NOMINAL
SIZE or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr w/GR5 w/GR8 SIZE
PLATED PLATED PLATED BOLT BOLT
SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD

1/4 55* (6.2) 72* (8.1) 86* (9.7) 112* (13) 121* (14) 157* (18) 61* (6.9) 86* (9.8) 1/4
5/16 115* (13) 149* (17) 178* (20) 229* (26) 250* (28) 324* (37) 125* (14) 176* (20) 5/16
3/8 17 (23) 22 (30) 26 (35) 34 (46) 37 (50) 48 (65) 19 (26) 26 (35) 3/8
7/16 27 (37) 35 (47) 42 (57) 54 (73) 59 (80) 77 (104) 30 (41) 42 (57) 7/16
1/2 42 (57) 54 (73) 64 (87) 83 (113) 91 (123) 117 (159) 45 (61) 64 (88) 1/2
9/16 60 (81) 77 (104) 92 (125) 120 (163) 130 (176) 169 (229) 65 (88) 92 (125) 9/16
5/8 83 (112) 107 (145) 128 (174) 165 (224) 180 (244) 233 (316) 90 (122) 127 (172) 5/8
3/4 146 (198) 189 (256) 226 (306) 293 (397) 319 (432) 413 (560) 160 (217) 226 (306) 3/4
7/8 142 (193) 183 (248) 365 (495) 473 (641) 515 (698) 667 (904) 258 (350) 364 (494) 7/8
1 213 (289) 275 (373) 547 (742) 708 (960) 773 (1048) 1000 (1356) 386 (523) 545 (739) 1

NOTE: Torque values shown with * are inch pounds.


IDENTIFICATION
CAP SCREWS AND CARRIAGE BOLTS

SAE GRADE 2 SAE GRADE 5 SAE GRADE 8

REGULAR NUTS SAE GRADE 5 SAE GRADE 8


HEX NUTS HEX NUTS

LOCKNUTS

GRADE IDENTIFICATION GRADE IDENTIFICATION GRADE IDENTIFICATION


GRADE A NO MARKS GRADE A NO MARKS
GRADE A NO NOTCHES
GRADE B LETTER B GRADE B THREE MARKS
GRADE B ONE CIRCUMFERENTIAL NOTCH GRADE C LETTER C GRADE C SIX MARKS
GRADE C TWO CIRCUMFERENTIAL NOTCHES MARKS NEED NOT BE LOCATED
AT CORNERS
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 27

TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
N·m kgm ft. lbs.
Main Bearing Bolts 163 14 120
Connecting Rod Nuts 85 9 63
Cylinder Head Bolts (with Engine Cold) 150 15 110
Intake Manifold-to-Cylinder Head 35 4 26
Exhaust Manifold-to-Cylinder Head 38 4 28
Exhaust Pipe-to-Flange 31 4 23
Flywheel-to-Crankshaft 217 22 160
Oil Pan Drain Plug 41 4 30
Valve Rocker Cover Bolts 18 2 13
Crankshaft Pulley-to-Crankshaft 224 23 165
Self-Locking Screw-Valve Rocker Arm 24 3 18
Injector Attachment Bolts 23 2 17
Oil Pump-to-Block 49 5 36
Water Pump-to-Cylinder Block 35 4 26
Water Pump Cover-to-Pump 27 3 20
Oil Pan-to-Cylinder Block (Stamped) 30 3 22
Injector Line Nuts 27 3 20
Leak-off Tube Banjo Fitting Bolts 8 1 6
Injection Pump-to-Front Adapter Plate 24 3 18
Camshaft Drive Gear-to-Block 140 14 103
Front Adapter Plate-to-Cylinder Block 19 2 14
Front Cover-to-Front Adapter Plate 22 2 16
Camshaft Gear Bolts 58 6 43
Oil Filter Retaining Bolts 65 7 48
Oil Filter Mounting Bolt Insert 34 4 25
Starting Motor-to-Rear Adapter Plate 31 3 23
Governor Drive Gear Nut 122 13 90
Oil Pump Gear Stop 95 10 70
Oil Pressure Switch Assembly 31 3 23
Turbocharger-to-Exhaust Manifold 44 5 33
Fan-to-Pulley Bolts 22 2 16
28 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

TURBOCHARGER TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS


N·m kgf.m ft. lbs.
Turbine Housing Bolts 20 - 25 2.0 - 2.5 15 - 18
Turbocharger to Manifold 41 - 47 4.1 - 4.7 30 - 35
Oil Feed Tube to Turbocharger (Banjo Bolt) 30 - 40 3.0 - 4.0 22 - 30
Oil Feed Tube to Filter Head Connector 18 - 20 1.8 - 2.0 13 - 15
Connector to Filter Head 54 - 81 5.4 - 8.1 40 - 60
Oil Return Tube Bolts from Turbocharger 20 - 25 2.0 - 2.5 15 - 18
Oil Return Tube to Block Connector 60 - 70 6.0 - 7.0 45 - 50
Oil Return Connector to Block 27 2.7 20
Inlet Hose Clamps 1.7 - 2.3 15 - 20 in. lbs
SEALER
Type ESE-M4G194-B Sealer Anaerobic Low Strength
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 29

DK GN/O

W D– B+

2 3

L B K D/ R
L B K D/ Y
R/ UP
B/ Y

B
4 T PU/O B
DK GN/O

13 LT BL/W

B R
5

PU/LT GN

B/Y

B/ L B TL
B
1
B B
6
EM1 12
B B
2
PU/O PK
3 M

LT BL/W

10 11
LT BL/O B B/Y

R 7

9 M
L B K D/ R

B
R/ W

B
B
B

R/DK BL

R
W/R
B 8

BSC0931A

5
ENGINE ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS - SL65B
1. Hydraulic Oil Filter Switch 8. Chassis ground
2. Engine Oil Pressure Switch 9. Starter
3. Alternator 10. Cold Advance Unit
4. Cold Start Advance switch 11. Fuel Solenoid
5. Engine Coolant Temperature Sender 12. Fuel Pump
6. Heater Plug 13. Battery
7. Air Filter Vacuum Switch
30 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 001 10

ENGINE REMOVAL BY TILTING THE CAB


AND BOOM FORWARD - SL65B
1. Securely block the skid steer loader with all four
wheels off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for
more detailed information on properly supporting
the skid steer loader.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer loader 1
could result in movement of the loader causing seri-
ous injury or damage to the equipment.
6
2. Tilt cab and boom forward. Refer to Section 00 for
more detailed information on this procedure.
3. Remove the battery. Refer to Section 55 for the
battery removal procedure.
4. Open the rear door and disconnect the radiator
overflow hose at the overflow tank. Remove the
cap screw and nut, 1. Remove the rear door.
5. Drain the engine cooling system.
6. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses, 1,
from the engine block and plug the hoses with 3
plastic plugs.
7. Remove cap screws and nuts, 2. Slide fan
shroud, 3, forward to access the oil cooler line
1
connection.
8. Disconnect the oil cooler bottom left line and cap 2
to prevent loss of oil.

7
9. Disconnect the air hoses, 1 and 2. Remove sup-
port rod hardware at 3. Remove air cleaner can-
ister support hardware at 4. 2
3

19984625
8
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 31

10. Remove the hydraulic oil filter restriction switch


wires, 1, and harness clamps, 2.
11. Disconnect hydraulic line, 3, from the oil filter
base.
NOTE: Figure illustrates original configuration with- 1
out any kit installation. With kits installed there may
be additional wiring and hydraulic hoses to discon- 2
nect.

9
12. Loosen clamps, 1, and remove the fuel tank filler
neck, 2.
2

10
13. Remove the rear door latch bracket, 1, by remov-
ing the two capscrews, 2.
1

19984501
11
32 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

14. Remove eight mounting cap screws, 1 (four cap


screws on each side). Remove the radiator/oil
cooler assembly from the skid steer.
NOTE: The radiator/oil cooler assembly is heavy and
may require a lifting device to remove.

19984502
12
15. Disconnect the engine main harness connector,
1. Remove ground strap, 2.
1

13
16. Disconnect throttle cable, 1.

19995957
14
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 33

17. Remove fuel supply line, 1, and return line, 2.

1
2
19995956
15
18. Remove the fan from the water pump shaft to
prevent damage during the removal process.
19. Remove the hydrostatic pumps from the trans- 1
mission gearbox. Refer to Section 5 for the hy-
drostatic pump removal procedure.
20. Remove ground wire connections, 1, and wire
harness clamps, 2, from the transmission gear- 2
box.

16
21. Attach a chain or cable to the engine lift eyes at
1, and hook to a suitable lifting device to support 1
the engine.

17
34 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

22. Remove the engine motor mount and splitter


drive mount hardware, 1. Slide the engine to the
rear to clear the hydrostatic pumps. Lift the en-
gine assembly from the skid steer.

18
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 35

Op. 10 001 20 Op. 10 001 53

MOUNTING THE ENGINE FOR MAINTEN- ENGINE DISASSEMBLY SEQUENCE -


ANCE - SL65B SL65B
The approximate weight of the engine is 363 kg (800 The following preliminary disassembly procedure is
lbs.). Use an engine repair stand with a minimum ca- suggested to remove external components when
pacity of 363 kg (800 lbs.). complete disassembly for overhaul is required. Refer
The engine repair stand should be used only by to the appropriate section when removing individual
qualified service technicians familiar with the equip- engine components.
ment. 1. Drain all coolant and engine oil. Check engine oil
To maintain shear strength specifications, alloy steel for metal contaminates.
SAE Grade 8 or higher bolts must be used to mount 2. Remove fan, fan belts, and alternator.
the engine. 3. Remove turbocharger and exhaust manifold.
For full thread engagement, check that tapped 4. Remove rocker arm cover with vent tube.
mounting holes in the engine blocks are clean and
5. Remove coolant outlet connection with thermo-
not damaged. A thread engagement equal to 1 - 1/2
stats and gasket.
screw diameters minimum is required to maintain
strength requirements. 6. Remove dipstick, oil filter, engine oil cooler, and
hoses.
To avoid structural or personal injury, do not exceed
the maximum capacity rating of the engine stand. 7. Remove fuel filter, fuel supply pump, and fuel
line.
To avoid an unsafe off-balance load condition, the
center of balance of an engine must be located near 8. Remove water pump.
the engine stand rotating shaft. The engine center of 9. Remove starting motor.
balance is generally located a few millimeters above 10. Remove transmission housing and flywheel.
the crankshaft. Adjust engine mounting to avoid an (See Section 27)
off-balance condition.
11. Remove oil pan.
To prevent possible personal injury due to engine
12. Remove crankshaft pulley.
slippage, recheck to make sure the engine is solidly
mounted while releasing support from the engine lift-
ing device.
Never permit any part of the body to be positioned
under an engine or component being lifted or sus-
pended. Accidental slippage may result in personal
injury.
36 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

ENGINE COMPONENT MAINTENANCE -


SL65B

CYLINDER HEAD AND VALVES


Op. 10 101 20

Removal
NOTE: The cylinder head can be removed with the
engine installed in the machine.
1. Disconnect the battery.
2
2. Remove the hood and side panel assemblies.
1
3. Drain the radiator and cylinder block. Remove
the upper radiator hose.
4. Remove the air cleaner and bracket assembly, 1,
disconnecting the outlet hose at the turbo-
charger, 2, and the air cleaner restriction indica- 3
tor switch electrical connections. Remove the
hose from the turbocharger outlet to the inlet to 4
the intake manifold, 3. 5
5. Disconnect and remove the valve rocker cover
ventilation tube, 4.
6. Remove the muffler, 5.
19
7. Remove the alternator, 1, and oil pressure
sender switch electrical connection, 2.

20
8. Remove the turbocharger oil supply and return
lines, 1. Remove the turbocharger, 2.
2
9. Remove the exhaust manifold, 3, and gasket.

1
3

21
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 37

10. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the


fuel electric lift pump, 1.
11. Disconnect the filter inlet and outlet fuel lines, 2.
12. Remove the two socket head capscrews, 3, and
remove the filter and pump assembly.

22
13. Remove the injector lines, 1, from the injection
pump and the injectors. Remove the fuel leakoff
line from the injection pump, 2. Cap all openings 2
to prevent dirt entry.
14. Disconnect the fuel and electrical connections at
the intake manifold heater located at the inlet to
the manifold.
15. Disconnect and plug the heater hoses.
16. Remove the retaining bolts and lock washers.
Remove the intake manifold and gasket.
17. Remove the rocker arm cover from the engine. 1
19995958
23
38 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

18. Hold the leak-off pipe at each injector and care-


fully disconnect the fuel injector leak-off pipes.
Clean the area surrounding the fuel injectors,
then remove the bolts, 2, and carefully withdraw
the fuel injectors, 1, and washers, 3 and 4.
19. Check the pushrods for straightness by rotating
the rods with the valve closed and identify any
bent rods.
20. Loosen the rocker shaft retaining bolts, which
also serve as cylinder head bolts, evenly and al-
ternately. Remove the rocker shaft assembly.
NOTE: Leave the bolts in the rocker shaft supports
during removal as they retain the supports on the
shaft. 24
21. Remove the pushrods and place in a numbered
rack.
22. Remove the remaining cylinder head bolts and
washers working inward from the ends to the
center of the head.
23. Lift the cylinder head from the block. If necessary,
lever the head off on the pads provided, taking
care not to damage the cylinder head or block
faces.
DISASSEMBLY
4
Op. 10 402 30
Thermostat Removal
1. Remove the coolant outlet connection, 4; the
thermostat, 3; and gasket, 2.

3 2

25
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 39

Op. 10 121 21

Cylinder Head
2. Clean the head and remove carbon deposits
from around the valve heads.
3. Using a valve spring compressor, 1, remove the
retainer locks, 2; spring retainers/ rotators;
springs, 3; and seals from each valve.
4. Withdraw the valves and place in a numbered
rack together with the valve rotators.

26

9 10
8
7

1
2
3

27
1. Intake valve spring retainer lock 6. Exhaust valve
2. Intake valve spring retainer 7. Exhaust valve spring
3. Intake valve seal 8. Exhaust valve seal
4. Intake valve spring 9. Exhaust valve spring retainer
5. Intake valve 10. Exhaust valve spring retainer locks
40 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 106 20

Rocker Shaft Assembly


5. Remove the cylinder head bolts, 3, which pass
through the rocker shaft supports, 2, and slide
the spring, 1; rocker arm, 4; and spacer, 6, from
the shaft.

28
INSPECTION AND REPAIR

Op. 10 101 21

Cylinder Head
1. Scrape all gasket surfaces clean, then wash the
cylinder head in a suitable solvent and thorough-
ly dry with a lint-free cloth or compressed air.
2. Inspect the cylinder head for damage and, if
necessary, remove nicks and burrs from the
gasket faces using a suitable abrasive. Ensure
all traces of abrasive material are removed after
repair.
29
3. Use a straightedge, 1, to check the flatness of the
cylinder head in all directions. Resurface or re-
place if found warped beyond 0.08 mm (0.003
in.) in any area.
4. After skimming the head, check whether any cyl-
inder head bolts are bottoming by mounting the
cylinder head on the block without a gasket and
without any of the pistons at T.D.C. Install all the
bolts finger tight and ensure the rocker shaft sup-
ports and flat washers are fitted with the long
bolts. If a 0.25 mm (0.010″) feeler gauge can be
inserted under the bolt head, then the bolts are
bottoming and the cylinder block thread must be
increased in depth. Use a 1/2″ x 13 UNC - 2A
thread tap.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 41

Op. 10 101 55
Valve Seats
5. Examine the valve seat inserts and reface if pitted.
Replace damaged inserts. If necessary, install an
oversize insert by machining the seat counterbore
in the cylinder head. Inserts are available in 0.254
mm (0.010 in.), 0.508 mm (0.020 in.) and 0.762
mm (0.030 in.) oversize. The insert must be
chilled in dry ice prior to installation.
NOTE: Valve seat inserts of 0.25 mm (0.010″) and
0.5 mm (0.020″) oversize on diameter are some-
times installed in cylinder heads in production.
Heads fitted with oversize inserts are stamped S010
or S020 on the exhaust manifold side in line with the 30
valve seat concerned.
When replacing exhaust valve seat inserts, en-
sure the replacement inserts are of the correct
type as the size and material specification varies
for the different engine types.
6. Check the width of the valve seat inserts and, if
necessary, reface by grinding to the dimensions
shown.
Valve Seat Angle: 45.0° - 45.3° for exhaust valve
seats. Intake valve seat to be 30.0° - 30.3°
Valve Seat Width: Intake 2.032 - 2.590 mm
(0.080″ - 0.102″) Exhaust 2.133 - 2.692 mm
(0.084″ - 0.106″)
NOTE: Refacing of the valve seat should always be
coordinated with refacing of the valve to ensure a
compression tight fit.
Op. 10 101 32
Valves
7. Examine the valve face and, if pitted, replace or
reface by grinding to the dimension shown. Be-
fore refacing the valve, ensure the valve stem is
not bent or worn and check that the valve seat
runout, measured at right angles to the seat,
does not exceed a total of 0.038 mm (0.0015″).
1 Exhaust valves
2 Intake valves
3 Dimension after Refacing:
1.58 mm (0.062″) Minimum
4 Dimension after Refacing:
31
0.79 mm (0.031″) minimum
IMPORTANT: The finished valve seat should contact
the center of the valve face. Using the refaced or new
valve, check the seat using Prussian blue. Rotate the
valve with a light pressure. If the blue is transferred
to the middle of the valve face, the contact is correct.
42 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Valve Guides
8. Using a telescopic gauge, 1, and micrometer,
measure the valve-to-guide clearance. If the in-
take side clearance exceeds 0.069 mm (0.0027
in.) or the exhaust side clearance exceeds 0.094
mm (0.0037 in.), ream the valve guide, 2, to fit the
next oversize valve.
NOTE: Production cylinder heads may have one or
more 0.38 mm (0.015) oversize valve guides and
valves installed. Such cylinder heads have 15 or
V015/OS stamped on the exhaust manifold side of
the head opposite the valve(s) concerned.
9. Use Kit No. FNH02136 to ream out the valve
guide to accept an oversize valve. The kit con- 32
tains three reamer and pilot combinations as fol-
lows:
0.076 mm (0.003″) Oversize Reamer and Stan-
dard Diameter Pilot
0.38 mm (0.015″) Oversize Reamer and 0.076
mm (0.003″) Oversize Pilot
0.76 mm (0.030″) Oversize Reamer and 0.38
mm (0.015″) Oversize Pilot
When going from a standard valve stem to an
oversize, always use the reamers in sequence.
After reaming a valve guide, always check the
valve seating and reface if necessary.
Valve Springs
10. Replace worn or damaged valve springs. Check
for squareness and reject if out-of-squareness,
1, exceeds 1.5 mm (0.06″).
11. Place the valve springs on a flat surface.
Measure the free-length of the spring. Replace
the spring if less than 54.6 mm (2.15 in.).
12. Place the springs in a suitable spring load tester
and measure the spring load rating. Replace
springs that do not meet the following specifica-
tions.
Load at 1.74 in. length (44.2 mm) 27.7 - 31.3 kg
(61 - 69 lbs).
33
Load at 1.32 in. length (33.53 mm) 57.8 - 63.1 kg
(125 - 139 lbs).
13. Check that the valve spring retainer locks are in
good condition and the exhaust valve rotators
are not binding or worn.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 43

Rocker Shaft Assembly


14. Examine the rocker arm for wear or damage.
Check the adjusting screw threads and replace
if damaged. Inspect the rocker arm locating
springs and spacers for damage. Check the
rocker arm-to-shaft clearances and replace if be-
yond specified limits. See “Specifications Ser-
vice Standards” in this section.
15. Clean the shaft in a suitable solvent and thor-
oughly dry with compressed air ensuring the oil
passages are free from obstruction.

REASSEMBLY

CYLINDER HEAD
1. Insert each valve in the guide bore from which it
was removed and lap in position to ensure an
even seat around the valve. Withdraw the valve
and ensure removal of all traces of lapping com-
pound.
2. Use a valve spring compressor to reassemble
the valves, valve springs, retainers, and retainer
locks. For the exhaust valves install a new seal-
ing ring in the second groove from the top of the
valve stem.
NOTE: Turbocharged engines have no seals fitted to
the intake valves.

Thermostat
3. Install the thermostat (spring end toward the
head), coolant outlet, and a new gasket.
Rocker Shaft Assembly
4. Coat all components with engine oil and position 1
the notch, 1, on the front of the rocker shaft up-
wards to correctly locate the oil holes.

Rocker Shaft Installation


5. Start the assembly from the shaft rear end by se-
curing a rocker arm support with a long bolt. En-
sure the notch, 1, on the support is positioned to
the right of the shaft when looking forward. Pro-
ceed to install a spacer, rocker arm, spring,
rocker arm, and support. Repeat the procedure
until complete.
34
44 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

INSTALLATION
Installation of the cylinder head and related compo-
nents follows the removal procedure in reverse. On
installation observe the following requirements:
Install new cylinder head, intake, and exhaust mani-
fold gaskets.
Ensure washers are installed under the heads of the
cylinder head retaining bolts. Tighten the cylinder
head bolts in the sequence shown and progressively
in three steps as follows:
1) Torque to 122 N·m (90 ft. lbs.).
2) Torque to 135 N·m (100 ft. lbs.).
3) Torque to 149 N·m (110 ft. lbs.). 35
NOTE: The cylinder head bolts should be torqued
only when the engine is cold.
Rotate the engine and set the valve lash on the ex-
haust side to 0.43 - 0.53 mm (0.017 - 0.021 in.), and 1
on the intake side to 0.36 - 0.46 mm (0.014 - 0.018
in. ), using the adjuster screw, 1, and a feeler gauge,
2.
Install the injectors with new seat washers and cork
seals. Tighten the attaching bolts to 23 N⋅m (17 ft.
lbs.).
Install the injector lines and leak-off pipe with new 2
washers. Tighten the lines to 27 N⋅m (20 ft. lbs.).
Tighten the leak-off pipe to 8 N⋅m (6 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Hold the leak-off plastic tube securely to pre-
vent pivoting when tightening the banjo fitting bolts to
the correct torque. See “Specifications Service Stan- 36
dards” in this section.
Use new lock tabs for the exhaust manifold retaining
bolts and bend the tabs to effect retention. Tighten
the attaching bolts to 38 N⋅m (28 ft. lbs.).
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 45

CYLINDER BLOCK, PISTONS, RINGS,


1
RODS AND BEARINGS

Op. 10 105 10

Removal
NOTE: The connecting rods and pistons can only be
removed after prior removal of the engine cylinder
head, oil pan and oil pump assembly as described in
this section.
1. If necessary, remove any ridge from the top of the
cylinder bores with a cylinder ridge, 1, reamer or
hand scraper. Do not cut down into the piston ring
travel area. 37
2. With the piston at the bottom of its stroke, remove
the nuts from the bearing cap bolts and remove
the bearing cap, 2, and liner, 1.
3. Use the handle end of a hammer to push the pis-
ton and rod assembly out of the top of the block.
Remove the bearing liner from the connecting
rod.
4. Turn the crankshaft to bring each piston to the
bottom of its stroke and repeat this procedure.
Keep the bearing caps and liners with their re-
spective connecting rods.

38
Op. 10 105 22

Disassembly
1. Remove the piston pin retainer (snap ring) from
each side of the piston and remove the pin.
2. Use an expander to remove the piston rings.

39
46 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

3. Identify each piston and rod for reassembly.


1. Piston 8
2. Pin retainers
3. Piston pin 1 2
4. Connecting rod
5. Bearing liners 7
6. Bearing cap
7. Retaining nuts
8. Piston rings
3
4
5
6

40
Inspection And Wear
1. Wash the piston and connecting rod assembly in
a suitable solvent and dry with a clean lint-free
cloth or compressed air.
2. Inspect the piston ring lands, skirts, and pin
bosses for damage. Check for separation of the
top ring insert from the piston.
3. Clean the ring grooves and using a new ring, 1,
and feeler gauge, 2, check the piston ring lands
for wear. Replace rings if the clearance is not
within 0.075 - 0.125 mm (0.00295 - 0.00485 in.).

41
4. Check the connecting rod components for dam-
age and place each connecting rod, 2, in an 1
alignment fixture to check for distortion. Replace 3
if distorted beyond the following: Max. twist –
0.30 mm (0.012 in.), Max. bend – 0.10 mm (0.004
in.)
5. Measure the outside diameter of the piston pin
and the inside diameter of the connecting rod
bushing. If the clearance is not within 0.013 -
0.018 mm (0.0005 - 0.0007 in.), press out the
connecting rod bushing and install a new bushing
using a press, 1, and a suitable adapter, 3.
2

42
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 47

6. After installation of a new connecting rod bush-


ing, 1, use the hole in the top of the rod as a guide
and drill a 6 mm (0.25″) diameter hole, 2, into the 1
bushing.
7. Use an expansion reamer to ream the bushing to
obtain the specified bushing-to-piston pin clear-
ance.
8. Check the connecting rod and main bearing
clearances as described in this section. If the
bearing clearances exceed 0.127 mm (0.005
in.), install new bearings as described in the
“Crankshaft” part of this section. 2
9. Clean and inspect the cylinder block. Rust
around the core plugs indicates leakage, and 43
new plugs should be fitted with suitable sealant.
10. Inspect and measure the cylinder bores for wavi-
ness, scratches, scuffing, out-of-round, wear
and taper. A wavy cylinder wall has a series of
parallel lines or rings worn around the cylinder,
within the ring travel area. These irregularities
can be felt by running a finger over the surface.
A scuffed cylinder can be identified by discolored
areas. Out-of-roundness, wear and taper can
only be detected with a cylinder bore gauge.
Measure lengthwise and crosswise to obtain di-
mensions A, B, C, and D. Dimension A compared
with B, and dimension C compared with D, indi-
cates taper while the crosswise dimensions C
and D compared to the lengthwise measure-
ments A and B show if an out-of-round condition 44
exists.
Taper
Repair Limit: 0.025 mm (0.001 in.)
Wear Limit: 0.127 mm (0.005 in.)
Out-of-Round
Repair Limit: 0.03 mm (0.0015 in.)
Wear Limit: 0.127 mm (0.005 in.)
48 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

11. If the cylinders are outside specification or the Bores to take 0.10 mm (0.004″) oversize pistons
walls are damaged, the cylinders should be need only be honed. All honing should be done
honed or bored to fit the next oversize pistons. with a rigid hone having a grit size of 150 - 220.
The finished bore size can be determined by After reboring and honing, thoroughly wash and
measuring the piston diameter at right angles to dry the cylinder block and coat the walls with en-
the piston pin and adding the appropriate piston- gine oil.
to-bore clearance. See “Specifications Service 12. For cylinders with severely damaged walls or to
Standards” in this section. Always bore the cylin- which maximum oversize pistons have already
der with the most wear first to determine the over- been installed, cylinder liners are available for
size pistons required. Oversize pistons are avail- sleeving the bore. A lipped, thin wall sleeve is
able as follows: used in engines with a 111.8 mm (4.4″) bore.
0.10 mm (0.004″)
0.51 mm (0.020″)
0.76 mm (0.030″)
1.0 mm (0.040″)
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 49

Block boring procedure for 111.76 mm (4.4″)


Bore Thin Walled Lipped Sleeve:
1) Measure the outside diameter of the sleeve in
four places and find the average diameter. Bore
the block to 0.00 - 0.05 mm (0.000 - 0.002″) less
than this average diameter.
2) Machine the counterbore to the dimensions
shown:
The counterbore depth is critical as the
sleeve must be flush with the block surface
when installed.
Dimensions for Machining Cylinder Bore for
Thin Walled Sleeve
45
A 2.41 - 2.51 mm (0.095 - 0.099″)
B 120.55 - 120.73 mm (4.746 - 4.753″)
C Bore Cylinder to Average Diameter of Sleeve
less 0.00 - 0.05 mm (0.000 - 0.002″)
D 0.50 - 0.75 mm (0.020 - 0.030″) x 45° Chamfer
E 0.381 mm (0.015″) Radius Maximum
3) Thoroughly clean and dry the bore and the out-
side surface of the sleeve.
4) Chill the sleeve in liquid nitrogen or dry ice and
assemble to the cylinder bore ensuring the lip is
bottomed in the counterbore.
5) If necessary, the sleeve may be machined to
bring it flush with the block face or, if necessary,
the block face may be skimmed by up to 0.13 mm
(0.005″) to achieve a flush condition. If the block
is skimmed, ensure the piston-to-block height di-
mension is within 0.288 - 0.58 mm (0.011 - 0.023
in.).
6) Bore and hone the sleeve to the diameter re-
quired. Only standard and 0.10 mm (0.004″)
oversize pistons can be used with the thin walled
111.76 mm (4.4″) bore lipped sleeve.
13. Check the flatness of the cylinder block-to-head
surface. Resurface if not within 0.08 mm (0.003
in.) in any 152 mm (6 in.) or 0.15 mm (0.006 in.) 46
overall limit.
50 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

REASSEMBLY
NOTE: Prior to reassembly, check the cylinder bores
for taper and out-of-round as previously described in
this section.
1. Prior to reassembly, check the piston-to-bore
clearance as follows:
Measure the cylinder bore diameter in a cros-
swise direction, then measure the piston diam-
eter at right angles to the piston pin.
Subtract the piston diameter from the bore diam-
eter and the resultant figure should be within the
0.162 - 0.196 mm (0.0064 - 0.0072 in.).
NOTE: Pistons are available in both standard and
oversizes. New pistons should be installed if the
clearance exceeds the specified limits.
If the clearance is greater than specified, try a
similar new piston. If the clearance still exceeds
the specified limit, measure the other cylinder
bores and pistons and determine the cylinder
with the greatest clearance. Based on the
greatest clearance, rebore the cylinders to take
the next oversize piston as previously described
in this section.
If the clearance is less than specified, hone the
bore to obtain the desired clearance as previous-
ly described in this section.
2. Lubricate all components with engine oil, then
assemble the piston to the connecting rod with
the notch, 1, on the piston crown aligned with the
pip, 2, on the connecting rod and install the piston
pin and retainers (snap rings).

47
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 51

3. Check the piston rings, 2, for minimum gap using


a feeler gauge, 1, prior to installation in the rel-
evant cylinder. Use a piston crown to squarely lo-
cate the ring in the bore. New rings should be
checked for side clearance in the piston as previ-
ously described in this section.
4. Use an expander to install the piston rings, start-
ing with the oil control ring in the bottom groove
and working upwards.
The service ring set comprises:
1 coiled wire expander for oil control ring
1 oil control ring
3 compression rings
Oil Control Ring 48
Open the coiled wire expander to fully reveal the
inner guide wire. Position the coiled expander in
the oil groove and insert the inner guide wire into
the open end of the coil. Close the coil until the
ends abut.
Install the cast iron ring (either side up) with the
inside groove over the coiled expander. Position
the ring gap diametrically opposite the coiled wire
ends.
3rd Compression Ring
Dull finish with a step or chamfer on the inside di-
ameter which must face upwards or a step on the
outside diameter which must face downwards on
assembly.
2nd Compression Ring
Bright chrome finish with a step on the inside di-
ameter which must face upwards on assembly.
NOTE: To facilitate assembly, the 2nd and 3rd com-
pression rings are marked with a punched dot or the
letters ‘TOP ’ engraved on their upper surfaces.
Top Compression Ring
Bright chrome finish with a chamfer on the inside
diameter which must face upwards on assembly.
NOTE: Some top compression rings do not have a
chamfer and may be installed either side up.
5. After installing the rings, stagger the ring gaps
around the circumference of the piston.
52 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before installing a piston and new rings into
a used cylinder bore, remove the high polish on the
cylinder wall by passing a hone lightly through the
cylinder or by making a figure-eight pattern with very
fine emery cloth dipped in a mixture of fuel and lubri-
cating oil. After honing, thoroughly wash and dry the
bores and coat the walls with oil.
1. Select the correct bearing liners, as described
later in this section, and install in the connecting
rod and cap. Ensure the bearing liner tang lo-
cates in the slots of the rod and cap.
2. Turn the crankshaft to position the No. 1 crankpin
at the bottom of the stroke. Oil the pistons, rings, 49
cylinder bore, and bearing liners. Use a com-
pressor, 2, to install the piston into the cylinder.
Ensure the notch on the top of the piston is to-
ward the front of the engine.
3. Using a hammer handle, 1, push the piston into
the bore until the connecting rod bearing liner
seats on the crankpin. Install the connecting rod
bearing cap with the number on the cap on the
same side as the number on the rod. Install new
nuts and tighten to 55 N⋅m (63 ft. lbs.).
4. Use feeler gauges to check the side clearance of
each connecting rod. Replace or repair if not
within 0.18 - 0.33 mm (0.007 - 0.013 in.).
5. Install the remaining piston and rod assemblies
in the same manner.
6. Install the oil pump, oil pan sump, and cylinder
head as previously described in this section.
7. Fill the engine with the correct grade and quantity
of oil and the radiator with coolant. See “Specifi-
cations Service Standards” in this section.
8. Start the engine and check for leaks.

50
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 53

CRANKSHAFT, MAIN BEARINGS, AND


FLYWHEEL
NOTE: Replaceable bearing liners are installed in
production to ensure the correct crankshaft journal-
to-bearing clearance can be maintained in service.
The main bearings and crankshaft can only be ser-
viced after removal of the engine from the skid steer
loader. See “Engine Removal” procedure in this sec-
tion.
1. Remove the transmission gearbox. See the pro-
cedure in Section 27.
2. Remove the flywheel.
MAIN BEARINGS

Op. 10 103 10

Removal
1. Remove the oil pan, the oil pump and intermedi-
ate shaft as described earlier in this section.
2. Remove the main bearing cap from the journal to 1
which the new bearing liners are to be installed. 2
Always install one set of bearings at a time, leav-
ing the other main bearing caps securely in
place.
3. Install a bearing liner removal tool in the crank-
51
shaft journal oil passage. Slowly turn the crank-
shaft counterclockwise until the tool forces the
bearing out of the cylinder block.
NOTE: If a bearing liner removal tool, 2, is not avail-
able, a suitable tool may be fabricated from a 1 (25
mm) x 1/8 (3 mm) split pin as shown. The shorter pin
is used to remove the thrust bearing insert, 1.
Flatten and bend the head to 30° to conform to
the angle of the oil passage in the crankshaft.
Inspection And Repair
1. Thoroughly clean the bearing liners, journals,
and caps.
2. Bearing liners with scored, chipped or worn sur-
faces must be replaced. If new liners are to be in-
stalled, check the clearances as described later
in this procedure.
54 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Installation Inspection And Repair


1. Apply a light coat of engine oil to the journal and 1. Inspect the flywheel ring gear and replace if the
bearing liner. teeth are damaged. Check the flywheel for dam-
2. Locate the liner installation tool in the crankshaft age due to a loosely or improperly fitted ring gear.
journal oil passage and position the liner on the 2. A damaged flywheel ring gear should be re-
journal with the plain end of the liner at the tang moved and replaced as follows:
side of the cylinder block. Slowly turn the crank- Cut the old ring gear free from the flywheel.
shaft clockwise until the bearing is fully located.
Thoroughly clean the mating surfaces of the new
Remove the installation tool.
ring gear and the flywheel.
3. Lubricate the bearing cap and liner and install the
Use temperature-indicating crayons to mark the
liner into the cap. Position the bearing cap with
side face of the ring gear at six equally spaced
the locking tang toward the camshaft side of the
locations. Mark with a 204°C (400°F) crayon at a
engine and install the retaining bolts. Tighten the
point 13 mm (0.5″) below the root of the teeth and
bolts to the correct torque. See “Specifications
mark with a 212°C (450°F) crayon at a point just
Service Standards” in this section.
below the root of the teeth.
4. If a new thrust bearing liner is installed, the bear-
Use an oxyacetylene torch with a tip size No. 2
ing must be aligned as described later in this pro-
maximum and direct the flame against the inter-
cedure.
nal face of the gear.
5. Install the oil pump and intermediate shaft and
Stop applying heat when the 204°C (400°F)
the oil pan.
crayon marks melt and before the 212°C (450°F)
crayon marks melt.
FLYWHEEL Quickly place the hot gear on the flywheel with
the flat face against the shoulder on the flywheel.
Op. 10 103 70 NOTE: The flywheel is an unbalanced flywheel. Do
not attempt to have the flywheel balanced to correct
Removal an engine vibration concern.
The flywheel may be removed by performing one of
the following procedures: Installation
Remove the transmission gearbox with the en- 1. Clean the crankshaft rear flange.
gine installed in the skid steer. See “Engine To 2. Establish the correct alignment of the flywheel-
Transmission Gearbox Removal” procedure in to-crankshaft mounting holes and install the fly-
Section 27. wheel. Tighten the attaching bolts to the correct
Remove the transmission gearbox and engine torque and recheck the flywheel runout. See
as an assembly. See “Engine Removal” pro- “Specifications Service Standards” in this sec-
cedure in this section. tion.
Withdraw the flywheel attaching bolts and carefully 3. Install transmission gearbox. See “Engine to
remove the flywheel. Transmission Gearbox Installation” procedure
Check the mating surfaces of the flywheel and the in Section 27.
crankshaft for correct seating. See “Specifications
Service Standards” in this section.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 55

CRANKSHAFT 5. Remove the connecting rod and main bearing


caps and liners and identify to facilitate reas-
Op. 10 103 10 sembly.
6. Carefully lift the crankshaft out of the cylinder
Removal block.
1. Remove the engine from the skid steer. See “En-
gine Removal” procedure in this section. Place Inspection And Repair
the engine on an engine stand. NOTE: Current production engines may have a
2. Remove the flywheel and engine rear cover crankshaft with main or crankpin journals ground
plates. 0.25 mm (0.010″) undersize. These are identified
with the letters 010 MUS and/or 010 PUS, respect-
3. Remove the crankshaft pulley and engine front ively. The letters are stamped on one of the crank-
cover. shaft counterbalance weights.
NOTE: If the crankshaft is removed with the cylinder 1. If the crankshaft gear teeth are excessively worn
head in position, ensure all timing marks are re- or chipped, install a new crankshaft gear which
aligned prior to reassembly. This action will prevent must be fully located on the shoulder of the
possible interference between the valves and pis- crankshaft.
tons during reassembly.
2. Clean the crankshaft and drilled passages.
4. Remove the oil pan, the oil pump and intermedi- Dress minor imperfections with an oil stone and
ate shaft. refinish severely marked journals to the next un-
dersize bearing.
56 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

3. Measure the diameter of each journal in four


places to determine out-of-round taper or wear.
Measurement A compared with B indicates verti-
cal taper while measurement C compared with D
indicates horizontal taper. Measurements A and
B compared with C and D indicate journal out-of-
round. If the journal exceeds the specified wear
limit, refinish the journals to the next undersize
bearing. See “Specifications Service Standards”
in this section. Always reproduce the original
journal side radii and after refinishing, chamfer
the oil holes.
4. Examine the rear oil seal journal for score marks.
Remove minor imperfections with fine emery
52
cloth and, if severely damaged, replace the
crankshaft.
Reassembly
1. Check the crankshaft bearing clearance with
micrometers or preferably using Plastigauge as
follows:
Position a piece of correct size Plastigauge
across the full width of the bearing cap and ap-
proximately 6.0 mm (0.25″) off center.
Install the cap and tighten the bolts to the speci-
fied torque.
Remove the cap and use the scale to check the
width of the flattened Plastigauge. The width of
the Plastigauge at the widest point establishes
the minimum clearance and, at the narrowest
point, the maximum clearance. The difference 53
between the two readings is the taper.
NOTE: Normally, main bearing journals wear evenly
and will not be out-of-round. However, if a liner is
fitted to an out-of-round journal which is within spec-
ifications, be sure to fit the bearing to the maximum
diameter of the journal.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 57

2. Standard size liners are color coded red or blue dersize bearings. See “Specifications Service
and are available in a copper lead or aluminum Standards” in this section.
tin alloy. See “Specifications Service Standards” 3. Position the bearing liners in the block and caps
in this section. and coat with oil. If the crankshaft has been refin-
IMPORTANT: The engine may be assembled with ished, fit the correct undersize main bearing
liners of different material, but liners of the same ma- liners. Ensure the bearing surfaces are clean and
terial must be installed on the same journal. the bearing liner tangs align with the slots in the
The red liners have a thinner wall section than the block and cap.
blue liners and provide greater clearance. A com- 4. Align the timing mark on the crankshaft gear with
bination of red and blue liners may be required to that of the camshaft drive gear and install the
obtain the desired clearance. If the clearance is crankshaft and all bearing caps except for the
greater than specified when two blue liners are rear main bearing. Install the thrust bearing cap
used, a 0.05 mm (0.002″) undersize liner with with the bolts finger tight. Pry the crankshaft for-
either red, blue or another 0.05 mm (0.002″) un- ward and the thrust bearing cap rearward to align
dersize liner should be installed. If any of these the thrust surfaces and tighten the bolts to the
combinations of liners do not produce the speci- specified torque, keeping the bearing cap in the
fied clearance, refinish the crankshaft and fit un- correct position.
58 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

5. Check the crankshaft, 2, end play with a dial indi-


cator gauge, 1. Move the crankshaft rearward 1
and set the dial indicator to zero. Pry the crank-
shaft forward and if the end play exceeds the
limit, install new thrust bearing liners. (See
“Specifications Service Standards” in this sec-
tion.) If the end play is less than the specified
limit, inspect the thrust bearing surfaces for 2
burrs, scratches or dirt. If the thrust surfaces are
not defective or dirty, realign the thrust bearings
as detailed in step 4.

54
6. Wipe the mating surfaces of the block and rear
main bearing cap, 1, and apply a light coat of 1
sealing compound, 2, to both surfaces. Install
new side seals in the rear main bearing cap to
project slightly beyond the block face of the cap
and assemble the cap to the block. Tighten the
bearing cap bolts and cut the side seals to allow
a projection of 0.4 mm (0.016″) above the sump
pan flange.

55
7. Apply a light coating of high-temperature grease
to the rear oil seal bore, seal and journal. Use
Tool No. FNH01301 and three flywheel retaining
bolts to install the seal. Tighten the three bolts
evenly and in sequence.

56
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 59

8. If the initial production seal is being replaced, in-


stall the service seal flush with the block face.
Any second or subsequent service seal replace- 4 1
ment must be fitted 1.5 mm (0.06″) below the
face of the cylinder block, 4.
Mount a dial indicator gauge, 1, on the end of the
crankshaft. Rotate the crankshaft, 2, and check
the runout of the seal, 3, does not exceed 0.38
mm (0.015″).
9. Apply a liberal amount of penetrating oil to the
side seals to cause them to swell. 3 2
10. Install the correct bearing liners in the connecting
rod and cap. If the journals are standard size, se-
lect the correct bearing liners as for main bear- 57
ings in steps 1 and 2. Ensure the bearing liner
tangs locate in the slots of the rod and cap.
11. Install the connecting rod bearing cap, as previ-
ously described in this section, with the number
on the cap on the same side as the number on the
rod. Install new nuts and tighten to the correct
torque. See “Specifications Service Standards”
in this section.

Installation
1. Installation of the components to effect complete
reassembly of the engine follows the removal
procedure in reverse.
CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEAR TRAIN

CAMSHAFT

Op. 10 106 40

Removal
NOTE: The camshaft bearings and/or tappets can
only be serviced with the engine removed from the
skid steer and mounted on an engine stand. See en-
gine removal and engine mounting procedures in this
section.
1. Remove the engine front cover and cylinder
head.
2. Remove the oil pump drive gear and shaft.
3. Check the camshaft end play as described later
in this section. If the clearance exceeds the
specified limit, see “Specifications Service Stan-
dards” in this section. Install a new thrust plate
during reassembly.
4. Invert the engine on the stand and remove the oil
pan if the camshaft bearings and/or the tappets
are to be removed.
60 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

5. If the fuel pump will not be removed, rotate the


engine in the normal direction of rotation to 29°
BTDC compression stroke. Lock the pump lock-
ing tag using the bolt to 13 N⋅m (9.6 ft. lbs.). Lock-
ing tab location “1”, is unlocked, and location “2”
is locked.
NOTE: If the fuel pump will be disassembled, fuel
pump timing adjustment will be necessary.
6. Withdraw the bolt and flat washer and remove
the camshaft gear.
7. Withdraw the bolts and lock washers and remove
the camshaft thrust plate.
8. Lift out the tappets and place in a numbered rack
to facilitate reassembly. 58
9. Remove the camshaft.
Inspection and Repair
1. Inspect the camshaft journals and lobes for dam-
age, pitting or heat discoloration.
2. Inspect the oil pump drive gear on the camshaft
for broken or worn teeth. Check the mating gear
on the oil pump drive shaft. If any damage is ap-
parent, install a new camshaft and/or oil pump
drive gear.
3. Measure the diameter and out-of-round of the
bearing journals. If the journals exceed the speci-
fied limits, see “Specifications Service Stan-
dards” in this section. Install a new camshaft.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 61

Camshaft Bearings
1. Inspect the camshaft bearings for pitting or scor-
ing. Measure the clearance between the internal
diameter of the bearings and the outside diam-
eter of the respective camshaft journals.
If the clearance exceeds the specified limit, see
“Specifications Service Standards” in this sec-
tion, remove and install new bearings, 1, using
Remover/Replacer Tool No. FNH01255, 3, and
Handle, Tool No. FNH 01442, 4.
2. Camshaft Bearing Removal:
Position Tool No. FNH01255 against the cam-
shaft bearing to be removed and attach handle
Tool No. FNH01442. Drive the camshaft bearing 59
from the bearing bore.
3. Camshaft Bearing Installation:
Align the oil holes of the new camshaft bearing
with the oil holes in the engine block, 2, then drive
the new bearing into place using Tool No.
FNH01255 and Handle, Tool No. FNH01442.
NOTE: A positive alignment check can only be made
with the crankshaft removed, when a 4.6 mm (0.18)
diameter rod may be passed down the oil passage
from the crankshaft main bearing. The liner is cor-
rectly positioned when the end of the rod passes
through the oil hole in the liner.

Installation
Installation of the camshaft follows the removal pro-
cedure in reverse. On installation, observe the fol-
lowing requirements:
Apply petroleum jelly to each tappet foot and coat the
tappet body with oil. Install the tappets in the bores
from which they were removed.
Oil the camshaft journals and apply petroleum jelly to
the cam lobes before carefully installing the camshaft
into the engine.
Install the spacer and a new key on the front of the
camshaft.
Align the camshaft drive gear timing mark and re-
check the camshaft end play.
62 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

TIMING GEAR

Op. 10 106

Removal
NOTE: The engine front cover and timing gears can
only be serviced after removing the radiator and oil
cooler assembly. See “Engine Removal” procedure
in this section.
1. Drain the engine oil and remove the oil pan.
2. If the fuel pump will not be removed, rotate the
engine in the normal direction of rotation to 29°
BTDC compression stroke. Lock the pump lock-
60
ing tag using the bolt to 13 N⋅m (9.6 ft. lbs.). Lock-
ing tab location “1” is unlocked, and location “2”
is locked.
NOTE: If the fuel pump will be disassembled, fuel
pump timing adjustment will be necessary.
3. Remove the fan drive belt and withdraw the bolt
and washer from the center of the crankshaft
pulley.

Op. 10 106 66
4. Using Puller No. FNH09539, 3, and Shaft Protec-
tor No. FNH09212, 1, remove crankshaft pulley,
4.
5. Withdraw the retaining bolts, then remove the
front cover and gasket. Remove the oil slinger.

61
6. Before removing the timing gears, measure the
backlash between each set of mating gears.
Op. 10 106 60
1 Camshaft gear
Op. 10 106 68
2 Crankshaft gear
3 Camshaft drive gear
4 Injection pump drive gear

62
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 63

Use a dial indicator or feeler gauges, 1, to measure


the backlash between each set of mating gears. Ro-
tate the gears and check the backlash at four equidis-
tant points on the gears. Replace the gears if the
backlash exceeds the specified limits. See “Specifi-
cations Service Standards” in this section.

63
7. Pry the camshaft gear, 3, away from the thrust
plate, 4, using a pry bar, 1. Use a dial indicator or
feeler gauges, 2, to measure the clearance. Re-
place the gears if the camshaft end play exceeds
the specified limits, see “Specifications Service
Standards” in this section.

64
8. Remove the fuel injection pump drive gear, cam-
shaft drive gear and adapter, and the camshaft 1
gear. Use Tool No. FNH02134, puller, with
FNH01237, adapter, 1, to remove the crankshaft
gear.
NOTE: The crankshaft gear should only be removed
if it shows signs of wear.

65
64 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Inspection And Repair


1. Wash the gears and adapter in a suitable solvent
and dry with a clean lint-free cloth or compressed
air.
2. Examine the gear teeth for wear, burrs, or
scratches. Any minor burrs or scratches may be
removed with a fine abrasive; ensure such parts
are thoroughly washed before reassembly.
3. Ensure the camshaft drive gear adapter oil pass-
age is free from obstruction and the drive gear
bushing is not damaged.
4. Check the key and keyway in the end of both the
camshaft and crankshaft for damage. Replace
the keys if necessary.
5. Inspect the front crankshaft pulley for the
counterweight and correct position. The counter-
weight is shown properly positioned at 1. The
counterweight must be positioned opposite the
open slots, 2, in the pulley.
If the counterweight is missing, order one #E8NN
- 6N310-AA and install as described and shown.
If the counterweight is positioned incorrectly, re-
move the weight retaining bolts and reposition as
shown
The counterweight can be either a single-piece
or two-piece construction. The two-piece weight
will be installed in the same manner as the single-
piece weight. The two-piece weight is the same 66
shape as the single-piece weight and requires
two weights bolted together to equal the same
weight as the single-piece weight. Both styles of
counterweight are acceptable for engine use.
Installation
1
1. Install the spacer, key, and the camshaft gear,
then recheck the camshaft end play.
2. Locate the key, then use Tool No. FNH02134,
puller, and FNH01237, adapter, 1, to install the
crankshaft gear.

67
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 65

3. Position No. 1 piston at Top Dead Center (refer


to Engine Timing section to determine Top Dead
Center). Install the camshaft drive gear, 3, and
adapter with the timing marks aligned with those
of the other gears.
Tighten the bolt to the specified torque and re-
check the backlash between the gears.
4. Asemble the fuel injection pump to the engine
front plate. Check No. 1 piston is at T.D.C. and in-
stall the injection pump drive gear, 4, with the tim-
ing mark aligned with that of the camshaft drive
gear, 3.

68
NOTE: All engines with a rotary (distributor) type fuel
injection pump have a common fuel injection pump 1
drive gear. This gear features two timing marks
identified by numerals 3 and 4 for 3- and 4-cylinder
engines, respectively. When installing the pump
drive gear, 1, ensure the 3-cylinder timing mark 4
aligns with the camshaft drive gear, 2, timing mark.
5. Install a new dust seal in the front cover. Lubri-
cate the oil seal with petroleum jelly and use a 3
Tool FNH09210 adapter to press the seal into the
front cover.
6. Locate the oil slinger onto the crankshaft with the 2
dished face outward.
7. Position a new gasket on the engine front plate 69
and install the front cover ensuring the cover
aligns with the dowel pins. Tighten the bolts to the
specified torque.
8. Lubricate the crankshaft pulley spacer and slide
over the key. Replace the pulley hub and tap onto
the crankshaft. Tighten the securing bolt to the
specified torque. See “Specifications Service
Standards” in this section.
9. Install the oil pan with a new gasket and tighten
the bolts to the specified torque. See “Specifica-
tions Service Standards” in this section.
10. Refill the engine with the correct grade and quan-
tity of oil. See “Specifications Service Standards”
in this section.
66 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

ENGINE TIMING
1. Remove the rocker cover and observe the valves 1
and rocker arms of the No. 1 cylinder while rotat-
ing the engine. Rotate the engine until the ex-
haust valve moves fully open then begins to
close.

70
When the exhaust valve is nearly closed, the in-
take valve begins to open. This is Top Dead
Center (TDC) for the exhaust stroke.
NOTE: If the tappets are set to the proper specifica-
tions, the intake valve opens at 12 before TDC and
the exhaust valve closes at 12 after TDC. This is re-
ferred to as “valve overlap.”

19993686
71
2. Mark the flywheel or pulley with chalk and con-
tinue to rotate the engine clockwise. Rotate one
full turn (360°) minus 29° of advance (331° total).
This position is the No. 1 piston to nearly TDC on
the compression stroke.

19993687
72
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 67

3. Remove the rocker arm and shaft assembly and


set it aside in a clean location.

19992950
73
4. Use a suitable valve spring compressor to re-
move the valve keepers from either thr intake or
exhaust valve on the #1 cylinder. This allows the
valve to drop slightly if the piston is at top center.
Lightly tap the end of the valve with a soft mallet
to be sure that the valve is against the piston.
IMPORTANT: Do not strike the valve with a metal
hammer or other similar tool. Striking the valve stem
with too much force will damage it, requiring expens-
ive valve repair and replacement.

19993689
74
68 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

5. Set a dial indicator over the valve stem and set


it to zero. Turn the engine clockwise, then
counterclockwise, moving several degrees each
direction. Reset the dial indicator to zero with the
valve stem at its highest point.
6. Turn the engine counterclockwise until the valve
lowers and the dial indicator reads at least 12.52
mm (0.500 in.).
7. Turn the engine clockwise, keeping the valve
against the piston, until the indicator shows the
correct measurement.
Pump Timing Degree Chart
19993690
No. of Engine Pump #1 Piston 75
Cylinders Timing Lock Drop
Degree
3 29° 340° 7.59 ±
BTDC 0.025 mm
(0.299 ±
0.001 in.)

NOTE: Piston drop distance includes the average


protrusion of the piston above the block face as re-
quired when using the drop valve timing method.
8. Install the locked, pre-timed fuel injection pump
(see “Installing the Fuel Injection Pump”).
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 69

9. Turn the engine clockwise until the dial indicator


reads zero. Set the valve spring, valve guide and
keepers in place on the valve stem. Fully seat the
keepers into the groove in the valve stem.

19993690
76
10. Reinstall the rocker arm and shaft assembly.
Tighten the bolts to 217 N⋅m (160 ft. lbs.) and set
the valve clearances.
Intake Valve Lash:
0.36 - 0.46 mm (0.014 - 0.018 in.)
Exhaust Valve Lash:
0.43 - 0.53 mm (0.017 - 0.021 in.)
Turn the engine at least two full revolutions to en-
sure that all valves open and close fully.

19992950
77
11. Reinstall the rocker cover with its gasket. Tighten
the rocker cover bolts to 20 - 27 N⋅m (15 - 20 ft. 1
lbs.).

78
70 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 400

COOLING SYSTEM - SL65B


2
RADIATOR

Op. 10 406 10
2 1
Removal
1. Drain the engine coolant system.
2. Lift up on the two handles, 1, to move the radiator
rearward.
3. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses. 79
4. Remove the radiator overflow hose to the over-
flow tank.
5. Remove two cap screws and spacers, 2. Re-
move the radiator.

Inspection and Repair


1. Inspect the fins for damage and ensure they are
free from obstruction.
2. Check the radiator for leaks.

Installation
Installation of the radiator follows the removal
procedure in reverse. On installation, observe
the following requirements:
Depending upon the weather conditions, ensure
the correct grade and quantity of antifreeze is
added to the coolant. See “Specifications Ser-
vice Standards” in this section.
Run the engine for several minutes and check
the radiator and connections for leaks.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 71

Op. 10 402 30
1
THERMOSTAT REMOVAL
1. Drain the cooling system to below the level of the
coolant outlet connection, 1.
2. Remove the coolant outlet connection retaining
bolts and slide the connection with the hose at-
tached to one side.
3. Remove the thermostat, 3, and gasket, 2.

Inspection and Repair 3 2


Place the thermostat in a container of water and heat
the water. If the thermostat valve does not open at or 80
near the specified temperature, or fails to close, in-
stall a new thermostat. For opening temperature, see
“Specifications Service Standards” in this section.

Installation
Installation of the thermostat follows the removal pro-
cedure in reverse. On installation observe the follow-
ing requirements:
Coat a new coolant outlet connection gasket with
sealer and position on the cylinder head or manifold
prior to installing the thermostat.
Coat the edge of the thermostat with grease and in-
stall with the heat element located in the cylinder
head.
72 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 402 10

WATER PUMP REMOVAL


1. Open the rear door and disconnect the radiator
overflow hose at the overflow tank. Remove cap
screw and nut, 1. Remove the rear door.
2. Drain the engine coolant system.

81
3. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses, 1,
from the engine block and plug the hoses with
plastic plugs. 3
4. Remove cap screws and nuts, 2. Slide fan
shroud, 3, forward to access the oil cooler line
connection. 1
5. Disconnect the oil cooler bottom left line and cap
to prevent loss of oil.
2

82
6. Remove the hydraulic oil filter restriction switch
wires, 1, and harness clamps, 2.
7. Disconnect hydraulic line, 3, from the oil filter
base.
1
2

83
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 73

8. Loosen clamps, 1, and remove the fuel tank filler


neck, 2.
2

84
9. Remove the rear door latch bracket, 1, by remov-
ing the two capscrews, 2.
1

19984501
85
10. Remove eight mounting cap screws, 1, (four
screws on each side). Remove the radiator/oil
cooler assembly from the skid steer.
NOTE: The radiator/oil cooler assembly is heavy and
may require a lifting device to remove.
11. Remove the alternator drive belt.
12. Withdraw the four bolts which pass through the 1
water pump into the block and remove the pump.

19984502
86
74 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 402 28
4
Disassembly
1. Withdraw the attaching bolts and remove the fan 1
from the pump pulley, 1.
2. Use Puller Tool No. FNH09539, 2, and a sleeve,
3, slightly smaller than the pulley shaft to remove
the pump pulley, 1.
3. Remove the retaining bolts, then separate the
pump covers, 4, and discard the gasket.
3 2

87
4. Use a sleeve, 1, with a diameter slightly smaller
than the bearing shaft to press the shaft and
bearing assembly, 2, out of the impeller, 3, and
pump housing, 4.
1

4 2

88
5. Use a suitable sleeve and press the seal assem-
bly, 1, out of the impeller side, 2, of the pump 2
housing. Discard the seal assembly, 1.

Inspection And Repair


1. Check the impeller, 2, for worn or damaged
vanes and inspect the seal surface on the rear
face of the impeller. Install a new impeller if the
seal surface or vanes are damaged.
2. Inspect the bearing shaft for scoring or any other
damage.
3. Check both parts of the pump housing for cracks 1
or signs of leakage. Replace any defective parts.
89
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 75

Reassembly
1. Use a sleeve, 1, which passes over the shaft and 1
rests on the outside diameter of the bearing, to
press the bearing and shaft assembly, 2, into the
housing until the bearing is flush with the face of 2
the housing. Use a straightedge to check the final
position.

90
2. Turn the pump housing over and position in a
press, 1, with the seal bore facing upwards. 1
3. Coat the outer diameter of the seal flange with a
thin application of thread sealer and position the
seal assembly over the shaft in the center bore
of the housing.
4. Place Tool No. FNH04672, 3, over the shaft and
onto the seal assembly, 2. Press the seal into the
bore until the flange is flush with the top of the
housing. 2
3

91
5. Support the shaft on a block of wood and use a
length of pipe of suitable internal diameter to
press the impeller, 1, onto the shaft, 2, and flush 1
with the rear face of the housing. Check the final
position with a straightedge.

92
76 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

6. Support the shaft on a block of wood and press


the pulley onto the shaft, to 63 mm (2.48″), di-
mension “A.” This dimension is from the rear face
of the front cover to the center of the pulley V-
groove. After installation, ensure the pulley, 1,
runs true on the shaft.
7. Install a new gasket and assemble the front and
rear halves of the pump together and tighten the
bolts to the specified torque. See “Specifications
Service Standards” in this section. A
8. Install the fan on the pulley and tighten the bolts
to the specified torque. See “Specifications Ser- 1
vice Standards” in this section.
93
Installation
1. Installation of the water pump follows the re-
moval procedure in reverse. On installation ob-
serve the following requirements:
Install a new pump gasket.
Adjust the alternator drive belt tension. See “Ad-
just Belt Tension” in this section.
After installation of the radiator, fill the cooling
system and run the engine to check for leaks.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 77

Op. 10 304 2. Inspect the sump for cracks, damaged drain plug
threads, or distorted gasket surface.
LUBRICATION SYSTEM - SL65B
Installation
Op. 10 102 10 On installation, observe the following requirements:
Ensure the gasket surfaces on the oil pan and
OIL PAN REMOVAL block are clean.
The oil pan can be removed with the engine installed Install a new gasket and apply a thin film of sealer
in the skid steer by first removing the rear engine to the gasket, front cover, and oil pan.
belly pan. This allows ready access to the pan secur- Position the oil pan and install a bolt finger tight
ing bolts. at each corner.
Install the remaining bolts, tighten the rear bolts
Inspection And Repair first, then tighten from the middle outward in each
1. Scrape all gasket material from the gasket sur- direction to the specified torque.
face, then wash the oil pan sump in a suitable sol- Fill the engine with the correct grade and quantity
vent and dry with a clean lint-free cloth or com- of oil.
pressed air. Operate the engine and check for oil leaks.
78 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

OIL PUMP REMOVAL

Op. 10 304 34
1. Remove the oil pan as described earlier in this
section. 4 1
2. Remove oil pump retaining bolts, 3. Remove the
oil pump, 4, with the filter screen, 1. Withdraw the
intermediate shaft, 2.

3 2

94
3. Remove the engine oil filter, 1.
4. Remove plug, 2, then withdraw the drive shaft
adapter assembly and the oil pump drive gear.

95
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 79

14
13

12 1
9 10 11

6 2
3
6 4
8 7
5

96
Disassembly
1. Remove the pump screen. 1. Oil pump retaining bolts
2. Plug
2. Withdraw the retaining screw and washer as-
3. Drive shaft adapter mounting base
semblies, then separate the inner and outer
4. Oil pump drive shaft and gear assembly
covers from the body and extract the rotor and
5. ntermediate shaft
shaft assembly.
6. Screw and washer assemblies
3. Insert a self-tapping screw into the relief valve 7. Screen
plug and pull the plug out of the body. Withdraw 8. Spring
the relief valve and spring. 9. Outer cover
10. nner cover
11. nner rotor and shaft assembly
12. Outer rotor
13. Body
14. Pressure relief valve assembly
80 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Inspection And Repair


1. Wash all parts in a suitable solvent and dry with 1
a clean lint-free cloth or compressed air.
2. Inspect the inside of the pump cover and body for
excessive wear. 4
3. Use a straightedge and feeler gauges, 4, to
measure the end play between the inner rotor, 3,
and the pump body, 1, and measure the clear-
ance between the outer rotor, 2, and the pump 2
body, 1. 3

97
4. Use feeler gauges, 3, to measure the clearance
between the periphery of the outer rotor, 1, and
the pump body, 2.
5. Check the relief valve spring tension. See “Spec-
ifications Service Standards” in this section.
6. Inspect the relief valve for wear and check for
freedom of movement within the bore.
7. Check the oil pump drive gear for worn or dam-
aged teeth.
8. Examine the intermediate drive shaft socket
ends for wear.

Reassembly
98
Reassembly of the oil pump components follows the
disassembly procedure in reverse. On reassembly,
observe the following requirements.
Oil all the parts.
The inner rotor and shaft assembly and the outer
rotor are serviced as an assembly.
Prior to installation, introduce clean engine oil
into the inlet port and rotate the pump shaft by
hand.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 81

Installation
Installation of the oil pump follows the removal pro-
cedure in reverse. On installation, observe the fol-
lowing requirements.
Apply silicone sealant to the mating surface of
plug, 1.
Remove all traces of seal material from the locat-
ing surface, then install a new oil filter and seal.
Apply a light, even coat of clean engine oil to the
seal surface prior to installation. Hand tighten the 1
filter until the seal contacts the locating surface,
then tighten an additional one-half to three-
quarters of a turn.
IMPORTANT: Never use a tool to tighten the spin-on 99
filter.
Op. 10 304 06

OIL LEVEL DIPSTICK


If the engine oil level dipstick is difficult to remove or
reinstall, the end of the dipstick may be bent or
broken off. This can be caused by the dipstick tube.
The long rubber tube, 1, allows the oil level to be
checked from the rear of the loader. The rubber tube
must connect correctly to the engine and the back
frame for the level reading to be accurate. Check that 2
the rubber tube is completely against the rear frame 1
support, 2.

19987124
100
Push the end of the rubber tube, 1, to make sure it
contacts the engine block, 2.

1
2
19987125
101
82 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 200

FUEL SYSTEM
The diesel fuel system consists of a fuel tank, electric
lift pump, fuel filter/sediment separator, DPS 200
series fuel injection pump, fuel injectors and inter
connecting fuel lines. A dry type air cleaner removes
dirt and contaminants from the air intake.

DP203
The fuel is drawn from the fuel tank, through the sedi-
ment separator and fuel filter by the electric lift pump,
and then fed into the injection pump.
The transfer pump delivers fuel to the injection pump
to supply fuel at high pressure to each injector and
also provides extra fuel which lubricates and cools
the injection pump. This extra fuel is recirculated via
a fitting on the fuel injection pump governor control
housing to the fuel tank by means of the injector leak
off line.
The excess fuel that leaks past the needle valve of
the injectors is directed back into the fuel tank at the
filler neck by means of the injection leak off line.
FUEL TANK
A plastic fuel tank, 1, is located on the lower left rear
of the machine.

1
19982962
102
Op. 10 210 21
2
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP
Mounted on the left hand side of the engine above the
fuel filter is an electrical lift pump, 1. The pump draws 1
fuel through the sediment separator, 2, and the fuel
filter, 3. The fuel is then pressurized and fed into the
fuel injection pump.

19982965
103
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 83

Op. 10 206 10

FUEL FILTER
The filter, 1, positioned on theright hand side of the
engine behind the injection pump directs the fuel
through the filter head to be directed down through
the filter paper into the base chamber. The filtered 1
fuel then flows up the center tube of the element to
the filter head outlet and flows onto the injection
pump.
The drain plug, 2, permits contaminated fuel to be 2
drained from the filter.
19982974
104
THERMOSTART
To aid engine starting in cold weather conditions, a
thermostart system incorporating an integral reser-
voir system is available.
The thermostart system is made up of a plug assem-
bly screwed intothe intake manHold, afuel line con-
nected to the injector leak off tube and an electrical
circuit, connected to the ignition switch.
The plug assembly, 1, consists of a check valve and
electrically heated element.
Fuel is gravity fed to the plug assembly and, when op-
erating the key starVstop switch and the thermostart
switch, the heater and “igniter” coils are both ener-
gized. The “heater” coil opens a check valve which al- 105
lows diesel fuel to flow through the thermostart. The
fuel is ignited by the “igniter” coil in the manifold, heat-
ing the intake manifold air prior to H entering the com-
bustion chamber.
When the thermostart switch is released to the off
position, the electrical current is disconnected from
the thermostart and the check valve closes.
Op. 10 246 14

FUEL PUMP
The fuel injection pump fitted to these vehicles is the
DP203 (emissionized) type. The fuel pump, which is
fed by an electric lift pumper, supplies fuel at high
pressure to the fuel injectors.

106
84 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 218 34

INJECTORS
The fuel injectors, 1, mounted in the cylinder head
supply fuel in the form of a spray pattern into the cylin-
der bores. The controlled amounts of fuel ensure
optimum engine performance throughout the operat-
ing ranae.

107
ADJUSTMENTS

INJECTION PUMP LOCK TIMING (ON BENCH)


1. Unlock the pump by loosening the locking screw,
1.

1
19983007
108
2. Install a key, 1, P/N 74145S, into the slot in the
fuel injection pump drive shaft, 2.

2
19983002
109
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 85

3. Place the small adapter, 1, P/N PD67/3, onto the


shaft. Place the key in the slot to make sure the
adapter is properly aligned. Use the lock washer,
2, P/N D8NN9G593AA, and nut, 3, P/N 4
D8NN9N904AA. Hold the adapter counterclock- 1
wise while tightening the nut to 27 Nm (20 ft Ibs). 2
4. Place the guide, 4, P/N MS67B/8, over the shaft
and pilot area of the pump housing, followed by 3
the protractor assembly.
NOTE: Preset the protractor to the 29 degree mark.
Pump Timing Degree Chart

No. of Engine Pump #1 Piston 19983002


Cylinders Timing Lock Drop 110
Degree
3 29° 340° 7.59 ±
BTDC 0.025 mm
(0.299 ±
0.001 in.)
5. Place the protractor, 1, on the adapter and into
the support. The marker (pointer) should extend
to allow maximum visibility for the pump timing
mark in the slot.

19983005
111
6. Rotate the pump until the timing mark, 1, on the
pump flange is centered in the marker (pointer)
slot, 2.

1
2

19983006
112
86 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

7. Lock the pump shaft as follows: Loosen the lock-


ing screw, 1, remove or realign the washer so the
large hole fits over the shoulder of the screw, then
retighten the screw against the pump shaft to 41
Nm (30 ft Ibs).
NOTE: Verify that the marker aligns with the pump
timing mark.
8. Remove the timing tool, nut and lock washer.
Loosen the adapter from the shaft.
IMPORTANT: Remove the key from the pump.
9. Install the pump on the engine (refer to Engine
Timing Section). 1
19983007
113
VERIFYING PUMP TIMING
1. Set the engine on its basic timing mark (see
chart).
2. Lock and remove the pump (see “Removing the
Injection Pump”).
3. Install a key, P/N 74145S, into the slot in the fuel
injection pump drive shaft.
4. Place the small adapter, 1, P/N PD67/3, onto the
shaft in alignment with the key. Use the lock
washer, 2, P/N D8NN9G593AA, and nut, 3, P/N
D8NN9N904AA. Hold the gear counterclockwise 4
to prevent the pump from rotating while tighten- 1
ing the nut to 27 N⋅m (20 ft Ibs). 2
5. Place the guide, 4, P/N MS67B/8, over the shaft
and pilot area of the pump housing. 3
Pump Timing Degree Chart

No. of Engine Pump #1 Piston


Cylinders Timing Lock Drop
Degree 19983002
3 29° 340° 7.59 ± 114
BTDC 0.025 mm
(0.299 ±
0.001 in.)
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 87

6. Loosen the marker (pointer) and place the pro-


tractor, 1, on the adapter and into the support.
The marker should extend to allow maximum vis-
ibility for the pump timing mark in the slot.

19983005
115
7. Slide the pointer bar until it aligns with the timing
mark, 1, on the pump flange.
8. If the reading is 29°, the pump is properly timed.
If the reading differs, the pump is out of time. Fol-
low the procedure in “Injection Pump Lock Tim-
ing” to retime the pump. Each degree the pump
1
varies from the proper timing equals two engine
degrees of timing.

19983006
116
INSTALLING THE INJECTION PUMP
1. Place the locked, pre timed fuel Injection pump
on the engine. The mounting bolts install from in-
side the front cover. Two bolts thread into the
pump flange, while the third bolt uses a nut on the
outside of the pump flange. Tighten to 20 - 25 Nm
(15 - 18 ft Ibs).
IMPORTANT: Use an O ring, P/N 14437585, on each
mounting bolt prior to inserting if through the mount-
ing holes. Failure to install new O rings on the bolts
may allow engine lubricant to leak out.
2. Place the washer and retaining nut on the gear,
leaving the nut loose for now. 19983009
117
88 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

3. Hold the gear counterclockwise to take up any


backlash between the pump gear and idler gear.
While holding the gear, tighten the nut, 1, to 74.5
- 81.3 Nm (55 - 60 ft Ibs). Do not move the gear
train.

19983010
118
4. Unlock the fuel pump by loosening the lock
screw, 1, and installing or realigning the washer
so that the small opening is under the screw
head. Retighten the lock screw to 11 - 13 Nm (8
- 10 ft Ibs). Do not overtighten.
5. Reinstall all fuel lines, tubing, access covers and
other hardware that was removed during service.
Use proper gaskets or sealants, and tighten all
hardware to the appropriate torque.
6. Prime the fuel system and start the engine. In-
spect the fuel system and repair any leaks.
NOTE: Always run the engine and inspect all con- 1
nections and components to be sure they function 19983007
properly before returning the unit to service. 119
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 89

Priming The Fuel System


NOTE: The fuel system should be primed whenever
fuel system components are removed or discon-
nected In order to expel any air In the system.
1. Make sure there is sufficient fuel in the tank and
all connections are tight.
2. Operate key start switch to activate the electric
fuel pump. An audible difference is dectectable
when the system is primed, this may take up to
5 minutes.
NOTE: The bleed screw, 1, in the filter head is on the
intake side and must be kept closed during priming.
NOTE: Attempt to start the engine. If It does not start,
continue through Step 4.
3. With the throttle in the maximum no load speed
position, operate the starting motor to crank the
engine. The fuel injection pump is self venting
and does not require bleeding.
IMPORTANT: Do not crank the starting motor con-
tinuously for more than 60 seconds as doing so may
cause starting motor failure. 1
4. If the engine fails to start after 60 seconds, repeat
19982965
the priming procedure outlined above.
120
5. Run the engine and check for leaks.
IDLE SPEED ADJUSTMENT
1. With the engine running and at normal tempera-
ture, disconnect the throttle cable at the injection
pump.
2. Loosen the locknut and adjust the idle speed stop
screw, 1, until the specified idle speed of 700 -
800 RPM is obtained. Tighten the locknut and re-
connect the throttle cable.
3. Operate the throttle lever several times and
1
check that the idle speed is correct. If excessive
free play is felt in either the foot or hand throttle
after adjustment, proceed to “Throttle Linkage
Adjustments” in this section.
121
90 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 218 34

INJECTORS
Coupled to the fuel injection pump are low inertia type
injectors. The turbocharged engine incorporates five
hole nozzle low inertia injectors. The overhaul pro-
cedure for the low inertia injector is described below.
1. Fuel inlet
2. Shims
3. Spring seat
4. Nozzle valve
5. Nozzle valve seat
6. Nozzle tip
7. Nozzle retaining nut 122
8. Nozzle
9. Doweled adapter plate
10. Spring
11. njector body
12. Leak-off line
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 91

Injector Testing ± 3 bar [44 PSI] approximately). When new


WARNING shims are assembled and the nozzle retaining
nut tightened to the correct torque, 48 N·m (35 ft.
The spray from an injector tester can pierce human lbs.), assemble to the tester, prime and recheck
skin with serious results. When an injector is spray- the opening pressure.
ing, the nozzle should be turned away from the oper-
NOTE: If a new spring has been fitted, the opening
ator and any other persons.
pressure should be set to 3528 PSI (236 bar) to allow
for spring settling.
During the nozzle opening pressure and spray pat-
tern tests, collect the spray in a container partly filled
with rags to absorb the spray. Nozzle Seat Leakage:
When conducting the nozzle seat leakage test, re- Wipe the nozzle tip dry and apply a pressure of 217
lease the injector tester pump pressure before touch- bar (3234 PSI), i.e., 10 bar (147 PSI) below the open-
ing the nozzle tip with a sheet of blotting paper. ing pressure. The nozzle tip and bottom face must re-
main essentially dry, and there must be no tendency
The spray is flammable - ensure no bare lights are in for blobs of fuel to collect or drip. A slight dampness
the area of the tester and do not generate excessive can be ignored. If there is any leakage from the
vapor. nozzle seat, the nozzle assembly must be scrapped.
1. Fill the injector tester with a calibrating fuel oil
(ISO 4113) and leave the filler cap loose to pre- Nozzle Back Leakage:
vent a vacuum forming during testing.
Apply a pressure of 217 bar (3234 PSI), i.e., 10 bar
2. Prime the tester until oil is emitted from the tester (147 PSI) below the opening pressure, then release
line, then connect the injector. the handle. The time/pressure drop should be be-
3. Ensure the knob on the right-hand side of the tween 148 - 99 bar (2205 and 1470 PSI) within 45
tester is screwed in to prevent the gauge being seconds to 6 seconds. If below 6 seconds, the nozzle
overpressurized if the injector nozzle is blocked. assembly must be scrapped. If above 45 seconds,
4. Pump the tester and check that the nozzle is free check for carbon on the valve and/or blocked back
to open. Open the pressure gauge valve and leak drillings.
begin injector testing. If the nozzle is blocked or
the needle jammed, begin the disassembly pro- Spray Pattern:
cedures. Pump the tester rapidly (80 - 90 strokes per min.) and
5. Nozzle opening pressure setting: Slowly pump observe the spray pattern from the five holes. An
the injector tester and observe the pressure at atomized spray free from distortion, irregular streaks
which the needle valve lifts and fuel is injected of unvaporized fuel and hosing should be observed.
from the nozzle tip. The opening pressure should The tester is not regarded as providing a substitute
be 227 bar (3381 PSI). If the opening pressure is for atomization under working conditions but gives
incorrect, dismantle the injector and add or sub- an approximate indication of the working of the
tract shims as necessary to obtain the correct nozzle.
opening pressure (± 0.02 mm of shims equals
92 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

123
FUEL INJECTOR OVERHAUL

Op. 10 218 34
Disassembly 1. Injector body
1. Place the injector in a holding fixture with the 2. Copper sealing washers
nozzle uppermost. Do not clamp the injector 3. Leak-off line connector
body in a vise. Remove the nozzle retaining nut 4. Shims
complete with the nozzle body, nozzle valve, and 5. Spring seat
the doweled adapter plate. 6. Nozzle valve
7. Nozzle
2. Remove the injector body, 1, from the holding fix-
8. Nozzle retaining nut
ture, invert and carefully remove the spring seat,
5, spring, 10, and adjustment shims, 4. To avoid 9. Doweled adapter plate
damage, place all dismantled components in 10. Spring
suitable baths of clean fuel oil.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 93

Inspection And Repair


NOTE: To prevent corrosion of injector components
after cleaning, rinse in clean fuel oil and place in a
suitable bath of clean fuel oil.
1. Clean the injector body by soaking in a carbon
solvent and brushing with a brass wire brush. In-
spect the body threads and pressure face for
damage, ensuring the fuel galleries are thor-
oughly clean with no signs of corrosion or pitting.
2. Clean the spring and spring seat using a brass
wire brush and check for scoring, pitting or cor-
rosion.
3. Clean the doweled adapter plate using a brass
wire brush. Inspect the plate for loose or bent do-
wels, damaged pressure face or corrosion.
4. Clean the nozzle valve and body by soaking in a
carbon solvent and brushing with a wire brush.
Using the tools included in a proprietary injector
nozzle cleaning kit, clean the nozzle, 2, as fol-
lows:
NOTE: If the nozzle valve is in any way damaged or
blued, it must be discarded and a new matched
nozzle valve and nozzle body assembly obtained. It
is not possible to grind or lap the three special angles
on the valve point.
a. Clean the spray holes with a 0.30 mm nozzle
cleaning wire, 3, held in a pin vise, 1, so that it pro-
trudes for only 1.5 mm, thereby giving maximum
resistance to bending. Insert the wire into each 124
hole, pushing and rotating gently until each hole
is cleared.
b. Clean the nozzle valve seat using the valve
seat scraper, 1, by rotating and pushing the tool
onto the valve seating.

125
94 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

c. Clean the fuel gallery using the fuel gallery


scraper, 1. Insert the scraper into the gallery,
press hard against the side of the cavity, and ro-
tate to clear all carbon deposits from this area.
5. Use a Reverse Flush Adapter, Tool No.
FNH08124, on the injector tester and reverse
flush the nozzle to remove the carbon loosened
during cleaning step 4.
6. Inspect the nozzle valve and body for scoring or
pitting and ensure there are no deposits of car-
bon or corrosion. Check that the spray holes and
fuel galleries are clean and that no blueing is
present. The nozzle valve must move freely with-
in the nozzle body. 126
7. Clean the nozzle retaining nut using a brass wire
brush and check that the threads are not dam-
aged and are free from carbon deposits.

Reassembly
1. Ensure all parts are absolutely clean and undam-
aged prior to reassembly. Rinse all parts in clean
fuel oil and assemble the components while still
wet.
2. Place the shims, spring and spring seat into the
injector body bore. Place the injector body into
the holding fixture.
3. Assemble the nozzle valve into the nozzle body
and then position the doweled adapter plate onto
the nozzle body. Insert this assembly into the
nozzle retaining nut.
4. Carefully assemble the doweled adapter plate, 2,
and the nozzle retaining nut assembly onto the
injector body, 1, and tighten the retaining nut to 1
48 N·m (35 ft. lbs.).

127
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 95

Op. 10 210 21
1
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP - SL65B
The pump, 1, is mounted into the head of the fuel filter
and is activated via the key-start switch.
The fuel is drawn up from the tank through the separ-
ator and filter assemblies and then out to the FIP
inlet.

A5378 - 07

128
1. With the key start on, check for 12V at the electri-
cal copnnector of the pump, 1. If 12V is not pres-
ent, check fuses, relay and wiring.
2. If there is no/little delivery, and voltage and fuel 1
are present at the pump, the pump should be re-
placed.

19995959
129
Removal
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Remove the two wires from the pump.
3. Unscrew the filter head/pump assembly connec-
tion and lift away from filter assembly.
Installation is reverse procedure, ensure O rings, 1,
are serviceable.

130
96 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Pump Testing
Fuel pump may be checked on the vehicle.
Ensure initially that the filter is serviceable and there
are no other restrictions between the fuel tank and
filters.
Disconnect the filter outlet to pump tube and recon-
nect to the filter, allowing the outlet to be positioned
into a suitable measuring jar.
Turn the key start to the first position for a measured
amount of time and record the fuel delivered.
Compare against specification.

131

PUMP TEST CONDITION POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION

Low pressure at pump outlet 1. Low or no fuel in tank 1. Refill tank


2. Blocked filter in lift pump 2. Clean filter
3. Actuating Shaft Worn 3. Replace Shaft
4. Pump Worn 4. Replace Pump

Air in the fuel from pump outlet 1. Blocked fuel tank breather 1. Clear blockage
2. Loose fuel connections 2. Check and tighten
3. Fuel Pump Diaphragm 3. Replace Pump
perforated
4. Fuel pump body seam 4. Replace Pump
. . leaking
5. Pump Worn 5. Replace Pump
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 97

FUEL TANK - SL65B

Op. 10 216 10

REMOVAL
1. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Refer to Section 1 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader causing serious injury or
damage to the equipment.

2. Open the rear door and remove the left engine


side shield to gain access to the fuel tank.
3. Remove the rear engine belly pan.
CAUTION
Use a floor jack to support the belly pan to prevent
serious injury.

4. Drain the fuel tank. Loosen the clamp and re-


move the fuel tank filler neck.
5. Remove fuel lines, 1 and 2.
6. Disconnect fuel sender wires, 3.

1
3
2
19995956
132
7. Remove cap screws, 2. Remove bracket, 1.

1 2

133
98 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

8. Support the fuel tank before removing the rear


bracket. Remove the cap screws, washers, and
nuts, 1. Remove bracket, 2. 1
9. Lower the fuel tank and slide rearward.

134
INSPECTION
If the fuel tank shows signs of contact by block protru-
sion, 2, the protrusion can be ground flat with the sur-
rounding area.
DO NOT grind the block beyond flat with the sur-
rounding web (dotted line).

135
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 99

INSTALLATION NOTE: For machines with restricted fill flow, new re-
1. Install the fuel tank into the loader and secure placement tubes can be obtained through the Ser-
with retaining hardware. vice Parts System. No additional parts are needed.
NOTE: Use silicone sealant on the two cap screws NOTE: To replace the tube, loosen the hose clamp,
holding the front retaining bracket to the final drive retaining the fill tube to the connector hose, and re-
case. move the old tube. Insert the new fill tube (part
#86542122) into the connector hose, until it contacts
2. Install the fuel lines and fuel level sender wires. the inlet to the fuel tank, and retighten the hose
3. Install the fuel tank filler neck. Tighten the hose clamp.
clamp. 4. Fill the fuel tank.
NOTE: NOTE: A redesigned fill tube was introduced 5. Install the engine belly pan and left side shield.
into production during July of 1997. This tube allows
free flow of fuel into the tank, without the restrictions 6. Lower the skid steer.
of the previous tube.
100 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

AIR INTAKE AND EXHAUST SYSTEM -


SL65B 1
1 4
AIR CLEANER 2

Op. 10 202 40

Removal
To service the engine air cleaner, the boom must be
raised and supported on the boom lock pins, 1.
The air cleaner, 2, is accessed by opening the rear
3
door and top engine cover and left engine side shield. 19984608
The air cleaner assembly uses two elements, a pri- 136
mary element and a safety element.
Disconnect the outlet hose, 3, and inlet hose, 4.
To access the air filter elements, loosen the three
clamps, 1, and unlatching end cap from air cleaner 1
body. 3
To remove the primary element, remove the end cap,
2. This exposes the primary element, 3.

1 1
2
19984609
137
Inspection
1. Pull the primary element, 1, from the canister. 1
Clean any loose dirt from the canister and inspect
the end of the canister for dirt that may prevent
the new element from sealing properly. Replace
the primary element when the EIC indicates air
cleaner restriction. Do not attempt to remove the
element when the engine is running because dirt
will be sucked into the engine. Do not attempt to
clean the element by beating or rapping it.
IMPORTANT: Do not attempt to remove the element
when the engine is running because dirt will be
sucked into the engine. Change the air cleaner el- 19984610
ement if a loss of power is noted. When installing a 138
new element make sure it seals properly in the can-
ister.
IMPORTANT: Clean any dirt and dust from the can-
ister before reinstalling the cleaner element. Make
sure the inner end of the canister is clean and free of
dirt to insure the element will seal properly to prevent
dirt from entering the intake of the engine. Failure of
a good seal between the filter and canister may
cause major engine damage.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 101

2. Do not clean the inner safety filter element, 1.


Once the element becomes partially clogged, re-
place it. To remove safety element pull the el-
ement from the canister. 1
Visual inspection can be done by placing a light
inside the element. If the element is partially
clogged, little light will show through the element.
If the element becomes clogged, it will cause air
restriction which will cause loss of engine power
or excessive exhaust smoke. For maximum en-
gine protection and air cleaner service life, re-
place the safety element with a new safety el-
ement every third primary element change or 19984611
1000 hours - whichever occurs first. 139
IMPORTANT: Clean any dirt and dust from the can-
ister before reinstalling the cleaner element. Make
sure the inner end of the canister is clean and free of
dirt to insure the element will seal properly to prevent
dirt from entering the intake of the engine. Failure of
a good seal between the filter and canister may
cause major engine damage.
The optional pre-cleaner/aspirator exhaust sys-
tem can be installed to replace the standard sys-
tem to extend the air cleaner element life.
3. Inspect the support rod hardware, 1, and the can-
ister support mounting hardware, 2.
Check that the support rods, 3, are not bent.
Check that the end cover, 4, fits snugly over the
outer canister with no large gaps.

140
102 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Reinstallation
Install a new primary element and/or safety element
by inserting the open end of the elements, 1, into the 1
canister, 2. Push the elements into the canister firmly
for proper sealing inside the canister.

19984612
141
Reinstall the end cap, 1, by positioning the top of the
4 3 6 4
end cap at 2. Seat the end cap into the lip on the can- 5 2
ister at 3, pushing the elements and end cap into
position.
Relatch the clamps, 4, by catching the top clamp into 3
a slot in the canister lip at 5. Relatch the second two
clamps after the top is clamped securely.
Reconnect the inlet hose, 6, and outlet hose, 7, to the
canister. 1

4 7
19984613
142
EXHAUST MUFFLER
1
3
Op. 10 254 40

Removal
2
1. Remove the right side engine shield to access
the exhaust muffler.
2. Remove four cap screws, 2. Remove the exhaust
muffler, 1, and gasket, 3.

Inspection
Check for damage to the housing and mounting
flange. 143

Installation
After installing a new gasket, reverse the procedure
previously outlined.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 103

TURBOCHARGER
4 1
Op. 10 250 30

Removal
1. Remove the left side engine shield.
2. Remove the exhaust muffler.
3. Disconnect the air cleaner to the turbocharger
tube and the turbocharger, 1, to intake manifold
tube, 4.
4. Disconnect the oil supply and return tubes, 2, 3 2
from the turbocharger, 1. Cap the ends of the
tubes and oil ports of the turbocharger to prevent 144
entry of foreign material.
NOTE: Before removing and cleaning the unit, look
for signs of oil and/or gas leakage, also wheel dam-
age, which may not be evident after cleaning.
5. Remove the turbocharger and gasket from the
exhaust manifold, 3. Cover the opening in the ex-
haust manifold to prevent the entry of dirt which
could cause damage to the turbine wheel blades
after installation and startup.
Disassembly
1. Clean the exterior of the turbocharger using a
non-caustic cleaning solvent to remove accumu-
lated surface matter before disassembly.
2. Mark the compressor housing, turbine housing,
and center housing with a punch or scribe to fa-
cilitate correct positioning of the housings during
reassembly.

145
3. Remove the compressor housing C clip from the
center housing intake side.

146
104 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

4. Loosen and remove the bolts from the turbine


housing exhaust side and lockplates.

147

148
NOTE: Exercise care when removing the com- Exploded View of Turbocharger
pressor housing to avoid damaging the compressor 1. Turbine housing
wheel blades. 2. Retainer plates
Tap the turbine housing with a soft-faced hammer if 3. Retainer bolts
force is needed to remove. 4. Center housing and rotating assembly (CHRA)
5. C clip
6. O ring
7. Compressor housing
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 105

Cleaning Nicks, dents, or distortion that could prevent


Before cleaning, inspect all parts for burning, rub- proper sealing between the compressor housing
bing, or impact damage that may not be evident after and the CHRA.
cleaning. Clean all parts in a non- caustic solution, NOTE: Replace the compressor housing if any of the
using a soft bristle brush, a plastic blade scraper, and above defects are found.
dry compressed air to remove residue. 2. Inspect the turbine housing assembly for the fol-
DO NOT use abrasive cleaning methods which might lowing defects.
damage or destroy machined surfaces. Wheel rub damage in the contour area that can-
DO NOT immerse the CHRA in solvent. not be polished out with 60-grit silicon carbide ab-
DO NOT blow under the compressor wheel with rasive cloth.
compressed air. Worn, broken, or corroded snap ring grooves
DO NOT permit the wheel/shaft assembly to spin (snap ring turbine housing models).
when blowing off solvent and residue. Nicks, dents, or warpage that could prevent
proper sealing between the turbine housing and
Inspection the CHRA.
1. Inspect the compressor housing assembly for NOTE: If there is any compressor or turbine wheel
the following defects: blade damage, the CHRA must be replaced. Operat-
ing a turbocharger with damaged blades will result in
Wheel rub damage in the contour area that can-
further damage to component parts or the engine.
not be polished out with 80-grit silicon carbide ab-
rasive cloth. Blades cannot be straightened in service.
Worn, broken, or corroded snap ring grooves.
106 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

Center Housing And Rotating


Assembly (CHRA)
IMPORTANT: The CHRA as an assembly has been
balanced at the factory under precision conditions.
As such, it must not be disassembled in any way. If
disassembled, the balance will be destroyed and a
new CHRA must be fitted.

Center Shaft Radial Check


Check the journal bearing radial clearance whenever
there is reason to suspect that the bearings are worn
enough to allow either the compressor wheel or the
turbine wheel to rub on its housing. This may be
heard as a high-pitched whine. 149
1. With the turbocharger removed, attach an indica-
tor with a dogleg probe, to the center housing.
The indicator plunger should extend through the
oil outlet port and contact the shaft of the turbine
wheel assembly.
2. Manually apply equal and simultaneous pres-
sure to the compressor and turbine wheels to
move the shaft as far as it will go away from the
dial indicator probe.
3. Set the dial indicator to zero.
4. Manually apply equal and simultaneous pres-
sure to the wheels to move the shaft as far as it
will go toward the plunger. Make a note of the
shaft movement shown on the indicator dial.
NOTE: To make sure the reading indicated is the
maximum possible, roll the wheels slightly in both
directions while applying pressure.
5. Manually apply equal and simultaneous pres-
sure to the compressor and turbine wheels to
move the shaft away from the plunger again.
Note that the indicator pointer returns exactly to
zero.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 5 several times to ensure
that maximum radial clearance, indicated by
maximum shaft movement, has been measured.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 107

7. If the maximum clearance is less than 0.056 mm


(0.0022″) or greater than 0.127 mm (0.0050″),
replace the CHRA.
Troubleshoot the engine to find the cause of the
bearing failure and correct the problem before re-
suming operations.

Axle Clearance Check


Check the thrust bearing axial clearance as follows:
1. Place a dial indicator with the probe on the com-
pressor end of the turbocharger shaft assembly.
2. Manually move the compressor/turbine wheel
assembly as far as it will go away from the
plunger. 150
3. Set the dial indicator, 1, at zero.
4. Manually move the compressor/turbine wheel
assembly as far as it will go toward the dial indica-
tor plunger. Make a note of the shaft movement
shown on the indicator dial.
5. Manually move the compressor/turbine wheel
assembly as far as it will go away from the
plunger. Note that the indicator plunger returns to
zero.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 5 several times to make
sure that the maximum axial clearance, as indi-
cated by maximum shaft movement, has been
measured.
7. If the maximum clearance is less than
0.0254 mm (0.0010″) or greater than 0.084 mm
(0.0039″), replace the CHRA.

Reassembly
1. Replace the following with factory- authorized
parts only at each overhaul or whenever parts
are removed.
Snap ring, compressor housing retainer
O ring seal, compressor housing
Retainer plates, turbine housing
Bolts, turbine housing retainers
108 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

2. Parts that require changing if faulty or damaged.


CHRA, turbine assembly
Compressor housing
Turbine housing
3. Inspect all mating surfaces and snap ring groove
to ensure that they are free of burrs, foreign
matter, and corrosion deposits.
4. Transfer scribe marks from old snap rings to new
and coat with a light coating of new engine oil.
5. Install oiled snap ring on compressor end of
CHRA with beveled face toward the turbine end.
6. Install an O ring, 1, on the center housing com-
pressor end flange and place compressor hous-
ing assembly in position. Be careful not to dam-
age the compressor wheel blades.
7. Carefully rotate the compressor housing onto the
CHRA to line up the scribed marks.
8. Install the oiled snap ring, lug first, into the com-
pressor housing groove. Be sure that the beveled
side faces the turbine end and the scribe marks
are aligned.
9. Tap the inner circumference or lug ends of the
ring with an appropriately sized drift to ensure
proper seating.
NOTE: When installing a new CHRA or turbine hous- 151
ing, transfer the scribed alignment marks from the old
to the new parts.
10. Position the turbine housing discharge side
down on a flat, level surface. Place the CHRA tur-
bine wheel end into the housing, using care to
avoid damaging the wheel blades. Check vis-
ually for proper alignment.
11. Carefully rotate the CHRA in the turbine housing
to line up the scribed marks. Recheck for proper
alignment and position the locking plates.
12. Coat the bolts in a suitable antiseize compound
and tighten to a torque of 20 - 25 N·m (15 - 18 ft.
lbs.).
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 109

Installation
1. Prior to installation, fill the turbocharger center
housing with new clean oil and rotate the main
shaft to lubricate the bearings.
2. Installation of the turbocharger follows the re-
moval procedure in reverse. Install a new mani-
fold gasket and tighten to 41 - 47 N·m (30 - 35 ft.
lbs.).
3. Replace the washers and reconnect the oil feed
1
tube banjo bolt, 1, and torque to 30 - 40 N·m (22
- 30 ft. lbs.).
– Oil feed tube to turbocharger (banjo bolt)
– Oil feed tube to filter head connector 4
– Connect to filter head
– Oil return tube from turbocharger to block 3
– Oil return tube to block connector
– Oil return connector to block 5
4. The oil feed tube connector to oil filter head as-
sembly, 3, if disturbed, should be refitted. Apply 6 2
sealer to connector. See “Specifications Service
Standards” in this section and torque to 54 - 81 152
N·m (40 - 60 ft. lbs.).
5. Apply sealer. See “Specifications Service Stan-
dards” in this section. Assemble the oil feed tube
to the oil filter head connector, 2, and tighten to
18 - 20 N·m (13 - 15 ft. lbs.).
6. Place a suitable receptacle below the oil outlet
port and with the electrical solenoid wire dis-
connected at the fuel injection pump, crank
the engine until oil flows from the outlet port.
7. Reconnect the oil outlet tube, 4, using a new
gasket and tighten the retaining bolts at the
turbocharger to 20 - 25 N·m (15 - 18 ft. lbs.).
8. Tighten the oil return tube to cylinder block con-
nector, 5, to 54 - 81 N·m (45 - 50 ft. lbs.).
9. If disturbed, oil return tube to block connector, 6,
should have sealer applied. See “Specifications
Service Standards” in this section. Torque to 27
N·m (20 ft. lbs.).
110 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

10. Reconnect the air inlet and outlet tubes with the
hose clamps and torque to 1.7 - 2.3 N·m (15 -
20 in. lbs.).
11. Reconnect the fuel injection pump solenoid wire.
12. Check the engine oil level and add oil if required.
Idle the engine and check all tubes and gaskets
for leaks.
13. Run the engine at rated speed and listen for
sounds of metallic contact from the turbocharger.
If any noise is apparent, stop the engine immedi-
ately and correct the cause.
NOTE: After the unit has reached operating tem-
peratures, the rotating assembly should coast freely
to a stop after the engine is stopped. If the rotating as-
sembly jerks to a sudden stop, the cause should be
corrected immediately.
Turbocharger Leaking Oil at Pressure Hose
Connection
Oil leakage in the area of the connecting hose be-
tween the turbocharger and crossover tube to the in-
take manifold at 1. This is a result of oil weeping out
the joint between the turbocharger and the hose.
A small amount of oil blow-by is normal in this turbo-
charger skid steer application. Due to the extremely
high speeds in a turbocharger, the turbine shaft rides
on a film of oil. It is a fluid bearing, not a metal bearing,
which supports the shaft and keeps it cool. At the
ends of the shaft, the oil is not fully sealed with a typi-
cal rubber lip seal. A labyrinth seal is used for the
shaft to allow the high rotational speed. The labyrinth 153
seal can protect against oil splashing out, but it will
allow pressurized oil to pass by it. When the turbo-
charger is running, excessive oil blow-by can be
demonstrated by intentionally blocking the air intake
into the turbocharger. This occurs because the high
vacuum causes the oil to travel across the labyrinth
seal. This phenomena occurs to a much smaller de-
gree under normal engine operating conditions.
However, it is somewhat worse with an application
such as with skid steers, where the engine is not op-
erated at a constant speed and load.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 111

The oil blow-by is not staying inside the hose and tub-
ing, but it is leaking to the outside surfaces, where it
collects dirt and gives the appearance that someth-
ing has failed. Oil leaking at this connection will also
give the appearance that there is an oil leak between
the turbine housing and the compressor housing at
the retaining ring and O ring.
To correct a leak, remove the hose from the turbo-
charger and tube at 1, and thoroughly clean the con-
nections. Remove and discard the original hose
clamps. These clamps are not properly seating and
sealing the hose to the rough casting of the turbo-
charger or steel tube.
NOTE: When the hose is removed, there may be evi-
dence of oil at this connection and inside of the hose
and tube. This is normal in the skid steer application.
Order and install two (2) new hose clamps, part
#58880, and tighten them to 35 in. lbs.
Install the hose and clamp onto the turbocharger at
1, half the length of hose, making sure that the hose
is positioned to allow enough area of hose past the 154
rolled edge on the turbocharger at 2, to insure the
hose clamp will properly seat the hose to the turbo-
charger.
Install the hose and clamp onto the crossover tube at
3, making sure the tube is fully inserted into the hose
so the hose clamp will seal the hose and tube past the
rolled edge on the tube.
112 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

STARTING A TURBOCHARGED ENGINE Return line tube to turbocharger - 20 - 27 N·m (15


AFTER INSTALLATION OF A TURBO- - 20 ft. lbs.)
CHARGER Return line tube to block connector - 60 - 70 N·m
1. Disconnect the outlet oil pipe from the turbo- (45 - 50 ft. lbs.)
charger. 4. Crank the engine until oil pressure rises. Recon-
2. Disconnect the electrical wire at the fuel injection nect the fuel solenoid wire. Start the engine and
pump fuel shutoff solenoid. Place a suitable con- let it idle for one minute.
tainer below the turbocharger oil outlet port and 5. Check the engine oil level and add oil if necess-
crank the engine until oil flows from the outlet ary. Start the engine and check for oil and air
port. leaks.
3. Reconnect the oil outlet tube, using a new
gasket, and tighten the fittings to the following
specifications.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 113

ENGINE INSTALLATION - SL65B

ENGINE ASSEMBLY SEQUENCE


The following assembly procedure is suggested for
installing external components onto the engine.
Refer to the appropriate section when installing en-
gine components.
1. Install crankshaft pulley.
2. Install oil pan.
3. Install transmission housing and flywheel. (See
Section 27.)
4. Install starting motor.
5. Install water pump.
6. Install fuel filter, fuel supply pump, and fuel line.
7. Install dipstick, oil filter, engine oil cooler and
hoses.
8. Install coolant outlet connection with thermostat
and new gasket.
9. Install rocker arm cover with vent tube.
10. Install turbocharger and exhaust manifold.
11. Install fan, fan belts, and alternator.
12. Fill coolant and engine oil to proper level.
INSTALLATION INTO LOADER
2
Before installing the engine into the skid steer, check 1
the condition of the engine isolator mounts and re-
place if necessary.
Examine the three isolation mounts, part #9803221,
for wear or damage to the inner steel bushing. Dam-
age may be in the form of wear or crushing to the end
bushing surface, 1, on either end of the inner steel
bushing. Severe damage may result in cracking of
inner bushing, 2. The inner bushing length should
measure EXACTLY 2.25″. If the bushing is less than
2.25″ replace it.
Bushing damage results if the center retaining hard- 19986415
ware is overtorqued. 155
If damaged, replace all three bushings.
114 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

1. Install the engine assembly into the skid steer,


aligning the engine mounts.
2. Install the engine mounting hardware, 1. Torque
the mounting cap screws to 172 N·m (127 ft. lbs.).
3. Install the hydrostatic pumps. Refer to Section 5
for hydrostatic pump installation.
4. Install previously removed ground wires and har-
ness clamps to the transmission gearbox.
5. Install engine fan.

156
6. Install fuel supply line, 1, and return line, 2.
7. Connect throttle cable. Adjust as required.

1
2
19995956
157
8. Connect the engine main harness connector, 1.
Install ground strap, 2.
1

158
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 115

9. Install the radiator/oil cooler assembly onto the


skid steer. Secure with the eight mounting cap
screws, 1.

19984502
159
10. Connect the oil cooler bottom left line.
11. Install fan shroud, 3, and secure with four cap
screws and nuts, 2. 3
12. Install the upper and lower radiator hoses, 1.
1

160
13. Connect hydraulic line, 3, to the filter base.
14. Connect the hydraulic oil filter restriction switch
wires, 1, and harness clamp, 2.
15. Install the air cleaner and tighten all hose clamps.
16. Install the fuel tank filler neck and tighten clamps. 1
17. Install the rear door latch bracket. 2
18. Install the rear door and connect the overflow
hose to the tank.
19. Install the battery. Refer to Section 3 for the bat-
tery installation procedure. 3
20. Refill all fluids to the proper level.

161
116 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

OPERATING THE ENGINE AFTER 5. Connect the wiring harness connector to the en-
OVERHAUL gine stop solenoid.
1. Check level of engine oil, coolant and fuel. 6. Move the hand throttle to the 1/3 or 1/2 open posi-
tion and start the engine. Operate at no more
2. Disconnect the wiring harness connector at the
than 1500 RPM.
engine stop solenoid.
7. Run the engine at 1500 RPM for about 30 min-
3. With the turbocharger oil return line removed,
utes to allow it to fully warm up and begin the ring
place a suitable container below the oil outlet
seating process. During warmup observe the fol-
port. Crank the engine until oil flows from the
lowing:
open port. Reinstall the oil return line.
– Listen for abnormal sounds.
4. Crank the engine until the oil pressure lamp is ex-
tinguished. – Monitor engine temperature.
– Check for fluid leaks (oil, coolant, fuel).
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 117

ELECTRICAL COMPONENT
MAINTENANCE - SL65B
3 2
CRANKING CIRCUIT (STARTING MOTOR)
5
Op. 55 201 50 1
Removal
7
IMPORTANT: Always disconnect the negative (-)
battery cable before removing the starter or a short
4 6
circuit could result.
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove solenoid cover, 1, from rear of solenoid. 19995960

3. Disconnect the positive battery cable, red wiring 162


leads and W/R wiring lead, 2, from the starter
solenoid.
4. Remove the oil dipstick cap screws and lower for
starter removal clearance.
5. Remove the negative battery cable, 3; ground
strap, 4; and black wiring lead, 5.
6. Remove three cap screws, 6. Remove starting
motor, 7.

Installation
1. Reverse the removal procedure previously out-
lined.
CHARGING CIRCUIT 2 5
3
Op. 55 301 10

Alternator Removal 4
IMPORTANT: Always disconnect the negative (-)
battery cable before removing the alternator or a
short circuit could result. 5
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable. 6
2. Disconnect the R/DK BL wiring lead, 3, from ter-
1
minal B+ and PU/R wiring lead, 2, from terminal 5
W.
3. Disconnect B wiring lead, 1, and Y/DK BL electri-
cal connector, 4. 163
4. Remove the three cap screws, 5. Remove belt,
6. Remove the alternator.

Installation
1. Reverse the removal procedure previously out-
lined.
2. Adjust belt tension.
118 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1

ADJUST BELT TENSION


3
Check and adjust the alternator belt, 1, for proper
tension every 50 hours of operation. The belt is tigh-
tened properly when a force of 1 kg (2 lbs.) is applied 4
perpendicular to the belt at the center of the span with
a 3 mm (1/8″) deflection. To adjust belt tension,
loosen the pivot bolt, 2, and the adjustor bolt, 3, and
pivot the alternator, 4, until the proper tension is ob-
tained. Retighten all hardware securely. 1
IMPORTANT: To prevent possible damage to the al-
2
ternator when replacing a belt, disconnect the nega-
tive (-) ground cable from the battery.

164
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 119

SPECIAL TOOLS - SL65B

DESCRIPTION TOOL NO.


Adjustable Bridge Puller FNH09539
Shaft Protectors FNH09212
Step Plate Adapters FNH09210
Bushing Kit FNH09514
Crankshaft Gear
Remover/Installer FNH02134
Adapter/Insert FNH01237
Valve Guide Reamer Kit FNH02136
Camshaft Bearings
Remover/Installer FNH01225
Handle FNH01442
Water Pump Seal Replacer FNH04672
Reverse Flush Adapter FNH08124
Crankshaft, Seal Replacer
Front Seal FNH10103
Rear Seal FNH01301
Fuel Injection Pump Timing Gauge, Splined Shaft and Slotted Arm NH013141
120 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES)

Chapter 1 – Gearboxes

CONTENT

Section Description Page


27 000 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-2
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-4
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-5
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-7
27 126 Gearboxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-8
Final Drive and Gearbox Fill/Check Plug (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-8
27 126 40 Gearbox Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-9
27 126 48 Gearbox Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-10
Gearbox Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-14
Gearbox Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-15
27 126 40 Gearbox Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-18
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-23
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox Removal - Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-23
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-28
Engine-to-Transmission Gearbox Reassembly - Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-29
Start-Up Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27-32
2 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

Op. 27 000

GENERAL INFORMATION
Each of the two hydrostatic pumps is driven by the
engine through a spur gear configuration located in
the engine-to-transmission gearbox. The hydrostatic
pumps then transmit hydraulic power to the hydro-
static motors, 1, which are connected to gearboxes,
2, located on the inside of the final drive cases. The
left and right drives are separate from each other and
are operated independently.

2
Power is then transmitted through gears to a drive
sprocket, 1, in the final drive case. The drive sprocket
is connected to the axle sprockets, 2, with chains, 3,
one endless chain to the front axle and one endless
chain to the rear axle.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 3

The right and left gearboxes, 2, are located under the


operator’s seat. Hydrostatic motors, 1, drive the
gearboxes, and power is transmitted through the
gearboxes to the final drive chains and axles.

OPS844

4
1. Hydrostatic motors (2) 4. Drive chains (front and rear) (4)
2. Gearboxes (2) 5. Axle drive sprockets (4)
3. Final drive sprocket assemblies (2) 6. Axle assemblies (4)
4 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

SPECIFICATIONS
Chain Case and Gearbox

Side Cover Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 N·m (11 ft. lbs.)


Drive Chain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . #100
Front Chain Length (64 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80″ (2032 mm)
Rear Chain Length – LS180 (58 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72.5″ (1841.5 mm)
Rear Chain Length – LS190 (64 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80″ (2032 mm)
Chain Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0 to 6 mm (0″ to 1/4″) movement at tire tread
Gearbox Mounting Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 ft. lbs. (316 N·m)
Drive Motor Mounting Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 ft. lbs. (85 N·m)
Front Cover Plate Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 ft. lbs. (20 N·m)
Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5 liters (2.5 US. gal.) each side - 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Other Materials

Description Use
Ultra/Blue Silicone Sealer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gearbox mounting bolts
Axle housing bolts
Chain case cover bolts
Gearbox to chain case
Gearbox cover and bolts
Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer
Gear Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High viscosity lithium base

NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to seal where required to prevent corrosion during the sili-
cone curing process.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 5

TROUBLESHOOTING

FINAL DRIVE SYSTEM


Before servicing or adjusting the final drive system,
the skid steer should be jacked up with the wheels off
the ground.
Remove any attachment from the skid steer; boom,
bucket, etc. Lower the boom to the lowered position
or, if servicing requires the boom to be in the raised
position, support the boom on the boom lock pins.
Raise the boom and lower onto the boom lock pins,
1.
1. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins.
5
2. Engage the boom lock pins.
3. Stop the engine; ignition key in the “OFF” posi-
tion.
4. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
5. Lower the boom onto the boom lock pins.
6. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
Never exit the loader with the boom in the raised posi-
tion unless the boom is supported on the boom lock
pins.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment
mounted. Always remove the attachment from the
loader.

Jack up the loader and support the loader with the


wheels off the ground. Use adequate jack stands or
blocks to securely support the loader.
Support the loader at the front of the final drive cases
at 1, and at the rear at 2.
CAUTION
Never service a raised loader unless it is securely
supported with adequate jack stands or blocks.

6
6 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

FINAL DRIVE SYSTEM

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Both drive wheels on one side No hydrostatic motor shaft rotation Check for pump to motor oil flow
not powered and repair
No gearbox output drive Check gearbox shaft rotation and
repair
Broken drive chains Check chains and repair

One drive wheel not powered Broken drive chain Check chain and repair
Axle or drive sprocket splines worn Check axle and sprocket; replace

Chain case noise Loose drive chains Check and adjust chains
No oil in final drive Check oil level
Worn drive sprockets Check sprockets and repair
Bearing failure Check axle and gearbox bearings
and repair

Excessive axle play Bearing failure on axle shaft Check bearings and repair
Snap ring failure on axle shaft Check axle bearing preload; repair

Noise in gearbox No or low oil in gearbox Check oil level


Bearing failure Check shafts and bearings; repair
Bearing or shaft failure in drive Check drive motor and repair
motor
Gears in gearbox worn Check and replace
Parking brake not released Release parking brake

Final drive case leaking Oil escaping past case side sheet Reinstall with sealant as described
and reinforcing plate in Service Bulletin (7/95-I7)
Oil escaping past studs Remove and reseal studs
Oil escaping around center Remove plate and reseal
inspection plate
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 7

TESTING
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at high idle (full throttle).
* Park brake in disengaged position.
STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION
1 Push both drive controls YES Drive system OK.
forward equally and loader
should move in a straight line. NO Engine stalls, wheels appear locked, check parking
brake for engaged. If OK, go to step 2.

Slow or no power; refer to hydrostatic drive section.


2 Check final drive chain; if broken, repair.
3 Pull both drive controls YES Drive system OK.
rearward equally and loader
should move in a straight line. NO Engine stalls, wheels appear locked, go to step 1.

Wheels rotate slow or no power, go to step 1.

One side of loader drags, go to step 2.

Pretest instructions:
* Lower boom and attachment to the ground.
* Stop engine.
* Jack loader with wheels off the ground.
* Release parking brake.

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Rotate each tire by hand, tires move YES Drive system OK.
less than 1/4″ at tread.
NO Tires move more than 6 mm (1/4″) at tread; check
chain tension.
2 One tire rotates freely, broken chain, or axle spline
worn.
3 Both tires on one side rotate freely together, inspect
drive gearboxes. If OK, check drive motor.
4 Tires rotate but are noisy. YES Check drive chains, axle bearings.

NO Drive system OK.


8 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

Op. 27 126

GEARBOXES
Two gearboxes are used to provide speed reduction
and transmit power from the hydrostatic drive motors
to the final drive chains. The parking brake assem-
blies are located in the gearboxes.

FINAL DRIVE AND GEARBOX FILL/CHECK


PLUG (2)
1
The final drive fill/check plug, 1, is located on each
side of the loader frame. Remove plug and oil should 3169-13
just begin to run from plug. Fill each final drive to the
7
bottom of check plug with SAE 80W-90 API Service
GL-5 gear oil.
The shared oil configuration circulates oil through
holes in the gearbox gear cover. A funnel, 1, takes oil
into the gearbox, and the oil returns through the op-
posite hole.

19987119
8
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 9

Op. 27 126 40
REMOVAL
1. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader causing serious injury or
damage to the equipment.

2. Tilt the cab and boom forward. Refer to Section


00 for more detailed information on this pro- 9
cedure.
3. Remove the drive control lever assembly. Refer
to Section 29 for the drive control lever removal
procedure.
4. Remove the tires and wheels from the final drive
being serviced.
5. Clean the axle and final drive area to prevent de-
bris from entering the final drive case.
6. Remove the eight axle housing retaining nuts, 1,
on each axle. Remove the final drive axles from
the frame.
7. Remove the final drive case cover, 2.
8. Remove drive chains, 1 and 2, from the final
gearbox sprocket.
9. Remove the transmission centering assembly.
Refer to Section 29 for the removal procedure.
10. Remove the hydrostatic motor two-speed control
linkage and hydraulic cylinder. Refer to Section
29 for this procedure.
11. Remove the hydrostatic motor. Refer to Section
29 for the hydrostatic motor removal procedure.
NOTE: For clearance, the high-pressure lines may
require removal. If the lines are removed, cap the 2
lines and fittings to prevent loss of oil and contamina-
1
tion of the hydrostatic system. 19997744
10
10 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

12. Disconnect the gearbox filler tube, hose, and


wire clamps as required. 1
13. Remove the four mounting cap screws, 1, hold-
ing the final gearbox housing to the drive case.
CAUTION
The gearbox is heavy and a suitable hoist/lift should
be used.

14. With a suitable hoist, lift the gearbox from the


loader. 1

19987119
11
Op. 27 126 48
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the gearbox.
2. Remove the four cap screws and washers, 1. Re-
move bracket, 2, and the parking brake cover, 3.

12
3. Remove the two brake discs, 2, and separator
plate, 3, from drive coupling, 1.

13
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 11

4. Remove the brake friction pad and spacer plate,


1, and drive coupling, 2.
NOTE: There are two magnets located at 3. Remove 3
the magnets from the housing.

3
14
5. Remove two cap screws, 2. Remove bracket, 3.
Remove the remaining five cap screws, 1. Separ-
ate the gearbox halves.

15
6. Inspect roller bearings, 1, 2, and 3. If worn or
rough, they must be removed and replaced.
NOTE: Roller bearings have some interference in
housing and may require a bearing puller to remove.
7. Loosen jam nut, 6, and cap screw, 5. Remove
park brake lever, 4.

16
12 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

8. Remove oil seal, 1.


NOTE: The oil seal will be destroyed when removed.
Replace it with a new seal.

17
9. Remove pinion gear, 2, and gear, 1, by sliding
them from the housing.
10. Remove snap ring, 3.

18
11. Place the gearbox in a press and support hous-
ing as close as possible to the drive sprocket.
12. Using an appropriate size shaft protector, press
the shaft assembly, 1, from the bearings and re-
move from the housing. Do not allow the shaft as-
sembly to drop to the floor when it breaks free of
the housing.

19
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 13

13. Remove gear, 1, and two bearing races, 2.

20
14. Remove roller bearings, 1.
NOTE: Roller bearings have some interference in
housing and may require a bearing puller to remove.
15. Remove oil seal, 2.
NOTE: The oil seal will be destroyed when removed.
Replace it with a new seal.

21
16. Support gear assembly in press as shown. Re-
move bearing race, 1, and gear, 2.
Do not allow the shaft to drop to the floor when it
breaks free of the gear.

22
14 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

17. Install a bearing separator as shown. Press on


pinion shaft to remove bearing race, 1.
Do not allow the pinion shaft to drop to the floor
when it breaks free of the bearing.

23
18. Invert the pinion shaft assembly in the press.
Support the shaft assembly with a bearing separ-
ator as shown. Remove bearing race, 1.

24
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Thoroughly clean all parts of old sealant, oil, etc.
before inspection.
2. Examine the shaft bearing surfaces for wear.
3. Check the shaft splines for wear.
4. Check the operation of the gearbox breather.
5. Check the gearbox housing for any cracks, etc.
6. Inspect the gearbox housing bearing areas for
wear.
7. Examine the mounting bolt threads for damage.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 15

REASSEMBLY
Reassemble the final drive gearbox in the reverse of
the disassembly procedures previously outlined
while observing the following precautions.
1. Install oil seals, 1, with the seal lips facing the
gearbox.

25
2. Install roller bearings into the housing until bear-
ing face, 1, is flush with the housing. DO NOT
bottom the bearings in the housing.

26
3. Install snap ring, 1, onto the drive shaft making
sure it is seated properly in its groove.

27
16 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

4. Install the parking brake friction pad, 1, into the


end cap, 2.

28
5. Install the parking brake pad spacer, 1, (thin disc)
into the inner brake housing. Install the friction
pad, 2, (thick disc) into the inner brake housing.
4
6. Install the splined coupler hub, 3, onto the gear-
box input shaft.
7. Reinstall the two magnets in holes, 4. One each
side.

4
29
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 17

8. Install the first brake disc, 1, over the splines of


the drive coupler, 2.

2
1

19987114
30
9. Install the separator plate on the drive coupler,
with the lugs, 1, over the extended tabs, 2, on the
gearbox case.

1
2
19987115
31
10. Install the second brake disc, 1, on the drive
coupler, 2. The splines, 3, of the drive coupler 2
should be visible above the brake disc. 3

1
19987117

32
18 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

11. Apply noncorrosive silicone sealer to the mating


surfaces of the housing and end cap.
12. Install the end cap onto the brake housing mak-
ing sure the lugs, 1, on the separator plate fit in
the notches, 2, on the end cap and the brake fric-
tion pads, 3, line up opposite each other across
the brake and separator plates.

33
13. Reinstall the gearbox breather, 1, if removed,
using pipe sealant on the fitting threads.

34
Op. 27 126 40
REINSTALLATION
1. Thoroughly clean the mating surfaces between
the chain case and the final drive gearbox to pro-
vide a good sealing surface.
NOTE: When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rusting and corrosion of parts after
assembly.
2. Apply a bead of silicone sealer to the corner of
the pilot OD on the final drive gearbox at 1.

35
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 19

3. Apply a circular bead of silicone sealer around


the four gearbox mounting holes, 1, on the chain
case mounting surface.

36
4. Using a hoist, lower the gearbox into position and
pilot into the chain case mounting hole, 1. 2
5. Apply a bead of silicone sealer under the heads
and washers of the gearbox retaining bolts, 2,
and install. Torque the bolts to 233 ft. lbs. (316 1
N·m). Check that the plastic funnel, 3, is not
cracked or broken, and reinstall if removed.

2
19987119

37
6. Install the two lower gearbox mounting bolts, 1,
through mounting plate, 2, and into the gearbox
at 3. Torque to 34 ft. lbs. (46 N·m).

38
20 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

7. Apply a bead of silicone sealer around the OD of


the hydrostatic motor pilot and on the mounting
surface of the gearbox at 1. Install the motor onto
the gearbox and retain with two attaching bolts,
2. Apply a bead of silicone sealer under the head
of the bolt and washer prior to tightening. Torque
to 45 ft. lbs. (61 N·m).
8. Install the motor case drain tube, 3, and the case
drain hose, 4, from the right motor to the hy-
draulic gear pump. Reinstall the gear pump suc-
tion hose, 5, if removed.
9. Install the gearbox oil level/filler tubes at 6.

39
10. Install the remaining hoses and control linkages:
– Neutralizer support bracket, connects the
right and left hydrostatic motors.
– Two-speed control linkage and shift cylinder,
1 (if applicable).
– High-pressure hydraulic and hydrostatic
hoses, 2.
– Neutralizer assembly, 3.
– Control handle assemblies and linkages, 4.

40
11. Install the drive chains onto the gearbox drive
sprocket, 1 with the front chain, 2, to the inside
and the rear chain, 3, to the outside.
12. Fill the chain case with SAE 80W-90 API service 1
GL-5 gear oil to the bottom edge of the lower two
threaded holes at 4.
13. Clean all sealer and oil from the chain case cover
mating area at 5.
4
5 3
2
19987119

41
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 21

14. If there are signs of oil leaking out of the bottom


of the axle housing, the oil may be escaping be- 1
tween the final drive case sheet and the outer re-
inforcing plate. The reinforcing plate, 1, has a
narrower opening than the drive case sheet, 2. If
the loader frame is welded between the reinforc-
ing plate and drive case sheet, the case should 3
not leak.
To seal off this area and prevent leaks, clean the 2
final drive case around the pilot mating area, 2,
and around the studs, 3, with an appropriate
cleaner. Place a bead of silicone sealant (such as
part #L58775), around the side sheet mating 19987113
area, 2, and the studs, 3.
42
NOTE: When installing the final drive case, the case
must lay flat against the frame and the pilot must rest
on the edge of the frame opening.
15. Position the drive sprocket, 1, in the axle open-
ing. Make sure the drive sprocket is placed in the
drive chain properly.
16. Lift the axle housing assembly and mate the
splines on the axle shaft, 2, and the drive
sprocket and slide together. Lifting the axle hous-
ing assembly over the retaining studs, pilot the
center of the housing, 3, into the hole in the case
and slide the housing tight against the case.
NOTE: When installing the rear final drive case, the
rear drive sprocket will stay in place better with the
front of the loader raised.

43
17. With the axle housing, 1, tight against the case,
install the retaining nuts and flat washers, 2, to
hold the housing against the case.
18. Slide the axle housing assembly to tighten the
drive chains.
NOTE: The chains are properly tensioned when
there is 0 to 6 mm (0, to 1/4,) movement at the outer
edge of tire tread.
19. Torque the axle retaining hardware to 140 ft. lbs.
(190 N·m).
CAUTION
When tightening the axle retaining hardware, the
axle housing must be tight against the case at 1, or 44
damage to the case may occur.
22 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

20. Apply silicone sealer to the perimeter of the


opening for the chain case cover, 1, and to the
bottom of the heads on the cover retaining bolts,
2. Install the cover and eight retaining bolts.
Torque to 11 ft. lbs. (15 N·m).
Check the final drive oil level at the check plug,
3. Add SAE 80W-90 API Service GL-5 gear oil as 2
required.
21. Replace any shields that were removed for the
repair.

3 1

45
22. Refer to “Start-Up Procedure” at the end of this
section, and complete the procedure prior to ma-
chine operation.
Start-Up Procedure Summary
– Connect charge pressure gauge.
– Remove fuel solenoid wire.
– Crank engine for up to 30 seconds until a
charge pressure of more than 50 PSI (3.4
bar) is obtained.
– Reconnect the fuel solenoid wire and start
engine. Operate for 30 min., observe charge
pressure gauge, and check for leaks. Repair
leaks if necessary.
– Stop engine, check oil level, and add if
necessary.
– Restart engine, operate at 1500 RPM and
slowly operate the control levers. Monitor
charge pressure.
– Stop engine, check oil level.
– Remove gauge, start engine, run for 30 min.
to filter oil. Stop engine, change oil filter.
23. Tilt cab back to operating position and install
tires.
24. Recheck the final drive chain adjustment. Rotate
each tire and check for movement: 0 to 6 mm (0″
to 1/4″) movement at the tire tread is acceptable.
25. Reinstall all shields removed for repair.
26. Lower the skid steer to the ground and operate.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 23

ENGINE-TO-TRANSMISSION GEARBOX
The engine-to-transmission gearbox transfers
power from the engine to the hydrostatic pumps
through an internal gear set. The gearbox is also
equipped to accept the optional hydraulic, high flow
kit pump assembly.

REMOVAL - DISASSEMBLY
The transmission gearbox should be removed with
the cab and boom tilted forward.
1. Remove any attachment, bucket, etc. from the
boom quick-attach plate
2. Raise the boom and lower it onto the boom lock
46
pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
always remove the attachment from the loader.

3. Stop the engine, turn the key to the run position


and operate the boom and bucket pedals to re-
lieve pressure in the boom and bucket circuits.
Turn off the key.
4. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.

19984337
47
24 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels


off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.

WARNING
Never attempt to tilt the skid steer cab over unless the
loader is securely supported.
48
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position, 1.
7. Remove the step shield, 2.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the systems to avoid serious injury.

49
9. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.

50
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 25

10. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting


the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.

51
11. Tilt the cab and boom forward. Refer to the “Cab
Tilting Procedure” in Section 0 of the operator’s
manual for additional information.

52
12. Remove the wiring harness attaching clips, 1 and
3. Mark their locations for reassembly.
13. Remove the ground wire cap screw at 2. Keeping
the wires on the bolt and threading a nut onto the
end of the bolt will ensure that all ground wires
are reconnected during reassembly.

53
26 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

14. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1 and the


neutralizer assembly at 2.
15. Remove the four neutralizer attaching bolts - two
at the front, 3, and two at the rear, 4. Lift the entire
neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.

54
NOTE: Clean the pumps thoroughly and mark the
hose locations to aid in reassembly.
16. To remove the right and left hydrostatic pumps,
1, disconnect the high-pressure hoses, 2, and
cap the hose ends and pump ports.
17. Disconnect the supply hose to the charge pump
at 3.

55
18. Remove the charge pressure cross tube, 1, and
the case drain cross tube, 2. Disconnect the
charge pressure sender hose at 3.
19. Disconnect the hydraulic gear pump suction line
at 5, the motor case drain hose at 6, and the main
control valve supply hose at 7.
20. Disconnect the two-speed control valve supply
hose at 4, and the return hose at 8, (if applicable).
21. Disconnect the rear hydrostatic control rods from
the pump control arms at 9 and 10.
22. Plug all hoses and pump ports to prevent the
entry of dirt and contaminants.

56
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 27

23. Remove the upper and lower pump attaching


bolts and remove the right-hand pump/charge
pump assembly, 1, and the left- hand pump/gear
pump assembly, 2. Remove the O rings if stuck
to the bellhousing cover.
24. If the entire flywheel housing is to be removed,
unbolt and remove the engine starter assembly,
3.

57
25. Drain the oil from the gearbox at drain plug, 1.
26. Support the front of the engine block with a piece
of wood or other device at 2. Remove the front
engine mount, 3, along with the retaining hard-
ware.
27. Remove the gearbox cover retaining bolts, 4, and
the gearbox cover, 5.

58
28. Remove the drive gear, 1, by removing the six
socket-head attaching bolts, 2.

59
28 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

29. Remove the drive gear oil seal, 1, using a seal re-
moval tool or puller arrangement.
30. Replacement of the drive gear oil seal, 1, can be
done without removing the flywheel housing, 2.
If for some reason the flywheel housing needs to
be removed, do the following:
– Support the engine at the engine block.
– Remove the engine starter assembly at 3.
– Remove the eight flywheel housing attaching
bolts, 4 (two at both the top and bottom, and
two at each side).
– Remove the flywheel housing.
60
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Inspect the drive gear seal, 1, for damage to the 3
inside diameter sealing surfaces, 2, or for loose-
ness in the flywheel housing, 3, outside diameter
of seal.
2. Look for signs of oil on the engine flywheel side
of the housing. This could indicate a leaking seal.
3. Replace the seal if necessary. Install the seal
with the spring-loaded seal lip toward the fly-
wheel cover side. Use the proper tools to press
fit the seal into the flywheel housing so damage
to the seal does not occur. 2

61
4. Inspect the drive gear teeth, 1, for damage or un-
even wear patterns.
5. Inspect the seal contact surface, 2, for damage
or wear.
6. Replace the gear if necessary.

62
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 29

7. Inspect the engine isolator mount, 1, for damage


or deformation. Be sure the center tube, 2, is not
crushed from over tightening of the mounting
hardware.
8. Replace the engine isolator mount if necessary.

63
9. Inspect the hydrostatic pump drive gears, 1, on
both the right- and left-hand hydrostatic pumps
(left-hand pump shown). Check for tooth wear or
damage.
10. Check for damage to the O ring, 2.
11. Replace parts as required.

64
REASSEMBLY - INSTALLATION
1. Clean all previously sealed surfaces, flywheel
housing to engine, flywheel cover to flywheel
housing, and drive gear retaining bolts.
When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rust and corrosion of parts after
assembly.
2. Apply a bead of silicone sealer along the engine
plate, 1, to seal any gap between the plate and
the flywheel housing.
3. Align the dowel pins and install the flywheel
housing. Attach with the previously used hard-
ware and torque to 290 ft. lbs. (394 N·m).
65
4. Reinstall the starter motor assembly.
30 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

5. Lubricate the seal lip, 1, with 80/90 gear oil.


6. Install the drive gear, 2, making sure not to dam-
age the seal.
7. Apply silicone sealer to the bottom of the bolt
heads at 3, and reinstall the six drive gear attach-
ing bolts, 4. Torque the bolts to 50 ft. lbs. (68
N·m).

66
8. Apply a bead of silicone sealer along the contact
surface of the flywheel cover, 1, align correctly,
and install onto the flywheel housing, 2.
9. Install attaching hardware, 3, and torque to 34 ft.
lbs. (46 N·m).
10. Install drain plug, 4, and tighten.
11. Install the ground wire bundle, 5, and harness re-
taining clips where removed.
NOTE: Properly stack the ground wires according to
wire size and number of wires to single spade. Start-
ing with largest first and wire size and multiple wire
spades to single wire spades last.

67
12. Install the isolator mount, 1, hardware, and
snubber plate, 2, in the order previously re-
moved. Tighten the main mounting bolt, 3, to 165
ft. lbs. (225 N·m).

68
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 31

13. Fill the gearbox with 80/90 gear oil to the proper
level as indicated on the gearbox dipstick, 1.

69
14. Reinstall the right and left hydrostatic pumps, 1
and 2, and secure with 1/2″ x 1-1/4″ cap screws
and washers. Torque the bolts to 64 ft. lbs. (87
N·m).
15. Reconnect the rear control rods, 3, to the hydro-
static pump control arms.
16. Reinstall the case drain cross tube, 4, and the
charge pressure cross tube, 5. Reconnect the
charge pressure sender hose at 6.

70
17. Reconnect the motor case drain hose, 1; the hy-
draulic gear pump suction hose, 2; and the main
control valve pressure hose, 3.
18. Reconnect the charge pump suction hose to the
fitting at 4.
19. Connect the two-speed control valve return hose
at 5, and the control valve supply hose at 6, (if ap-
plicable).

71
32 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

20. Reconnect the hydrostatic system high- pres-


sure hoses to their correct positions on the hydro-
static pumps.
Hose 1 (RH Pump) to bottom port, RH Motor
Hose 2 (RH Pump) to top port, RH Motor
Hose 3 (LH Pump) to top port, LH Motor
Hose 4 (LH Pump) to bottom port, LH Motor
RH Pump - 5
LH Pump - 6

72
21. Reinstall the neutralizer assembly, 5. Retain with
two bolts at the front, 3, and two bolts at the rear,
4. Reconnect the neutralizers at 2, and the dam-
pener shocks at 1.

73
START-UP PROCEDURE
1. Recheck all hydraulic/hydrostatic lines to be sure
they are tight.
2. Fill the hydraulic reservoir with API Service SH/
CG-4 10W-30 oil to the proper level, as indicated
on the back of the reservoir.
3. Install a 600 PSI (0 - 50 bar) gauge in the charge
pressure line at 1.

74
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 33

4. Remove the fuel solenoid power wire, 1, to pre-


vent the engine from starting.
5. Put the steering control levers in the neutral posi-
tion.

75
6. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
7. Turn the ignition key, 2, to the start position, and
allow the engine to crank for 30 seconds at a
time, until the pressure gauge starts to move. If
after trying three times the gauge does not move,
1
loosen the gear pump pressure line at the control
valve to bleed the air from the hydraulic system.
Recrank the engine until the gauge moves. After
the gauge moves, stop cranking and reconnect 2
the fuel solenoid wire.
8. Start the engine and monitor the charge pressure
gauge to insure charge oil to the hydrostatic sys- 19987741

tem. The pressure reading should be 250 - 300 76


PSI (17.2 - 20.7 bar).
IMPORTANT: If the charge pressure remains below
50 PSI (3.4 bar) for more than 10 seconds, stop the
engine and locate the cause. If the unit is operated
with low or no charge pressure, severe damage will
occur to the hydrostatic system.
Do not stroke the hydrostatic controls at this time.
9. Start the engine and operate at 1500 RPM for ap-
proximately 30 minutes. Stop the engine; check
the oil level at 1, and fill as required.

77
34 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1

10. Restart the engine and operate at 1500 RPM.


Slowly operate the hydrostatic controls to re-
move the air trapped in the system; monitor the
charge pressure.
11. Stop the engine; recheck the hydraulic oil level
and add as required.
12. Remove the charge pressure test gauge.
13. Adjust the neutral control linkage if required; refer
to neutral adjustment procedures.
14. Run the engine at 1500 RPM for an additional 30
minutes to filter the oil.
Stop the engine, allow the hydraulic oil to cool,
and change the oil filter, 1.
78
15. Check for oil leaks and repair as required.
16. Tilt the cab back to the operating position.
17. Reinstall all shields removed for repair.
18. Lower the skid steer to the ground and operate.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION

Chapter 1 – Neutralizer, Pumps, Motors, Two-Speed

CONTENT

Section Description Page


29 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-4
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-4
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-6
29 100 01 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-8
Low Power Through the Engine/Transmission System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-10
Hydrostatic Drive System Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-13
Hydrostatic System Oil Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-16
Hydrostatic Charge System Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-19
Hydrostatic Pump Case Drain Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-21
Hydrostatic Pump High Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-23
Hydrostatic Motor Case Drain Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-25
Hydraulic, Hydrostatic System Air Ingress Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-27
Hydrostatic and Charge Pumps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-29
Hydrostatic Pumps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-29
29 100 40 Hydrostatic Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-29
29 100 46 Hydrostatic and Charge Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-35
Hydrostatic Charge Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-36
Hydrostatic Charge Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-36
Hydrostatic Charge Pump Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-37
Hydrostatic Charge Pump Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-38
Hydrostatic Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-39
Hydrostatic Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-39
Hydrostatic Pump Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-44
Hydrostatic Pump Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-50
Hydrostatic Pump Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-57
Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-60
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-60
29 100 60 Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-60
29 100 66 Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-64
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-67
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-71
Hydrostatic Motor - Single Speed Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-73
2 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-77


29 100 60 Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-77
29 100 66 Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-87
Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-86
Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-90
Hydrostatic Motor - Two Speed Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-96
29 134 Two Speed High/Low Range Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-99
29 134 20 Two Speed High/Low Control Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-101
Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-102
29 134 24 Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-103
Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-103
Two Speed High/Low Control Valve Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-104
29 134 Control Valve Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-105
29 134 30 Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-106
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-107
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-107
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-108
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-108
Two Speed High/Low Slave Cylinder Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-108
29 134 40 Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-109
Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-110
Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-111
Two Speed High/Low Motor Control Linkage Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-112
Two Speed Control Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-113
Hydraulic System Cleaning Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-114
Start-up Procedure After Rebuild (After Pump or Motor Replacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-117
29 100 Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-120
Hydrostatic System Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-120
Neutralizer Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-122
29 130 10 Neutralizer Assembly Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-122
Neutralizer Assembly Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-122
Neutralizer Assembly Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-123
Neutralizer Assembly Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-125
29 130 30 Control Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-127
Control Linkage Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-128
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-129
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 3

29 100 10 Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-129


Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-129
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-130
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-130
Left Control Handle With No Boom Control Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-130
Left Control Handle With Boom Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-132
29 100 11 Left Control Handle With Boom Control Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-132
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-133
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-134
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-135
Left Control Handle With Boom Control Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-136
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-138
29 100 15 Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-138
29 100 15 Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-139
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-141
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-142
Right Control Handle With Auxiliary or Bucket Control Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-145
Control Linkage and Neutralizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-147
Control Linkage and Neutralizer Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-147
29 130 06 Drive Control Adjustment Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-148
SL65B Links and Arms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-149
29 130 06 SL65B Neutralizer Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-150
Control Lever Parallel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-150
SL65B Linkage and Control Lever Equal Movement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-151
Left Control Linkage Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-152
SL65B Straight Travel and Forward/Reverse Stop Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-152
SL65B High/Low Range .Adjustment
. . . . . . . . . . (Optional)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29-155
4 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100

GENERAL INFORMATION
The hydrostatic system provides a means to transfer
power from the engine to the final drives and wheels.
It provides an infinite number of operator speed
selections for both forward and reverse directions.
The hydrostatic system also furnishes a means to
steer the loader.
Each of the two hydrostatic pumps receive power
from the engine through a spur gear drive configur-
ation located in the engine to transmission gearbox.
The pumps convert rotary power, developed by the
engine, to variable pressure/flow fluid power. Fluid
power is then transferred to the hydrostatic motors
where it is transferred back to rotary motion. The ro-
tary motion from the hydrostatic motors is transferred
to the final drive gearboxes, axles, and finally to the
wheels.
Hydrostatic pump flow and fluid direction is operator-
controlled by levers. Both left and right side pump
and motor configurations are operated independent-
ly of each other and power each side separately.
OPERATION
The hydrostatic system is a closed loop, fluid power
system that provides a smooth transition of power
from the engine to the wheels. The hydrostatic sys-
tem is made up of two piston pumps, 1 and two piston
motors, 2. Hydrostatic charge pressure is supplied to
the pumps by a gerotor charge pump, which is at-
tached to the right hand hydrostatic pump. This pro-
vides replenishing oil for the oil that is lost due to leak-
age for lubrication and cooling purposes.
Steering is controlled by two hand levers located in
the operator’s cab. These hand levers control the for-
ward and reverse direction and the amount of oil flow
for speed of the skid steer. The variable oil flow from 1
the pumps is a result of the rotation of the pump cam-
plates within the individual pumps. The further the
control levers are pushed from neutral, the greater
the camplate angle. More oil is then pumped to the
motors, resulting in an increase in wheel speed. The
greatest wheel torque is when the control levers are
closest to neutral. When operating the skid steer,
more power (torque), is available by destroking the
control levers, thus increasing the skid steer effi-
ciency.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 5

10
1

2 6
14 7
8

9
3
16

17

15
11
5
13

4
12

2
Hydrostatic System Components:
1. Hydraulic reservoir - Right front of engine compart- 9. Hydrostatic pump for right drive - Under operator’s
ment. seat.
2. Suction line - From the reservoir to the gear pump 10. Hydrostatic motor for right drive - Attached to the
under the operator’s seat. right gearbox assembly.
3. Pressure line - From the gear pump to the control 11. Hydrostatic pump for left drive - Under operator’s
valve. seat.
4. Return line - From the control valve to the oil cooler. 12. Hydrostatic motor for left drive - Attached to the left
5. Oil cooler - Engine side of radiator in engine com- gearbox assembly.
partment. 13. Two-Speed high/low control valve, if equipped.
6. Oil filter - After the oil cooler at the engine compart- 14. Two-Speed high/low shift cylinder, if equipped.
ment rear door. 15. Engine.
7. Charge pump suction line - From tee in the line from 16. Engine to transmission gearbox.
the oil filter to the hydrostatic charge pump. 17. Hydraulic gear pump.
8. Hydrostatic charge pump - Attached to the front of
the right hydrostatic pump.
6 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

SPECIFICATIONS
HYDROSTATIC PUMPS

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable Displacement Piston Pump

Displacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82.3 l/min. (21.47 US. GPM) @ 2000 RPM

Pressure Relief Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 bar (5000 PSI)

Minimum Pump Efficiency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 %

Maximum Pump Case Drain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US. GPM) per pump

Maximum Pump Case Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.7 bar (25 PSI)

HYDROSTATIC MOTORS

SL65B Single-Speed Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed Displacement Piston Type


Displacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40.6 cc (2.48 cubic in.)

SL65B, Two-Speed Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable Displacement Piston Type


Displacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21.0 - 40.6 cc (1.28 - 2.48 cubic in.)

Minimum Motor Efficiency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 %

Maximum Motor Case Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 L (1 US. GPM) per motor

CHARGE PRESSURE SYSTEM

Charge Pump Relief Valve Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.2 - 20.7 bar (250 - 300 PSI)

Relief Valve Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 - 41 N·m (27 - 30 ft. lbs.)

OIL REQUIREMENTS

Type and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . API Service SH/CG-4 10W-30

TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS

PUMPS

Relief Valves Caps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 N·m (100 ft. lbs.)

Backplate and Charge Pump Adaptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 N·m (27 ft. lbs.)

Servo Control Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5 N·m (40 in. lbs.)

Gear Pump to Backplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 N·m (27 ft. lbs.)

Pump Mount to Engine Gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 N·m (45 ft. lbs.)

MOTORS

Backplate (Fixed Displacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 N·m (15 ft. lbs.)

Backplate (Variable Displacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 N·m (27 ft. lbs.)

Gearbox Attaching Bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 N·m (45 ft. lbs.)


SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 7

OTHER MATERIALS

Hydraulic Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . API Service SH/CG-4 10W-30

Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer

NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to prevent damage to the components being sealed during
the silicone curing process.
8 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100 01 WARNING


Gauges, gauge fittings, and hoses must have operat-
TROUBLESHOOTING ing pressure ratings of at least 25 percent higher than
When performing tests on the hydrostatic system, the highest pressures of the system.
use the proper test procedures and test equipment. Never adjust or replace the relief valves to get higher
Before testing, lower the attachment to the ground or pressures than those specified by the equipment
remove attachment from the skid steer. manufacturer.
If testing is to be performed with a raised boom, make Fluid under pressure can have sufficient force to pen-
sure the boom is raised above and resting on the etrate the skin, causing serious personal injury. Al-
boom lock pins, attachment removed. ways protect the skin and eyes from escaping fluid
Before opening the hydraulic system, clean the area under pressure.
thoroughly to prevent contaminating the system. Before disconnecting lines or fittings, be sure to turn
Before opening the hydraulic system, relieve all pres- off the skid steer engine and relieve all pressure. Be-
sure from the system. fore applying pressure to the system, be sure all con-
nections are tight and that lines, pipes, and hoses are
Before testing the hydraulic system, check the hy- not damaged.
draulic oil level.
If injured by escaping fluid, obtain medical assist-
Before testing the hydraulic system, the oil must be ance at once. Serious infection or reaction can devel-
at normal operating temperature. op if medical treatment is not administered immedi-
If testing requires the skid steer to be raised, use ad- ately.
equate blocking and/or jack stands to securely sup- Remove any attachment from the mounting plate be-
port the skid steer. fore loosening or disconnecting any hydraulic lines.
CAUTION
When connecting test equipment to the hydrostatic CAUTION
system, relieve the pressure in the system. Stop the Use adequate blocking and/or jack stands to ensure
engine, with the seat belt fastened, turn the ignition that the skid steer is safely supported with all four
switch to the “on” position and operate all hydraulic wheels off the ground.
control valve circuits to relieve pressure. Turn the
ignition switch to the “off” position.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 9

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Machine will not move either direc- Parking brake engaged Release parking brake
tion Low hydraulic oil Check oil level
Low charge pressure Check charge pressure/repair
Incorrect oil Drain and replenish with proper oil
Air in system Purge air and repair system
Water in system Drain, clean, and replace oil
Output pressure too low Check pressure replace relief valve
Internal pump or motor damage Check pump/motor case drain flow
Linkages loose or broken Check and repair
One side moves, other side does Relief valve stuck open Check and repair
not Internal pump or motor damage Check pump/motor case drain flow
Brake engaged on one side Check parking brake system and
repair
Linkage loose or broken Check and repair
Broken drive chain Check and repair
Gearbox damaged Check and repair
Noisy pump or motor Air in system Purge air and repair system
Wrong kind of oil Drain, clean system and replace oil
Water in system Drain, clean, and replace oil
Internal pump or motor damaged Check pump/motor case drain flow
Linkage loose or broken Check and repair
Parking brake engaged Release parking brake
Low power Low hydraulic oil Check oil level
Low charge pressure Check charge pressure/repair
Relief valve stuck open Check and repair
Air in system Purge air and repair system
Output pressure too low Check pressure replace relief valve
Internal pump or motor damage Check pump/motor case drain flow
Sluggish response to changes in Relief valve stuck open Check and repair
speed Air in system Purge air and repair system
Output pressure too low Check pressure replace relief valve
Linkage loose or broken Check and repair
Oil too heavy, cold weather Allow unit to warm up before oper-
ating
Wrong kind of oil Drain, clean system and replace oil
10 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

LOW POWER THROUGH THE ENGINE/ b. Check for plugged fuel filters and drain water
TRANSMISSION SYSTEM trap.
Perceived low power has been noted in certain c. Check engine timing.
heavy power demand applications. Possible causes d. The injection pump calibration has not been
include: found out of range on any complaint ma-
• Machine overloaded - The bucket or attachment chines. However, it could still be a factor.
is too large for the material being handled. In most cases, engine performance has been
• Engine concerns. found acceptable, with the exception of bad fuel
or plugged fuel filters.
• The operator is not properly trained and is over-
steering the servo-controlled transmissions. 3. Machine operation has been the most significant
contributing factor. Operators tend to over-steer
1. Match the correct attachment for the material
the servo-controlled transmission in heavy
being handled. Use the bucket chart and material
power demand situations, resulting in the engine
density chart found in the attachment section of
lugging down or stopping.
the operator’s manual. It may be necessary to
weigh a bucket of material to determine the Operators must be instructed to reduce the wheel
weight being handled. speed (ground speed) by positioning the steering
levers closer to the neutral position in heavy digging,
2. Engine Concerns:
backing out of steep inclines, or turning on pave-
a. Check fuel quality and grade and replace fuel ment-type surfaces with heavy loads.
if necessary.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 11

LS180 - Adjustable steering links


Hole 1 - Gives maximum linkage travel and
wheel speed.
Hole 2 - Reduces linkage travel and wheel speed
when steering levers are fully stroked.
Hole 3 - Maximum reduction in linkage travel and
corresponding wheel speed.

Factory assembly of linkage is in hole, 2, as shown


in Figures 3 through 5. If an operator is in a less
power-demanding operation and needs maximum
ground speed, the linkage can be moved to hole, 1.
3
For maximum wheel torque, use hole, 3.
NOTE: Left and right linkage must be in the holes for
machines to operate in a straight line of travel and
with the same power. 1 3
Wheel speed on SL65B (in low range, if two-speed)
and engine speed at high idle (2350 + 25 RPM) is:
Hole 1 - 80 RPM + 5
Hole 2 - 67 RPM + 5
Hole 3 - Seldom used (use only when 67 RPM
cannot be reached using hole 2)

Axle speeds should be set as close as possible to 4


maximize straight travel in the forward direction.
When moving the linkage between holes 1, 2, and 3,
neutral positioning may have to be reset.
NOTE: When changing linkage position, have the 3 1
skid steer up on blocks, securely supported with all
four wheels off the ground so neutral can be ad-
justed, if needed, on engine start-up. This also aids
when using a tachometer to adjust wheel speed.

5
12 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDROSTATIC DRIVE SYSTEM TESTING


Hand controls - forward and reverse
Pre-test instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Seat belt buckled
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Key switch in the “OFF” position
STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION
1 Levers should move freely NO Check control linkage from levers to the pumps.
YES System OK
2 Stroke both levers forward or re- YES System OK
verse, the levers should return to NO Check neutralizer system for binding or adjust-
neutral position ment.
3 Stroke both levers forward or re- YES System OK
verse and release one lever, both NO Check neutralizer system for binding or adjust-
levers should stay in direction ment
stroked

Hand controls - forward and reverse


Pre-test instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Seat belt buckled
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Parking brake disengaged
* Key switch in the “RUN” position
* Engine operating at low idle speed
STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION
1 Control levers in neutral, unit YES System OK
should not move NO Check and adjust for neutral
2 Stroke both levers forward or re- YES System OK
verse, unit should accelerate NO Check for loose or damaged control linkage, if
smoothly OK go to next step.
3 Check hydraulic oil level and add as required, if
OK go to next step.
4 Check hydrostatic hoses, tubing, and connec-
tions for leaks, if OK go to next step.
5 Check parking brake for being engaged or cor-
rect adjustment, if OK go to next step.
6 Check hydrostatic charge pressure, if OK go to
next step.
7 Check forward or reverse relief valve operation
and pressure settings.
8 Control levers in neutral park brake YES Control System OK
engaged, pumps should be quiet NO Check and adjust for neutral, if OK go to next
step.
9 Check for loose or damaged control linkage, if
OK go to next step.
10 Control levers in full forward, ma- YES Control System OK
chine should go in straight line NO Reset control lever stops
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 13

Before performing any hydraulic tests, operate the


skid steer to get the hydraulic oil to operating tem-
perature (approximately 55° C [100° F] above the
ambient temperature).
For access to the hydrostatic system, remove any at-
tachment from the skid steer attaching face plate and
support the boom on the boom lock pins.
1. Raise the boom, extend the boom lock pins, 1,
and rest the boom on the boom lock pins.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the key to the run position


and operate the boom and bucket pedals to re-
lieve pressure in the boom and bucket circuits.

7
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
1

19984337
8
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.

9
14 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch, 1, in the


raised position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely 1
latched in the raised position.

10
6. Check the hydraulic oil level, 1, and add if re-
quired to the proper level.
WARNING
Gauges, gauge fittings, and hoses must have operat-
ing pressure ratings of at least 25% higher than the
highest pressures of the system.
Never adjust or replace the relief valves to get higher
pressures than those specified by the equipment
manufacturer. 1
Fluid under pressure can have sufficient force to pen-
etrate the skin, causing serious personal injury. Al-
ways protect the skin and eyes from escaping fluid
under pressure.
11
Before disconnecting lines or fittings, be sure to turn
off the skid steer engine and relieve all pressure. Be-
fore applying pressure to the system, be sure all con-
nections are tight and that lines, pipes, and hoses are
not damaged.
If injured by escaping fluid, obtain medical assist-
ance at once. Serious infection or reaction can devel-
op if medical treatment is not administered immedi-
ately.
Remove any attachment from the mounting plate be-
fore loosening or disconnecting any hydraulic lines.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 15

6
12
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW The left hand hydrostatic pump, 4, supplies high-
pressure oil through high-pressure lines, 5, to the left
Hydrostatic Pumps and Motors High-Pressure hand hydrostatic motor, 6, when the left forward/re-
Flow verse control lever is stroked in either direction.
The hydrostatic pumps are driven by the engine The hydrostatic system is protected by four high-
through a spur gear configuration in the transmission pressure relief valves, two in each pump, one for for-
gearbox. ward and one for reverse. All four high-pressure relief
valves are the same and are factory set at 345 bar
The right hand hydrostatic pump, 1, supplies high- (5000 PSI). Do not try changing the pressure setting
pressure oil through high-pressure lines, 2, to the of these relief valves. If during testing the relief valves
right hand hydrostatic motor, 3, when the right for- are found to be incorrectly set, replace the complete
ward/reverse control lever is stroked in either direc- valve cartridge.
tion.
16 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

3
8
5
6

13
Hydrostatic Pump Charge Pressure Oil Flow Charge oil is also supplied to the Transmission
A gerotor charge pump, 1, is attached to the right Charge Pressure switch, 5, through hose 6. This
hand hydrostatic pump, 2, and provides charge pres- hose tees into the charge pressure circuit at the left
sure oil to both the right and left hand hydrostatic hand hydrostatic pump.
pumps, 2 and 3. Oil is supplied to the left hand hydro- On the two-speed skid steers, charge oil is used to
static pump through line 4. This charge oil replaces supply oil to the Hi/Low Control Valve, 7, through
oil in the high-pressure circuit that was used for lu- hose 8. This hose also tees into the charge pump cir-
brication and cooling of the internal rotating parts of cuit at the left hand hydrostatic pump.
the pumps and motors.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 17

5 6

3 8
9
14
Hydrostatic Pump and Motor Case Drain Flow drain from the pump and motor housings (cases)
(SL65B Two-Speed Shown) through the case drain lines.
NOTE: SL65B Models with fixed displacement mo- On the hydrostatic pumps, the case drain line, 1, con-
tors operate the same, without the two-speed selec- nects the right and left pumps 2 and 3. Line 4 tees into
tor valve and shift cylinder. the case drain port, 5, at the rear of the right-hand hy-
During operation of the hydrostatic pumps and mo- drostatic motor, 6. The hot case drain oil is returned
tors, oil from the high-pressure circuits used for lu- to the hydraulic system (to be cooled and filtered)
brication drains into the pump and motor housings. through the return line, 7.
The lubrication oil will fill the housings approximately Tube, 8, from the front case drain port on the left hand
half full. This oil then becomes cooling oil and will hydrostatic motor, 9, tees into the case drain port at
the hydraulic reservoir.
18 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDROSTATIC CHARGE SYSTEM


PRESSURE TEST
The hydrostatic charge pump provides charge pres-
sure oil to the right and left hand hydrostatic pumps.
This oil replenishes the hydrostatic system for lu-
brication and cooling of the hydrostatic pumps and
motors.
The charge pressure can be checked at the charge
pressure port on the top of the left hand hydrostatic
pump, 1.
The charge system pressure is regulated by the
charge pump relief valve and can not be adjusted. If
there is some reason to suspect incorrect pressure,
check the pressure as follows:

Checking Charge System Pressure 15


Fittings and gauge required:
1. 0 - 50 bar (0 - 600 PSI) gauge (minimum)
2. 7/16 - 20, 37° (JIC) swivel nut run tee and hose
to gauge

Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Disengage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Support the front of the skid steer
at 1, to the front of the final drive case and at 2,
to the rear of the case (tires removed for clarity).
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.

5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely 16
latched in the raised position.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 19

6. Disconnect the hose to the Transmission Charge


Pressure switch at 1, install a swivel nut run tee,
hose and pressure gauge, and reinstall the hose
to the charge pressure switch.
IMPORTANT: Check the oil level in the hydraulic oil
reservoir and add SAE 10W-30 oil (if required) to
make sure there is sufficient oil for the test.
7. Start the engine, run at full throttle (2225 - 2275
RPM), and take a pressure reading. The pres-
sure should be within the 17.2 - 20.7 bar (250 -
300 PSI) allowable range.
8. Operate the hydrostatic control levers in forward
and reverse until the system bypasses and take
a pressure reading. Return the controls to neu- 17
tral. The pressure should remain within the range
of 17.2 - 20.7 bar (250 - 300 PSI).
CAUTION
Always stay clear of moving parts during testing or
serious injury could occur.

9. If the charge pressure is within the specified


range, but the EIC warning light is on indicating
low charge pressure, replace the Transmission
Charge Pressure sending unit, 1.
10. If charge pressure is low, refer to the Hydrostatic
Pump section for disassembly instructions and
check the following:
a. Charge pressure relief valve damage:
1. Broken spring
2. Damaged poppet seat
3. Dirt or debris under poppet seat

b. Remove charge pump assembly and check:


1. Gerotor ring wear, both inner and outer 18
2. Drive key failure

11. Low charge pressure could also be a result of ex-


cess case drain flow from the hydrostatic pumps/
motors. This is a result of worn or damaged inter-
nal components. Refer to the test procedures
outlined in this section to determine the case
drain flow. If case drain flow is the problem, refer
to the Hydrostatic Pump/Motor Section for ser-
vice instructions.
20 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDROSTATIC PUMP CASE DRAIN TEST


The hydrostatic pump case drain oil flow should be
checked to determine if wear and possible damage
to the internal rotating components has occurred.

Checking Pump Case Drain Flow


Fittings and other equipment required:
1. Misc. 37° JIC fittings for case drain tubes: Plugs,
elbows and adapters.
2. Drain hose
3. 5 gallon bucket
4. Stop watch

Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Engage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.

5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
19
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 21

Right Hand Hydrostatic Pump, 1


6. Remove the case drain cross tube, 2, at the right
and left pump housing outlet ports, 3 and 4. Cap
the open fitting at 4, on the left pump. Connect a
hose to the case drain fitting at 3, on the right
pump, and run into a suitable container.
IMPORTANT: Check the hydraulic oil level and add
if required to ensure sufficient oil for the test.
7. Start the engine and run at full throttle
(2225 - 2275 RPM). Take a flow reading. The
maximum flow should be 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US. gal./
min.).
8. Stroke the hydrostatic control levers forward and
reverse and take a flow reading in both direc- 20
tions. If the flow exceeds the 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US.
gal./min.), there is excessive leakage from the
forward and/or reverse high pressure loops.
CAUTION
Always stay clear of moving parts during testing or
serious injury could occur.

Left Hand Hydrostatic Pump, 1


9. Remove the case drain cross tube, 2, and case
drain tube, 3. Connect a hose from the case drain
port on the right pump at 4, to the open inlet port
on the hydraulic gear pump at 5. Remove the tee
fitting, 6, connect a hose to the case drain port at
7, on the left pump, and run the hose into a suit-
able container.
IMPORTANT: Check the hydraulic oil level and add
if required to ensure sufficient oil for the test.
10. Start the engine and run at full throttle
(2225 - 2275 RPM). Take a flow reading. The
maximum flow should be 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US. gal./
min.). 21
11. Stroke the hydrostatic control levers forward and
reverse and take a flow reading in both direc-
tions. If the flow exceeds the 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US.
gal./min.), there is excessive leakage from the
forward and/or reverse high pressure loops.
CAUTION
Always stay clear of moving parts during testing or
serious injury could occur.

12. If the flow from the hydrostatic pumps is less than


5.7 l/min. (1.5 US. gal./min.), the problem may be
in the motors. Refer to the Hydrostatic Motor
Case Drain Test in this section for further details.
22 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDROSTATIC PUMP HIGH-PRESSURE


TEST
The hydrostatic drive system is protected by four
high-pressure relief valves; two in each pump, one
for forward and one for reverse. All four valves are the
same and are factory set at 345 bar (5000 PSI).
The valves are located opposite each other at the
bottom of the backplate section of the pumps. Right
hand pump at 1, and left hand pump at 2.
If one relief valve is in question, the valve can be
switched with a known good valve; if the problem fol-
lows the switched valve, replace the suspect valve.
Switching forward and reverse relief valves on the
same pump should reverse the problem if the relief
valve is defective. If the problem remains, internal
wear or damage in the pump or motor is the likely 22
cause. Refer to the pump case drain test for further
testing to locate the problem.

Gauge Required
0 - 690 bar (0 - 10,000 PSI)

Relief Valve Test Procedure


1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Engage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground.
23
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.

5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 23

6. Install a tee fitting, in the high-pressure loop


being tested, at the pump outlet, 1.
IMPORTANT: Check the hydraulic oil level and add
if required to ensure sufficient oil for the test.

24
The following hydrostatic pump relief valves pro-
tect the forward and reverse direction of the hy-
drostatic drive motor (tire) rotation.
Right pump controls the right motor
1 - Forward
2 - Reverse

Left pump controls the left motor


3 - Reverse
4 - Forward

7. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2225 -


2275 RPM).
8. Stroke the hydrostatic lever on the side being 25
tested and in the direction being tested, and take
a pressure reading. The pressure should be 345
bar (5000 PSI). If the pressure is not at specifica-
tion of 345 bar (5000 PSI), replace the suspect
relief valve.
CAUTION
Always stay clear of moving parts during testing or
serious injury could occur.

NOTE: All four directional relief valves can be tested


in this manner.
If the pressure is within specification, refer to the
pump/motor case drain test for further testing to
locate the problem.
24 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CASE DRAIN TEST


The hydrostatic motors should be checked for ex-
cessive internal leakage if one or both of the ground
drive systems appears weak. The excessive leakage
is caused by wear or damage to the motors internal
rotating groups, thus allowing high-pressure oil to
leak into the case.

Checking Motor Case Drain Flow


Ideally, case drain to each motor should be checked
individually to properly evaluate their condition. But
due to the inaccessibility of the hydrostatic motor and
case drain lines, the following procedure should be
used.
Fittings and other equipment required:
1. Misc. 37° JIC fittings
2. Drain hose
3. 5 gallon bucket
4. Stop watch

Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Engage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.

5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
26
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 25

6. Verify that the hydrostatic pumps are in good


condition by performing a case drain test on the
pumps. Refer to the pump case drain test pro-
cedure as outlined earlier.
7. If either the right or left hand side was appearing
weak, and the pump case drain test was within
specifications, a check of the total case drain flow
from the motors should be performed.
8. Disconnect the hydrostatic motor case drain
hose at the hydraulic gear pump at 1, and cap the
fitting at the pump.
9. Connect another hose to the end of the motor
case drain hose, and run into a suitable con-
tainer.
IMPORTANT: Check the hydraulic oil level and add
if required to ensure sufficient oil for the test.
10. Start the engine and run at full throttle (2225 -
2275 RPM).
11. Stroke the control lever for the side being tested,
both forward and reverse, and take a flow read-
ing. Flows in excess of 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US. GPM)
indicate excessive leakage in the motor. This will 27
also indicate the need for either repair or replace-
ment of the motor.
NOTE: Even though the case drain flow is for both
motors, flow from the unstroked side is not enough to
affect the results.
CAUTION
Always stay clear of moving parts during testing or
serious injury could occur.
26 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDRAULIC, HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM AIR


INGRESS TEST
Hydraulic system air ingress, causing oil aeration,
can affect performance of the hydraulic oil. This may
be evident on a machine by jerky or uneven move-
ment of the skid steer boom or bucket.
To assist in testing and finding leaks, a tool has been
developed (part #FNH22ESS95). This tool com-
prises a cap which replaces the reservoir filler
breather for testing purposes, a pressure gauge and
a relief valve. The cap has fittings for air pressure to
be applied to the hydraulic reservoir.
CAUTION
Do not start the engine with the test tool installed, as
the hydraulic system must be able to breathe.

Test Procedure
1. Remove the filler/breather cap.
2. Remove the self-tapping screws around the cap
base and screen assembly.
3. Remove the base, screen and gasket assembly,
clean all sealing surfaces.
4. Re-install new gaskets and base, taking care not
to overtighten the screws.
5. Make sure the tank has 10W-30 oil visible.
6. Pressurize the tank using an air pressure line.
The tool is equipped with a 3 PSI relief valve and
a pressure gauge. The reservoir should not be
pressurized beyond 4 PSI.
The following checks should then be performed to
trace the source of the air ingress.
• Examine the suction tubes and fittings to the hy-
draulic gear pump and the return tubes from the
filter to the reservoir.
• Examine the transmission case drain tubes/
hoses and fittings from the hydraulic motors and
pumps to the suction side of the hydraulic pump.
Also check the cam plate shaft seals and the
pump and motor casing gaskets.
• Potential leakage areas could also be input shaft
seals in the engine bell housing, gearbox or out-
put shaft seals in motors and gearboxes and the
chain case.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 27

• It may be necessary in some instances (where


leakage is occurring on shaft seals into gear-
boxes or bell housing), to pressurize the reser-
voir for 2 to 4 hours and monitor the oil level in the
gearboxes.
• If the prior checks do not locate the source of the
leak, it may be necessary to pressurize each hy-
drostatic component individually.
To do this it will be necessary to disconnect each
case drain line in turn and pressurize using an air
line to a maximum pressure of 10 PSI.
NOTE: A check valve can be installed in the case
drain tube which maintains a 5 PSI pressure in the
pump and motor cases. This helps prevent air in- 28
gress into the system.
28 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDROSTATIC AND CHARGE PUMPS

HYDROSTATIC PUMPS

Op. 29 100 40
REMOVAL
The hydrostatic pump assemblies can be removed
from the top and front, or the cab and boom can be
tilted forward for more access. Refer to Section 00 for
the cab tilting procedure.
To remove the hydrostatic pump assembly without
tilting the cab forward:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi- 29
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position, and operate the boom and bucket pe-
dals to relieve pressure in the boom and bucket
1
circuits. Turn off the key.
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake.

19984337
30
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 29

5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels


off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.

31
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

7. Remove the step shield, 2, to access the hydro-


static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 3 or 4.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION 32
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system to avoid serious injury.

Unless the hydraulic system requires cleaning,


draining of the hydraulic oil reservoir is not re-
quired. Make sure the suction and return lines
are capped to prevent loss of oil.
9. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.

33
30 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

10. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting


the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.

34
11. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
12. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at the front, 3, and two at the rear, 4. Lift
the entire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one
piece.

35
NOTE: Clean the pumps thoroughly and mark the
hose locations to aid in reassembly.
13. Disconnect hydrostatic lines, 1 and 2, and cap
the ends.
14. Disconnect hydrostatic lines, 3 and 4, and cap
the ends.

36
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 31

15. Disconnect the rear control rods, 1 and 2, at the


pump control arms. 1
16. Disconnect the hydraulic suction hose, 3, the hy-
draulic high pressure hose, 4, and if equipped,
the two-speed slave cylinder supply hose at 5.
4 5

2
A3649-
12 37
17. Disconnect the charge pump suction line at 1.
Remove the charge pressure cross tube, 2, and 3 2 5
the case drain tubes, 3 and 5. Disconnect the
1
charge pressure sender line at 4. Cap all lines. 7
Two-speed skid steers - If equipped, remove the
two-speed solenoid valve supply line, 6, and the 4
solenoid valve return line, 7. Cap lines.

A5358-
12 38
18. Remove the two 3/8″ gear pump attaching bolts,
1, and the gear pump assembly, 2, set aside.
Refer to Section 6, “Hydraulic Gear Pump”, for
repair information.

39
32 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

NOTE: To access the lower mounting bolts on the hy-


drostatic pumps, remove the inspection cover on the
underside of the machine.
19. Securely support the hydrostatic pumps.
20. Remove the upper pump mounting bolts, 1, and
the lower pump mounting bolts, 2.
21. Remove the left hydrostatic pump, 3, and the
right hydrostatic pump, 4.
22. Remove the O rings, 5, between the hydrostatic
pumps and the engine bell housing.

42
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 33

23. Remove the outer retaining ring, 1, pump drive


gear, 2, and inner retaining ring, 3, from the hy-
drostatic pump drive shaft, 4.

43
24. Loosen clamp bolt, 1, and remove control arm, 4,
and key, 3, from the servo control shaft, 2.
The right hand pump and control arm are shown. Re-
peat steps 23 and 24 for the left hand pump and con-
trol arm.

44
34 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100 46
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the complete pump assembly
before teardown. Plug all ports so dirt and solvent
do not enter the pump.
The right hand hydrostatic pump consists of
these main components; charge pump adaptor
assembly, 1, backplate, 2, main pump housing,
3, and servo control assembly, 4.

45
The left hand hydrostatic pump consists of the
backplate, 1, main pump housing, 2, and servo
control assembly, 3.
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for any
hydrostatic component repair must include the ma-
chine model, serial numbers, transmission model
number, and date codes. These codes are stamped
into the servo control end cap.
The following disassembly instructions apply to
the right hand hydrostatic pump, with gerotor
charge pump. When disassembling the left hand
pump, disregard steps concerning the charge
pump.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation- 46
ship between the servo control assembly, charge
pump adaptor assembly, and main pump hous-
ing with a marker or scribe.
3. As the pump is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench top or heavy cardboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. Position the pump into a protected jaw vise,
clamping onto the outer portion of the mounting
flange with the cap screws of the gerotor charge
pump facing up.
5. Remove the four cap screws, 1, and tap the
housings with a plastic or rubber mallet to separ-
ate the two pumps. Lift the charge pump adaptor
assembly straight up off the shaft and backplate.
The gerotor may stay in the adaptor or on the
backplate.

47
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 35

HYDROSTATIC CHARGE PUMP

DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the charge pump to prevent
contamination of internal parts.
2. Remove two cap screws, 1, cover plate, 3, and
O ring, 2.

48
3. Remove the inner gerotor ring, 3, the outer gero-
tor ring, 1, and molded O ring, 2.
If the inner gerotor ring, 3, stays on the shaft, re-
move it and the drive key. If not, remove the drive
key and set with the charge pump assembly.

49
4. Remove the relief valve assembly which consists
of: plug, 1, O ring, 2, shims, 3, spring, 4, and
poppet, 5.
5. The needle bearings, 6, are a press fit in the
adapter housing. Do not remove at this time un-
less the bearing is loose in the housing or if there
are loose, damaged or missing needles.

50
36 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

PARTS INSPECTION
1. Clean all parts with a suitable solvent.
2. Inspect the relief valve seat inside the charge
pump adaptor housing at 1. Check to make sure
that the seat is smooth and free from burrs or
other defects.
3. Inspect the relief valve poppet, 2, for damage and
scratches in the seat contact area. Also check to
make sure the relief valve spring, 3, is not broken.

51
4. The shaft needle bearing assembly, 1, is a press
fit in the charge pump adaptor housing and
should not be loose. Inspect for looseness.
Check for loose or missing needles in the bearing
housing.
Remove bearing assembly if any problems are
found.

52
5. Check the gerotor pocket, 1, inside the charge
pump adaptor assembly, the inner gerotor ring,
2, and the outer gerotor ring, 3, for scoring and
excessive wear.
6. All seals should be replaced upon reassembly.
7. Inspect the drive key for wear or partial shearing.

53
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 37

REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
2. Use a clean 10W-30 oil to lubricate all moving
parts as they are reassembled.
3. If necessary, press a new bearing into the 2.41
adaptor assembly. The bearing should be in- mm
stalled with the numbered end, 1, facing outward (0.095,)
and closest to the mounting flange, 2. The gero-
tor pocket is located at 3. Install to a dimension
of 2.41 mm (0.095″).

54
4. Install the relief valve poppet, 1, spring, 2, shims,
3, and plug, 4, with new O ring, into the adaptor
assembly. Torque the plug to 37 - 41 N·m (27 - 30
ft. lbs.).

55
5. Lubricate both a new molded O ring, 2, and the
outer gerotor ring, 1; install in adaptor assembly.
Upon reassembly to the main pump housing, the
inner gerotor ring, 3, and drive key will be in-
stalled on the pump shaft prior to installing the
charge pump adaptor assembly.
6. The four retaining cap screws are torqued to 37
- 42 N·m (27 - 31 ft. lbs.).

56
38 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100 46

HYDROSTATIC PUMP

DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the complete pump assembly
prior to teardown; plug ports so dirt and solvent
do not enter the pump.
After removal of the charge pump adaptor as-
sembly, described earlier, the main pump con-
sists of these main components: charge pump
backplate, 1, pump body, 2, and servo control as-
sembly, 3.
57
The backplates carry high-pressure oil from the
pumps to the motors via high-pressure hoses.
The low-pressure return oil from the motors flows
back to the pumps through the backplates to
complete the closed loop circuit.
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for any
hydrostatic component repair must include the ma-
chine model, serial numbers, transmission model
number, and date codes. These codes are stamped
into the servo control end cap.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation-
ship between the backplate, pump body and
servo control assembly with a marker or scribe.
3. As the pump is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench top of heavy carboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. With the pump still clamped in a protected jaw
vise and the charge pump adaptor assembly re-
moved, lift the backplate, 1, straight up and off
the shaft and housing.

58
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 39

5. Remove valve plate, 1, and housing gasket, 2,


from backplate, 3.
Valve plate may stick to the rotating group in
housing when backplate is removed.

59
6. Mark the position of the two relief valves to aid in
reassembly.
7. Remove the relief valve assemblies, 1 and 4. O
rings, 5 and 6, on the relief valves, should be re-
moved and replaced on reassembly.
8. Remove retaining ring, 2, and plug, 3, from the
backplate assembly.

60
9. To remove the rotating group, 1, from the hous-
ing, set the edge of the housing on a 2 x 4 or 4 x
4 block and tilt the open end of the housing down.
Turn the rotating piston block and pull it out as a
complete unit without scratching or burring the
parts.
NOTE: Keep the rotating group as an assembly at
this time.

61
40 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

10. Remove the camplate, 1, from the pump housing


by tilting the open end of the housing down and
guiding the camplate to the opening. With the
long end of the shaft pointing down and support-
ing the pump housing, rotate the camplate until
the servo piston follower, 2, aligns with the notch
in the housing, and remove.

62
11. The pump drive shaft, 1, can be removed by
doing the following:
a. Remove the large retaining ring, 2.
b. Use an arbor press or tap the internally
splined end of the shaft with a soft faced
mallet to remove the drive shaft.
c. Remove seal, 3, and washer, 4. The seal
may be damaged during removal.

63
12. Remove both retaining rings, 1, thrust washers,
2, and thrust bearing, 3, from drive shaft, 4.
Set all drive shaft components aside for inspec-
tion.

64
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 41

13. Remove the cradle assembly attaching bolts, 1,


and move the cradle back and forth to release it
from the dowel bushings. Remove the cradle as-
sembly, 2.

65
14. Remove the six socket head cap screws, 2, and
the manual servo control assembly, 1.

66
15. Remove the servo control assembly gasket, 1.
Note the position of the alignment tab, 2, on both
the gasket and the servo control housing, for
proper installation of the gasket during reas-
sembly.

67
42 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

16. Remove the four socket head cap screws and flat
washers, 1, from the servo piston cover plate.
Remove the cover plate, 2, and gasket, 3. Re-
move the four remaining socket head cap screws
and washers from the cover plate at the opposite
end of the servo piston at 4.

68
17. To remove the cover plate, 1, from the servo pis-
ton bolt, 2, remove jam nut, 3, washer, 4, and seal
washer, 5. Hold the servo piston bolt, 2, with an
allen wrench and unscrew the cover plate off the
bolt. Remove gasket, 6.

69
18. Use a wooden hammer handle to push the servo
piston, 1, from the pump housing, 2.
Remove the two servo piston seal assemblies, 3,
from the pump housing, 2.
Disassembly of the servo piston assembly is not
required.
CAUTION
Do not disassemble the servo piston, personal injury
may occur. An internal spring inside the piston as-
sembly is under pressure.

70
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 43

PARTS INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry.
Pump Housing
1. The shaft needle bearing assembly, 1, in the
pump housing, is a press fit, and should not be
loose. Inspect for looseness. Check that all
needles are in the cage and move freely. Inspect
the needles for wear or damage.
The bearing is shown with the numbered end, 1,
facing out toward the flange end of the housing,
2.

71
2. Verify that the bearing is positioned correctly and
to the dimension shown.
3. Remove the shaft needle bearing assembly if
any problems are found. Install a new bearing in
the housing with the numbered end, 1, facing out
toward the flange end of the housing, 2. Install to
the dimension shown.

1.78
mm
(0.07,)

72
Servo Control and Piston
1. Inspect the servo piston, 1, and housing, 2, for
scratches. All seals and gaskets should be re-
placed at reassembly.

73
44 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Cradle Assembly
1. Inspect the cradle bushing, 1, for contamination
embedded in the bushing surface from contact
with the camplate.
2. If contamination is found, remove button head
cap screw, 2, and remove cradle bushing. Re-
place bushing.
3. If bushing is replaced, torque the button head cap
screw to 1.6 - 1.8 N·m (14 - 16 in. lbs).

74
Pump Shaft
1. Inspect the areas that contact the shaft needle
bearings, 1, for wear or a rough bearing surface.
2. Check for a bent or worn shaft.
3. Check the spline areas, 2, for wear or twist.
4. Check the thrust bearing, 3, races, 4, and retain-
ing rings and grooves, 5. If bearing or races show
wear or roughness, they must be replaced.

75
5. Input seal, 1, will be replaced upon reassembly.
6. Inspect retaining ring, 2, and washer, 3.

76
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 45

Camplate
1. Shoes of the pump pistons rotate at high speeds 1
against the camplate surface, 1. The surface
must be smooth with no metal flaked away and
no scoring. Circular scratches centered on the
machined surface are due to contamination. If
scratches can be felt with your thumbnail, re-
place the camplate.
2. Check the camplate surface for smearing. The
surface must be smooth and bright with no disco-
loration or brass color on the flat surface.

77
3. Check the camplate bushing surface, 1, for wear
and transfer of coating from the cradle bushing.
Replace if necessary.
4. Inspect the lubrication ports, 2, for blockage.
Clean thoroughly.
5. Inspect the servo piston follower, 3, and aligning
pin, 4, for wear.

78
Shoe and Piston Assemblies

Replace the rotating group if:


1. The piston skirt area, 1, shows signs of scratches
or wear.
2. The edges of the shoes, 2, are worn (shoe roll)
from contact with the camplate.
3. There is wear on the underside of the slipper, be-
tween the slipper and shoe plate at 3.
4. The shoes have a loose, sloppy fit on the ball end
of the piston at 4.
5. The flat surfaces of the shoes, 5, show metal flak-
ing or are deeply scratched. Light or shallow
scratches in the shoes will not cause any harm. 79
Do not lap the shoes.
46 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Shoe Plate
1. Check for cracks and wear at the holes for the
spherical washer and shoes at 1. The shoe plate
is only available as part of the rotating group.
2. Check for wear in the area of the slippers, 2. This
area should be flat, smooth, and have no
grooves.
3. Check the internal splines of the piston block, 3,
for wear.
Spherical Washer (pivot), 4.
1. Check for wear on the top surface where the
shoe plate fits. The spherical washer is only
available as part of the rotating group.
80
2. Check the sides, rolled area for cracks.
Rotating Piston Block 4.

Replace the rotating group if:


1. Cylinders, 1, are worn or scored so the pistons do
not move freely.
2. Surface, 2, is worn or grooved or shows metal
buildup. Nicks must not extend from the cylinders
to the edge of the raised area, 3.
3. The pistons have side play in the piston block.

81
Loading Pins

The three block loading pins, 1, are spring loaded


and are held in place by the pin keeper (split bush-
ing), 2.
1. The pins should be the same height.
2. The pins should be seated in the special grooves.
3. The head of the pins should be seated between
the washer and the block.

82
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 47

Replaceable Bearing Plate


1. Check for flatness.
2. Check for scratches on the brass side of the
plate, extending outward across the area where
the raised area of the piston block contacts the
plate at 1.
3. Check for scratches between the kidney ports at
2.

83
Back Plate
1. Check the back plate for flatness, 1.
2. The back plate needle bearing assembly, 2, is a
press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness and wear. Check that all needles are
in the cage and move freely.

84
3. Verify that the needle bearing, 1, is positioned
correctly and to the dimension shown.
4. Remove the needle bearing if any problems are
found. Install a new bearing in the housing with
the numbered end, 3, toward the valve plate. In-
stall to dimension of 2.29 mm (0.09″ ) above the 2.29 4.39
surface of the back plate as shown. The bearing mm mm
is used as a pilot for the valve plate. (0.09,) (0.173,)
5. Check the back plate roll pin, 2. If the pin is tight
and set to the dimension shown, replacement is
not required.

85
48 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

6. Two directional relief valves, 1, are located in


each transmission. These relief valves limit the
maximum system pressure to 345 bar (5000
PSI). Relief valve pressures are factory set and
should not be changed.
7. Check the seat area, 2, in the back plate for
scratches that could prevent the relief valves
from sealing properly.
8. Inspect the end plug, 3, and retaining ring, 4.

86
9. Check the relief valves for scratches in the seat
areas, 1. Also check for broken springs, 2. If
problems are found, the complete relief valve
must be replaced.

87
LS190 skid steers only - Inspect the splines, 1, of the
coupler for wear or damage. Remove the inside snap
ring, 2, and inspect for damage. Replace if necess-
ary. (The coupler is part #86566800 and the snap ring
is part #49894.)

19987697
88
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 49

LS190 skid steers only - Inspect the mating areas, 1,


of the spacer for chips or scores that could cause a 1
leak. Replace if necessary.

19987698

89
REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
IMPORTANT: Due to tight tolerances and finish of in-
ternal pump surfaces, it is very important to maintain
absolute cleanliness during reassembly.
2. Use clean SAE 10W-30 oil to lubricate all moving
parts as they are being reassembled. Fill the
transmission cases with oil through the case
drain hole after completing assembly of the com-
ponent.
IMPORTANT: Lubrication of the pump components
during assembly is required to ensure lubrication oil
for start-up.
3. Install the new O rings, seals, gaskets, and re-
taining rings provided with the repair kit.
4. If required and not done during inspection, install
new needle bearings in the pump housing and
backplate. Installation details are shown in the in-
spection area.
5. Install two new seal sub-assemblies, 1, into the
servo piston housing at 2.
6. Install the servo piston assembly, 3, into the right
hand side of the housing by inserting end, 4, first.
Roughly center the piston in the housing.

90
50 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

7. Install a new cover plate gasket, 1, over the end


of the servo piston bolt, 2, and screw on the cover
plate, 3. Align the gasket with the cover plate and
retain with four flat washers and socket head cap
screws, 4. Tighten all bolts to 4.5 - 5.4 N·m (40 -
48 in lbs.). Install seal washer, 5, washer, 6, and
jam nut, 7. Do not tighten at this time.

91
8. To obtain neutral, centering of the servo piston is
required.
a. Insert an allen wrench into the servo piston 12.7
bolt, 1, on the right hand side. mm
b. Measure in from the left hand side of the (0.5,)
housing, 2, and turn the servo piston bolt, 1,
either in or out to obtain a measurement from
the face of the housing to the servo piston of
12.7 mm (0.5″).
c. While holding the bolt steady, tighten jam nut,
3, to 17 - 18 N·m (150 - 160 in lbs.).

92
9. Install a new LH servo piston cover plate gasket,
1, and cover plate, 2. Align the gasket with the
cover plate and retain with four flat washers and
socket head cap screws, 3. Torque to 4.5 - 5.4
N·m (40 - 48 in lbs.).

93
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 51

10. Press the cradle assembly, 1, into the pump


housing making sure that the cradle and dowel
bushings are firmly seated. Apply Loctite 262 to
the threads of the cradle assembly retaining
bolts, 2, and torque to 34 - 38 N·m (25 - 28 ft.
lbs.).

94
11. Reassemble the pump drive shaft bearing as-
sembly by installing retaining ring, 1, in groove,
6. Next install thrust washer, 2; thrust bearing, 3;
and second thrust washer, 4. Secure assembly
with second retaining ring, 5, in groove, 7.

95
12. Install the shaft and bearing assembly, 1, into the
pump housing. Install washer, 2, and new shaft
seal, 3. Seat seal into position with a seal driver
and secure with retaining ring, 4.

96
52 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

13. Camplate
a. Reinstall the servo piston follower, 1, onto the
camplate aligning pin, 2.

97
b. Coat the cradle bushing, 1, previously in-
stalled with the cradle assembly in the pump
housing, with SAE 10W-30 oil.
c. Carefully align the servo piston follower with
the notch in the pump housing opening, 2,
and slide the camplate into the pump hous-
ing.
d. Make certain that the servo piston follower, 1,
Figure 97, on the camplate is aligned with the
large groove in the servo piston assembly, 3,
to ensure correct positioning of the camplate.

98
14. Check the three piston block loading pins, 1.
Make sure they are seated properly in the over-
size grooves in the splines and held in place by
the retaining ring, 2.

99
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 53

15. Reinstall the pistons and piston plate, 1, and


pivot, 2, into the piston block, 3, at the locations
they were removed. Check to be sure that the
pivot is resting on the loading pins, 4.

100
16. With the pump housing resting on its side, insert
the piston block assembly into the housing. Ro-
tate the piston block slowly to align the splines
and slide together.
NOTE: Check to be sure that the camplate is still
positioned correctly in the housing and that the piston
shoes contact the camplate before proceeding.
NOTE: If the rotating group assembly will not easily
slide over the splined shaft, DO NOT FORCE. One
or more of the three loading pins may be out of their
groove or the pin head is not seated properly be-
tween the washer and block. Forcing the rotating
group may cause pin failure and early transmission
failure.
IMPORTANT: Make sure all mating surfaces are well
lubricated with SAE 10W-30 motor oil to insure
proper lubrication for start-up.
17. Install new O rings on the relief valve assemblies,
1, and install the valves at their original positions
in the backplate at 2.
18. Install a new O ring on plug, 3; install plug, and
secure with retaining ring, 4.

101
54 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

19. Apply a small amount of petroleum jelly to the


steel side of the valve plate, 1, to hold it in place
during assembly. Align the small notch on the
outer edge of the valve plate with the backplate
indexing pin, 2, and install with the steel side to-
ward the backplate. The brass side of the valve
plate should be next to the piston block when as-
sembled.

102
20. Clamp the pump assembly in a protected jaw
vise at the pilot flange, 1, with the open end up.
Install a new gasket, 2, between the pump hous-
ing and backplate, and slide the backplate, 3,
down over the shaft. Make sure the ports are
positioned correctly and the gasket and valve
plate are aligned.

103
NOTE: With no gerotor pump, go to step 23.
21. Install the gerotor pump drive key and inner gero-
tor ring, 1, onto the pump shaft. Lubricate the
inner gerotor ring.
22. Install the charge pump adaptor assembly, 2,
onto the pump housing. Make sure the molded O
ring, 3, stays in place and that the inner and outer
gerotor rings, 1 and 4, are properly aligned.

104
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 55

23. Install cover plate, 3, new O ring, 2, and attaching


bolts, 1. Torque bolts to 37 - 42 N·m (27 -
31 ft lbs).
24. Retain the backplate and charge pump adaptor
(when used) with four cap screws. Torque to 37
- 42 N·m (27 - 31 ft. lbs.).

105
NOTE: When the backplate assembly, 1, is in place,
and prior to inserting bolts, a small gap (approx. 1/8,) 1
will be noticed between the pump housing gasket
and backplate at 2. This is normal. Tightening the
bolts brings the housing against the rotating group
spring, resulting in an internal spring load to the valve
plate and slippers. After torquing the retaining bolts,
the shaft should turn easily with a pair of 8, pliers. The 2
shaft should have some rolling resistance but should
not be tight (locked down) or rotate easily. If it is
locked down or rotates freely, the pump is assembled
incorrectly and requires teardown and reassembly.

106
25. Install the servo control assembly, 1, and new
servo control gasket, 2, onto the pump housing,
making sure the feedback link, 3, aligns with the
small groove in the servo piston.
NOTE: Make sure the tabs, 4, on both the servo con-
trol housing, 1, and gasket, 2, are aligned. Also note
the position of the gasket over the control ports, 5.
26. Retain the servo control assembly with six (6)
socket head cap screws. Torque to 5 - 8 N·m (4
- 6 ft lbs).
27. Install new O rings on all pump plugs. Install
plugs into pump housing. Torque to the following
specs:
3/4″ Plugs: 28 - 32 N·m (21 - 24 ft. lbs.) 107
1-1/4″ Plugs: 54 - 61 N·m (40 - 45 ft. lbs.)
56 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

28. Install key, 3, into slot in trunnion shaft, 2, and in-


stall control arm, 4, onto shaft. Secure with 5/16″
x 2″ cap screw and locknut, 1. Torque to 20 N·m
(15 ft. lbs.). Right side shown.

108
29. Install inner retaining ring, 3, drive gear, 2, and
outer retaining ring, 1, onto pump drive shaft, 4.
30. Install the pumps onto the engine bell housing at-
taching plate, using 1/2″ x 1-1/4″ cap screws and
washers. Torque to 87 N·m (64 ft. lbs.).

109
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 57

REINSTALLATION
1. Install a new O ring, 1, on the gear pump pilot, 2.
For SL65B skid steers, install the gear pump onto 1
the hydrostatic pump, mating the splines on the
input shaft. 2

19987701
110
58 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

2. Install new O rings on the hydrostatic pump pilot.


Support each pump assembly properly and
lower them into place. Install the upper pump
mounting bolts, 1, and the lower pump mounting
bolts, 2. Tighten all the mounting bolts to 101 N·m
(75 ft lbs).

116
3. Connect the charge pump suction line, 1, the
charge pressure cross tube, 2, the case drain 3 2 5
tube, 3, the charge pressure sender line, 4, and
1
the case drain tube, 5. 7
If equipped, connect the two-speed solenoid
valve supply line, 6, and the solenoid valve return 4
line, 7.

A5358-
12 117
4. Connect the rear control rods, 1 and 2, at the
pump control arms. 1
Connect the hydraulic suction hose, 3, the hy-
draulic high pressure hose, 4.
If equipped, connect the two-speed slave cylin-
der supply hose, 5. 4 5

2
A3649-
12 118
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 59

5. Connect the hydraulic lines, 1 through 4, refer-


ring to the identification marks made during re-
moval.

119
6. Lower the entire neutralizer assembly into place.
Reconnect the dampener shocks, 1, and neutral-
izer assemblies, 2.
Install the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, 3 and 4.

120
7. Make sure the return line, 1, is installed into the
tee, 2, connecting to the hydraulic reservoir.
Reinstall all shields and fittings removed during
hydrostatic pump removal.

121
60 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100 60

MOTORS
HYDROSTATIC MOTOR - SINGLE SPEED

REMOVAL
The hydrostatic motor assembly can be removed
from the top and front or the cab and boom can be
tilted forward for more access, refer to Section 00 for
the cab tilting procedure.
To remove the hydrostatic motor assembly without
tilting the cab forward:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key. 122
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake. 1
NOTE: Engaging the parking brake during removal
of the hydrostatic motors will hold the brake assem-
bly components (discs, pads, coupler) in place for
easier reassembly.

19984337
123
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 61

5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels


off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more in-
formation on properly supporting the skid steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.

124
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

125
7. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-
static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system to avoid serious injury.

126
62 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Unless the hydraulic system requires cleaning,


draining of the hydraulic oil reservoir is not re-
quired. Make sure the suction and return lines
are capped to prevent loss of oil.
9. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.

127
10. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting
the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.

128
11. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
12. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4. Lift the en-
tire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.

129
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 63

13. Remove the four neutralizer support bracket at-


taching bolts, 1, and remove the neutralizer sup-
port bracket, 2.

130
14. Clean the motors, 1, high-pressure hoses, 2, and
case drain tube, located under the motors, and
mark their positions to aid in reassembly.
15. Remove the high-pressure hoses, 2, and case 4
drain lines, 3, from the motor and cap to prevent
loss of oil. Plug the motor ports to prevent dirt
from entering the motor housing. 3
16. Unbolt and remove the motor from the gearbox
assembly, 4. Make sure the parking brake is en- 3
gaged. This will hold the brake components in
place for easier reassembly.
4

131
64 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100 66

DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for oil 2
leak repairs, other repairs, or overhaul of the motor
must include the model number of the motor and date
code. These are stamped into the mounting flange of
the motor housing at 1.
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the motor hous-
ing before disassembly. Plug the ports to prevent
dirt and solvent from entering the motor housing.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation- 1
19986361
ship between the motor housing and backplate
with a marker or scribe, 2. 132
3. As the motor is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench or heavy cardboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. Clamp the motor in a protected jaw vise at the
mounting flange. Remove the six cap screws, 1,
from the backplate assembly, 2, and lift the back-
plate straight up from the housing to prevent
damage to the shaft and bearings.
NOTE: The backplate assembly should pop up with
the removal of the six cap screws. If the plate does
not pop up, use a plastic mallet and tap on the back-
plate to remove.
IMPORTANT: The motor housing is aluminum and
can be easily damaged. Do not use sharp objects to
pry the backplate from the housing or damage to the
machined surfaces may occur.
133
5. Remove valve plate, 1, and O ring, 3, from the
backplate, 2. Note the position of the valve plate
for reassembly.

134
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 65

6. Hold the rotating piston block, 1, in one hand and


tilt the open end of the motor housing, 2, down.
Rotate the piston block and pull it out as a com-
plete unit without scratching or burring the parts.

135
7. The rotating group consists of the following parts:
a. Piston block, 1.
b. Spherical washer, 2 (spider pivot).
c. Piston assemblies, 3.
d. Piston plate, 4 (spider).
Carefully disassemble these parts and lay them
on cardboard to avoid damage.

136
8. Remove camplate, 1.

137
66 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

9. To remove the motor drive shaft, 1, from the


motor housing, remove retaining ring, 2, and tap
the opposite end of the shaft with a soft mallet.
The seal may be damaged during removal.

138
10. Remove shaft seal, 1, and washer, 2, from motor
shaft, 3. The motor shaft, thrust bearing assem-
bly, consists of two retaining rings, 4, two thrust
washers, 5, and thrust bearing, 6. Disassemble
these parts for inspection.

139
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 67

PARTS INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
IMPORTANT: Due to close tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is important to maintain ab-
solute cleanliness during inspection and reassembly
or damage to the components may occur.
Motor Housing
1. The shaft needle bearing, 1, in the motor housing
is a press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness. Check that all needles are in the cage
and move freely.
2. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
140
place the bearing.
Motor Shaft
1. Inspect the ares that contact the shaft needle
bearings, 1, for wear or a rough bearing surface.
2. Check for a bent or worn shaft.
3. Check the splined areas, 2, for wear or twist.
4. Inspect the thrust bearing, 3, bearing races, 4,
and retaining rings and grooves, 5. If bearing or
races show wear or roughness, they must be re-
placed.

141
5. Input seal, 1, and retaining ring, 2, will be re-
placed upon reassembly. Inspect washer, 3, for
wear and flatness.

142
68 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Camplate
1. Shoes of the motor pistons rotate at high speeds
against the camplate surface at, 1. The surface
must be smooth with no metal flaked away and
no scoring. Circular scratches centered on the
machined surface are due to contamination. If
scratches can be felt with your thumbnail, re-
place the camplate.
2. Check the camplate surface for smearing. The
surface must be smooth and bright with no disco-
loration or brass color on the flat surface.

143
Shoe and Piston Assemblies

Replace the rotating group if:


1. The piston skirt area, 1, shows signs of scratches
or wear.
2. The edges of the shoes, 2, are worn (shoe roll)
from contact with the camplate.
3. There is wear on the underside of the slipper, be-
tween the slipper and shoe plate at 3.
4. The shoes have a loose, sloppy fit on the ball end
of the piston at 4.
5. The flat surfaces of the shoes, 5, show metal flak-
ing or deeply scratched. Light or shallow
scratches in the shoes will not cause any harm. 144
Do not lap the shoes.
Piston Plate (Spider)
1. Check for cracks at the holes for the spherical
washer and shoes at 1. The shoe plate is only
available as part of the rotating group.
2. Check for wear in the area of the slippers, 2. This
area should be flat smooth and have no grooves.
3. Check the internal splines of the piston block, 3,
for wear.
Spherical Washer (Pivot), 4
1. Check for wear on the top surface where the pis-
ton plate fits. The spherical washer is only avail-
able as part of the rotating group.
2. Check the sides or rolled area for cracks. 145
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 69

Rotating Piston Block

Replace the rotating group if:


1. Cylinders, 1, are worn or scored so the pistons do
not move freely.
2. Surface, 2, is worn or grooved or shows metal
buildup. Nicks must not extend from the cylinders
to the edge of the raised area, 3.
3. The pistons have side play in the piston block.

146
Loading Pins
The three block loading pins, 1, are spring loaded
and are held in place by the pin keeper (split bush-
ing), 2.
1. The pins should be the same height.
2. The pins should be seated in the special grooves.
3. The head of the pins should be seated between
the washer and the block.

147
Replaceable Bearing (Valve) Plate
1. Check for flatness.
2. Check for scratches on the brass side of the
plate, extending outward across the area where
the raised area of the piston block contacts the
plate at 1. If scratches can be felt with your
thumbnail, replace the bearing plate.
3. Check for scratches between the kidney ports at
2.

148
70 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Backplate
1. Check the backplate for flatness, 1.
2. The backplate needle bearing assembly, 2, is a
press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness and wear. Check that all needles are
in the cage and move freely.
3. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
place the bearing.
4. Check the alignment pins to make sure they are
in place.

149
Shuttle Flow Valves
1. Remove the shuttle valves. Inspect the spool, 1,
seats, 2, and springs, 3, for damage.
IMPORTANT: Do not adjust the recirculate valve
screw assembly, 4.

3 2 1 2 3

19986350
150
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 71

REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
IMPORTANT: Due to tight tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is very important to main-
tain absolute cleanliness during reassembly.
2. Use a clean SAE 10W-30 oil to lubricate all mov-
ing parts as they are being reassembled.
3. Install the new O ring, seal and retaining rings in-
cluded with the repair kit.
4. Motor Housing
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the motor housing with the numbered end to-
ward the outside (flange end) of the housing.

151
b. Install the bearing with the numbered end, 1,
facing out towards the mounting flange end
of the motor housing, 2. Press into place and
to the dimension shown, 1.78 mm (0.07″).
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear-
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.
1.78
mm
(0.07,)

152
72 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

5. Reassemble the motor drive shaft, 1, by installing


a new retaining ring, 2; thrust washer, 3; thrust
bearing, 4; and second thrust washer, 5. Secure
with a second new retaining ring, 6.

153
6. Install the shaft and bearing assembly, 1, into the
motor housing. Install the washer and new shaft
seal, 2, into the housing and set in place with a
seal driver. Secure the shaft in place with a new
retaining ring, 3.

154
7. Install the camplate, 1, into the motor housing, 2,
in the direction indicated on the camplate.

155
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 73

8. Reinstall the pistons and piston plate, 1, and


spherical washer (pivot), 2, into the piston block,
3. Make sure the pivot is resting squarely on the
loading pins, 4.

156
9. Invert the motor housing, 2, and insert the rotat-
ing group assembly, 1, into the housing.
NOTE: Piston shoes must contact the camplate. Be
sure all parts are in their proper position before pro-
ceeding.
NOTE: If the rotating group assembly will not easily
slide over the splined shaft, DO NOT FORCE. One
or more of the three loading pins may be out of their
groove or the pin head is not seated properly be-
tween the washer and block. Forcing the rotating
group may cause pin failure and early transmission
failure.
IMPORTANT: Make sure all mating surfaces are well
lubricated with SAE 10W-30 motor oil to insure 157
proper lubrication for start-up.
10. Backplate
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the backplate. The bearing should be in-
stalled with the numbered end facing the
center of the motor assembly.

158
74 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

b. Press the bearing into the housing with the


numbered end, 1, facing the center of the
motor assembly and to the dimension
shown, 2.29 mm (.09″) above the face of the
backplate. The bearing is a pilot for the valve
plate during assembly.
2.29 4.39
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or mm mm
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear- (0.09,) (0.173,)
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.

159
11. Lubricate the valve plate, 1, and place the steel
side toward the backplate. Align one of the
notches on the outer edge of the valve plate with
alignment pin, 2. The brass side of the valve plate
should be next to the piston block when as-
sembled.
To assist in reassembly, place a small amount of
vaseline between the valve plate and the back
plate to hold the two pieces together.
12. Install a new O ring, 3, over the backplate flange
at 4.

160
13. Clamp the motor housing and rotating group in a
protected jaw vise and carefully install the back-
plate assembly onto the shaft. Match your align-
ment marks and dowel pin. Secure with six cap
screws and torque to 20 - 24 N·m (15 - 18 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: When the backplate assembly is in place and
prior to inserting bolts, a small gap (approx. 1/8,) will
be noticed between the motor housing and the back-
plate at 1. This is normal. Tightening the bolts brings
the housing against the rotating group spring, result-
ing in an internal spring load to the valve plate and
slippers. After torquing the retaining bolts, the shaft
should turn easily with a pair of 8, pliers. The shaft
should have some rolling resistance but should not
161
be tight (locked down) or rotate easily. If it is locked
down or rotates freely, the motor is assembled incor-
rectly and requires teardown and reassembly.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 75

REINSTALLATION
1. Clean the previously sealed surfaces between
the motor flange and gearbox at 1. 1 2
When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rust and corrosion to parts after
assembled.
2. Place a bead of New Holland Ultra-Blue silicone
sealer around the face of the motor housing.
3. Align the motor assembly splines with the 1 2
coupler splines in the gearbox, and slide the
motor shaft into the gearbox. Install two 1/2″ x
1-1/4″ cap screws and washers, 2, and torque to
101 N·m (75 ft. lbs.). A3549-
10 162
4. Reinstall motor fittings if removed.
5. Install the neutralizer support bracket, 1, and se-
cure with four attaching bolts, 2, two at each
gearbox.
6. Reinstall the case drain tube that runs beneath
the motor assemblies. The tube connects at the
front of the left motor at 3, and at the rear of the
right motor at 4. A hose assembly connects the
tee fitting at the rear of the right motor, 4, and the
inlet fitting of the gear pump.
7. Reconnect the high-pressure hydraulic hose, 5,
between the gear pump and the main control
valve.

163
8. Install the neutralizer assembly, 1, and secure
with four cap screws, 2; two at the front and two
at the rear.
9. Install the high-pressure hydrostatic hoses, 3,
from the pumps to the motors and tighten secure-
ly. When tightening fittings, first align hoses and
tubes for clearance and tighten to seat fittings,
then loosen and retorque.

164
76 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

10. Reinstall the hydrostatic control handle assem-


blies, 1, if removed.
11. Reconnect the neutralizer assemblies, 2, the
dampener shocks, 3, and control rods, 4.

165
12. For neutral adjustment, refer to the “Control Link-
age” section of this manual for the proper pro-
cedure and adjustments.
13. After a rebuild of any hydraulic or hydrostatic
component, refer to the “Start-Up Procedure”
section of this manual for the correct start-up pro-
cedure.
14. Put the Service/Run switch in the “SERVICE”
position.
15. Operate the unit and check for oil leaks and re-
pair if needed.
CAUTION
Securely support the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground, or movement of the skid steer may
cause serious injury or damage to the equipment.

16. Tilt the cab and boom back into position, if tilted
forward.
17. Reinstall the step shield, 1, fenders, etc., re-
moved for the repair.
18. Fill the hydraulic system (reservoir) with SAE
10W-30 oil.

166
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 77

HYDROSTATIC MOTOR - TWO-SPEED


Op. 29 100 60
REMOVAL
The hydrostatic motor assembly can be removed
from the top and front, or the cab and boom can be
tilted forward for more access. Refer to Section 00 for
the cab tilting procedure.
To remove the hydrostatic motor assembly without
tilting the cab forward:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key. 167
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake. 1
NOTE: Engaging the parking brake during removal
of the hydrostatic motors will hold the brake assem-
bly components (discs, pads, coupler) in place for
easier reassembly.

19984337
168
78 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels


off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more in-
formation on properly supporting the skid steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.

169
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

170
7. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-
static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system to avoid serious injury.

171
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 79

Unless the hydraulic system requires cleaning,


draining of the hydraulic oil reservoir is not re-
quired. Make sure the suction and return lines
are capped to prevent loss of oil.
9. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.

172
10. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting
the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.

173
11. Disconnect the dampener shocks at, 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at, 2.
12. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4. Lift the en-
tire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.

174
80 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

13. Clean the motors, 1, high-pressure hoses, 2, and


case drain tube, located under the motors, and
mark their positions to aid in reassembly.
14. Remove the high-pressure hoses, 2, from the
motor and cap to prevent loss of oil. Plug the
motor ports to prevent dirt from entering the
motor housing.
1
2

1
A3625-
14 175
15. Disconnect the hydraulic line from the two-speed
control valve, 1, to the rear of the slave cylinder, 1
2, and cap. 2
16. Disconnect the high pressure hydraulic hose, 3,
from the gear pump, 4, to the main control valve,
6
5, and cap.
17. Remove the slave cylinder, 2, and control link, 6.
Loosen and disconnect the control arm spring, 7, 4
at the rear control arm. 3

5
7
A3622-
4 176
18. Remove the front and rear control arms, 1 and 2.
These arms are attached to a tapered camplate
shaft and should be removed using a puller ar- 4
rangement as shown at 3.
NOTE: The holes, 4, in both motor cam plate arms
may be tapped and a cap screw used to remove
arms.

177
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 81

19. Remove the four neutralizer support bracket at-


taching bolts, 1, and remove the neutralizer sup-
port bracket, 2.

178
20. Remove the case drain hoses, 1, by loosening
the hose clamps, 2. 2
21. Unbolt and remove the motors from the gearbox
assembly. Make sure the parking brake is en-
gaged. This will hold the brake components in 1
place for easier reassembly.

1 2

A5358-
12 179
82 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100 66
DISASSEMBLY
1
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for oil
leak repairs, other repairs, or overhaul of the motor
must include the model number of the motor and date
code. These are stamped into the mounting flange of
the motor housing at 1.
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the motor hous-
ing before disassembly. Plug the ports to prevent
dirt and solvent from entering the motor housing.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation-
ship between the motor housing and backplate 19986349
with a marker or scribe.
180
3. As the motor is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench or heavy cardboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. Clamp the motor in a protected jaw vise at the
mounting flange, 1. Remove the four cap screws,
1
2, from the backplate assembly, 3, and lift the
backplate straight up from the housing to prevent
damage to the shaft and bearing.
NOTE: The backplate assembly should pop up with
the removal of the six cap screws. If the plate does
2
not pop up, use a plastic mallet and tap on the back-
plate to remove.
IMPORTANT: The motor housing is aluminum and 3
can be easily damaged. Do not use sharp objects to
pry the backplate from the housing or damage to the
machined surfaces may occur. 19986349
181
5. Remove the valve plate, 1, from backplate, 2.
Note the position of the valve plate for reassemb-
ly.
The valve plate may stick to the rotating group
when the backplate is removed.

182
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 83

6. Remove the gasket, 1, from the motor housing,


2. The gasket should be replaced during reas-
sembly.

183
7. Hold the rotating piston block, 1, in one hand and
tilt the open end of the motor housing, 2, down.
Rotate the piston block and pull it out as a com-
plete unit without scratching or burring the parts.

184
8. The rotating group consists of the following parts:
a. Piston block, 1.
b. Wave washer, 2.
c. Spherical washer, 3 (spider pivot).
d. Piston assemblies, 4.
e. Piston plate, 5 (spider).
Lift the rotating group parts out of the piston block
and carefully lay them on clean cardboard to
avoid damage. Mark the holes the pistons came
from with a soft marker (do not scratch the sur-
face) so they can be inspected and reassembled
in the same manner.
185
84 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

9. Remove the motor drive shaft, 1, from the motor


housing by removing retaining ring, 2, and tap-
ping the opposite end of the shaft with a soft
mallet. The seal may be damaged during re-
moval.

186
10. Remove the outer shaft seal, 1, and washer, 2,
from the motor drive shaft, 3.

187
11. The motor shaft, thrust bearing assembly, con-
sists of two retaining rings, 1, two thrust washers,
2, and a thrust bearing, 3. Disassemble these
parts for inspection.

188
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 85

12. Camplate
To remove the camplate from the motor housing:
a. Remove the two torx head screws, 1, seal
cover plate, 2, and gasket, 3, on the pintle
shaft side of the camplate.
b. Remove pintle shaft seal, 4, and washer, 5,
located behind the seal.

189
c. Remove the two torx head screws, 1, trun-
nion cover plate, 2, and gasket, 3, on the stub
shaft end of the camplate.
d. Remove the O ring cover, 4, and O ring, 5, lo-
cated behind the O ring cover.

190
e. Remove needle bearing, 1, and inner race, 2,
on the stub shaft end of the camplate, and
needle bearing, 3, on the pintle shaft end, by
sliding the camplate back and forth until the
bearings can be grasped. The bearings are
not a press fit and should be fairly easy to re-
move.
f. Remove the camplate, stub shaft end first.
NOTE: A bearing race is not used on the pintle shaft
end of the camplate.

191
86 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

PARTS INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
IMPORTANT: Due to close tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is important to maintain ab-
solute cleanliness during inspection and reassembly
or damage to the components may occur.
Motor Housing
1. The shaft needle bearing, 1, in the motor housing
is a press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness. Check that all needles are in the cage
and move freely.
2. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
place the bearing.

192
Camplate
1. Shoes of the motor pistons rotate at high speeds
against the camplate surface at 1. The surface
must be smooth with no metal flaked away and
no scoring. Circular scratches centered on the
machined surface are due to contamination. If
scratches can be felt with your thumbnail, re-
place the camplate.
2. Check the camplate surface for smearing. The
surface must be smooth and bright with no disco-
loration or brass color on the flat surfaces.
3. Inspect the areas that contact the camplate
needle bearings, 2, for wear or a rough bearing
surface. 193
4. Inspect the camplate bearings for loose or mis-
sing needles in the bearing housing. Replace if
necessary.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 87

Motor Shaft
1. Inspect the areas that contact the shaft needle
bearings, 1, for wear or a rough bearing surface.
2. Check for a bent or worn shaft.
3. Check the splined areas, 2, for wear or twist.
4. Inspect the thrust bearing, 3, bearing races, 4,
and retaining rings and grooves, 5. If the bear-
ings or races show wear or roughness, they must
be replaced.

5. The seal, 1, and retaining ring, 2, will be replaced


upon reassembly. Inspect washer, 3, for wear
and flatness.

194
Shoe and Piston Assemblies

Replace the rotating group if:


1. The piston skirt area, 1, shows signs of scratches
or wear.
2. The edges of the shoes, 2, are worn (shoe roll)
from contact with the camplate.
3. There is wear on the underside of the slipper, be-
tween the slipper and shoe plate at 3.
4. The shoes have a loose, sloppy fit on the ball end
of the piston at 4.
5. The flat surfaces of the shoes, 5, show metal flak-
ing or deeply scratched. Light or shallow
scratches in the shoes will not cause any harm. 195
Do not lap the shoes.
88 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Piston Plate (Spider)


1. Check for cracks at the holes for the spherical
washers and shoes at 1. The piston plate is only
available as part of the rotating group.
2. Check for wear in the area of the slippers, 2. This
area should be flat smooth and have no grooves.
3. Check the internal splines of the piston block, 3,
for wear.
Spherical Washer (Pivot), 4
1. Check for wear on the top surface where the pis-
ton plate fits. The spherical washer is only avail-
able as part of the rotating group.
2. Check the sides or rolled area for cracks. 196
Rotating Piston Block
Replace the rotating group if:
1. Cylinders, 1, are worn or scored so the pistons do
not move freely.
2. Surface, 2, is worn or grooved or shows metal
build-up. Nicks must not extend from the cylin-
ders to the edge of the raised area, 3.
3. The pistons have side play in the piston block.

197
Loading Pins
The three block loading pins, 1, are spring loaded
and are held in place by the pin keeper (split bush-
ing), 2.
1. The pins should be the same height.
2. The pins should be seated in the special grooves.
3. The head of the pins should be seated between
the washer and the block.
Wave Washer
Inspect the wave washer, 3, for bent or broken tabs.

198
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 89

Replaceable Bearing (Valve) Plate


1. Check for flatness.
2. Check for scratches on the brass side of the
plate, extending across the area where the piston
block contacts the plate at 1. If scratches can be
felt with your thumbnail, replace the bearing
plate.
3. Check for scratches across the kidney ports at 2.

199
Backplate
1. Check the backplate for flatness, 1.
2. The backplate needle bearing assembly, 2, is a
press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness and wear. Check that all needles are
in the cage and move freely.
3. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
place the bearing.
4. Check the alignment pin, 3, to make sure it is in
place.

200
Shuttle Flow Valves
1. Remove the shuttle valves. Inspect the spool, 1,
seats, 2, and springs, 3, for damage.
4
IMPORTANT: Do not adjust the recirculate valve
screw assembly, 4. 3

3
2

2 1
19986362

201
90 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
IMPORTANT: Due to tight tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is very important to main-
tain absolute cleanliness during reassembly.
2. Use a clean SAE 10W-30 oil to lubricate all mov-
ing parts as they are being reassembled.
3. Install the new O ring, seals, gasket and retaining
rings included with the repair kit.
4. Motor Housing
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the motor housing with the numbered end to-
ward the outside (flange end) of the housing.

202
b. Install the bearing with the numbered end, 1,
facing out towards the mounting flange end
of the motor housing, 2. Press into place and
to the dimension shown, 1.78 mm (0.07″).
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear-
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.
1.78
mm
(0.07,)

203
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 91

5. Camplate
a. Reinstall camplate, 1, into the motor housing.
Make certain that the camplate pintle shaft is
on the correct side.
b. The figure shows the camplate and all the
parts used, in the order they should be reas-
sembled.

204
c. Install the inner bearing race, 2, and shaft
needle bearing, 1, on the stub shaft end of
the camplate.
d. Install the shaft needle bearing, 3, on the
pintle shaft end of the camplate.

205
e. Install a new camplate shaft O ring, 1, and O
ring cover, 2, on the stub shaft end of the
camplate at 3.

206
92 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

f. Install gasket, 1, and trunnion cover plate, 2.


Secure with two torx head screws, 3, on the
stub shaft end of the camplate. Torque the
screws to 4 - 5 N·m (36 - 48 in lbs.).

207
g. Install flat washer, 1, new pintle shaft seal, 2,
gasket, 3, and seal cover plate, 4. Secure
with two torx head screws, 5, on the pintle
shaft end of the camplate. Torque the screws
to 4 - 5 N·m (36 - 48 in. lbs).

208
6. Reassemble the motor drive shaft, 1, by installing
a new retaining ring, 2; thrust washer, 3; thrust
bearing, 4; and second thrust washer, 5. Secure
with a second new retaining ring, 6.

209
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 93

7. Install the shaft and bearing assembly, 1, into the


motor housing. Install washer, 2, and a new
motor shaft seal, 3 into the housing and set in
place with a seal driver. Secure the shaft in place
with a new retaining ring, 4.

210
8. Reassemble the rotating group by installing the
wave washer, 1, over the loading pins. Install the
spherical pivot washer, 2, and insert the piston
assembly, 3, into the piston block, 4. The pistons
should be reinstalled into the same piston block
cylinders as they were removed.

211
9. Invert the motor housing, 2, and insert the rotat-
ing group assembly, 1, into the housing.
NOTE: Piston shoes must contact the camplate. Be
sure all parts are in their proper position before pro-
ceeding.
NOTE: If the rotating group assembly will not easily
slide over the splined shaft, DO NOT FORCE. One
or more of the three loading pins may be out of their
groove or the pin head is not seated properly be-
tween the washer and block. Forcing the rotating
group may cause pin failure and early transmission
failure.
IMPORTANT: Make sure all mating surfaces are well
lubricated with SAE 10W-30 motor oil to insure 212
proper lubrication for start-up.
94 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

10. Backplate
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the backplate. The bearing should be in-
stalled with the numbered end facing the
center of the motor assembly.

213
b. Press the bearing into the housing with the
numbered end, 1, facing the center of the
motor assembly and to the dimension
shown, 2.29 mm (0.09″) above the face of the
backplate. The bearing is a pilot for the valve
plate during reassembly.
2.29 4.39
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or mm mm
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear- (0.09,) (0.173,)
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.

214
11. Lubricate the valve plate, 1, and place the steel
side toward the backplate. Align one of the
notches on the outer edge of the valve plate with
alignment pin, 2. The brass side of the valve plate
should be next to the piston block when as-
sembled.
To assist in reassembly, place a small amount of
vaseline between the valve plate and the back-
plate to hold the pieces together.

215
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 95

12. Install a new gasket, 1, onto the motor housing,


2.

216
13. Clamp the motor housing and rotating group, 1,
in a protected jaw vise and carefully install the
backplate assembly, 2, onto the shaft. Match
your alignment marks and dowel pins. Secure
with four cap screws, 3, and torque to 37 - 42 N·m
(27 - 31 ft. lbs.).

217
NOTE: When the backplate assembly is in place and
prior to inserting bolts, a small gap (approx. 1/8,) will
be noticed between the motor housing and the back-
plate at 1. This is normal. Tightening the bolts brings
the housing against the rotating group spring, result-
ing in an internal spring load to the valve plate and
slippers. After torquing the retaining bolts, the shaft
should turn easily with a pair of 8, pliers. The shaft
should have some rolling resistance but should not
be tight (locked down) or rotate easily. If it is locked
down or rotates freely, the motor is assembled incor-
rectly and requires teardown and reassembly.

218
96 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

REINSTALLATION
1. Clean the previously sealed surfaces between
the motor flange and gearbox.
When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rust and corrosion to parts after
assembled.
2. Place a bead of New Holland Ultra-Blue silicone
sealer around the face of the motor housing at 1.
3. Align the motor assembly splines with the
coupler splines in the gearbox, and slide the
motor shaft into the gearbox. Install two 1/2″ x
1-1/4″ cap screws and washers, torque to
101 N·m (75 ft. lbs.).
219
4. Reinstall motor fittings if removed.
5. Install the case drain hoses, 1, and tighten the
hose clamps, 2, securely. 2

1 2

A5358-
12 220
6. Install the neutralizer support bracket, 1, and se-
cure with four attaching bolts, 2, two at each
gearbox.
7. Install the front and rear control arms, 3 and 4,
onto the tapered camplate pintle shafts. The
short arm on the right motor, long arm on the left
motor.

221
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 97

8. Install spring, 1, as shown, and adjust the draw-


bolt to obtain a spring length of 109 mm (4.3″).
Secure with jam nuts at 2.
9. Install control link, 3, but do not tighten the hard-
ware.
10. Make sure both the front and rear control arms
are rotated clockwise and held firmly against the
109 mm
internal motor stops by spring, 1.
(4.3,)
11. With the arms in this position, tighten the control
link hardware at 4.

222
12. Reinstall the slave cylinder, 1. Connect the sup-
ply hose, 2, from the two-speed control valve to 2
the rear of the cylinder.
6
13. Reconnect the high-pressure hydraulic hose, 3,
between the gear pump, 4, and the main control
valve, 5.
14. Reinstall the case drain tube that runs beneath 1
the motor assemblies. The tube connects at the 4
front of the left motor and at the rear of the right 3
motor. A hose assembly runs from the tee fitting
at the rear of the right motor to the inlet fitting of 5
the hydraulic gear pump at 6.
A3622-
4 223
15. Install the neutralizer assembly, 1, and secure
with four cap screws, 2; two at the front and two
at the rear.
16. Install the high-pressure hydrostatic hoses, 3,
from the pumps to the motors and tighten secure-
ly. When tightening fittings, first align hoses and
tubes for clearance and tighten to seat fittings,
then loosen and retorque.

224
98 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

17. Reinstall the hydrostatic control handle assem-


blies, if removed.
18. Reconnect the neutralizer assemblies, 1, the
dampener shocks, 2, and control rods, 3.
19. For neutral adjustment, refer to the “Control Link-
age” section of this manual for the proper pro-
cedure and adjustments.
20. After a rebuild of any hydraulic or hydrostatic
component, refer to the “Start-Up Procedure”
section of this manual for the correct start-up pro-
cedure.
21. Put the Service/Run switch in the “SERVICE”
position.
225
22. Operate the unit and check for oil leaks and re-
pair if needed.
CAUTION
Securely support the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground, or movement of the skid steer may
cause serious injury or damage to the equipment.

23. Tilt the cab and boom back into position, if tilted
forward.
24. Reinstall the step shield, 1, fenders, etc., re-
moved for the repair.
25. Fill the hydraulic system (reservoir) with SAE
10W-30 oil.

226
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 99

Op. 29 134

TWO-SPEED HIGH/LOW RANGE


COMPONENTS
The Two-Speed, high/low range system consists of
five main components:
1. Two-Speed Drive Motors - Refer to “Hydrostatic
Motor” Section.
2. Two-Speed Control Valve.
3. Two-Speed Slave Cylinder.
4. Two-Speed Motor Control Linkage.
5. Two-Speed Control Switch (on handle).
This feature gives the operator a wider range of travel
speeds, low range for normal operations, and high
range for travel between job sites.

227
The Two-Speed control switch is located in the
handle of the right-hand hydrostatic control. The
switch, 1, is thumb operated and protected by the
handle assembly.

228
100 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Two-Speed Transmission Motor Shifting and


Adjustment
• Transmission motors may not immediately shift
to low range from high range when the electric
switch is activated. Eye bolt, 4, may be broken.
• The machine may not run straight with handles
in full forward or full reverse.
The two-speed transmission motors shift from low
range to high range, using a single-acting hydraulic
cylinder. When the switch is actuated to return to low 9
range, spring, 1, pulls both transmission arms, right 7
drive, 2, and left drive, 3, to low. Eye bolt, 4, may be
broken and results in spring, 1, becoming discon- 5
nected. Eye bolt, 4, was 5/16″ (part #9615127). 3
A 3/8″ eye bolt (part #86526562) is now in produc-
tion. The arm, 2, eye bolt mounting hole will have to
be enlarged to accept the larger 3/8″ bolt.
Additionally, a standard 3/8″ nut, 6, is used on the
spring side of the eye bolt, and two 3/8″ nuts, 7, are 2
used as jam nuts. 6
4 1
If the machine will not travel straight in forward or re-
verse, with levers adjusted at the steering lever stops
beside the seat, the two-speed linkage should be in-
spected. Check that the arms, 2 and 3, are secured
tightly to the motor shaft, and a key, 8 , in place on
each tapered shaft. 8
The following adjustment procedure should be used
to adjust the two-speed linkage between the two final
drive motors:
1. Install arms, 2 and 3, to the pintle shafts of the hy-
draulic motors, using square keys and Grade 8,
fine-thread bolts.
2. Install spring, 1, between the welded rivet on
arm, 3, and the eye bolt, 2. Adjust the eye bolt to
obtain the spring length of 109 mm (4.3″) as
shown. Secure the eye bolt with jam nuts. 229
3. Loosely install connecting arm, 8, between arms,
2 and 3, mounted on the motors.
4. Make sure both arms are rotated clockwise and
are held firmly against the internal motor stops by
the spring.
5. With the arms in this location, tighten hardware
on both ends of link, 9.
The square slot dimensioned 13.0 mm x 19.5 mm
(0.51″ x 0.77″) in the end of arm, 2, has been in all
production parts. A change was made to arm, 3. The
square hole was changed to a 13.0 mm x 19.5 mm
(0.51″ x 0.77″) slot and the orientation of the hub was
changed by one degree. There were no part number
changes made.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 101

Op. 29 134 20

TWO-SPEED HIGH/LOW CONTROL VALVE


Before adjustments or repairs can be made to the
skid steer, two-speed high/low system components,
do the following:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key. 230
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake. 1

19984337

231
5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

232
102 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

6. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-


static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.

233
REMOVAL
1. The control valve, 1, is mounted to the left chain
case along the inside edge next to the hydrostatic
pumps.

234
2. To remove the control valve, disconnect the elec-
trical connection, 1. Wires from the harness are
light blue and black (Lt Blu/Blk).
3. Disconnect the hydraulic supply line to the valve
at 2, the hydraulic supply line to the slave cylinder
at 4, and the return line to the hydraulic gear
pump at 5. Cap all hoses and fittings to prevent
dirt from entering the system.
4. Remove the two attaching bolts, 3, and remove
the valve.

235
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 103

Op. 29 134 24

DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the control valve
assembly prior to disassembly. Plug all ports to
prevent solvent from entering the valve.
2. Remove retainer, 1; top O ring, 2; coil assembly,
3; bottom O ring, 4; and cartridge assembly, 5,
from control valve body, 6.
3. Remove O ring, 7, from cartridge assembly, 5.
4. If there are no noticeable leaks around the hy-
draulic fittings, do not remove.
236
INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
1. Inspect the cartridge assembly O rings and seals
at 1, 2, and 3. O ring, 1, is part of the seal kit, and
will be replaced during reassembly.
2. Inspect O rings 2 and 3, they should not be
broken or nicked. These must seal properly for
the valve to operate correctly. Replace if necess-
ary.

237
3. Using a VOM, check continuity across the coil
leads at 1. There must be continuity. Also check
the resistance. A reading of 7.2 ohms, plus or
minus .2 ohms, indicates a good coil.
4. Apply 12 volts to the coil leads, 1. Maximum am-
perage draw should be 1.5 - 2.0 Amps.
5. Replace if necessary.
6. The upper and lower waterproofing O rings, 2
and 3, should be replaced during reassembly.

238
104 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

7. Assemble the coil onto the cartridge assembly


and apply 12 volts to the coil leads, 1. A clicking
sound should be heard and movement of the
plunger in the cartridge noticed at 2.
8. If no sounds are heard or no movement noticed,
replace the cartridge assembly.

239
9. Inspect all ports, 1, in the valve body for dirt or de-
bris.
10. Inspect the cartridge port, 2, for scratches or
damage.
11. Replace parts as needed.

240
REASSEMBLY
Be sure all parts are clean and air-dried before reas-
sembly.
1. Install a new O ring, 1, on the valve cartridge, 2.
Coat the lower portion of the cartridge with
10W-30 oil and screw into the valve body, 3.
Torque to 22 - 27 N·m (16 - 20 ft. lbs.).

241
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 105

2. Install a new lower O ring, 1, coil assembly, 2,


new upper O ring, 3, and retainer nut, 4. Torque
nut to 5 - 7 N·m (4 - 5 ft. lbs.).

242
CONTROL VALVE REINSTALLATION
1. Position valve on mounting bracket as shown
along the inside of the left chain case. Secure
with two attaching bolts, 1.
2. Reconnect the hydraulic supply line, 2, the sup-
ply line to the slave cylinder, 3, and the return line
to the hydraulic gear pump, 4.
3. Reconnect the coil wires, 5, to the main wiring
harness.

243
4. Reinstall the hydrostatic control handle assem-
blies, 2 and 3, if removed, and the step shield, 1.
5. Return the operator’s seat to its correct position.

244
106 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 134 30

TWO-SPEED HIGH/LOW SLAVE CYLINDER


Before adjustments or repairs can be made to the
skid steer, two-speed high/low system components,
do the following:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key. 245
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake.
1

19984337
246
5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

247
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 107

6. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-


static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.

248
REMOVAL
1. The two-speed slave cylinder, 1, is located direct-
ly above the right hydrostatic motor.
2. Remove control rod attaching bolt, 2, and control
link pivot bolt, 3. Rotate the control link, 4, back
out of the way.
3. Disconnect the supply line to the slave cylinder,
5, and cap the ends.
4. Remove cap screws, 6, at rear of cylinder, and,
7, on the cylinder rod end. Note the position of the
washers and spacers as they are removed. Re-
move cylinder.
IMPORTANT: Do not remove cylinder retaining hard-
249
ware until all pressure is released from the cylinder.
Op. 29 134 34

DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove piston rod, 1.
2. Remove rod seals, 2 and 3.

250
108 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
1. Inspect piston rod, 1, for wear, scratches and
nicks that could damage or cut the seals during
reassembly.
2. Inspect the cylinder bore, 4, for damage or wear.
3. Inspect the seals, 2 and 3, for wear or damage.
Replace seals if necessary.
4. If leakage is noticed at the inlet fitting, 5, remove
and inspect O ring, 6, for damage. Replace if
necessary.
251
REASSEMBLY
Be sure all parts are clean and air-dried before reas-
sembly.
1. Install new seals, 2 and 3, if needed.
2. Apply clean 10W-30 oil to all contact surfaces of
the piston rod, cylinder, and seals.
3. Insert the piston rod, 1, into the cylinder, 4, mak-
ing sure not to damage the seals.
4. Install a new O ring, 5, on hydraulic fitting, 6. In-
stall fitting.

252
SLAVE CYLINDER REINSTALLATION
1. Align the cylinder, 1, in the mounting bracket and
install the washers, spacers, and attaching bolts,
6 and 7, in the order they were removed.
2. Reconnect the hydraulic supply line, 5, to the cyl-
inder.
3. Realign the control link, 4, and install the control
link pivot bolt, 3, and control rod attaching bolt, 2.
4. Reinstall the hydrostatic control handle assem-
blies, if removed. Replace the step shield.
5. Return the operator’s seat to its correct position.

253
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 109

Op. 29 134 40

TWO-SPEED HIGH/LOW MOTOR


CONTROL LINKAGE
Before adjustments or repairs can be made to the
skid steer, two-speed high/low system components,
do the following:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key. 254
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake. 1

19984337

255
5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Support at the front, 1, and rear,
2, of the final drive cases.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.

1 2

256
110 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.

257
7. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-
static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.

258
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
2. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4. Lift the en-
tire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.

259
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 111

3. Remove the cylinder rod bolt at 1.


4. Undo the bolts at 2, and remove the control link,
3.
5. Loosen the drawbolt, 4, and remove the spring,
5.

260
6. Remove the front and rear control arms, 1 and 2.
These arms are attached to a tapered camplate
shaft and should be removed using a puller ar- 4
rangement as shown at 3.
NOTE: The holes, 4, in both motor cam plate arms
may be tapped and a cap screw used to remove
arms.

261
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the rear control arm shaft hub, 1, for wear
on the taper and keyway. Check the spring at-
taching pin, 2, for wear, and inspect the bolt hole
at 3, to make sure it’s not worn or enlarged.
2. Inspect the front control arm shaft hub, 4, for
wear on the taper and keyway. Check for worn or
enlarged bolt holes at the control link attaching
point, 5, and the cylinder attaching point, 6.
3. Inspect the spring, 7, for stretch and for wear at
the end hooks.

262
112 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

4. Inspect the bushings, 1, in the control link, 2. If


the bushings are worn, loose, or damaged, re-
place the control link.
5. 5. Check for worn or damaged hardware.

263
CONTROL LINKAGE REINSTALLATION
1. Install the front and rear control arms, 1 and 2, to
the tapered camplate pintle shafts. The short arm
on the right motor, long arm on the left motor.
2. Install spring, 3, as shown, and adjust the draw-
bolt to obtain a spring length of 109 mm (4.3″).
Secure with jam nuts at 4.
109 mm
(4.3,)

264
3. Install control link, 1, but do not tighten the hard-
ware. 3
4. Make sure both the front and rear control arms
are rotated clockwise and held firmly against the
internal motor stops by spring, 2. 2
5. With the arms in this position, tighten the control 4
link hardware, 3.
6. Install cylinder rod bolt, 4.

265
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 113

7. Reinstall the neutralizer assembly, 1, by instal-


ling the four neutralizer assembly attaching bolts,
two at front, 2, and two at rear, 3.
8. If removed, reinstall the hydrostatic control
handle assemblies.
9. Connect the neutralizer assembly to the control
handles at 4, and the dampener shocks at 5.

266
TWO-SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
The two-speed control switch, 1, located in the right
hydrostatic control handle, supplies power to the
two-speed control valve when the switch is shifted to
the high speed position.
Wiring from the harness is dark green/red and light
blue (DK GN/R, LT BL). A white and black (W, B) wire
run from the switch to the harness connector.
To check the switch, use a VOM to check continuity
at the white and black wires. There should only be
continuity with the switch in the high speed position.
Replace the switch if necessary.
With the skid steer still securely blocked with all four
267
wheels off the ground, start the engine and operate
the control switch. Check for correct operation of the
valve, cylinder and control linkage.
Install the step shield and return the operator’s seat
to its correct position.
114 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

HYDRAULIC SYSTEM CLEANING


PROCEDURE

After A Hydraulic System Or Transmission


Overhaul
The hydraulic/hydrostatic system must be cleaned if
contamination caused a problem and the trans-
missions show wear on the pistons and shoes, rotat-
ing piston blocks, valve plate or cam plate.
IMPORTANT: Do not use the gear pump and gerotor
charge pump to flush the system with solvent. The
solvent will not provide enough lubrication to protect
moving parts inside the transmissions or gear pump.

1. Drain all remaining oil from the hydraulic system.


2. Remove the fill breather cap, 1, and screen, 2, by
removing the six retaining screws from the reser-
voir fill neck. Thoroughly clean the screen, the
area around the screen, and the fill breather cap
in solvent.

268
3. Drain and flush the hydraulic oil reservoir.
a. Remove the small access door, 1, at the front
right corner of the belly pan by removing the
two rear bolts, 2, loosening the front two
bolts, 3, and sliding the door rearward.

269
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 115

b. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnect-


ing the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the
oil into a suitable container.
c. Thoroughly flush the reservoir with a suitable
clean solvent or clean, SAE 10W-30 oil.

270
4. Thoroughly flush the oil cooler with solvent by
forcing the solvent through the cooler.
5. Remove the oil filter and base, clean the base, 1,
and check the bypass valve, 2, for operation.
6. Clean and flush all hydraulic lines. If the failure
was hydrostatic, be sure to flush and clean the
high pressure hoses from the pumps to the mo-
tors.

271
7. After the system is cleaned, thoroughly flush out
the solvent used to clean the system with fresh,
clean SAE 10W-30 oil.
8. Reconnect all lines removed for cleaning.
9. Install a new oil filter, 1.
10. Before start-up, fill the hydraulic system, pumps,
motors, etc., as full as the case drain lines permit
with SAE 10W-30 oil.

272
116 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

11. Fill the hydraulic oil reservoir with clean SAE


10W-30 oil. Check the oil level at 1.

273
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 117

START-UP PROCEDURE AFTER REBUILD


(AFTER PUMP OR MOTOR
REPLACEMENT)
After replacement or repair of a hydrostatic pump or
motor, and prior to start-up, the “Hydraulic System
Cleaning Procedure” should be performed. This will
clean the system of contaminants or water that may
have entered the system during repair.
1. Check all hydraulic/hydrostatic lines to be sure
they are tight.
2. Fill the hydraulic reservoir with SAE 10W-30 oil
the proper level, as indicated on the back of the
reservoir.
3. Install a 0 - 50 bar (600 psi) gauge in the charge
pressure line at 1.

274
4. Remove the fuel solenoid power wire, 1, from the
fuel solenoid, 2, to prevent the engine from start-
ing.
5. Put the steering control levers in the neutral posi-
tion and set the parking brake.

275
118 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

6. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”


position.
7. Turn the ignition key, 2, to the start position, and
allow the engine to crank for 30 seconds at a
time, until the pressure gauge starts to move. If
the gauge does not move after trying three times, 2
loosen the gear pump pressure line at the control
valve to bleed the air from the hydraulic system.
Re-crank the engine until the gauge moves. After 1
the gauge moves, stop cranking and reconnect
the fuel solenoid wire.
CAUTION 19997741
Do not crank the starter for more than 30 seconds or
damage to the starter may occur. Crank the starter 276
for 30 seconds and cool 1 minute.

8. Start the engine and monitor the charge pressure


gauge to ensure charge oil to the hydrostatic sys-
tem. The pressure reading should be 17.2 - 20.7
bar (250 - 300 PSI).
IMPORTANT: If charge pressure remains below 3.4
bar (50 PSI) for more than 10 seconds, stop the en-
gine and locate the cause. If the unit is operated with
low or no charge pressure, severe damage will occur
to the hydrostatic system.
Do not stroke the hydrostatic controls or operate
the boom and bucket controls at this time.
9. Start the engine and operate at 1500 RPM for ap-
proximately 30 minutes. Stop the engine; check
the oil level at 1, and fill as required.

277
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 119

10. Restart the engine and operate at 1500 RPM.


Slowly operate the hydrostatic controls to re-
move air trapped in the system; monitor the
charge pressure. Operate the boom and bucket
controls several times to remove air from the hy-
draulic system.
11. Stop the engine and recheck the hydraulic oil
level and add as required.
12. Remove the charge pressure test gauge.

278
13. Adjust the neutral control linkage if required; refer
to neutral adjustment procedures in this manual.
14. Run the engine at 1500 RPM for an additional 30
minutes to filter the oil. Stop the engine and
change the oil filter, 1.
15. Check for oil leaks and repair as required.
16. Reinstall all shields removed for repair.
17. Lower the skid steer to the ground and operate.

279
120 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 100

STEERING SYSTEM
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM CONTROLS
Before any control linkage adjustments or repairs are
made to the skid steer, do the following:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion, resting on the ground, or remove any attach-
ment and raise the boom and rest on the boom
lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.

2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run


position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key. 280
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
4. Engage the parking brake. 1

19984337

281
5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Support at the front, 1, and rear,
2, of the final drive cases.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.

1 2

282
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 121

6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

7. Remove the step shield, 2, to access the control


linkages, 1.

283
122 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

NEUTRALIZER ASSEMBLY
Op. 29 130 10
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
2. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4.
3. Lift the entire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one
piece.

284
DISASSEMBLY
1. Unbolt the dampener shocks, 1, at the mounting
tabs, 2, and remove.
2. Loosen the jam nuts, 3, on the neutralizer rod, 4,
and unscrew ball joint end, 5.
3. Remove the three jam nuts at 3, the washer at 6,
and remove the neutralizer rod, 4.
4. Repeat these steps for both rods.

285
5. Remove the neutralizer spring assembly, 1, by
first removing the two lube fitting cap screws, 2.
CAUTION
Spring is under tension. Use extreme care when re-
moving.

286
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 123

6. Carefully remove the neutralizer spring, 1, the


spring guides, 2, and shaft, 3.
7. Remove the four neutralizer rod bushings, 4, and
set with the rod assemblies for inspection.

287
INSPECTION
Thoroughly clean all parts before inspection.
1. Inspect the dampener shocks for equal pressur-
es for both extending and retracting. Check for
leakage around the rod seals at 1.
2. Check for a bent piston rod, 2, and for any bind-
ing.
3. Check the rubber bushing, 3, for wear and dam-
age.
4. Replace dampener shock if worn or damaged.
5. Check the ball joint end, 4, for looseness and
OPS85263
wear. Replace if worn.
288
6. The neutralizer rod assembly consists of the fol-
lowing parts:
a. Neutralizer rod, 1.
b. Flat washers, 2.
c. Nylatron bushings, 3.
d. Jam nuts, 4.
e. Ball joint end, 5.

289
124 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

7. Inspect the rod, 1, for wear and bending that may


cause binding in the neutralizer assembly.
8. Check the bushings, 2, for wear on the internal
bore. Also check the fit in the mounting bracket.
Inspect for cracks or breaks.
9. Inspect the ball joint end, 3, for looseness and
wear in the ball area, 4.
10. Replace parts that are worn or damaged.

290
11. Inspect the neutralizer spring, 1, for wear or a
permanent spring set. Free length of the spring
is 200.7 mm ± 4.6 mm (7.9″ ± 0.18″).
12. Inspect the spring guides, 2, for wear on both the
inner and outer surfaces of the tube and at the
guide holes for the neutralizer rods.
13. Inspect the shaft, 3, for wear or bending. Look for
scratches or wear that may indicate lack of lu-
brication.
14. Check the lube fitting cap screws, 4, for blockage
that would prevent proper lubrication.
15. Replace all parts that are worn or damaged.

291
16. Inspect the bushing and guide holes, 1, on both
sides of the mounting bracket, 2, for wear. Re-
place bracket if worn.

292
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 125

REASSEMBLY
1. Insert the four neutralizer rod bushings, 1, into
the mounting bracket, 2, with the shoulder to the
inside.
2. Apply grease to the inner bore of the spring
guides, 3, and to the ends of the shaft, 4.
3. Insert shaft, 4, into one of the spring guides, 3,
and slide spring, 5, over this assembly. Assemble
the second spring guide into the open end of the
spring and align with the shaft.

293
4. Insert the neutralizer spring assembly, 1, into the
mounting bracket and resting against the rod
bushings at 2. Be careful not to break the bush-
ings when installing the spring assembly.
NOTE: The spring assembly must be pried into place
and will be under tension. Be cautious until the retain-
ing bolts and rods are in place.
5. Install a flat washer and lube fitting cap screws,
3, at both ends and tighten.

294
6. Install flat washer, 1, onto the neutralizer rod, 2,
and insert the rod through the bushings, 3, and
spring guides, 4.
7. Install a second flat washer and two jam nuts at
5. Tighten the inner jam nut finger tight. There
should be no free play between the rod and bush-
ing at 6, or between the bushing and mounting
bracket at 7. Tighten the outer jam nut against the
inner jam nut.
NOTE: If the jam nuts on the rods are turned in too
far or not far enough, free play will result.
8. Repeat these steps for both neutralizer rods.

295
126 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

9. Install the third jam nut, 1, and ball joint end, 2, on


both neutralizer rods. Do not tighten the jam nut
at this time. The location of the ball joint end de-
termines the position of the hydrostatic control
handles.
10. Reinstall the dampener shocks, 3, at the mount-
ing tabs, 4.

296
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 127

Op. 29 130 30

CONTROL LINKAGE
REMOVAL
The neutralizer assembly is removed for clarity.
1. The control linkage consists of three main com-
ponents:
a. Front control rod, 1.
b. Control link (pivot), 2.
c. Rear control rod, 3.
The right side control linkage is shown; the left
side control linkage is the same except for control
rod lengths.
Repeat each step for the left side.

297
2. Disconnect the front control rod at 1, the control
link at pivot bolt, 2, and the rear control rod at, 3.
Remove the control linkage assembly.

DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove the front control rod from the control link
at 4, and the rear control rod, 5.

298
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the control rod ball joint ends, 1, for
looseness and wear in the swivel.
2. Inspect the control rods, 2, for straightness.
3. Inspect the control link pivot bushing, 3, for wear
and damage.
4. Check for wear and bending of the pivot bolt, 4.
5. Replace any parts that are worn, damaged, or
bent.

299
128 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

REASSEMBLY
Control rod lengths are measured from center to
center of the ball joint ends.
1. Adjust the length of the right rear control rod, 1,
to obtain a vertical center line of the control arm
pivot, 2, and link pivot, 3, shown at 4, with the 1 2
control linkage in neutral and no tire rotation.
The center of the control arm pivot, 2, and center
4
of link pivot, 3, must align to ensure equal stroke
forward and reverse.
Remove the control link, 1, at 5, and adjust the 5 3
length of the link if required. 19984618
2. Reattach the rear control rod, 1, to the control link
300
at 5, and the front control rod to the control link at
2.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 129

LEFT CONTROL HANDLE WITH NO BOOM


CONTROL 3
1
Op. 29 100 10
REMOVAL
1. Securely latch the seat in the raised and latched
position. Remove the step shield and front step
cover to access the control handle, linkage and 2
valve area.
2. Disconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-
izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3,
under the left handle support plate. Take note of 3172-07
the number and position of all washers and 301
spacers for reference during installation.
3. If the unit is high-flow, disconnect the wires from
the high-flow switch. Remove the five handle
mounting bolts, 1, and remove the handle as-
sembly from the unit. 1

302
DISASSEMBLY
1. Loosen the boot securing bolts, 1, and slide the
boot, 2, off the handle.
2. Remove the roll pin, 3, and shim washers, 4.
Take note of the number and position of all shim 2
washers for reassembly.
3. Slide the handle sideways and remove from the
stub shafts.
5 4
4. Remove the bearings, 5, from the handle. 1
3

303
130 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

INSPECTION
3
1. Inspect the handle pivot bearings, 1; replace if
worn or damaged.
2. Inspect the control handle for excessive wear or
bends in the bearing mounting plates, 2, and
pivot stub shafts, 3.

2 1
304
REASSEMBLY
1. Slide the handle sideways over the stub shafts.
7
2. Install the bearings, 1, on the handle. Install shim
washers, 2, to center the handle in the slot, 3.
3. Install shim washers, 4, to reduce side play on 6
the stub shafts. Retain the shims on the stubs
shaft with a roll pin, 5.
4. Slide the boot, 6, over the handle and tighten the 1
boot securing bolts.
4
3
5. Install a new hand grip, 7, if grip is worn. 3
2

305
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the handle assembly in the unit and install
the five handle mounting bolts, 1, and tighten se-
curely. If the unit is high-flow, reconnect the wires 1
from the high-flow switch.

306
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 131

2. Reconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-


izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3. 3
Use the same number and position of spacers 1
and washers noted during removal.
3. Reinstall all shields removed for the repair.

3172-07
307
132 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

LEFT CONTROL HANDLE WITH BOOM


CONTROL 3
1
Op. 29 100 11
REMOVAL
1. Securely latch the seat in the raised and latched
position. Remove the step shield and front step
cover to access the control handle, linkage and 2
valve area.
2. Disconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-
izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3,
under the left handle support plate. Take note of 3172-07
the number and position of all washers and 308
spacers for reference during installation.
3. Remove the boom control rod, 1, from the left
control handle arm, 2.

2
1
19996848
309
4. If the unit is high-flow, disconnect the wires from
the high-flow switch. Remove the five handle
mounting bolts, 1, and remove the handle as-
sembly from the unit.
1

310
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 133

DISASSEMBLY
1. Take note of the number and position of all shim 4
washers for reassembly. 9 8
2. Remove the bolt, 1, securing the ball end to the
control arm.
3. Remove the jam nut, 2, and ball end, 3, from the 10
rod, 4. 12
4. Remove the groove pin, 5, from the arm, 6. 11
5. Loosen the set screw, 7, on the set collar. Re- 10
move the cotter pins, 8, and shim washers, 9, tak- 7
ing note of the number of shim washers for reas- 6 5 8 9 11
sembly.
6. Remove the bearings, 10, from the control 311
handle and the bearings, 11, from the handle
mounting plates. Slide the handle sideways and
remove from the stub shafts.
7. Remove the nuts, 1, lock washers, and carriage
bolts securing the handle support to the handle
tube. Remove the handle support, 2, and control
rod, 3, from the handle tube, 4.

1 2

4
19996838
312
8. Remove the locknut, 1, and bolt to separate the
handle from the handle support.
9. Remove the ball end, 2, from the handle by re- 3
moving the capscrew, 3, flat washer and locknut. 1
Remove the ball end, 2, and jam nut, 4, from the
rod, 5.

2 4

19996839
313
134 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

10. Loosen the boot securing bolts, 1, and slide the


boot, 2, off the handle.

1 1

2
19997750
314
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the handle pivot bearings, 1; replace if 2
worn or damaged.
2. Inspect the pivot stub shafts, 2, for any obvious
bends or deformation.
3. Inspect the control handle for excessive wear or
bends in the bearing mounting plates, 3.

3
1
19997747
315
4. Inspect the pivot handle linkage for looseness in
the ball joints, 1; replace if worn.
5. Inspect the pivot handle, 2, and handle support, 2
3, for damage or deformation. Replace as
necessary. 1

316
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 135

REASSEMBLY
1
1. Install a new hand grip on the top of the handle,
1, if grip is worn. 6 5
9
2. Attach the ball end, 2, and jam nut, 3, to the rod,
8
4. Fasten the ball end to the handle, 5, with the
capscrew, 6, flat washer and locknut. Position the
flat washer between the ball end and handle. Do 7
not tighten the jam nut at this time.
2
3. Attach the handle assembly to the handle sup-
3
port, 7, with the long bolt, 8, and locknut, 9.
4. Tighten the locknut to remove any movement be-
4
tween the handle assembly and support, but do
19996839
not overtighten. The support should be loose
enough to allow the handle to pivot without bind- 317
ing.
5. Slide the handle tube up through the slot, 1, in the
handle support base.
7
6. Slide the handle sideways over the stub shafts.
7. Install the bearings, 2, on the handle, install shim
washers, 3, to center the handle in the slot, 1.
Fasten each bearing with two 5/16″ x 3/4″ car-
riage bolts, lock washers, and nuts at 4. 1 2
8. Install shim washers, 5, to reduce side play on 5
the stub shafts. Retain the shims on the stubs
shaft with a roll pin, 6. 6
9. Slide the rubber boot, 7, down over the end of the 4
control handle, one side at a time, and secure 3 4
with the the hardware removed during disassem-
bly. 318
10. Attach the handle and rod assembly, 1, to the
control handle by first sliding the rod down
through the control handle tube, 2.
11. Attach the handle assembly to the handle tube
arms, 3, with the short carriage bolts, 4, lock
washers, 5, and nuts, 6. Tighten securely. 5 3
6

4
1

2
19996838
319
136 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

12. Assemble the pivot shaft, 1, shim washers, 2,


arm, 3, set collar, 4, and bearings, 5, in the control
arm housing. 5
3
13. Rotate the pivot shaft, 1, to position the arm up- 7
ward as shown at 7.
14. Note the position of the arm, 3, on the shaft in
relation to the arm at 7. Insert groove pin, 8,
through arm, 3, and into shaft just far enough to 6
position the arm. Do not hammer into place at this 6
time.
5
1 2
4 8

320
15. Attach the ball end and jam nut, 1, onto rod, 2. In-
stall spacer, 12, (OD - 7/16″; length - 15/32″) be- 8
tween the ball end and arm, 3. Secure with a 2
5/16″ x 1-3/4″ bolt, lock washer, and nut at 4. 1
16. Install shim washers at 5, between the cotter pin, 4
6, and bearing, 7, to center rod, 2, in the control 10
handle tube at 8. Secure the cotter pin and slide
12
the set collar, 9, against the opposite bearing to
remove any side movement of the shaft and
tighten the setscrew. 10
17. Drive the groove pin in the arm, 3, completely into 9
place. 3 7 11
6 5
18. With the handle in the neutral position angle, ad-
just the length of the rod, 12, so the ball stud at 321
the arm aligns with the pivot bearings at 10. This
will also set the pivot arm, 11, in a vertical posi-
tion.
19. Rotate the handle to make sure the rod, 2, does
not interfere at the top or bottom of the control
handle tube. Move the control handle back and
forth (forward and reverse) and make sure the
control arm, 3, does not move. When there is no
movement, tighten the jam nuts at both ends of
the rod.
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the handle assembly in the unit and install
the five handle mounting bolts, 1, and tighten se-
curely. If the unit is high-flow, reconnect the wires
from the high-flow switch. 1

322
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 137

2. Install the left control rod, 1, on the boom control


handle arm, 2.

2
1
19996848
323
3. Reconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-
izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3. 3
Use the same number and position of spacers 1
and washers noted during removal.
4. Reinstall all shields removed for the repair.

3172-07
324
138 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

RIGHT CONTROL HANDLE WITH


AUXILIARY OR BUCKET CONTROL 4 3 1

Op. 29 100 15
REMOVAL
1. Securely latch the seat in the raised and latched
position. Remove the step shield and front step 2
cover to access the control handle, linkage and
valve area.
2. Disconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-
izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3.
Take note of the number and position of all 3172-07
washers and spacers for reference during in- 325
stallation.
3. Disconnect the wires, 4, to the two-speed control
switch under the right control handle support, if
applicable.
4. Remove the auxiliary hydraulic control or bucket
control rod, 1, from the right control handle arm,
2.

2
1
19996848
326
5. Remove the five handle mounting bolts, 1, and
remove the handle assembly from the unit.

327
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 139

DISASSEMBLY
1. Take note of the number and position of all shim 4
washers for reassembly. 2
3
2. Remove the bolt, 1, securing the ball end to the
control arm. 9 10
3. Remove the jam nut, 2, and ball end, 3, from the
rod, 4.
8
4. Remove the groove pin, 5, from the arm, 6.
5. Loosen the set screw, 7, on the set collar.
6. Remove the cotter pins, 8, and shim washers, 9, 10 7
taking note of the number of shim washers for re- 1 5 6
assembly.
7. Remove the bearings, 10, from the control 328
handle and the bearings, 11, from the handle
mounting plates. Slide the handle sideways and
remove from the stub shafts.
Op. 29 100 15
Auxiliary Boom Control Handle (only)
8. Boom hydraulics control - Remove the setscrew,
1, and remove the handle support, 2, and control
rod, 3, from the handle tube, 4.

2
1

4
19996890
329
9. Boom hydraulics control - Remove the roll pin, 1,
the L-pin, 2, and the spring and ball at 3.

1
19997746
330
140 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

10. Boom hydraulics control - Remove the locknut, 1,


and bolt, 2, to separate the handle, 3, from the
handle support, 4. Retain the bushing and caps- 6
crew. Remove the ball end, 5, from the handle by 3
1
removing the capscrew, 6, flat washer and lock-
nut. Remove the ball end, 5, and jam nut, 7, from 2
the rod.
5 7

19996889
331
Bucket Control Handle
11. Bucket control - Remove the nuts, 1, lock
washers, and carriage bolts securing the handle
support to the handle tube. Remove the handle
support, 2, and control rod, 3, from the handle
tube, 4. 1 2

4
19996838
332
12. Bucket control - Remove the locknut, 1, and bolt
to separate the handle from the handle support.
Remove the ball end, 2, from the handle by re- 3
moving the capscrew, 3, flat washer and locknut. 1
Remove the ball end, 2, and jam nut, 4, from the
rod, 5.

2 4

19996839
333
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 141

13. Loosen the boot securing bolts, 1, and slide the


boot, 2, off the handle.

1 1

2
19997750
334
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the handle pivot bearings, 1; replace if 2
worn or damaged.
2. Inspect the pivot stub shafts, 2, for any obvious
bends or deformation.
3. Inspect the control handle for excessive wear or
bends in the bearing mounting plates, 3.

3
1
19997747
335
4. Bucket control - Inspect the pivot handle linkage
for looseness in the ball joints, 1; replace if worn.
1
5. Bucket control - Inspect the pivot handle, 2, and 2
handle support, 3, for damage or deformation.
Replace as necessary.
3

19997751
336
142 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

6. Boom Hydraulics Control - Inspect the pivot


handle linkage for looseness in the ball joints, 1; 2 1
replace if worn.
7. Boom Hydraulics Control - Inspect the pivot
handle, 2, and handle support, 3, for damage or
deformation. Replace as necessary. 4
8. Boom Hydraulics Control - Inspect the handle
lock components, 4. Replace the spring if bent or
broken.
3

337
REASSEMBLY
1
1. Bucket control - Install a new hand grip on the top
of the handle, 1, if grip is worn. 6 5
9
2. Bucket control - Attach the ball end, 2, and jam
8
nut, 3, to the rod, 4, and fasten to the handle, 5,
with the capscrew, 6, flat washer and locknut.
Position the flat washer between the ball end and 7
handle. Do not tighten the jam nut at this time.
2
3. Bucket control - Attach the handle assembly to
3
the handle support, 7, with the long bolt, 8, and
locknut, 9.
4
4. Bucket control - Tighten the locknut to remove
19996839
any movement between the handle assembly
and support, but should be loose enough to all 338
the handle to pivot without binding.
5. Bucket control - Slide the handle tube up through
the slot, 1, in the handle support base. 7
6. Bucket control - Slide the handle sideways over
the stub shafts.
7. Bucket control - Install the bearings, 2, on the
4
handle, install shim washers, 3, to center the
handle in the slot, 1. Fasten each bearing with 2 1
5
two 5/16″ x 3/4″ carriage bolts, lock washers, and
nuts at 4.
8. Bucket control - Install shim washers, 5, to re- 6 4
duce side play on the stub shafts. Retain the
shims on the stubs shaft with a roll pin, 6. 4 3
9. Bucket control - Slide the rubber boot, 1, down
over the end of the control handle, one side at a 339
time, and secure with the the hardware, 2, re-
moved during disassembly.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 143

10. Bucket control - Attach the handle and rod as-


sembly, 1, to the control handle by first sliding the
rod down through the control handle tube, 2.
11. Bucket control - Attach the handle assembly to
the handle tube arms, 3, with the short carriage
bolts, 4, lock washers, 5, and nuts, 6. Tighten se- 5 3
curely. 6

4
1

2
19996838
340
12. Boom hydraulics control - Install a new hand grip
on the top of the handle, 1, if grip is worn. 1
13. Boom hydraulics control - Attach the ball end, 2, 6
and jam nut, 3, to the rod, 4, and fasten to the 5
handle, 5, with a 5/16″ x 1-1/4″ capscrew, 6, flat 8
washer and locknut. Position the flat washer be- 9
tween the ball end and handle. Do not tighten the
jam nut at this time. 2 3
14. Boom hydraulics control - Attach the handle as-
sembly to the handle support, 8, with the long 7
bushing, 3/8″ x 3-1/4″ capscrew and locknut at 9.
15. Boom hydraulics control - Tighten the locknut to 4
remove any movement between the handle as- 19996889
sembly and support, but should be loose enough 341
to all the handle to pivot without binding.
16. Boom hydraulics control - Slide the handle tube
up through the slot, 1, in the handle support base. 7
17. Boom hydraulics control - Slide the handle side-
ways over the stub shafts.
18. Boom hydraulics control - Install the bearings, 2, 4
on the handle, install shim washers, 3, to center
the handle in the slot, 1. Fasten each bearing with 2 1
5
two 5/16″ x 3/4″ carriage bolts, lock washers, and
nuts, 4.
19. Boom hydraulics control - Install shim washers, 6 4
5, to reduce side play on the stub shafts. Retain
the shims on the stubs shaft with a roll pin, 6. 4 3
20. Boom hydraulics control - Slide the rubber boot,
7, down over the end of the control handle and 342
secure with the the hardware removed during
disassembly.
144 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

21. Boom hydraulics control - Attach the handle and


rod assembly, 1, to the control handle, 2, by first
sliding the rod, 3, down through the control
handle tube.
22. Boom hydraulics control - Position the handle
support on the tube by aligning the setscrew, 4,
with the drilled hole in the tube. Tighten the sets-
crew and locknut. 3

1
4

2
19996890
343
23. Boom hydraulics control - Insert the spring and
ball at 1. Insert the L-pin, 2, and drive the roll pin,
3, in flush to retain the L-pin.

3
19997746
344
24. Assemble the pivot shaft, 1, shim washers, 2,
arm, 3, set collar, 4, and bearings, 5, into the con- 5
trol arm housing. Fasten each bearing with two
5/16″ x 3/4″ carriage bolts, lock washers, and 3
nuts at 6. 7
25. Rotate the pivot shaft, 1, to position the arm up-
ward as shown at 7.
26. Note the position of the arm, 3, on the shaft, 1, in 6
relation to the arm at 7. Insert groove pin, 8, 6
through arm, 3, and into shaft, 1, just far enough 2
to position the arm. Do not hammer into place at 8
this time. 1 4 5

345
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 145

27. Attach the ball end and jam nut, 1, onto rod, 2. In-
stall spacer, 12, (OD - 7/16″; length - 15/32″) be- 8 2
tween the ball end and arm, 3. Secure with a
5/16″ x 1-3/4″ bolt, lock washer, and nut at 4. 1
28. Install shim washers at 5, between the cotter pin, 4 10
6, and bearing, 7, to center rod, 2, in the control
handle tube at 8. Secure the cotter pin and slide 12
the set collar, 9, against the opposite bearing to
remove any side movement of the shaft and
tighten the setscrew.
29. Drive the groove pin in the arm, 3, completely into 10 9
place. 11 7 6 3
5
30. With the handle in the neutral position angle, ad-
just the length of the rod, 2, so the ball stud at the 346
arm, 3, aligns with the pivot bearings at 10. This
will also set the pivot arm, 11, in a vertical posi-
tion.
31. Rotate the handle to make sure the rod, 2, does
not interfere at the top or bottom of the control
handle tube. Move the control handle back and
forth (forward and reverse) and make sure the
control arm, 3, does not move. When there is no
movement, tighten the jam nuts at both ends of
the rod.
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the handle assembly in the unit, install the
five handle mounting bolts, 1, and tighten secure-
ly.
1

347
2. Install the auxiliary hydraulic control or bucket
control rod, 1, on the right control handle arm, 2.

2
1
19996848
348
146 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

3. Reconnect the wires, 1, to the two-speed control


switch under the right control handle support. 1
4 2
4. Connect the dampener shocks, 2, the neutral-
izer, 3, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 4.
Use the same number and position of spacers
and washers noted during removal.
5. Reinstall all shields removed for the repair.
3

3172-07
349
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 147

CONTROL LINKAGE AND NEUTRALIZER


REINSTALLATION
1. Install the control handle assemblies into their
correct positions, and secure with hardware
previously removed.
2. Install the control linkage assembly, 1, by recon-
necting the control link (pivot) at 2, the rear con-
trol rod at 3, and the front control rod at 4.

350
3. Install the neutralizer assembly, 1, and secure
with four attaching bolts, 2. Two at the front and
two at the rear.
4. Connect the neutralizer assemblies to the control
handles at 3, and reconnect the dampener
shocks at 4.

351
148 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

Op. 29 130 06

DRIVE CONTROL ADJUSTMENT PRO-


CEDURE
If the machine creeps (tires rotate slowly with steer-
ing control in neutral) and the transmissions make a
noise indicating they are being slightly stroked, a
neutralizing adjustment is required.
CAUTION
To make a neutralizer adjustment, block the machine
off the ground so that the wheels turn freely. Raise
the boom and place it on the boom lockpins. When
the engine is running, stay clear of the rotating
wheels.

To make any transmission control linkage adjust-


ments, first block the skid steer off the ground with the
boom in the raised position resting on the boom lock-
pins, 1. Put the Service/Run switch in the “SERVICE”
position to prevent movement of the boom and
bucket.

352
Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised posi-
tion.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

353
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 149

The seat and seat support rod, 1, shown properly


latched in the raised supported position.
CAUTION
Make sure the seat is properly latched before work- 2
ing under the seat assembly.

4825-09
354
Before making any adjustments make sure there is
no binding in the control linkage, shocks or neutral-
izers.
The skid steer must be raised and supported with the
tires off the ground. Use adequate blocking or jack
stands to securely support the skid steer.
The engine must be started and running to make final
linkage or neutral adjustments. Place the “SERVICE/
RUN” Switch, 1, in the “SERVICE” position to allow
the engine to be started. 1

19984593
355
SL65B LINKS AND ARMS
4 3
Control lever and link, 1, arm, 2, link, 3, and dam-
pener assembly, 4, controls the right side. Control
lever and link, 5, arm, 6, link, 7, and dampener as- 1 2
sembly, 8, controls the left side. The two dampener
shocks, 4 and 8, are connected to the steering link- 8
age to dampen the hydraulic vibration from the con-
trol levers and the operator’s hands. The neutralizer
assemblies are spring loaded to return the steering
linkage to the neutral position.
5
When the operator strokes both control levers in the 6
same direction the unit will travel in that direction until 7
the levers are stroked differently to change direction. 4319-10
When both levers are released the steering linkage 356
will return to neutral.
150 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

The control arm, 1, and linkage, 2, must be set in the


appropriate hole for linkage travel and wheel speeds.
1
Hole 3 – Gives maximum linkage travel and wheel 3
speed.
Hole 4 – Reduces linkage travel and wheel speed
when steering levers are fully stroked to provide
more wheel torque.
2
Hole 5 – Maximum reduction in linkage travel and 5
corresponding wheel speed.
Factory assembly of linkage is in hole, 4, as shown. 4
If an operator is in a less power-demanding operation
and needs maximum ground speed, the linkage can
4319-11
be moved to hole, 3.
357
For maximum wheel torque, use hole, 5.
NOTE: Left and right control linkage must be in the
same holes for machines to operate in a straight line
of travel and with the same power.
For maximum use of engine horse power and wheel
torque the skid steer must be operated at reduced
wheel speed (ground speed) by positioning the
steering levers closer to the neutral position.
Op. 29 130 06
2
SL65B NEUTRALIZER ADJUSTMENT
1. Check the dampeners, 1, for equal pressure re- 3
quired to move shaft in/out of housing and for no
binding. Repair or replace dampener if required. 1
2. Check the rods, 2, and front and rear bushing, 3, 2 4
to ensure there is no binding between the rods
and bushings and bushings and support, 4.

3649-05
358
3. Check and remove any free play in the neutral-
izer spring assemblies, 1, right side and, 2, left 2
side. There should be no free play between the
rod and bushing at, 3, or between the bushings 3
and the support at, 4. To remove the free play
loosen nuts and adjust on rods at, 5. 1
NOTE: If the rods are turned in too far or not far 4
enough, free play will result. 2

3649-05
359
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 151

CONTROL LEVER PARALLEL


ADJUSTMENT
1. Set the hydrostatic control levers to 9.5 degrees 1
forward and parallel with each other. To obtain
the proper settings loosen jam nuts at, 1, and
thread rods, 2, in/or out of yokes, 3. Each side 2
must be set.
IMPORTANT: If the hydrostatic control levers are not 3
set properly, the straight travel and forward/reverse
stop adjustment and equal wheel speeds will be diffi-
cult to obtain.
NOTE: If the skid steer is equipped with a back-up 1 2
3410-10
alarm, the alarm switches will require adjustment if
rods, 2, are rotated. 360
SL65B LINKAGE AND CONTROL LEVER
EQUAL MOVEMENT 5 2
3
Right Control Linkage Adjustment
1. Check the length of link, 1, and adjust if required 1
to obtain a vertical center line at 3, with the con-
trol linkage in neutral and no tire rotation.
The center of the control arm pivot, 4, and center 4
of link pivot, 5, must align to insure equal stroke
forward and reverse.
Remove the control link, 1, at 2, and adjust the
length of the link if required. 4319-11
361
2. Unhook link, 1, at 2 and start the skid steer en-
gine, at this time. Pivot the control arm, 3, until the
hydrostat control neutralizes the hydrostatic
2
pump with no tire rotation.
3
3. With the control levers previously set to the 9.5
degrees, forward position, rotate the arm, 3, until
the tires start to rotate forward and then rotate the
arm, 3, back until tires just stop rotating. Now ad-
1
just the length of link, 1, with yoke, 4, to allow the 4
yoke to be reconnected at, 2. Adjust both the right
and left sides in this sequence.
Start the unit and check for neutral, no tire rota-
tion. If the tires rotate repeat step three, if there 4319-11
is no tire rotation go to straight travel adjustment. 362
NOTE: If adjusted correctly it will take the same
movement of the left and right hydrostatic control
levers to produce tire rotation in the forward direction.
152 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

LEFT CONTROL LINKAGE ADJUSTMENT


1. Check the length of link, 1, and adjust if required 2
to obtain a vertical center line at 3, with the con- 5
trol linkage in neutral and no tire rotation.
The center of the control arm pivot, 4, and center 3
of link pivot, 5, must align to insure equal stroke
forward and reverse.
Remove the control link, 1, at 2, and adjust the 1 4
length of the link if required.

4319-09
363
2. Unhook link, 1, at 2 and start the skid steer en-
gine, at this time. Pivot the control arm, 3, until the 3 2
1
hydrostat control neutralizes the hydrostatic
pump with no tire rotation.
3. With the control levers previously set to the 9.5
degrees, forward position, rotate the arm, 3, until
the tires start to rotate forward and then rotate the 4
arm, 3, back until tires just stop rotating. Now ad-
just the length of link, 1, with yoke, 4, to allow the
yoke to be reconnected at, 2. Adjust both the right
and left sides in this sequence.
Start the unit and check for neutral, no tire rota-
tion. If the tires rotate repeat step three, if there 4319-09
is no tire rotation go to straight travel adjustment. 364
NOTE: If adjusted correctly it will take the same
movement of the left and right hydrostatic control
levers to produce tire rotation in the forward direction.
SL65B STRAIGHT TRAVEL AND
FORWARD/REVERSE STOP ADJUSTMENT 1
Before straight travel can be adjusted, the control
levers, 1, must be set for equal movement. When
both the right and left control levers are stroked for-
ward, the tires should start rotating at the same time.
To obtain equal movement, refer to steps 2 and 3 of
LINKAGE AND CONTROL LEVER EQUAL MOVE- 2
MENT ADJUSTMENT. A hand held tach is required
to properly set forward and reverse wheel speeds.
IMPORTANT: If the external control lever stops, 2,
are not adjusted properly, overspeed may occur and
the control linkage and transmission may be dam- 19984866
aged. 365
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 153

Once the control levers are set for equal movement,


adjust the control lever forward stops, 2, and the re-
verse stops, 3, for correct wheel speed and straight
travel. 4
If no hand tach is available, adjust the stops as fol-
lows to prevent transmission overspeed:
1. Set the forward stops, 2, in the middle of the slots, 4 3
4.
2. Set the reverse stops, 3, with the stop fully for-
4
ward.
NOTE: This procedure will not set the wheel speeds
to maximum, but should insure against transmission
2
19984867
overspeed and linkage and transmission damage.
366
Use a hand tach to adjust the forward and reverse
stops to set wheel speeds to maximum equal 4
speeds: 1
1
1. Loosen the forward stop retaining hardware, 1,
and slide stops, 2, forward.
2. Loosen the reverse stop hardware, 3, and slide
stops, 4, rearward.
3
3. Using a hand tach, set wheel hub speed forward
and reverse equal by RPM in low range, or in high 1 1
range if the loader is equipped with the two–
speed variable motors.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT EXCEED a maximum of 120 1 2 2 1
19984866
RPM in high range to prevent transmission over-
speed. 367
154 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

4. Operate unit and stroke control levers forward to NOTE: If stop plates are not adjusted properly equal
obtain maximum speed, and slide the forward travel speeds forward and reverse will not be ob-
stops rearward to contact the control lever and tained. If too much forward stroke is allowed, the re-
tighten stop retaining hardware. verse speed may be diminished.
5. Stroke the control levers in reverse to obtain CAUTION
maximum speed and slide the reverse stops
the skid steer must be raised and supported with the
against the control levers and tighten retaining
tires off the ground. Use adequate blocking or jack
hardware.
stands to securely support the skid steer.
IMPORTANT: The hydrostatic pump control valve
and linkage has a dead band area in neutral, forward, IMPORTANT: If the external control lever stops are
and reverse. Within the dead band areas, there will not adjusted properly the control linkage and trans-
be a control lever movement without wheel move- mission may be damaged.
ment or increase in speeds.
7. Return the “SERVICE/RUN” Switch to the “RUN”
6. Operate the skid steer and check for straight position.
travel and make final adjustment by slowing
down the fast side.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 155

SL65B HIGH/LOW RANGE ADJUSTMENT


(OPTIONAL)
1
The HIGH/LOW (two–speed) feature gives the oper-
ator more range in travel speeds. The control is at, 1,
on the right hydrostatic control lever.

3461-11
379
Before checking or adjusting the HIGH/LOW linkage,
make sure the control arms, 1, are tight on the motor 1
cam plate shafts, 2. The neutralizer and dampeners 2
are shown removed for clarity.

1 2

3625-13
380
Spring Adjustment
Adjust the high/low return spring to a spring length of 2
4-5/16″ (109 mm) from eye at, 1, to eye, 2, by tighten-
ing or loosening the draw bolt, 3.
NOTE: Once the skid steer neutral adjustments and
straight travel speeds are correct in low range, and 1
the variable motors are set to the high range position,
the skid steer may not run in a straight line.

3
3461-16
381
156 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1

High/Low Linkage Adjustment


1. Control arms, 1, clamped tight onto the motor 2 1 4
cam plate shafts, 2. 3
2. Spring adjusted to the proper length.
4
3. Loosen the control link, 3, on the control arms at
4.
4. Rotate both control arms, 1, clockwise and hold
firmly against the internal motor stops by the
spring.
5. With both arms, 1, firmly against the internal 2
1
motor stops, tighten link, 3, and retaining hard-
ware, 4. 3625-13
382
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS

Chapter 1 – Parking Brake

CONTENT

Section Description Page


33 000 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-2
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-3
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-4
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-6
33 110 Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-7
Parking Brake Removal and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-8
33 110 Parking Brake Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33-13
2 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1

OPS844

1
Op. 33 000 The park brake prevents movement of the loader
when power is applied or the machine is parked on
GENERAL INFORMATION an incline.
The parking brake system is a mechanically acti- CAUTION
vated double disc brake system. Brake discs are at- Always engage the parking brake before exiting the
tached to each of the two hydrostatic motor shafts, lo- loader. Never operate the loader until the parking
cated inside the gearboxes, 1. Both left and right side brake is released.
parking brakes are activated by a single control lever.
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 3

SPECIFICATIONS
Chain Case and Gearbox

Side Cover Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 N·m (11 ft. lbs.)


Drive Chain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . #100
Front Chain Length (64 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80″ (2032 mm)
Rear Chain Length – SL65B (58 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72.5″ (1841.5 mm)

Chain Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0 to 6 mm (0″ to 1/4″) movement at tire tread


Gearbox Mounting Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 ft. lbs. (316 N·m)
Drive Motor Mounting Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 ft. lbs. (85 N·m)
Front Cover Plate Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 ft. lbs. (20 N·m)
Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5 liters (2.5 US. gal.) each side - 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Other Materials

Description Use
Ultra/Blue Silicone Sealer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gearbox mounting bolts
Axle housing bolts
Chain case cover bolts
Gearbox to chain case
Gearbox cover and bolts
Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer
Gear Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High viscosity lithium base

NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to seal where required to prevent corrosion during the sili-
cone curing process.
4 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1

TROUBLESHOOTING

FINAL DRIVE/PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM


Before servicing or adjusting the final drive/parking
brake system, the skid steer should be jacked up with
the wheels off the ground.
Remove any attachment from the skid steer; boom,
bucket, etc. Lower the boom to the lowered position
or, if servicing requires the boom to be in the raised
position, support the boom on the boom lock pins.
Raise the boom and lower onto the boom lock pins,
1.
1. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins.
2
2. Engage the boom lock pins.
3. Stop the engine; ignition key in the “OFF” posi-
tion.
4. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
5. Lower the boom onto the boom lock pins.
6. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.

CAUTION
Never exit the loader with the boom in the raised posi-
tion unless the boom is supported on the boom lock
pins.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment
mounted. Always remove the attachment from the
loader.

Jack up the loader and support the loader with the


wheels off the ground. Use adequate jack stands or
blocks to securely support the loader.
Support the loader at the front of the final drive cases
at 1, and at the rear at 2.
CAUTION
Never service a raised loader unless it is securely
supported with adequate jack stands or blocks.

3
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 5

TROUBLESHOOTING

PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Parking brake will not hold Park brake not engaged. Engage parking brake.
loader.
Brake not adjusted properly. Adjust parking brake.
Handle not operating or latching. Check handle components; repair
or replace.
Loose brake linkage. Inspect and repair linkage.
Worn brake pad. Inspect and repair brake pad.

Parking brake will not release. Brake not adjusted properly. Adjust parking brake.
Handle not operating properly. Check handle components; repair
or replace.
Brake caliper not releasing. Check brake caliper and repair.

Parking brake handle will not Handle not operating properly. Check handle components; repair
move or release. or replace.
Control linkage not moving. Check and repair linkage.
Brake caliper not releasing. Check brake caliper and repair.

Grinding noise when Handle not releasing properly. Check handle components; repair
operating. or replace.
Brake not adjusted properly. Adjust parking brake.
Brake caliper not releasing. Check brake caliper and repair.
6 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1

TESTING
PARKING BRAKE
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at 1500 RPM.
* Park brake in disengaged position.

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Push both drive controls forward YES Brake system OK.
equally and loader should move
without restriction. NO Parking brake not releasing; check control handle. If
OK, go to next step.
2 Parking brake linkage not free; check for loose or
binding linkage. If OK, go to next step.
3 Parking brake not releasing; check caliper and brake
pad and repair.

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at 1500 RPM.
* Park brake in engaged position.

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Push both drive controls forward NO Parking brake OK.
equally and loader should not
move. YES Parking brake not adjusted properly. If OK, go to next
step.
2 Parking brake linkage loose or broken. If OK, go to next
step.
3 Parking brake caliper not operating properly. Check
and repair.
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 7

Op. 33 110

PARKING BRAKE

OPERATION
The parking brake system is a mechanically acti-
vated, double disc brake system. Brake discs are at-
tached to each of the two hydrostatic motor shafts lo-
cated in the gearboxes. Both left and right side
parking brakes are activated by a single control lever.
The park brake prevents movement of the loader
when power is applied or the machine is parked on
a slope.
The parking brake control lever, 1, is located to the 4
right of the operator’s seat. When the lever is in the
lowered, unlatched position, the brake is disen-
gaged. When the lever is in the raised, latched posi-
tion, the brake is engaged.
When the parking brake is engaged and the hydro-
static control levers are stroked, the skid steer should
not move if the brake is adjusted properly.
The hydrostatic system is the primary brake for the
skid steer when the unit is in operation. The parking
brake is intended to hold a stopped machine in place,
preventing rolling or creeping when parked.
The parking brake should always be engaged before
exiting the skid steer.
CAUTION
Always activate the parking brake before leaving the
operator station. Never operate the skid steer unless
the brake is released.
8 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1

REMOVAL AND INSPECTION


The hydrostatic motor two-speed control linkage, hy-
draulic cylinder (if applicable), and hydrostatic motor
will need to be removed to access the parking brake
assembly.

Op. 33 110 48
Removal
1. Tilt the cab and boom forward. Refer to Section
00 for the cab and boom tilting procedure.
2. Remove the hydrostatic motor two-speed hy-
draulic cylinder and control linkage (if appli-
cable). Refer to Section 29 for the removal pro-
cedure.
3. Remove the hydrostatic motor. Refer to Section
29 for the removal procedure.
NOTE: If only the hydrostatic motor is to be removed,
apply the parking brake before removal to retain the
brake discs and splined coupler in place.
4. Remove two cap screws, 4.
5. Remove four cap screws, 2. Remove the park
brake housing cover, 1, and bracket, 3.

5
6. Remove two discs, 1; divider plate, 2; and splined
coupler 3, by sliding them off the gearbox input
shaft.

6
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 9

7. Remove the steel friction pad, 1, from the park


brake housing cover.

7
8. Remove the steel friction pad, 1, and spacer, 2,
from the gearbox housing.

8
Inspection
1. Inspect the discs and divider plates for warping,
scoring, galling or wear. Inspect the spline area,
1, of the discs and the lugs, 2, on the separator
plates. Replace if necessary.

9
10 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1

2. Inspect the coupler splines, 1, for excessive wear


or chipped teeth.

19987107
10
3. Inspect the brake friction pads, 1. If worn to 7 mm
(1/4″) or less, replace.
4. The spacer plate, 2, will show a small amount of
wear in the center. This is normal.

11
Repair and Assembly
After cleaning and careful inspection, reassemble
the parking brake, using new parts where necessary.
1. Install the friction pad, 1, into the brake end cap.

12
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 11

2. Install the thinner spacer plate, 1, into the gear-


box housing, then the thicker friction pad, 2. In-
stall the splined coupler, 3, onto the gearbox
input shaft.

13
3. Install the first brake disc, 1, over the splines of
the drive coupler, 2.

1
19987114
14
4. Install the separator plate on the drive coupler,
with the lugs, 1, over the extended tabs, 2, on the
gearbox case.

1
2
19987115
15
12 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1

5. Install the second brake disc, 1, on the drive


coupler, 2. The splines, 3, of the drive coupler 2
should be visible above the brake disc. 3

1
19987117

16
6. Apply silicone sealer to the mating surfaces of
the housing and end cap.
7. Install the end cap onto the brake housing mak-
ing sure the lugs, 1, on the separator plate fit in
the notches, 2, on the end cap and the brake fric-
tion pads, 3, line up opposite each other across
the brake and separator plates.

17
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 13

Op. 33 110
PARKING BRAKE ADJUSTMENT
The parking brake control lever is located to the right
of the operator’s seat. With the lever in the down
position, the brake is released; up is engaged. The
parking brake should prevent movement of the
loader when power is applied or parked on an incline.
To adjust the parking brake, do the following:
1. Put the control lever in the released (down) posi-
tion.
2. Put the seat in the raised position, making sure
the seat assembly is locked up securely.
NOTE: The fenders can be removed to access brake 18
linkage.
3. Remove cotter pin from spring link, 1, and lever,
2, at 3.
4. Unhook the spring link.
5. Adjust the spring assembly bolts, 6, equally to
obtain a spring length of 152 mm (6″) with the
parking brake control lever in the released posi-
tion.
6. Loosen the setscrew, 4, in lever, 2, to allow the
lever to be removed from the actuator shaft, 5.
7. Rotate the lever down to turn the actuator shaft
into the caliper support to remove any play in
brake caliper.
8. Slide the lever off the actuator shaft and rotate
the lever up on the splined shaft until the spring
link can be rehooked.
9. Slide the lever onto the shaft and reposition the
lever to prevent contact with the hydraulic oil res-
ervoir, hoses, etc. and tighten the setscrews.
10. Reinstall the cotter pin to retain the spring link to
the lever.
CAUTION
Before adjusting the brake linkage, be sure that the
brake is disengaged and the loader is on level ground
to prevent the loader from rolling.
Always engage the parking brake before leaving the
operator’s seat. Never operate the unit unless the
brake is released.
14 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Chapter 1 – Valves, Gear Pump, Cylinders, and Pedal Controls

CONTENT

Section Description Page


35 000 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-3
Hydraulic System Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-4
Boom Cylinder Pivot Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-6
Boom Cylinder Pivot Pin Location and Machine Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-6
Control Valve Power Beyond . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-7
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-8
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-11
Auxiliary Boom Hydraulics Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-15
Hydraulic System Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-17
Hydraulic System Oil Flow (Neutral Position) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-23
Control Valve - Bucket Spool Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-24
Control Valve - Boom Spool Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-25
Control Valve - Auxiliary Spool Shifted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-26
Hydraulic System Oil Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-27
35 710 02 Main System Pressure Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-29
Checking Main System Pressure at Boom Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-32
Checking Main System Pressure at Bucket Cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-33
Checking Main System Pressure at Auxiliary Boom Hydraulic Quick Couplers . . . . . 35-34
Boom Circuit Relief Valve Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-35
Gear Pump Flow Efficiency Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-37
Boom and Bucket Spool Lock Solenoid Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-40
Hydraulic, Hydrostatic System Air Ingress Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-42
Control Valve Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-44
35 724 50 Control Valve Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-45
35 724 54 Control Valve Disassembly and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-47
Control Valve Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-51
Control Valve Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-52
Control Valve Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-56
Hydraulic Pump Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-57
35 710 10 Hydraulic Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-58
35 710 20 Hydraulic Pump Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-60
Hydraulic Pump Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-61
2 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Hydraulic Pump Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-63


Hydraulic Pump Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-66
Cylinders, Boom and Bucket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-69
35 710 10 Boom Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-70
35 730 18 Boom Cylinder Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-71
Boom Cylinder Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-73
Boom Cylinder Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-74
Boom Cylinder Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-76
35 730 10 Bucket Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-77
35 730 13 Bucket Cylinder Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-77
Bucket Cylinder Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-78
Bucket Cylinder Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-80
Bucket Cylinder Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-82
Pedal Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-83
35 724 16 Pedal Removal (With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-83
Pedal Inspection (With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-83
Pedal Reinstallation (With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-85
35 724 16 Pedal Removal (With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-88
Pedal Inspection (With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-89
Pedal Reinstallation (With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-90
35 300 Hydraulic Cooling, Filter, Reservoir System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-93
35 705 Filter System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-94
35 705 04 Filter Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-94
35 705 05 Base Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-94
Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-95
Oil Cooler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-96
35 300 10 Oil Cooler Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-96
Oil Cooler Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-96
35 300 Oil Reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-97
35 300 10 Oil Reservoir Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-98
Oil Reservoir Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-99
Oil Reservoir Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-100
Adapting Attachments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35-101
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 3

Op. 35 000

GENERAL INFORMATION
The hydraulic system provides hydraulic oil to the The hydraulic gear pump, which is attached to the
boom and bucket circuits. On skid steers equipped left-hand hydrostatic pump, provides continuous oil
with the boom auxiliary hydraulic kit, system oil will flow through the system to power the boom and
also be supplied to quick couplers at the front of the bucket circuits and, if equipped, the auxiliary boom
boom to operate optional hydraulic attachments. circuit.
The hydraulic system on the SL65B is an open center Figure 1 shows the hydraulic circuit layout and sys-
type hydraulic system. An open center means means tem components for the SL65B skid steers.
that the first control valve function has priority over
the next function in line.

17 4 6 9 5 18 12
1
13

15

14
1
4 8 16 3 18 7 11 10
BSC0938A

1
LS180 Hydraulic Circuit and System Components
1. Bucket cylinders 10. Engine (power supply)
2. Control valve (3 spool) 11. Engine gearbox
3. Hydraulic gear pump 12. Hydraulic reservoir
4. Boom cylinders 13. Hydraulic filter
5. Hydrostatic pump (RH) 14. Hydraulic oil cooler
6. Hydrostatic motor (RH) 15. Auxiliary boom hydraulics
7. Hydrostatic pump (LH) 16. High/low control valve (if two-speed equipped)
8. Hydrostatic motor (LH) 17. High/low shift cylinder (if two-speed equipped)
9. Charge pump 18. Hydraulic high flow kit (optional)
4 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

HYDRAULIC SYSTEM COMPATIBILITY


There are important questions that must be ans-
wered before adapting attachments that require hy-
draulic oil power.
1. What is the hydraulic pressure requirement,
minimum and maximum? Are they higher
than the maximum pressure of the model?

Model Maximum Pressure


SL65B 170-176 bar
(2500 to 2600 PSI)

2
2. What is the hydraulic oil flow requirement? Is
it more than the highest total flow rate of the
skid steer model?

Model Standard Hydraulics* High Flow Hydraulics*

SL65B 18.5 US. GPM (70.0 l/min.) @2350 RPM 32.0 US. GPM (122 l/min.) @2350 RPM
68 bar (@1000 PSI) 68 bar (@1000 PSI)

* Hydraulic flow rates are rated at 150 RPM below high idle at 90% pump efficiency.
NOTE: When using the High-Flow system, 3/4 quick Example: Snow blowers must free wheel to a
couplers must be used or high system backpressure stop.
may result. 5. Will the attachment accept hydraulic system
3. Will the attachment accept oil flow in both backpressure?
directions?
If “YES”, nothing is required.
If “YES”, nothing is required. If “NO”, the attachment will not function properly
If “NO”, install a check valve or cross into the at- on a skid steer. Normal backpressure for skid
tachment return line to prevent reverse oil flow to steers is between 13.8 to 17.3 bar (200 to 250 PSI).
the attachment.
Examples: Backhoes and trees spades with a Examples: Post drivers, some breakers, and
separate control valve do not accept oil flow in some hand held hydraulic tools do not accept
both directions. system backpressure.
4. Must the attachment “Free Wheel” to a If all the skid steer oil flow is not required to oper-
STOP? ate an attachment (e.g., shaver post driver), a
flow divider can be installed into the hydraulic oil
If “YES”, a crossover relief connection must be circuit on the attachment. The flow divider sends
installed on the attachment side to allow the at- the required oil flow to the attachment and the re-
tachment to free wheel to a stop after the skid mainder back to the normal skid steer hydraulic
steer hydraulics is turned off. circuits.
If “NO”, nothing is required.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 5

6. Does the attachment have a separate case NOTE: Skid steers equipped with High Flow Hy-
drain oil line? draulics have a separate case drain coupler and re-
turn line attached to the right boom arm.
If “NO”, nothing is required.
7. Does the attachment require circuit relief in
If “YES”, install a separate case drain line to re- the bucket circuit?
turn the attachment case drain oil directly to the
hydraulic oil reservoir. If “NO”, nothing is required.
Example: Cold planners have a separate case If “YES”, install a bucket circuit relief valve on
drain oil line. front of the control valve.
NOTE: Most attachment case drains will not accept Example: Some mini-backhoes attach like a
backpressure and must drain directly into the reser- bucket, and require a bucket circuit relief.
voir.
6 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

BOOM CYLINDER PIVOT PINS


When the main boom, upper and lower boom links
and cylinders are removed, the following figures and
charts may be used for proper pin placement.
The figure and chart show the boom and cylin-
der tapered and straight pivot pins, location/descrip-
tion, quantity used, part number, and model skid
steer the pin is used on.

BOOM AND CYLINDER PIVOT PIN


LOCATION AND MACHINE USAGE
Ref.# Description Qty. Part Number
1 Mounting Plate Pivot 2 86501434
2 Upper Bucket Cylinder Pivot 2 86501432
3 Lower Bucket Cylinder Pivot 2 9614349
4 Upper Boom Cylinder Pivot 2 86521982
5 Lower Boom Cylinder Pivot 2 86501428

SEAL KITS/DUST CAPS


Seal kits are available for coupler seal repair. A
special tool must be used to disassemble the
couplers. It is recommended each dealer have this
tool for coupler repair. Also, dust caps are available
for the 1/2 couplers only.
Part Number Description
86539430 1/2 male coupler seal kit
86539431 1/2 female coupler seal kit
86539432 Coupler repair tool
86539389 1/2 male coupler dust cap
86539390 1/2 female coupler dust cap
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 7

CONTROL VALVE POWER BEYOND


The control valve, used on all skid steers, has a
plugged power-beyond port, 1. This port is not nor-
mally used with supplied attachments, as these can
be operated through the auxiliary boom hydraulics
(the third control valve spool), 2.

1
19987103
4
To use the power-beyond port for a second oil supply
to additional attachments, remove the factory power-
beyond plug to access inner hole, 1. This hole must
be plugged to divert oil to the power-beyond instead
of normal oil flow to the out port.

1
19987104
5
Install part #236622 allen head type pipe plug in the
inner port, 1. Tighten the plug securely. A regular O
ring type fitting can now be inserted in the power-be-
yond port.
IMPORTANT: Once the power-beyond fitting and
plug is installed, oil must be constantly returned from
the attachment valve into the return line, 2. If oil is
blocked at the power-beyond port, hydraulic system
overheating and component damage could occur. 2
Also, engine horsepower requirements will increase.
A tee fitting can be inserted in the return line at 2, for
attachment oil return. 1
19987105
6
8 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

SPECIFICATIONS
MAIN CONTROL VALVE

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-spool open center

Relief Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170-176.8 bar (2500 PSI-2600 PSI)


Nonadjustable

Circuit Relief (boom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 bar (3500 PSI)


Nonadjustable

Electrical solenoid boom and bucket spool locks (controlled by the EIC) will lock the control valve spools when
the operator is out of the seat or the ignition key is in the “OFF” position with the spools in the neutral position.

HYDRAULIC PUMP

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gear pump

Output @ 2225 RPM - @ 1000PSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66.6 LPM (17.6 US. GPM)

BOOM CYLINDERS - SL65B

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Double Acting

Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63.5 mm (2.50″)

Stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 611.12 mm (24.06″)

Cycle Times (Seconds)


Raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6
Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5

BUCKET CYLINDERS - SL65B

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Double Acting

Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63.5 mm (2.50•)

Stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447.04 mm (17.60•)

Cycle Times (Seconds)


Raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8
Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 9

RESERVOIR

Capacity
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24.6 (6.5 US. gal.)

Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SAE


. . . 10W-30 motor oil

Filter Spin-on
. . . . . .Canister
................................................................. 10 micron
10 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS

Control Valve

Control Valve Retaining Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 N·m (18 ft. lbs.)


Control Valve Plugs (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)
Control Valve Plugs (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 N·m (23 ft. lbs.)
Circuit Relief Valve (boom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)
Spool Lock Solenoids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 N·m (11 ft. lbs.)
Solenoid Mounting Block Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 N·m (12 ft. lbs.)
Main System Relief Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 N·m (38 ft. lbs.)
Spool Cap Assembly Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 N·m (12 ft. lbs.)
Plugs, BYD Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

Boom Cylinders

Piston Locknut Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 N·m (170 ft. lbs.)


Cylinder Gland Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 N·m (225 ft. lbs.)
Lower Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 N·m (125 ft. lbs.)
Upper Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

Bucket Cylinders

Piston Cap Screw Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 N·m (225 ft. lbs.)


Cylinder Head Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 N·m (225 ft. lbs.)
Lower Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 N·m (125 ft. lbs.)
Upper Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

Gear Pump

Pump Mounting Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 N·m (29 ft. lbs.)


Pump Body Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 N·m (26 ft. lbs.)

OTHER MATERIALS

Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer


Hydraulic Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SAE10W-30 motor oil-API Service SH/CG4

NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to prevent damage to the components being sealed during
the silicone curing process.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 11

TROUBLESHOOTING WARNING
When performing a test on the hydraulic system, use Gauges, gauge fittings, and hoses must have operat-
the proper test procedures and test equipment. ing pressure ratings of at least 25% higher than the
Before testing, lower the attachment to the ground or highest pressures of the system.
remove the attachment from the skid steer. Never adjust or replace the relief valves to get higher
If testing is to be performed with a raised boom, make pressures than those specified by the equipment
sure the boom is raised above and resting on the manufacturer.
boom lock pins. Fluid under pressure can have sufficient force to pen-
Before opening the hydraulic system, clean the area etrate the skin, causing serious personal injury. al-
thoroughly to prevent contaminating the system. ways protect the skin and eyes from escaping fluid
Before opening the hydraulic system, relieve all pres- under pressure.
sure from the system. Before disconnecting lines or fittings, be sure to turn
Before testing the hydraulic system, check the hy- off the skid steer engine and relieve all pressure. Be-
draulic oil level. fore applying pressure to the system, be sure all con-
nections are tight and that lines, pipes, and hoses are
Before testing the hydraulic system, the oil must be not damaged.
at normal operating temperature.
If injured by escaping fluid, obtain medical assist-
If testing requires the skid steer to be raised, use ad- ance at once. Serious infection or reaction can devel-
equate blocking and/or jack stands to securely sup- op if medical treatment is not administered immedi-
port the skid steer. ately.
CAUTION Rmove any attachment from the mounting plate be-
When connecting test equipment to the hydraulic fore loosening or disconnecting any hydraulic lines.
system, relieve the pressure in the system. Stop the
engine, turn the ignition switch to the “on” position CAUTION
and operate all hydraulic control valve circuits to re-
Use adequate blocking and/or jack stands to make
lieve pressure. Turn the ignition switch to the “off”
sure that the skid steer is safely supported with all
position.
four wheels off the ground.
12 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION


Noisy system pump Oil level too low Add proper oil and amount
Oil of incorrect viscosity Replace oil and filter
Suction line plugged Clean or replace line
Reservoir air vent plugged Clean reservoir cap
Air leaks at pump inlet line fittings
Tighten or replace line and fittings
Check for air leak in hydrostatic
pump case drain line from hydro-
static pumps to suction side of gear
pump
Hydraulic reservoir oil foaming/ Air or water in system Check for air leak on suction side of
milky pump and check reservoir fill neck
for leaks allowing water to enter
system
Check for air leak in hydrostatic
pump case drain line from hydro-
static pumps to suction side of gear
pump
Low system pump oil flow, under Plugged inlet line Clean or replace line
pressure Low oil level in reservoir Add proper oil and amount
Air leaks at pump inlet line and fit- Tighten or replace line and fittings
tings
Check for air leak in hydrostatic
pump case drain line from hydro-
static pumps to suction side of gear
pump
Worn pump body Replace body if ID of body exceeds
acceptable limits. Refer to Hy-
draulic Pump Inspection.
No system pressure Inoperative relief valve Replace valve
Plugged inlet line Clean or replace inlet line
Worn hydraulic pump Rebuild or replace pump
Pump shaft broken Replace relief valve and replace or
repair pump
Internal leak in control valve or cyl- Rebuild components
inders
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 13

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION


Boom and bucket will not function Service/Run switch in the service Put Service/Run switch in the run
position position
Boom and bucket solenoids mal- Check solenoid operation
functioning
Pump shaft broken Replace relief valve and replace or
repair pump
Boom arms will not raise, or raise Low oil flow from pump Plugged inlet line or worn pump
slowly Low relief valve pressure Check pressure, replace valve if
pressure is not correct
Control linkage binding Free linkage
Boom solenoid malfunctioning Check solenoid operation
Boom and bucket overloaded Reduce load
Cylinder rods are bent Rebuild or replace cylinders
Boom arms are binding at pivots Remove binding and lubricate link-
age
Boom circuit relief valve malfunc- Check circuit relief valve pressure
tioning setting
Bucket tilt valve spool is not return- Correct binding, spool centering
ing to center position, binding spring damaged.
Auxiliary hydraulic handle locked in Return handle to neutral position
detent position
Boom or bucket leaks down, or low Control valve O rings leaking on Repair control valve with seal kit
bucket circuit pressure plugs or circuit relief valve and replace O rings and back-up
rings
Boom and/or bucket will not move Air leaks at pump line and fittings Tighten or replace line and fittings
smoothly, jerky.
Bucket will not tilt back, tilts back Low oil flow from pump Plugged inlet line, clean or replace
slowly, or tilts forward slowly line
Worn or damaged pump Check pump flow, rebuild or re-
place pump as necessary
Valve spool is not in correct posi- Free control linkage, centering
tion, spool binding spring damaged
Bucket solenoid malfunctioning Check solenoid operation
Cylinder rods are bent Rebuild or replace cylinders
Cylinder seals are leaking Rebuild cylinders
Bucket is overloaded Reduce load
Auxiliary hydraulic handle locked in Return handle to neutral
detent position
Bucket cylinder pin will not take Pin drilled incorrectly Replace with new pin
grease
14 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION


Hydraulic system hot Low oil flow from pump Plugged inlet line, clean or replace
line
Main control valve linkage or spool Check and correct linkage
is binding or damaged
Auxiliary boom hydraulic control Lock handle in neutral when not in
not in neutral use
Hydraulic oil cooler restricted Clean oil cooler
Leaking cylinder packing Repair cylinders
Main system relief valve low pres- Check main system pressure
sure
Hydraulic attachment being over- Back off and let system cool down,
used DO NOT operate at or close to relief
pressure
Oil filter indicator light stays on Oil filter clogged Change filter
Incomplete circuit Check the DkGn/O wire and con-
nections
Undersize tubes, hoses, or fittings Replace any undersize tubes,
hoses, or fittings
Filter base Replace if pressure differential
across filter is over 40 PSI
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 15

AUXILIARY BOOM HYDRAULICS TROUBLESHOOTING

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION


No oil flow to quick couplers Broken control linkage Check and repair linkage
Inoperative quick coupler Repair or replace
Plugged supply line Clean or replace
Control valve plugs leaking oil to re- Check O ring and back-up washer
turn on plugs
Inoperative gear pump Check and repair
Control will not hold in detent posi- Loose linkage Repair
tion Misadjusted linkage Repair
Inoperative control valve spool Check and repair
(binding)
Inoperative control valve detent Check and repair
cap
Hydraulic system overheats when Restriction in return line Check and repair
auxiliary hydraulics is in use Inoperative quick coupler Repair or replace
Restriction in attachment Check and repair
Operating at, or close to, relief pres- Operate at lesser loads
sure
Relief pressure too low Check operating pressure
Plugged oil cooler not allowing Clean oil cooler
cooking air to pass through
Hydraulic system overheats when Control handle shifted slightly Return control to neutral and lock
auxiliary hydraulics is not in use Control linkage not adjusted Adjust linkage
properly
Control valve spool binding Check and repair
16 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Adjustments Control Handle Locked, 1, In Neu-


tral
Lock the control handle in Neutral with the L-pin,1.
Adjust the length of rod, 2, by threading the ball joints,
3, on or off, at both ends of the rod to set the link, 4,
vertical. Check adjustment by shifting the hydrostatic
control lever forward and reverse. If the rod length is
set correctly, there should be no movement in the
link, 4, as the rod, 5, moves.
With the control handle locked in neutral and the con-
trol valve spool centered in the neutral position, ad-
just the length of rod, 6, with yoke, 7, to allow the in-
stallation of the yoke pin.
When the skid steer is operated, there should be no
noise in the hydraulic system when in neutral.

7
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 17

HYDRAULIC SYSTEM TESTING


Foot or hand controls and control valve spool locks:

Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “OFF” position

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Foot and/or hand controls, NO System OK
(boom and bucket) YES Check linkage to control valve spools, if OK go to
Controls should not move. next step.
2 Check control valve spools for centering, if OK go to
next step.
3 Check for bent control valve spools, if OK go to next
step.
4 Check spool lockout solenoid operation, if not OK
refer to solenoid testing

Foot or hand controls and control valve spool locks:

Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Foot and/or hand controls, YES System OK
(boom and bucket) NO Check linkage to control valve spools, if OK go to
Controls should move. next step.
2 Check control valve spools for centering, if OK go to
next step.
3 Check for bent control valve spools, if OK go to next
step.
4 Check spool lockout solenoid operation, if not OK
refer to solenoid testing
18 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Foot or hand control and control valve spool lock solenoids:

Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Solenoid YES System OK
Solenoid plunger should move NO Check for battery voltage at solenoid wire connec-
from valve spool. tion, if OK replace solenoid. If not OK go to next
step.
Sit in seat and buckle seat belt in sequence, if not
OK check operation of seat belt buckle. If OK go
to next step.
Check wires from solenoid to EIC board, if OK go
to next step.
Check EIC board operation

Electronic instrument cluster (EIC) hydraulic oil temperature light:

Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Electronic instrument cluster YES System OK
(EIC) NO Check hydraulic oil temperature, if OK go to step
Hydraulic oil temperature light 3. If not OK go to next step.
should be off.
2 Check oil cooler and radiator for restricted air flow.
3 Check oil temperature sender for proper oper-
ation.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 19

Electronic instrument cluster (EIC) hydraulic oil filter light:

Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Electronic instrument cluster YES System OK
(EIC) NO Replace oil filter, if problem still exists go to next
Hydraulic oil filter light should step.
be off.
2 Check filter sender and wires.

Boom operation:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Boom movement YES System OK
Boom should move freely NO Check for binding in boom linkage, if OK go to next
through full range when the step.
foot or hand controls are
moved.
2 Check for bent cylinders, if OK go to next step.
3 Check hydraulic system oil flow and pressure, if OK
go to next step.
4 Check cylinders for internal damage.
5 Boom movement YES System OK
Boom should raise smoothly NO Check for air in the hydraulic system. Check, tighten,
without jerking. or replace suction line and fittings.
Check for air leak in hydrostatic pump case drain line
from the hydrostatic pumps to the suction side of
gear pump.
20 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Boom lift check test:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Boom stopped midrange and YES System OK
restarted, the boom should NO
start raising without dropping Check for a leaking lift check valve, broken spring, or
first. scored plunger and/or seat. If OK go to next step.
2 Check cylinders for leaky packing.
3 Check O ring and backup washer on circuit relief
valve and O ring on front plug in control valve.

Boom drift down test:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Boom stopped midrange YES System OK
should hold in position with no NO
visual movement. Check control valve spool for centering, if OK go to
next step.
2 Check for leaky packing in cylinders, if OK go to next
step.
3 Check boom circuit relief valve, if OK go to next step.
4 Check control valve for leakage.
5 Check O ring and backup washer on circuit relief
valve and O ring on front plug in control valve.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 21

Bucket operation:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Bucket movement YES System OK
Bucket should move freely NO Check for binding in the bucket pivots, if OK go to
through full range when the next step.
foot or hand controls are
moved.
2 Check for bent cylinders, if OK go to next step.
3 Check hydraulic system oil flow and pressure, if OK
go to next step.
4 Check cylinders for internal damage.
5 Boom movement YES System OK
Boom should raise smoothly NO Check for air in the hydraulic system. Check, tighten,
without jerking or replace suction line and fittings.
Check for air leak in hydrostatic pump case drain line
from the hydrostatic pumps to the suction side of
gear pump.

Bucket lift check test:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Bucket stopped midrange and YES System OK
restarted, the bucket should NO
not drop first Check for a leaking lift check valve, broken spring, or
scored plunger and/or seat. If OK go to next step.
2 Check cylinders for leaky packing.
3 Check O ring and backup washer on front and rear
plug in control valve.
22 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Bucket drift down test:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Bucket stopped midrange YES System OK
should hold in position with no NO
visual movement Check control valve spool for centering, if OK go to
next step.
2 Check for leaky packing in cylinders, if OK go to next
step.
3 Check boom circuit relief valve, if OK go to next step.
4 Check control valve for leakage.
5 Check O ring and backup washer on front and rear
plug in control valve.

Spool lock solenoid test:

Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Battery voltage at solenoid YES System OK, go to step 5.
NO
Check seat belt operation, if OK go to next step.
2 Check wires to the solenoid valves for open circuit, if
OK go to next step.
3 Check EIC board operation, if OK go to next step.
4 Check EIC board operation, if not OK refer to
ELECTRICAL SECTION of the SERVICE
MANUAL.
5 Remove solenoid coil and check operation, if OK go
to next step.
6 Check control valve spools for centering, binding,
and binding between solenoid and block, if OK
replace solenoid valve.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 23

4 2 1

3 7
BSC0938B

8
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW
Control Valve - Spools in Neutral Position 6. The oil flows through return line, 7, to oil cooler,
1. Hydraulic oil reservoir, 1, storage for system oil. 8.
2. Oil flows through suction line, 2, from reservoir, 7. Oil passes through the oil cooler, 8, being cooled
1, to gear pump, 3. with the air blast from engine fan through the
cooler.
3. Oil flows from gear pump, 3, through pressure
line, 4, to control valve, 5. 8. Oil flows from the oil cooler, 8, through oil filter, 9,
and back to reservoir, 1.
4. Control valve, 5, is equipped with a system relief
valve, 6.
5. With the control valve spools in neutral position,
the oil flows through center of control valve, 5, to
return line, 7.
24 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

1
BSC0938C

9
CONTROL VALVE - BUCKET SPOOL 1. Oil flows from the gear pump, 1, through pres-
SHIFTED0 sure line, 2, to the control valve, 3.
2. When the bucket valve spool, 4, is pulled out, the
oil flows from the rear work port, 5, to the shaft
Bucket Control Operation
side of the bucket cylinder to curl the bucket
back.
Foot Controls
3. When the bucket valve spool, 4, is pushed in, the
When the toe of the control pedal is pushed down, it
oil flows from the front work port, 6, to the base
will shift the control valve spool in, dumping the
(piston) end of bucket cylinder to dump the buck-
bucket. When the heel of the control pedal is pushed
et.
down, it will shift the control valve spool out, curling
the bucket back. 4. When the bucket circuit is operated to maximum
pressure or cylinders are bottomed, the main
system relief valve will relieve the high pressure
Hand Controls oil into the return oil galley in the control valve, re-
When the right control handle is pivoted up, it will shift turning the oil to the reservoir.
the control valve spool in, dumping the bucket. When 5. The return oil from the opposite side of the cylin-
the right control handle is pivoted down, it will shift the der being pressurized will return through the con-
control valve spool out, curling the bucket back. trol valve to the reservoir.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 25

2 1
BSC0938D

10
CONTROL VALVE - BOOM SPOOL 3. When the boom valve spool, 4, is pushed in, the
SHIFTED oil flows from the front port, 6, to the shaft end of
boom cylinders to lower the boom.
4. When the boom circuit is operated to maximum
Boom Control Operation
pressure or cylinders are bottomed, the main
system relief valve will relieve the high pressure
Foot Controls oil into the return oil galley in the control valve, re-
When the toe of the control pedal is pushed down, it turning the oil to the reservoir.
will shift the control valve spool in, lowering the boom.
5. The return oil from the opposite side of cylinders
When the heel of the control pedal is pushed down,
being pressurized will return through the control
it will shift the control valve spool out, raising the
valve to the reservoir.
boom.
6. When the boom cylinders are extended, the
boom control valve spool is in neutral, and a load
Hand Controls is put on the boom cylinders causing them to re-
When the left control handle is pivoted down, it will tract, the circuit relief valve, 7, will relieve the
shift the control valve spool in, lowering the boom. pressure in the base (piston) side of the cylinders
When the left control handle is pivoted up, it will shift protecting the cylinder and lines. The oil relieved
the control valve spool out, raising the boom. from the circuit relief valve enters the return oil
galley in the control valve and returns to the res-
ervoir.
1. Oil flows from the gear pump, 1, through pres-
sure line, 2, to control valve, 3. 7. When the boom valve spool, 4, is pushed in all
the way, it will put the spool into detent position,
2. When the boom valve spool, 4, is pulled out, the
opening both work ports 5 and 6 to the return oil
oil flows from the rear work port, 5, to the base
galley, allowing the boom to float.
(piston) end of the boom cylinder raising the
boom.
26 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

9 3
BSC0938E

11
CONTROL VALVE - AUXILIARY SPOOL plies oil to the female quick coupler, 6, at the front
SHIFTED of the boom.
3. When the auxiliary valve spool, 4, is pushed in,
the oil flows from the front work port, 7, and sup-
Auxiliary Control Operation
plies oil to the male quick coupler, 8, at the front
of the boom.
Hand Controls
4. When the auxiliary circuit is operated to maxi-
When the right control handle is pivoted down, it will
mum pressure, the main system relief valve will
shift the control valve spool in, supplying oil to the
relieve the high pressure oil into the return oil gal-
male quick coupler. When the right control handle is
ley in the control valve, returning the oil to the res-
pivoted up, it will shift the control valve spool out,
ervoir.
supplying oil to the female quick coupler.
5. The return oil from the opposite quick coupler be-
ing pressurized will return through the control
Foot Control valve to the reservoir.
When the toe of the control pedal is pushed down, it NOTE: The return oil from the quick couplers must be
will shift the control valve spool in, supplying oil to the returned through the normal return line, 9, to
male quick coupler. When the heel of the control replenish the hydrostatic system; hydrostatic charge
pedal is pushed down, it will shift the control valve oil is required for lubrication of the hydrostatic pumps
spool out, supplying oil to the female quick coupler. and motors.

1. Oil flows from the gear pump, 1, through pres- 6. When the auxiliary valve spool, 4, is pushed in all
sure line, 2, to control valve, 3. the way, it will put the spool into detent position,
2. When the auxiliary valve spool, 4, is pulled out, holding the spool for continuous oil flow to the
the oil flows from the rear work port, 5, and sup- male quick coupler.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 27

3 2
BSC0938F

12
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW When the selector is Off, the oil is directed to the
control valve return line, 3.
High Flow - Selector Off When using the high flow, always use the 3/4″
The high flow gear pump, 1, supplies the high flow oil couplers to prevent high back pressure and
to the control valve block through the selector, 2. overheating of the hydraulic system.
28 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

3 2
BSC0938G

13
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW When the selector is On, the high flow oil is directed
to the control valve, 3.
High Flow - Selector On When using high flow, always use the 3/4″ couplers
The high flow gear pump, 1, supplies high flow oil to to prevent high back pressure and overheating of the
the control valve block through the selector, 2. hydraulic system.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 29

Op. 35 710 02

MAIN SYSTEM PRESSURE TESTS


Check the main system pressure to ensure the main
1
relief valve is within specifications and providing ad-
equate working pressure to the hydraulic system.
The main system pressure can be checked at the
base end of the boom cylinders at 1.

14
The main system pressure can also be checked at
the base end of the left bucket cylinder at 1 or at the
auxiliary boom hydraulic quick couplers, 2, if
equipped.

15
To check main system pressure at the boom cylin-
ders, the boom must be up and resting on the boom
lockpins, 1.

16
30 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

The hydraulic system pressures are factory set.


Changes to the settings should not be necessary.
To access the control and relief valve area, remove
the step shield, 1.

17
Raise the seat and seat pan to the raised latched
position, 1. Be sure the seat support rod is latched se-
curely at 2, before working under a raised seat.
CAUTION
Do not work under raised seat unless securely
latched in the raised position.

18
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 31

The main system relief valve, 1, is located in the con-


trol valve. If there is some reason to suspect incorrect
pressure, check the pressures as follows:
WARNING 1
Gauges, gauge fittings, and hoses must have operat-
ing pressure ratings of at least 25% higher than the
highest pressures of the system.
Never adjust or replace the relief valves to get higher
pressures than those specified by the equipment
manufacturer.
Fluid under pressure can have sufficient force to pen-
etrate the skin, causing serious personal injury. Al- 19997742
ways protect the skin and eyes from escaping fluid
under pressure. 19
Before disconnecting lines or fittings, be sure to turn
off the skid steer engine and relieve all pressure. Be-
fore applying pressure to the system, be sure all con-
nections are tight and that lines, pipes, and hoses are
not damaged.
If injured by escaping fluid, obtain medical assist-
ance at once. Serious infection or reaction can devel-
op if medical treatment is not administered immedi-
ately.
Remove any attachment from the mounting plate be-
fore loosening or disconnecting any hydraulic lines.
32 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

CHECKING MAIN SYSTEM PRESSURE AT


BOOM CYLINDERS
NOTE: Before performing any hydraulic test, operate
the skid steer to get the hydraulic oil to operating tem-
perature (about 55 C [100 F] above ambient tem-
perature).
Fittings and gauge required:
1. 238 bar (3500 PSI) gauge (minimum)
2. 3/4″ - 16 UNF O ring fitting
Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom, extend the boom lockpins, 1,
and lower the boom down on the lockpins.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position, and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the cylinders.
Turn off the key.

20
3. Install the pressure test gauge in the boom cylin-
der at 1.
1
4. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
5. Operate the boom control to raise the boom to
the fully raised position until the system by-
passes and take a pressure reading. Lower the
boom down to the boom lockpins and relieve
pressure in the system.
6. The pressure should be from 177 - 190 bar (2600
- 2800 PSI) when the hydraulic oil is at operating
temperature.

21
7. The relief valve is a cartridge type and is not ad-
justable. Replace the relief valve cartridge, 1, if
the pressure is not within specifications.
CAUTION 1
Do not attempt to change the pressure setting or alter
the pressure to a higher setting as the hydraulic com-
ponents, hoses, tubes, and cylinders may be dam-
aged and could cause injury.

19997742
22
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 33

CHECKING MAIN SYSTEM PRESSURE AT


BUCKET CYLINDERS
Fittings and gauge required:
1. 238 bar (3500 PSI) gauge (minimum)
2. 3/4″ - 16 UNF O ring fitting
Test Procedure
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the cylinders.
Turn off the key.

23
3. Install the pressure test gauge in the left bucket
cylinder at 1.
4. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
5. Operate the bucket control to dump the bucket to
the fully dumped position until the system by-
passes and take a pressure reading. Curl the
bucket back to relieve pressure in the system.
6. The pressure should be from 177 - 190 bar (2600
- 2800 PSI) when the hydraulic oil is at operating
temperature.

24
7. The relief valve is a cartridge type and is not ad-
justable. Replace the relief valve cartridge, 1, if
the pressure is not within specifications.
CAUTION 1
Do not attempt to change the pressure setting or alter
the pressure to a higher setting as the hydraulic com-
ponents, hoses, tubes, and cylinders may be dam-
aged and could cause injury.

19997742
25
34 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

CHECKING MAIN SYSTEM PRESSURE AT


AUXILIARY BOOM HYDRAULIC QUICK
COUPLERS
Fittings and gauge required:
1. 238 bar (3500 PSI) gauge (minimum)
2. 1/2″ quick coupler fitting
Test Procedure
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom, bucket, and aux-
iliary controls to relieve pressure in the systems.
Turn off the key.

26
3. Install the pressure test gauge in one of the quick
couplers at 1.
4. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
5. Operate the auxiliary control to pressurize the
auxiliary circuit until the system bypasses and
take a pressure reading. Move the control handle
in the opposite direction to relieve pressure in the
system.
NOTE: Pivoting the control handle down supplies oil
to the male quick coupler.
6. The pressure should be from 177 - 190 bar (2600
- 2800 PSI) when the hydraulic oil is at operating
temperature. 27
7. The relief valve is a cartridge type and is not ad-
justable. Replace the relief valve cartridge, 1, if
the pressure is not within specifications.
CAUTION 1
Do not attempt to change the pressure setting or alter
the pressure to a higher setting as the hydraulic com-
ponents, hoses, tubes, and cylinders may be dam-
aged and could cause injury.

19997742
28
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 35

BOOM CIRCUIT RELIEF VALVE TEST


The boom circuit is equipped with a circuit relief
valve, 1, located in the boom control valve. This valve
will protect the cylinders and lines when the control
valve spool is in the neutral (centered) position.
Fittings and gauge required:
1. 340 bar (5000 PSI) gauge (minimum)
2. 3/4″ - 16 UNF O ring fitting
3. Hydraulic hand pump
NOTE: The relief valve is factory set at 241 3 bar
(3500  50 PSI). The boom circuit relief valve is not
adjustable. All replacement valves are set at 3500
PSI.
29
Test Procedure
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground.
2. Stop engine, turn ignition key to the run position
and operate the boom and bucket control pedals
to relieve pressure in the cylinders. Turn off the
key.

30
3. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the control
valve and circuit relief valve area.

31
36 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

4. Place the boom control valve spool in the neutral


(centered) position.
5. Disconnect the tee fitting, 1, from the control
valve elbow, 2. Loosen the tee fitting at the side
tubes, and rotate the tee fitting upward. Loosen
the elbow, 2, and rotate counterclockwise ap-
proximately 45°.
6. Connect a hand pump and pressure gauge, 3, to
the elbow, 2, and build pressure against the cir-
cuit relief valve. Monitor the pressure gauge to
read the pressure at the point where the relief
valve starts to open.

CAUTION 32
Do not increase pressure over 3800 PSI. If the relief
valve does not open when pressure reaches 3600
PSI, discontinue the test and replace the valve.

7. If there is an operational complaint and the boom


circuit relief valve releases pressure under 235
bar (3400 PSI), replace the valve, 1. If the valve
does not release pressure by 248 bar (3600 PSI),
also replace the valve. All replacement boom cir-
cuit relief valves are set at 241 bar (3500 PSI)
and are not adjustable.

33
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 37

GEAR PUMP FLOW EFFICIENCY TEST


Fittings and gauges required:
1. Hydraulic flow tester (30 GPM capacity).
2. Male and female 1/2″ quick couplers for units
equipped with auxiliary boom hydraulics.
3. Two male 3/4″ UNF 37° flare to tester fittings for
units without auxiliary boom hydraulics.

Test Procedure
Gear pump flow test on units equipped with auxiliary
boom hydraulics.
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion, resting on the ground.
2. Stop engine, turn ignition key to the run position
and operate the boom and bucket control pedals
to relieve pressure in the cylinders. Turn off the
key.
3. Attach the pressure (inlet) hose from the flow
tester with the female quick coupler to the male
half on the skid steer at 1.
4. Attach the return (outlet) hose from the flow
tester with the male coupler to the female half on
the skid steer at 2.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the flow tester is connected
into the hydraulic system properly for proper oil flow
through the tester to prevent damage to the hydraulic
test equipment or hydraulic system.

CAUTION
Never position tester between the gear pump and
control valve as the system relief valve will be out of 34
the test circuit, and pump over pressure may cause
a pump failure by splitting the center section or twist-
ing off the input shaft.

5. Turn the resistance valve on tester to “O” setting.


6. Start the engine and run it at full throttle
(2175 RPM - 2275 RPM).
7. Operate the auxiliary control handle by pivoting
down to pressurize the male quick coupler and
inlet hose to tester.
8. Take a free flow and pressure reading and record
it. The flow at this time is oil flow through the hy-
draulic system and the pressure reading at this
point is force required to pump the oil through the
system. The pressure is called back pressure.

35
38 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

9. Turn the resistance valve on the tester to apply


resistance in the hydraulic system to obtain the
following specifications:
2225 RPM (engine)
68 bar (1000 PSI) - 17.6 US. GPM (63.2 LPM)
If the gear pump flow in step 9 is not within 80% of the
pump flow in step 8, remove and repair or replace the
pump.
Example:
17.0 GPM free flow Step 8.
12.7 GPM flow Step 9.
80% of 17 GPM = 13.6 GPM
The pump is not within 80% of free flow. Repair or re- 36
place pump.
NOTE: The oil must be at operating temperature be-
fore any hydraulic testing.
If the pressure cannot be obtained, replace the main
system relief valve.
Test Procedure
Gear pump flow test with units NOT equipped with
auxiliary boom hydraulics.
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion, resting on the ground.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the cylinders.
Turn off the key.
3. Unhook line, 1, from the base end of the bucket
cylinder, cap cylinder port.
4. Attach the pressure (inlet) hose from the flow
tester to line, 1, with 3/4″ UNF 37° flare fitting to
37
tester.
5. Unhook line, 2, and cap the hose fitting.
6. Attach the return (outlet) hose from the flow to
line, 2, with 3/4″ UNF 37° flare fitting to tester.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the flow tester is connected
into the hydraulic system properly for proper oil flow
through the tester to prevent damage to the hydraulic
test equipment or hydraulic system. Refer to the test
equipment manufacturer’s Operator’s Manual.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 39

7. Turn the resistance valve, 1, on the tester to “O”


setting.
8. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
9. Operate the bucket control to dump the bucket
for proper oil flow to the inlet hose and tester.
10. Take a free flow and pressure reading and record
it. The flow at this time is oil flow through the hy-
draulic system and the pressure reading at this
point is force required to pump the oil through the
system. The pressure is called back pressure.
11. Turn the resistance valve on the tester to apply
resistance in the hydraulic system to obtain the
following specifications: 38
2225 RPM (engine)
68 bar (1000 PSI) - 17.6 US. GPM (63.2 LPM)
If the gear pump flow in step 9 is not within 80% of the
pump flow in step 10, remove and repair or replace
the pump.
Example:
17.0 GPM free flow Step 8.
12.7 GPM flow Step 9.
80% of 17.0 GPM = 13.6 GPM
The pump is not within 80% of free flow. Repair or re-
place pump.
NOTE: The oil must be at operating temperature be-
fore any hydraulic testing.
If the pressure cannot be obtained, replace the main
system relief valve.
40 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

BOOM AND BUCKET SPOOL LOCK SOLE-


NOID TEST
The boom and bucket control valve solenoid spool
locks are controlled by the EIC (Electronic Instru-
ment Cluster). The operator must be in the operator’s
seat with the seat belt buckled for the EIC to unlock
the control valve spool lock solenoids.
Operational check procedure:
1. Service/Run switch, 1, in “RUN” position.
2. Sit in seat.
3. Turn ignition key switch, 2, to the “ON” position.
4. Attempt to move boom and bucket foot or hand 2
controls. The controls should not move the con-
trol valve spools from the neutral position.
5. Fasten the seat belt. 1
6. Attempt to move boom and bucket foot or hand
controls. The controls should move the control
valve spools from the neutral position.
NOTE: If the EIC shows an FOA fault in the readout 19997741
display, this is an indication of a shorted/open circuit 39
to the solenoid locks.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 41

Electrical test procedure:


1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground or
rest the boom on the boom lock pins, 1; remove
attachment if on boom locks.

40
2. Raise the seat, 1, and latch securely in the raised
latch position, 2. Remove the step shield, 3, from
over the control valve to access the solenoid
locks.

41
3. Unplug one solenoid, 1, at a time and check for
battery voltage at the main wire harness plugs, 1 1
pink/light-blue and black wires. The operator
must be in the seat with the seat belt buckled and
the ignition key in the “ON” position.
NOTE: If both solenoids are unplugged, the EIC will
show an FOA fault and there will be no voltage from
the EIC to the solenoids.
4. If there is battery voltage at the solenoids, re-
move the coils and check their operation. If the
plunger moves in when power is applied, check
for binding when the coil is threaded into the
body. Check for spool centering to allow the coil 19997742
plunger to seat into the groove in the spool. 42
DANGER
If the lockout solenoids are loosened or removed
from the control valve body, the pedal(s) are no
longer locked. Pedal or hand control movement will
result in spool movement and boom/bucket move-
ment.
42 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

HYDRAULIC, HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM AIR


INGRESS TEST
Hydraulic system air ingress, causing oil aeration,
can affect performance of the hydraulic oil. This may
be evident on a machine by jerky or uneven move-
ment of the skid steer boom or bucket.
To assist in testing and finding leaks, a tool has been
developed (part #FNH22ESS95). This tool com-
prises of a cap which replaces the reservoir filler
breather for testing purposes, a pressure gauge and
a relief valve. The cap has fittings for air pressure to
be applied to the hydraulic reservoir.
CAUTION
Do not start the engine with the test tool installed, as
the hydraulic system must be able to breathe.

Test Procedure:
1. Remove the filler/breather cap.
2. Remove the self-tapping screws around the cap
base and screen assembly.
3. Remove the base, screen and gasket assembly.
Clean all sealing surfaces.
4. Re-install new gaskets and base, taking care not
to overtighten the screws.
5. Make sure the tank has 10W-30 oil visible.
6. Pressurize the tank using an air pressure line.
The tool is equipped with a 3 PSI relief valve and
a pressure gauge. The reservoir should not be
pressurized beyond 4 PSI.
The following checks should then be performed to
trace the source of the air ingress.
• Examine the suction tubes and fittings to the hy-
draulic gear pump and the return tubes from the
filter to the reservoir.
• Examine the transmission case drain tubes/
hoses and fittings from the hydraulic motors and
pumps to the suction side of the hydraulic pump.
Also check the cam plate shaft seals and the
pump and motor casing gaskets.
• Potential leakage areas could also be input shaft
seals in the engine bell housing, gearbox or out-
put shaft seals in motors and gearboxes and the
chain case.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 43

• It may be necessary in some instances (where


leakage is occurring on shaft seals into gear-
boxes or bell housing) to pressurize the reservoir
for 2 to 4 hours and monitor the oil level in the
gearboxes.
• If the prior checks do not locate the source of the
leak, it may be necessary to pressurize each hy-
drostatic component individually.
To do this it will be necessary to disconnect each
case drain line in turn and pressurize using an air
line to a maximum pressure of 10 PSI.
NOTE: A check valve can be installed in the case
drain tube which maintains a 5 PSI pressure in the
pump and motor cases. This helps prevent air in- 43
gress into the system.
44 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

CONTROL VALVE
Specifications

Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-spool open center

Relief Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 - 177 bar (2500 - 2600 PSI)


Nonadjustable

Circuit Relief (boom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 bar (3500 PSI)

Electrical Solenoid Spool Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bucket and Boom

Torque Specifications

Control Valve Retaining Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 N·m (18 ft. lbs.)

Control Valve Plugs (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

Control Valve Plugs (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 N·m (23 ft. lbs.)

Circuit Relief Valve (boom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

Spool Lock Solenoids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 N·m (11 ft. lbs.)

Main System Relief Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 N·m (38 ft. lbs.)

Spool Cap Assembly Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 N·m (12 ft. lbs.)

Plugs, BYD Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)


SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 45

CONTROL VALVE
Op. 35 724 50
REMOVAL
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1. Roll the attachment plate to
the fully “DUMPED” position.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key.
44
3. Raise the seat and seat pan to the raised latched
position, 1.
4. Remove the step shield, 2, to access the gear
pump area. For more access, remove the right or
left hydrostatic control handle assembly, 3 or 4.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised latched position.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev- 45
ing all pressure in the system.

Draining the hydraulic oil reservoir is not required


if the suction and return lines are capped to pre-
vent loss of oil. Drain the reservoir when the hy-
draulic system requires cleaning.
5. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.

46
46 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

6. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting


the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.

47
7. Unplug the spool lock solenoids, 1.
8. Remove the pressure line, 2, and return line, 3;
cap both lines to prevent loss of oil and conta- 4
mination from entering the hydraulic system. 2 3
9. Remove the hydraulic lines connected to the
work ports of the control valve, 4, four or six lines, 7 5
if unit is equipped with auxiliary boom hydraulics
and cap. 7
10. Remove the line from the power beyond port, 5,
if equipped with auxiliary hydraulics and cap. 1
1
11. Unhook the control linkage from the control valve
spools at 6. 6 6
19984464
12. Remove the control valve retaining hardware, 7.
48
Lift the control valve assembly from the skid
steer.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 47

Op. 35 724 54
DISASSEMBLY AND INSPECTION

Main System Relief Valve


The non-serviceable, non-adjustable, cartridge- type
main system relief valve, 1, is set at 170 - 177 bar
(2500 - 2600 PSI). The relief valve should not be re-
placed with a valve of a higher pressure setting, as
structural damage to the boom and/or main frame or
internal damage to hydraulic system may occur. 1
CAUTION
Component failure from high hydraulic pressure 19984465
could result in injury. 49

Lift Check Valves


There is a check valve in each circuit - bucket, boom,
and auxiliary.
The only time the check valves serve a function is
after the control spools have been shifted. If the
valves are operating properly, they prevent any
movement of either the boom or bucket until pres-
sure opens the lift checks.
Inspect the lift check components for damage to the 2 3
seat, 1, spring, 2, or cap, 3. 1

19984466
50
Op. 35 724 90
Spool Locks (Boom and Bucket)
Remove the solenoid plunger assemblies, 1, from
the ports, 2, over the control spool ends.
2

1
19984467
51
48 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Remove the boom circuit relief valve, 1, from the


valve body.
NOTE: The boom circuit relief valve protects the lift
circuit against high pressure related damage caused
by external forces acting against the boom. The
valve is factory set at 241 bar (3500 PSI), is non ad-
justable, and must be replaced if malfunctioning.
Remove the plugs, 2, over the bucket and auxiliary
spool caps.

2
2 1
19984468
52
Remove the plug, 1, from the port, 2, over the main
relief valve port. Remove the plug, 3, from the port,
4, over the auxiliary control spool.

2 4

3
19984469
53
Spools, Caps, and O Rings
Oil is directed through the housing to the different 4
ports by way of the spools: the bucket spool, 1, the 1
boom spool, 2, and the auxiliary spool, 3.
Some oil circulates around the spools for lubrication
and smooth operation. If an oil leak appears on the
outside of the valve and all lines connected to the
ports are tight, check the O rings on each end of the
spools. The spools can be pulled from the control
valve housing while the valve is still in the skid steer 2
by disconnecting the control linkage and removing
5
3
the spool caps.
19984470
CAUTION
If removing spool caps on the tractor, make sure all 54
system pressure has been relieved first.

Notice that the bucket spool has a plain cap, 4. The


boom spool and auxiliary spools have detent caps, 5,
to hold the spools in position for float position boom
circuit or continuous flow auxiliary circuit operation.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 49

1. Thoroughly clean the control valve and unscrew


the allen head capscrews, 1, on the caps.
2. Remove the caps, 2, from the rear of the valve
body. 2

1
19984471
55
NOTE: Before removing the spools, make sure the
exposed portion of the spool is free from any paint or
corrosion which could damage the internal porting of
the valve.
3. Remove the spools, 1, from the valve body.
NOTE: Each spool is different. Make sure to replace
the correct spool in the correct part of the valve body.

19984472
1
56
4. Remove the O rings, 1, from the spool ports. In-
spect the O ring seating area for burrs, and re-
move them before installing new O rings.

1
19984473
57
50 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

5. The complete control valve components include:


1. Main system relief valve
2. Boom circuit relief valve
3. Plugs
1
4. Caps 3 3
5 6
5. Plain control spool cap
6. Detent control spool caps 7
7. Centering springs and hardware
7
8. Bucket control spool
9. Boom control spool
10. Auxiliary control spool
11. Lift check, springs, and caps 11
12. Bucket and boom solenoids
13. Boom lower circuit orifice plate

4 13
3 8 9
3 10
12
2

19984474
58
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 51

PARTS INSPECTION
Inspect the control valve components thoroughly for 2
scratches or nicks, weak centering springs, weak lift 1
check springs, and scored lift checks or valve seats. 3
Valve Body, 1
1. Check for cracks in casting that allow an oil leak.
2. Check the lift check seats, 2.
3. Check O ring seating surfaces.
4. Damaged fitting thread areas.
Control Spools, 3
1. Check the spool lands for scratches.
19984475
2. Check spool straightness.
59
IMPORTANT: The spools are matched to the control
valve body. If excessively worn or damaged, replace
the control valve assembly.
NOTE: The three spools are different. Do not mix
spools and return spring assemblies during reas-
sembly.
Detent Caps, 1
1. Check the detent pins and springs for proper 1
operation. All pins should move freely and return
to position with spring pressure. 2
2. Clean the caps thoroughly and lubricate the pins
with a light grease.
Lift Checks, 2 3
1. Check the lift check seat surface for wear or
4
scratches.
2. Check the lift check springs, 3.
3. Check the caps to ensure free movement of lift
checks into the caps. 19984472
Orifice Plate, 4 (Boom Lower Circuit) 60
1. Check the flat surface for scratches.
2. Check the hole in the plate for dirt and clean.
Solenoid Spool Locks
1. Check solenoid operation
52 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

REASSEMBLY
1. Install O rings, 1, in the boom control spool ports,
the bucket control spool ports, and auxiliary con-
trol spool ports.

1
19984473
61
2. Install the O ring seals, 1, on the boom circuit re-
lief valve, 2, and all the plugs, 3.
3. Install small O rings, 4, and backup rings, 5, on
the relief valve and plugs.

62
4. Install the boom circuit relief valve, 1, into the
valve body.
5. Install the plugs, 2, over the bucket and auxiliary
spool caps.

2
2
19984468
1
63
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 53

6. Install the plug, 1, into the port, 2, over the main


relief valve port. Install the plug, 3, into the port,
4, over the auxiliary control spool.

2 4

3
19984469
64
7. Install new O rings, 1, on the spools.
8. Install the washers, 2, spring retaining plate with
small hole, 3, centering spring, 4, spring plate
with large hole, 5, and end screw, 6, on each
spool.

65
NOTE: The spring retaining plate with the small hole
must go next to the valve. The plate with the large
hole, 5, must be over the end pin, 6, for proper spool.
9. Tighten the end screw, 6, securely.

66
54 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

10. Install the control spools into the valve body -


bucket, 1, boom, 2, auxiliary, 3. 5 4
11. Reinstall the boom lower orifice plate, 4, with the
slot towards the fitting in port, 5.
NOTE: The three spools are different. Do not mix
spools and return spring assemblies during reas-
sembly.

1 2 3
19984472
67
12. Install the plain cap, 1, over the bucket control
spool and the detent caps, 2, over the boom and 1
auxiliary control spools. Tighten the allen head
screws, 3, securely.
NOTE: If any spool binds in the housing, rotate the
spool 180_ and check it. If the spool still binds, check
the end caps for proper alignment. If a spool still
binds, the complete control valve must be replaced.
NOTE: On the tractor, binding can be caused by
mounting hardware that is too tight (valve to main 2
frame).
3
19984470
68
13. Install the solenoid plunger assemblies, 1, into
the ports, 2, over the control spool ends.

19984467
1
69
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 55

14. Add O rings to the lift check valve caps, 1. Install


the lift checks, 2, springs, 3, and caps.
15. Install the two caps, 4, with O rings into the valve
body.

2 3 1

19984466
70
16. Install an O ring on the main system relief valve,
1, and install into the valve body.

19984465
71
56 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

REINSTALLATION
1. Place the rubber isolation mount, 1, in place
under the control valve space.
2. Reinstall the control valve into the skid steer with
the retaining hardware previously removed. 2
Align the valve with the control linkage and
torque the valve retaining hardware to 24 N·m
(18 ft. lbs.). 1
3. Reconnect the control linkage and wiring har-
ness to the lockout solenoids.
4. Reinstall orifice plate with the flat surface to-
wards valve body and the slotted side towards
19984464
the fitting in the rear boom port at 2.
72
5. Reinstall the hydraulic lines and tighten to seat
the fittings, then loosen the lines and retorque.
6. Refill the hydraulic reservoir with 10W-30 oil.
7. With the unit supported off the ground, start the
unit and check for any oil leaks and repair.
8. Reinstall the step shield and belly pan.
9. Recheck the hydraulic oil level and add as re-
quired.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 57

HYDRAULIC PUMP
Specifications 26000 Series
SL65B
Type Gear Pump
Output @2225 RPM - 17.6 US. GPM
69 bar (1000 PSI) (63.2 L/min)
Rotation (Viewed from shaft end) Clockwise
Gear teeth 13 per gear
Wear plate Black, powdered metal with Te-
flon coating
Bushings Teflon coated
Internal lubrication system Inlet (suction) side
58 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 35 710 10
PUMP REMOVAL
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key.
3. Raise the seat and seat pan, 1, to the raised
latched position, 2.
4. Remove the step shield, 3, to access the gear 73
pump area. For more access remove the right or
left hydrostatic control handle assembly.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised latched position.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system.

Draining the hydraulic oil reservoir is not required


if the suction and return lines are capped to pre-
vent loss of oil. Drain the reservoir when the hy-
draulic system requires cleaning.
5. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.

74
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 59

6. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting


the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.

75
7. Disconnect the hydrostatic high pressure hoses
at 1 and 2, and cap.

76
8. Remove suction line, 1, from the hydraulic reser-
voir, and cap to prevent oil loss.
9. Remove pressure line, 2, to the control valve,
and cap.
10. Disconnect the motor case drain line, 3, the two-
speed control valve return line, 4, and the pump
case drain tube, 5, and cap.
11. Remove the gear pump retaining hardware, 6,
and remove the gear pump from the skid steer.

77
60 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 35 710 20
DISASSEMBLY
Identify the pump by the two series of numbers and
letters on the pump flange at 1.
26 = Series
0 = Features 0-Standard Single Gear Pump 1
08 = Displacement Code
L = Rotation (left, counterclockwise)
A = Catalog No.
A = Shaft, Port, Type, and Size
B = Revision Level
96 = Year Built 80
06 = Month Built
17 = Day Built
LJ = Tester

NOTE: On any warranty work or requests for in-


formation about gear pumps, please list these two
lines of information.
Clean the pump thoroughly and mark the pump as-
sembly, 1, to ensure proper reassembly.
Remove the pump housing hardware and separate
the end plates and body section.
IMPORTANT: The pump body is aluminum and can
be easily damaged. BE CAREFUL not to damage
machined surfaces. DO NOT use a screwdriver or
other hard, sharp objects to pry the pump from the
plate.

81
The 26000 gear pump consists of the following com-
ponents:
1. Capscrews
2. Pump front plate (drive end)
3. Pump body
4. Pump back plate
5. End cap O ring seals (2)
6. Pump idler gear assembly
7. Pump drive gear assembly
8. Wear plate
9. Backup gasket
10. Seal

82
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 61

PARTS INSPECTION
1. Inspect the pump front plate (drive end) for ex- 3
cessive wear. The oil grooves in the bushings in 1
the front plate should be in line with the dowel pin-
holes and 180 apart, 1. If the bushing oil
grooves are not positioned as noted, the bush-
ings have turned in the plate - the plate should be 3
replaced. 2
The bushings in the front plate should be at 3.20
mm (0.126) above the surface of the plate, 2. 4
Replace the front plate if the I.D. of the bushing
exceed 19.2 mm (0.755).
3
2. Check the seal areas, 3, for scratches or damage
that could prevent a good seal. 83
3. The plug, 4, does not have to be removed unless
damaged. The plug can be removed by thread-
ing a 3/8″ UNC bolt into the plug center. This plug
MUST be in place for proper pump operation.
4. Inspect the pump back plate for excessive wear.
The oil grooves in the back plate bushings should
be at approximately 37 to the pressure side, 1.
If the bushing oil grooves are not positioned as
noted, the bushings have turned in the plate, and
the plate should be replaced.
Replace the back plate if the I.D. of a bushing ex-
ceeds 19.2 mm (0.755″). Check for scoring on
the face of the back plate, 2. Replace the back
plate if wear exceeds 0.038 mm (0.0015″).

84
5. Inspect the pump body for excessive wear.
Check the pump body inside the gear pockets, 1,
for excessive scoring or wear.
Replace the pump body if the I.D. of gear pockets
exceed 43.7 mm (1.719″).

85
62 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

6. The wear plate, 1, should be replaced when the


pump is rebuilt. The flat Teflon-coated surface to- 2 1
3
wards the gears should not show any scratches
or grooves that can be caught with a fingernail.
7. The wear plate, 1, has a backup gasket, 2, and
a seal, 3, that should be replaced when the pump
is rebuilt. Inspect for damage, such as nicks and
tears, to determine if any problem exists.

19984487
86
8. Inspect the pump gears for excessive wear.
Check for obvious twisted or broken shaft 4 2
splines, 1, on the drive gear. Replace if damage
is found. Inspect the gear keys and retaining
rings, 2, to ensure they are not sheared. Replace
if found twisted or sheared.
The gear shaft assemblies should measure
greater than or equal to 19.0 mm (0.748″) in the 2 1
bushing area, 3. If the shaft measures less then
3
the specified diameter, replace the gear assem- 3
bly.
The gear width, 4, should be close to the follow-
ing specs. If the gears measure less than the 19984488
specified width, the gear pump will not develop 87
sufficient flow or pressure for loader application.

Part # Eaton Model # Gear Width


86528338 26005-RAQ 16.15 mm
(0.636″)
86528339 26007-RAA 22.56 mm
(0.888″)
86528340 26008-RAA 25.76 mm
(1.014″)
86528341 26008-LAA 25.76 mm
(1.014″)

NOTE: If replacement of the gear assemblies is


necessary, the gear assemblies should be replaced
in pairs.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 63

REASSEMBLY
1. Coat all parts with a thin coat of petroleum jelly or
oil to aid in reassembly.
2. Install a new washer, 1, and shaft seal, 2, in the 1 2
pump front plate (drive end), 3. The seal is
pressed into the housing to a depth of 6.35 mm
(0.25) from the outer seal housing lip.
NOTE: Once the seal is installed, make sure that the
washer can rotate freely. If the washer cannot rotate,
reinstall the seal to a lesser depth to obtain freedom
of movement for the washer. 3
19984489
89
3. Install new O rings, 1, in the pump front and back
plates. Ensure that the plug, 2, is installed on the
1
pressure side of the pump front plate (drive end),
3.

2 3
19984490

90
4. Make sure the dowel pins, 1, are in place and in-
stall the body on the pump front plate (drive end) 1
with the half-moon cavities in the body facing
away from the pump front plate. Check that the
reference marks made during disassembly align
correctly.
NOTE: The small half-moon cavity, 2, must be on the
pressure side (plugged side) of the pump. 2

1
19984491
91
64 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

5. Install the seal, 1, and backup gasket 2, on the


wear plate, 3. BE SURE that the flat area, 4, on 3
1 2
the gasket AND seal, 5, are properly aligned and
lay flat when installed in the wear plate.

5 4

19984487

92
NOTE: The gasket AND seal must align and lay flat
at 4 when installed in the wear plate.

93
6. Install the wear plate assembly, 1, with the
gasket/seal side towards the pump front plate,
into the body cavity with the mid section cut away 1
on the suction side (large half moon cavity), 2, of
the pump.
NOTE: To best accomplish the installation of the
wear plate, hold the pump body/front plate assembly
upside down while sliding the wear plate assembly
up into the housing until it is seated against the front
plate. This helps ensure that the seal and backup
gasket stay in place.
2
19984492

94
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 65

7. Install the drive gear, 1, into the housing, 2. Install


the idler gear, 3, into the housing. Rotate the 2
gears to help slide them into the gear pockets.

19984493

95
8. Install the pump back plate, 1, over the gear
shafts. Check that the reference marks made
during disassembly align correctly.

96
9. Install the housing hardware with the four bolts
with sealing washers, 1, on the inside bolt holes,
2, with the remaining bolts installed in outside
holes, 3. Torque the bolts evenly in a criss-cross
pattern to 34 - 38 N·m (25 - 28 ft. lbs.).
3

2 1

19984494

97
66 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O ring, 1, on the gear pump pilot, 2.
For SL65B skid steers, install the gear pump onto 1
the hydrostatic pump, mating the splines on the
input shaft. Tighten the mounting hardware to 39 2
N⋅m (29 ft. lbs.).

19987701
98
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 67

7. Connect hydraulic lines, 2, pressure line, 3, and


suction line, 4. Make sure that when lines are
tightened they are positioned to prevent contact
with other components. 4 2
NOTE: Make sure all hoses are tightly clamped to fit-
tings where clamps are used. Make sure all fittings
are properly seated and tight. Loose fittings on suc- 1
tion hoses can cause oil aeration. Loose pressure
lines will cause an external oil leak.

2
3
104
8. Connect hydrostatic lines, 1 and 2, previously re-
moved for pump access.

105
9. Reconnect hydraulic line, 1, previously removed
to drain the reservoir.
10. Fill the reservoir with SAE 10W-30 oil to the
proper level.
11. Reinstall the hydrostatic control lever assem-
blies, if removed, and install the step shield.

106
68 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Gear Pump Start-up Procedure


This procedure must be performed if the gear pump
has been removed for repair purposes or any gear
pump hydraulic lines have been removed.
1. Fill the reservoir with SAE 10W-30 oil to the
proper level.
2. Loosen suction line, 1, at the gear pump. When
oil flows from the connection, tighten the connec-
tion.
3. Start the engine and run it at 1500 RPM. Operate
all hydraulic controls to remove remaining air
from the system.
4. Check reservoir level and add oil as necessary.
107
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 69

CYLINDERS, BOOM AND BUCKET


BOOM CYLINDERS - SL65B
Specifications

Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63.5 mm (2.5″)

Stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 611 mm (24.06″)

Rod Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38.1 mm (1.5″)

Cycle Times (seconds)


Raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6
Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5

Torque

Piston Locknut Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 N·m (170 ft. lbs.)

Cylinder Head (gland) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 N·m (225 ft. lbs.)

Lower Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338 N·m (250 ft. lbs.)

Upper Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

BUCKET CYLINDERS - SL65B


Specifications

Bore Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63.5 mm (2.5″ )

Stroke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447 mm (17.6″)

Rod Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31.8 mm (1.25″)

Cycle Times (seconds)


Curl Back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8
Curl Down (dump) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4

Torque

Piston Cap Screw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 N·m (225 ft. lbs.)

Cylinder Head (gland) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 N·m (225 ft. lbs.)

Lower Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 N·m (28 ft. lbs.)

Upper Pivot Pin Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 N·m (80 ft. lbs.)


70 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

BOOM CYLINDER

Op. 35 710 10
REMOVAL
CAUTION
Before removing the boom cylinders, the boom must
be in the up, locked position supported by the boom
lock pins.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system.

1. Remove any attachment from the skid steer


boom attaching plate, bucket, etc.
2. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins, ex-
tend the boom lock pins, and lower the boom on
the boom lock pins, 1.
3. After stopping the engine and before removing
the seat belt and dismounting from the skid steer,
turn the ignition switch to the “RUN” position.
4. Push both the boom and bucket pedals to relieve
all residual hydraulic pressure in both hydraulic
circuits.

108
5. Turn off the ignition switch.
6. Disconnect both the upper, 1, and lower, 2, boom
hydraulic hoses from the cylinder.

109
7. Using a screwdriver, remove the plastic plug, 1,
from inside the cab to access the lower cylinder
pivot retaining hardware.
8. Loosen the LOWER boom pin retaining hard-
ware.
NOTE: DO NOT remove the retaining hardware at
this time.

110
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 71

9. Support the cylinder and with a hammer strike


the cylinder at the base area, 1, to loosen the tap-
ered pivot pin from the skid steer main frame.

111
10. Remove the UPPER boom pin retaining bolt, 1,
and boom pin, 2.
11. Remove the cylinder.

112
Op. 35 730 18
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the cylinder.
2. Pull the piston rod out slowly, and drain the oil
from the barrel into a suitable container.
3. Clamp the base of the cylinder in a vise at 1, and
unscrew the cylinder head (gland), 2.
NOTE: Do not clamp the cylinder barrel in the vise to
unscrew the cylinder head. Flattening of the barrel
will cause damage to the piston and piston seals.

113
72 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

4. Remove the piston rod assembly, 1, from the bar-


rel, 2.

114
5. Remove the piston retaining nut, 1; the piston, 2;
spacer, 3; and cylinder head (gland), 4, from the
piston rod, 5.

115
6. Remove the wiper seal, 1; O ring and backup
washer, 2; and inner seal and wear ring, 3, from
the cylinder head (gland), 4.

116
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 73

7. Remove the wear ring, 1, and seal, 2, from the


piston, 3.

117
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Thoroughly clean all parts and remove any nicks
or burrs with a fine emery cloth.
2. Inspect the inner diameter of the barrel, 1, for ex-
cessive wear or scoring.
3. Inspect the threaded area of the barrel, 2, for
damaged threads that would prevent proper
tightening of the cylinder head.
4. Inspect the O ring seal area, 3, and remove any
burrs or nicks that could damage or prevent the
O ring from sealing properly.

118
5. Inspect the outer diameter of the piston, 1, for ex-
cessive wear or scoring. If the piston is damaged,
the inner surface of the barrel will also most likely
be damaged. Inspect the barrel thoroughly. If the
piston is not damaged, do not replace.

119
74 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Make sure the new “T” seal, 1, and two backup


seals, 2, are installed correctly.

2 2
1

19987106

120
6. Inspect the cylinder head (gland) inner and outer
seal areas, 1 and 2, for sharp edges and scoring.
Inspect the threaded area of the gland, 3, for
damaged threads that would prevent proper
tightening of the retaining nut. Replace the gland
if necessary. All seals should be replaced during
reassembly.

121
REASSEMBLY
1. Clean and dry all parts. The metal parts should
be lightly oiled prior to assembly.
2. Install a new O ring, 1, and backup washer, 2, in
the outer groove of the cylinder head, 3. Install a
new shaft seal, 4, and wear ring, 5, in the inner
grooves.
NOTE: Install the shaft oil seal, 4, with the lip of the
seal facing the piston.
3. Install a new shaft wiper seal, 6, into the cylinder
head. The seal lip should face outward.

122
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 75

4. Examine the piston assembly prior to installation.


The wear ring, 1, and T-seal, 2, should be firmly 3
in their groove and snug against the piston, 3. In-
4 4 1
sert the L shaped back-up rings, 4, on both sides
of the T-seal with the short leg of the L shaped 2
back-up rings towards the T-seal as shown.

19987106

123
5. Install the cylinder head assembly, 1, and spacer,
2, onto the piston rod, 3.
6. Prior to installing the piston, clean and apply a
bead of hydraulic sealant between the piston and
piston rod at 4. Install the piston assembly, 5, and
new locknut, 6. The wear ring on the piston
should be toward the threaded end of the rod.
NOTE: The flat side of the piston must face the
spacer, and the recessed side must face toward the
end of the rod. The effective length of the piston rod
must be maintained, with the locknut fitting into the
recessed area of the piston.
7. Torque the locknut to 230 N·m (170 ft. lbs.).
124
8. Lubricate the piston and cylinder head assem-
blies with 10W-30 oil and install the piston rod as-
sembly, 1, into the barrel, 2.
9. Prior to threading the cylinder head into the bar-
rel, apply a coat of grease around the cylinder
head, in the area between the backup washer
and the cylinder head flange at 3.
10. Torque the cylinder head assembly to 306 N·m
(225 ft. lbs.).

125
76 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

REINSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the boom pivot pins, 1, with an antise-
1
ize-type lubricant.
2. Install the cylinder onto the skid steer.
NOTE: Refer to Service Bulletins 5/96 - I6 and 7/96 2
- I6 for updated pivot pin support information and
proper pin, spacer, and bolt part numbers.
3. Install a 3/8″ bolt, 2; flat washer, 3; and spacer, 4,
through the pivot pin retaining strap and boom 6
side plate. Secure with flat washer, 5, and lock- 3
nut, 6. 5 4
4. Torque the upper pivot pin hardware to 38 N·m 19997745
(28 ft. lbs.).
126
5. Install the lower pivot pin and 3/4″ hardware at 1,
and torque to 338 N·m (250 ft. lbs.).
6. Using a six-pound hammer and a piece of 2x4
hardwood to protect the pivot pin, place the board
over the end of the pin and hit briskly to properly
seat the tapered pin in the side frame. Retorque
the hardware to 338 N·m (250 ft. lbs.).
7. Reinstall the hydraulic tubes, 2, and position to
prevent contact with other components, fenders,
etc. at 3.
8. Reinstall the plastic plug on the side of the cab
inner shell.
9. Start the skid steer and cycle the boom several
times to remove trapped air from the system and 127
check the cylinder for leaks.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 77

BUCKET CYLINDER

Op. 35 730 10
REMOVAL
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system.

1. Remove any attachment, bucket, etc. from the


boom attaching plate and lower the boom to the
lowered position.
2. Extend the cylinder to the fully extended position.
3. After stopping the engine and before removing 128
the seat belt and dismounting from the skid steer,
turn the ignition switch to the “RUN” position.
4. Push both the boom and bucket pedals to relieve
all residual hydraulic pressure in both circuits.
5. Turn off the ignition switch.
6. Remove the hydraulic hoses from both ends of
the cylinder, 1, and cap the lines to prevent loss
of oil.
7. Remove the retaining bolt and pin, 2, from the
lower end of the cylinder.
8. Loosen the upper tapered pivot pin retaining
hardware, 3.
9. Support the cylinder and, with a hammer, strike
the cylinder at the base area, 4, to loosen the tap-
ered pivot pin.
10. Remove the cylinder.

129
Op. 35 730 13
DISASSEMBLY
1. Clean the outside of the cylinder and clamp the
cylinder base, 1, in a vise.
2. Use a spanner wrench to remove the cylinder
gland, 2. The gland is threaded into the cylinder.
3. Pull the cylinder rod assembly from the barrel.

130
78 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

4. Remove piston retaining stud, 1, piston, 2, and


gland, 3, from the piston rod, 4.

131
5. Remove seals from the gland; the outer O ring
seal and backup ring, 1, the inner shaft seal, 2,
and the wiper seal, 3.

132
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Thoroughly clean all parts and remove all nicks
and burrs with a fine emery cloth.
2. Inspect the inner diameter of the barrel for ex-
cessive wear or scoring.
3. Inspect the gland thread area, 1, for damaged
threads that would prevent proper tightening of
the gland.
4. Inspect the O ring seal area, 2, and remove burrs
or nicks that would prevent the O ring from seal-
ing properly.

133
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 79

5. Inspect the outer diameter of the piston, 1, for ex-


cessive wear or scoring. If the piston is damaged,
the inner surface of the barrel will also most likely
be damaged. Inspect the barrel thoroughly. If the
piston is not damaged, do not replace.

134
Make sure the new “T” seal, 1, and two backup
seals, 2, are installed correctly.
2
1
80 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

6. Inspect the cylinder head (gland) inner and outer


seal areas, 1 and 2, for sharp edges and scoring.
Inspect the threaded area of the gland, 3, for
damaged threads that would prevent proper
tightening of the retaining nut. Replace the gland
if necessary. All seals should be replaced during
reassembly.

137
REASSEMBLY
1. Clean and dry all parts. The metal parts should
be lightly oiled prior to assembly.
2. Install a new shaft seal, 2.
3. Install a wiper seal, 1, and wear ring, 3.
NOTE: Install shaft seal, 2, with the lip of the seal
facing the piston.

138
4. Install O ring, 1, and backup washer, 2, on the cyl-
inder gland.

139
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 81

5. Examine the piston assembly prior to installation.


The wear ring, 1, and T-seal, 2, should be firmly 3
in their groove and snug against the piston, 3. In-
4 4 1
sert the L shaped back-up rings, 4, on both sides
of the T-seal with the short leg of the L shaped 2
back-up rings towards the T-seal as shown.

19987106

140
6. Slide cylinder gland, 1, and piston, 2, with seals
installed, 3, onto the piston rod.
7. Use a hydraulic sealant to seal the piston and
rod. Install piston retaining stud, 4, with medium-
strength 242 Loctite and torque to 386 N·m (285
ft. lbs.).
82 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

8. Liberally oil the piston and place it inside the bar-


rel, being careful not to damage the seals. 3 2
9. Apply a coat of grease around the gland at 1.
10. Thread the cylinder gland, 2, into the barrel, 3,
and torque to 285 N·m (210 ft. lbs.).

143
REINSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the pivot pins with an antiseize-type lu-
bricant.
2. Install the cylinder on the skid steer.
3. Torque the upper pivot pin hardware to 108 N·m
(80 ft. lbs.).
4. With a hammer and using a piece of 2 x 4 hard-
wood to protect the pin, hit the pivot pin and re-
taining hardware at 1, to properly seat the tap-
ered pin and retorque to 108 N⋅m (80 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the lower pivot pin hardware to 38 N·m
(28 ft. lbs.).
6. Cycle the boom several times to remove the air 144
from the system and check the cylinder for leaks.
7. Check the hydraulic oil level and add 10W-30 oil
as required.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 83

PEDAL CONTROLS

Op. 35 724 16
REMOVAL
With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls
1. Remove the step shield hardware and step
shield.
2. Remove the clip washer, 1, that connects the 1
control rod, 2, to the pedal hub arm. 2

145
3. Remove the bolts, 1, connecting the two bracket
halves.
4. Disconnect the control valve links, 2, at the con- 1
trol valve.
5. Remove the pedal mounting bolts, 3, and remove
both pedals from the loader.
3
3

146
PEDAL INSPECTION
2
With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls
1. Remove the control valve links, 1, from the hub 1 1
control arms, 2.

19996895
147
84 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

2. Inspect the control valve links for any obvious


damage, bends or twisting.

19996894
148
3. Inspect the auxiliary hydraulic hub arm, 1, the
boom hub arm, 2, and the bucket hub arm, 3, for 1
any deformation or cracks. 4
2 4
4. To disassemble hub arms, remove the roll pins, 3
4, from the hub arms and control shaft.
5. Inspect the control shafts, 5, for any obvious
damage or bends.

5
5
19996893
149
6. To remove control shafts, remove bolt, 1, secur-
ing shaft arm to pedal. Take note of the position 2
and number of any spacer washers or shims. Re-
move the nuts, 2, holding the bearings on the
pedal support. Separate the shaft from the pedal
and bearing.

2
1
19996891
150
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 85

7. Inspect the shaft bearings, 1, for excessive wear.


If bearings do not move easily, replace.
1

19996826
151
8. Inspect the pedals, 1, and pedal supports, 2, for
any excessive wear or deformation.

19996827
152
PEDAL REINSTALLATION
With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls
1 1
1. Reinstall the bearings, 1, shafts, 2, brackets, 3, 3
and control arms, 4, using the same number and
position of washers or shims.

2 4 4 2
19996896
153
86 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

2. Install the left pedal assembly, 1, and attach the


front plate with hardware, 2, previously removed.
Do not tighten the hardware at this time. 1

154
3. Slide the pedal assembly to align the auxiliary
boom hydraulic hub arm and boom hub arm as
shown. Align the inside edge of each hub arm, 1,
with the slot in the control valve spool, 2. Tighten
the pedal mounting hardware.
4. Recheck the alignment of the hub arm and spool.
2

155
5. Install the right pedal, 1, adding shim washers as
necessary so pedal mounting holes line up cor-
rectly. Check that the inside edge of the bucket 1
hub arm aligns with the slot in the control valve 3
spool as described above. Install the pedal with
hardware, 2, previously removed, and tighten se-
curely. Connect the two-piece bracket with the
two bolts, 3, washers and nuts.
2
6. Check for free operation of the foot pedals and
hub control arm assemblies. If any components
are binding, adjust or reshim the pedal assem-
blies.

156
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 87

7. Install the control spool links, 1, with clevis pins,


2, and cotter pins, 3. 3 2
8. Attach each link to each hub arm with 3/8″ hex
head bolts, 4, flat washer, 5, two link washers, 6,
1
lock washer, 7, and nut, 8.
5 7
4 8

157
9. Connect the auxiliary hydraulic control rod, 1, to
the pedal hub arm, 2, with the clip washer re-
moved during disassembly.
10. Install the step shield and hardware.

3
2
1

158
88 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 35 724 16

PEDAL REMOVAL
With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls
1. Remove the step shield hardware and step 2 2
shield.
2. Remove the bolts, 1, washers, lock washers and
nuts, that connect the control rods, 2, to the pedal
hub arms.

159
3. Disconnect the control valve links, 1, from the
control valve spools by removing the cotter pins,
2, and clevis pins, 3. 3
4. Disconnect the control valve links, 1, from the
control hub arms by removing the bolts, 4,
2 1
washers, lockwashers, and nuts. 1

19996833
160
5. Remove the right pedal mounting bolts, 1, and re-
move the right pedal, 2.
6. Remove the left pedal mounting bolts, 3, and re-
move the left pedal, 4.
1
3

4 2
19996832
161
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 89

PEDAL INSPECTION
With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls
1. Remove the bucket hub arm assembly, 1, and 3
4
the boom hub arm assembly, 2. Inspect the hub
arm assemblies for any deformation or cracks.
2. Inspect the control shaft, 3, for any obvious dam-
age or bends. To remove control shafts, remove
the two allen screws, 4, securing the auxiliary hy-
draulic hub, 2, to the control shaft. Then remove
the bolt, 5, securing shaft arm to pedal. Take note
of the position and number of any spacer 5
washers or shims. 2 1
19996824
162
3. Remove the two allen screws, 1, securing the
boom hydraulics hub, 2, to the control shaft. In- 1
spect the boom hydraulics hub for any deforma-
tion or cracks. 2

19996825
163
4. Inspect the shaft bearings, 1, for excessive wear.
If bearings do not move freely, replace.
1

19996826
164
90 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

5. Inspect the pedals, 1, and pedal supports, 2, for


any excessive wear or deformation.

19996827
165
6. Inspect the control valve spool links, 1, for bends
or excessive wear. 1

19996829
166
PEDAL REINSTALLATION
With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls 3
1. Insert the control shaft, 1, through the left pedal, 1
6
2, and left pedal support, 3, fitting three washers,
4, between the pedal and support. 5
2. Slide the auxiliary boom hydraulic hub assembly,
5, onto the control shaft and secure with allen
screws, 6.

2 4

19996824
167
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 91

3. Install the left pedal assembly, 1, and attach the


front plate with hardware, 2, previously removed.
Do not tighten the hardware at this time. 1 4
3 5
4. Install the boom hub assembly, 3, and bucket hub
assembly, 4, onto the pivot shaft, 5.
2

19996831

168
5. Slide the pedal assembly to align the auxiliary hy-
draulic hub arm as shown. Align the inside edge
of the hydraulic hub arm, 1, with the slot in the
control valve spool, 2. Tighten the pedal mount-
ing hardware.
6. Recheck the alignment of the hub arm and spool.
7. Check the alignment between the hub arms and 2
control valve spools. Add shim washers if
necessary to correct alignment.
1

169
8. Install the right pedal, 1, adding shim washers as
necessary at 2, fitting inside the bearing, 3, so 3
pedal mounting holes line up correctly. Install the
pedal with hardware, 4, previously removed, and 2
tighten securely.
4
9. Check for free operation of the foot pedals and
hub assemblies. If any components are binding,
adjust or reshim the right pedal assembly.

1
19996832

170
92 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

10. Install the control spool links, 1, with clevis pins,


2, and cotter pins, 3.
11. Link the boom valve link and the bucket valve link
2
to the hub arms with 3/8″ hex head bolts, 4, flat
washer, 5, thick link washer, 6, lock washer, 7, 1
and nut, 8.
3
12. Install the auxiliary hydraulic link with 3/8″ hex 5
head bolts, flat washer, two flat washers, 9, lock 6 4
9
washer, and nut. 7

8
19996833
171
13. Install control rods, 1, to the pedal hub arms, 2,
with the bolts, washers, lock washers and nuts
removed during pedal removal.
14. Install the step shield and step shield hardware.
1
1

172
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 93

HYDRAULIC COOLING, FILTER,


RESERVOIR SYSTEM
Specifications

Filter (spin-on canister) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 micron

Reservoir (filter screen at fill cap) capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22.7 L (6 US. gal.)


94 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 35 705

FILTER SYSTEM
The skid steer is equipped with a single spin-on filter
canister type located at 1, to the right of the engine
radiator. The filter is a 10-micron element.
NOTE: Allow the hydraulic oil to cool before changing
the filter.
CAUTION
The hydraulic oil filter will be under pressure when
the oil is at operating temperature.

173
The filter base is equipped with a bypass valve, 1, to
allow cold oil to bypass the filter without damaging
the filter or starving the hydrostatic system of lubrica-
tion oil during cold weather start-ups.
In cold weather start-ups, allow the hydraulic oil to
warm up before operating the boom, bucket, or the
hydrostatic ground drive system, to prevent possible
damage to the systems.
The filter base is also equipped with a pressure sen-
sor that is monitored by the EIC (Electronic Instru-
ment Cluster) to signal the operator of a plugged oil
filter.

174
Op. 35 705 04
FILTER REMOVAL

Op. 35 705 05
BASE REMOVAL
The filter base can be removed by opening the rear
door and removing the right engine side panel.
1. Remove the sensor wires, 3.
2. Remove the inlet, 2, and outlet, 6, oil lines and
cap to prevent loss of oil.
3. Remove the two cap screws, 5; ground wire, 7;
and wire clamp, 4.
4. Remove the filter assembly, 1, from the unit. 175
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 95

REASSEMBLY
1. Reinstall the filter base with the hardware previ-
ously removed and reconnect the ground wire, 1.
Torque the mounting hardware to 20 N·m (15 ft.
lbs.).
2. Reinstall the hydraulic lines, tighten the lines to
seat line on fittings; loosen and retorque.
3. Reinstall the filter sensor and connect the sensor
wires, 2.
4. Reinstall a new filter, coat the filter seal ring with
10W-30 oil, and tighten the filter unit until it con-
tacts the base, and then tighten another half to
three-quarter turn.
176
96 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

OIL COOLER

Op. 35 300 10

REMOVAL
The hydraulic oil cooler is located between the radi-
ator and the engine cooling fan. To access the oil
cooler, the radiator will have to be removed.
1. Drain the engine cooling system.
2. Lift up on the release handles, 1, and move the
radiator rearward.
3. Disconnect the upper and lower radiator hoses,
2.
4. Remove the coolant overflow hose to the over- 177
flow tank, 3.
5. Remove the two cap screws and spacers, 4. Re-
move the radiator.
6. Disconnect the oil cooler inlet and outlet lines, 1,
at the bottom of the cooler. Cap to prevent loss
of oil and contamination.
7. Remove the four nuts holding the fan shroud and
move it forward.
8. Remove four cap screws, 2, and remove the oil
cooler from the support frame.

178
REASSEMBLY
1. Reattach the oil cooler, 1, to the support bracket
with the previously removed hardware.
2. Reattach the fan shroud.
3. Reconnect the hydraulic lines to the oil cooler.
Tighten the lines to seat the fittings, then loosen
and retighten the connections.
4. Remount the radiator, 2, reinstalling the two
spacers and cap screws.
5. Reconnect the radiator hoses and fill the cooling
system with a 50/50 water-antifreeze mixture
with corrosion inhibitor.
6. Check the hydraulic oil level and fill with 10W-30 179
oil as necessary.
7. Start the unit, operate the hydraulic system, and
check for oil and coolant leaks. Repair as required.
8. Recheck hydraulic oil and coolant levels and add
as required.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 97

Op. 35 300

OIL RESERVOIR
The hydraulic oil reservoir fill is accessed through the
top engine shield. The fill cap assembly is the hy-
draulic system breather and is equipped with a
screen to help prevent contamination into the sys-
tem.
To clean the breather cap, 1, remove the cap from the
reservoir and back flush the cap assembly with a
clean solvent. Blow dry with low-pressure air.

180
Op. 35 300 28
Filter/Breather Cap Cleaning
To clean the fill screen, remove the six screws and
washers, 2, and lift the screen assembly from the res-
ervoir neck. Carefully clean the filler neck area before
removing the screen.
Back flush the screen, 1, with a clean solvent and
blow dry with low-pressure air.
Reinstall the screen assembly making sure the
screen is sealed between the screen and reservoir
neck with gaskets, 2. Use of a silicone sealer with
gaskets to seal between the screen and reservoir is
recommended.
181
The hydraulic reservoir is equipped with a tempera-
ture sender, 1, which allows the EIC (Electronic In-
strument Cluster) to monitor the hydraulic oil tem-
perature and signal the operator of an oil overheat
condition.
IMPORTANT: Do not over tighten the sender or dam-
age to the reservoir may occur.

182
98 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 35 300 10
OIL RESERVOIR REMOVAL
To access the reservoir, open the rear door and re-
move the right engine side shield.
To remove the reservoir from the skid steer, the cab
and boom must be tilted forward. Refer to Section 1
for cab tilting procedures.

183
With the cab tilted forward:
1. Remove the rear engine belly pan.
2. Drain the reservoir by removing hydraulic line, 1,
and allowing the oil to drain into a suitable con-
tainer.

184
3. Remove the hydraulic oil temperature sender
wires, 1 and 2.
4. Disconnect the suction and return lines, 3 and 4,
from the oil tank.
5. Remove front and rear mounting hardware, 5.
6. Lift the oil reservoir from the skid steer.
NOTE: If the reservoir should leak due to a hole or
crack, DO NOT repair. Replace the reservoir.

185
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 99

INSPECTION
Check the reservoir for cracks and leaks. Check for
signs of interference or wear from the transmission
control arm.

186
NOTE: The reservoirs have a vent area molded into
the fill neck, 1, to allow air to escape around the plas-
tic strainer when filling the tank. This improves the
rate that oil can be added to the reservoir.
IMPORTANT: Do not remove or modify the plastic
strainer, as any material that gets past the strainer
can go directly to the gear pump, control valve,
cylinders, and auxiliary hydraulic attachments and
cause major damage to these components.

187
Inspect the return line port, 1, and suction line port,
2, for cracks and debris buildup.

188
100 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

REINSTALLATION
1. To increase the reservoir clearance from the con-
trol arm, install a #80424 socket-head setscrew,
3/8 x 5/8, as a plug in hole, 1, in the chaincase.
Apply pipe thread sealer or Loctite to the plug
threads to keep chaincase oil from leaking out
and to hold the plug in place.
2. Loosely reinstall the previously removed hard-
ware with thread sealer applied into tank slot, 2,
and thread into the chaincase.
3. Install the previously removed rear hardware
loosely in the tank slot/chain mount, 1. Make sure
the tank is positioned flat against the chaincase
wall. Tighten front hardware bolt assembly and 189
rear hardware bolt assembly securely to hold the
tank in place.
4. Install the two oil temperature sender wires, 1
and 2.
5. Connect the suction and return lines, 3 and 4,
and tighten the hose clamps securely. Check the
mounting hardware, 5, is tight.
6. Reconnect the hydraulic line disconnected for
draining.

190
7. Fill the tank with SAE 10W-30 oil and operate the
system to remove all air from the system. Check
for leaks. Repair as required.
8. Install the rear engine belly pan.
9. Tilt the cab and boom back to operating position.
10. Reinstall all shields previously removed.

191
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 101

ADAPTING ATTACHMENTS WITH


PREVIOUS-STYLE CONSTRUCTOR
SUPPLIED BALL/PIN COUPLERS TO 1
FLAT-FACED COUPLERS
If the attachment to be used has the 1/2 ball/pin-
type couplers, adaptors, 1 and 2, can be used to at-
tach to the loader flat-faced couplers.
Part
Number Description Item #
2
86539404 1/2 male flat-faced/ 1
1/2 female ball/pin-type
86539403 1/2 female flat-faced/ 2
1/2 male ball/pin-type 192

NOTE: These adaptors are useful for occasionally


adapting attachments; however, they significantly
lengthen the coupler assembly and make assembly
more likely to be damaged in usage. It is preferred for
heavy attachment usage to convert the attachment
quick couplers or loader quick couplers to the flat-
faced style.
102 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 37 – TOWING HOOKS AND BALLASTING

Chapter 1 – Rear Counter Weights

CONTENT

Section Description Page


37 140 10 Rear Counterweights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37-2
37 140 12 Rear Counterweight Support Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37-2
2 SECTION 37 – TOWING HOOKS AND BALLASTING – CHAPTER 1

Op. 37 140 10

REAR COUNTERWEIGHTS
Counterweights can be installed to improve the sta-
bility of the loader when handling heavy loads or
when operating the skid steer with a heavy front
mounted attachment.
Six 27.2 kg (60.0 lbs) weights, 1, (three per side may
be added to the rear of the loader as shown.
The rear counterweights should be removed when
not required. Operating the skid steer with rear 1
counterweights installed and with light front loads,
3173-03
may cause uneven tire wear.
1
Op. 37 140 12

REAR COUNTERWEIGHT SUPPORT


REMOVAL
SECTION 39 – FRAMES

Chapter 1 – Lower Main, ROPS

CONTENT

Section Description Page


General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
ROPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
ROPS Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
90 152 46 ROPS Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-2
ROPS Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39-9
2 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1

GENERAL INFORMATION

ROPS
The ROPS, 1, is a welded frame structure to provide
rollover protection for the operator and pivot point
locations for the boom assembly.

1
ROPS FRAME

Op. 90 152 46 1
1
REMOVAL
The ROPS can be removed from the lower frame with
the cab inner shell and boom attached in place or
removed.
To remove the ROPS with the inner shell and
boom removed:
Follow the instructions for “Cab Inner Shell Removal” 2 2
in Section 90 and “Boom, Upper and Lower Link
Removal” in Section 82. 19984332
1. Remove the rear attaching bolts, 1, left and right 2
sides.
NOTE: If the rear bolts, 1, have spacers under the
bolt heads they must be reinstalled during
reassembly for proper torquing.
2. Support the ROPS with a suitable lifting device
and remove the front attaching bolts, 1, two each
side.
3. Lift the ROPS frame from the lower main frame
and move to a level area. Lower the ROPS to the
floor.

3
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 3

To remove the ROPS with the cab inner shell and


boom attached:
1. Remove any attachment from the loader
mounting plate, raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.

2. Remove the front step shield, 1.


3. Remove the right and left fenders, 2. 4
4. Raise and latch the engine top screen, 1.
5. Remove the engine side panels, 2.

5
6. Lower the boom to the lowered position and turn
the ignition (key) switch to the “OFF” position. Do
not unbuckle the seat belt and exit the loader.
7. Relieve the hydraulic pressure from the boom
and bucket circuits.
– Turn the ignition (key) switch to the “ON”
position.
– Operate the boom and bucket controls
relieving all pressure in the system.
– Turn the ignition switch “OFF” and exit the
loader.

6
4 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1

8. Raise the operator’s seat/seat pan support to the


raised latched position, 1. Remove step shield, 2.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

7
9. Disconnect the parking brake linkage at 1.
10. Raise the parking brake control lever, 2, to the
raised, engaged position.

8
11. Disconnect the (–) negative ground battery
cable, 1.

+ –

9
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 5

12. Unplug the engine wire harness from the main


harness, 1.
13. Remove the ground wires from the engine bell
housing, 2.
14. Remove the wire harness from along the fuel
tank on the left side of the engine.
15. Remove the wires from the hydrostatic charge
pressure sender, oil filter sensor, and remove the
wire harness from the right side of the engine.

10
16. Remove the wire harness clamps and plastic ties
along the left side of the lower frame at 1, 2, and
3.

11
17. Remove the ground strap, 1, from the cab inner
shell and lower main frame.

12
6 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1

18. Remove the engine fuse/relay panel support


hardware, 1, and raise and tie the panel
assembly to the back of the cab.

13
19. Remove the throttle control cable, 1, from the
control lever at 2. Remove the cable retaining
nut, 3, and slide the cable down through the right
side shield at 4.

14
20. With the boom in the lowered position and the
hydraulic pressure relieved in the boom and
bucket circuits, disconnect the boom, bucket, 1 1
and auxiliary boom hydraulics hose connections,
1, and cap all connections.

CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first
relieving all pressure in the system.

15
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 7

21. Rotate the boom lock pin control lever to extend


(engage) the boom lock pins, 1, above the top of
1
the lower link, 2, as shown. 2

16
22. With a suitable lifting device, support the boom at
the rear, lifting the boom assembly until it
contacts the boom lock pins, 1.

17
23. With a suitable lifting device, support the boom at
the rear, and lift the boom assembly at the front
until it contacts the boom lock pins, 1.

18
8 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1

24. Remove the left and right rear attaching


hardware, 1.
NOTE: If the rear bolts, 1, have spacers, 2, under the 1
bolt heads, they must be reinstalled during
1
reassembly for proper torquing.

2 2

19984332
19
25. Remove the right and left front retaining bolts, 1.
26. Lift the ROPS and boom assembly from the lower
main frame and move to a level area. Rest the
assembly on the floor, lowering the boom to the
floor.

20
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 9

REINSTALLATION
1. Lift the ROPS and boom assembly onto the lower
frame resting the rear ROPS post on the lower
frame pads. Supporting the front of the ROPS,
install the front retaining hardware at 1. With the
front hardware installed, align the rear ROPS
posts and install the rear hardware at 2.
2. Torque the front hardware, 1, to 160 ft. lbs. (217
N·m).

21
3. Torque the rear hardware, 1, to 80 ft. lbs.
(108 N·m).
NOTE: If the rear bolts, 1, had spacers, 2, under the 1
1
bolt heads, they must be reinstalled during
reassembly for proper torquing.

2 2

19984332
22
4. With the ROPS and boom securely attached to
the lower frame and the boom in the lowered 1 1 1
position, remove the lifting device from the
ROPS.
5. Reinstall the wire harness, 1, along the main
frame and attach the engine fuse/relay panel.
6. Reconnect the main harness to the engine
harness, re-route the wire harness along the fuel
tank and the right side of the engine installing all
clamps and ties previously removed.

23
10 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1

7. Reconnect the ground wires to the bell housing


at 1. Place the largest wire next to the ground
surface, stacking the remaining wire by size,
largest to smallest, to insure proper grounding.

24
8. Reconnect all hydraulic lines, 1, and position for
clearances between other components. Install
any hose clamps removed. 1 1

25
9. Slide the throttle cable up through the hole in the
left cab panel and secure with retaining nut at 1.
Reattach the cable to the control handle at 2. 2

26
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 11

10. Reconnect the parking brake spring links, 1, to


the control rod at 2, and install the cotter pins.
11. Reconnect the (-) negative ground battery cable.

27
12. After all wires and hydraulic hoses are
connected, start the unit, raise the boom, and
check for oil leaks.
NOTE: The boom and bucket hydraulic circuits may
require cycling several times to purge the air from the
hydraulic system.
13. Reinstall all fenders, shields, etc. removed.
14. After the fenders are reinstalled, raise and lower
the boom and recheck the hoses and tubes for
clearance at 1. Readjust the hoses and tubes if
they contact the fenders.

28
12 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS

Chapter 1 – Axles

CONTENT

Section Description Page


44 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-2
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-4
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-5
Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-7
44 106 Axles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-8
44 106 10 Axle Housing Assembly Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-8
44 106 16 Axle Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-9
Axle Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-11
Axle Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-12
Axle Housing Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-14
Final Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-16
44 106 48 Drive Chain and Sprocket Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-16
Final Drive Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-18
Final Drive Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-19
44 511 Tyres/Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-22
Tyre and Track Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44-23
2 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

Op. 44 100

GENERAL INFORMATION
Each of the two hydrostatic pumps is driven by the
engine through a spur gear configuration located in
the engine-to-transmission gearbox. The hydrostatic
pumps then transmit hydraulic power to the hydro-
static motors, 1, which are connected to gearboxes,
2, located on the inside of the final drive cases. The
left and right drives are separate from each other and
are operated independently.

2
Power is then transmitted through gears to a drive
sprocket, 1, in the final drive case. The drive sprocket
is connected to the axle sprockets, 2, with chains, 3,
one endless chain to the front axle and one endless
chain to the rear axle.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 3

The axle sprocket, 1, is splined to the axle shaft, 2,


and hub assembly.

OPS844

4
General arrangement of Chains and Axles
1. FINAL DRIVE SPROCKET ASSEMBLIES (2) 3. AXLE DRIVE SPROCKETS (4)
2. DRIVE CHAINS(FRONT AND REAR) (4) 4. AXLES ASSEMBLIES (4)
4 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

SPECIFICATIONS
Drive Axles

Wheel Nut Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 N·m (125 ft. lbs.)


Mounting Bolt Torque (Axle housing to case) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 N·m (140 ft. lbs.)
Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High temperature lithium grease
Chain Case and Gearbox

Side Cover Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 ft. lbs. (15 N·m)


Drive Chain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . #100
Front Chain Length (64 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80″ (2032 mm)
Rear Chain Length –SL65B (58 links) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72.5″ (1841.5 mm)
................................................
Chain Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0 to 6 mm (0″ to 1/4″) movement at tyre tread
Other Materials

Description Use
Ultra/Blue Silicone Sealer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gearbox mounting bolts
Axle housing bolts
Chain case cover bolts
Gearbox to chain case
Gearbox cover and bolts
Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer
Gear Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High viscosity lithium base

NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to seal where required to prevent corrosion during the sili-
cone curing process.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 5

TROUBLESHOOTING
Before servicing or adjusting the final drive system,
the skid steer should be jacked up with the wheels off
the ground.
Remove any attachment from the skid steer; boom,
bucket, etc. Lower the boom to the lowered position
or, if servicing requires the boom to be in the raised
position, support the boom on the boom lock pins.
Raise the boom and lower onto the boom lock pins,
1.
1. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins.
2. Engage the boom lock pins.
3. Stop the engine; ignition key in the “OFF” posi- 5
tion.
4. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
5. Lower the boom onto the boom lock pins.
6. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
Never exit the loader with the boom in the raised posi-
tion unless the boom is supported on the boom lock
pins.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment
mounted. Always remove the attachment from the
loader.

Jack up the loader and support the loader with the


wheels off the ground. Use adequate jack stands or
blocks to securely support the loader.
Support the loader at the front of the final drive cases
at 1, and at the rear at 2.
CAUTION
Never service a raised loader unless it is securely
supported with adequate jack stands or blocks.

6
6 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


Both drive wheels on one No hydrostatic motor shaft Check for pump to motor oil flow
side not powered rotation and repair
No gearbox output drive Check gearbox shaft rotation
and repair
Broken drive chains Check chains and repair

One drive wheel not powered Broken drive chain Check chain and repair
Axle or drive sprocket splines Check axle and sprocket;
worn replace

Chain case noise Loose drive chains Check and adjust chains
No oil in final drive Check oil level
Worn drive sprockets Check sprockets and repair
Bearing failure Check axle and gearbox
bearings and repair

Excessive axle play Bearing failure on axle shaft Check bearings and repair
Snap ring failure on axle shaft Check axle bearing preload;
repair

Noise in gearbox No or low oil in gearbox Check oil level


Bearing failure Check shafts and bearings;
repair
Bearing or shaft failure in drive Check drive motor and repair
motor
Gears in gearbox worn Check and replace
Parking brake not released Release parking brake

Final drive case leaking Oil escaping past case side sheet Reinstall with sealant as
and reinforcing plate described in Service Bulletin
(7/95-I7)
Oil escaping past studs Remove and reseal studs
Oil escaping around center Remove plate and reseal
inspection plate
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 7

TESTING

FINAL DRIVE
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at high idle (full throttle).
* Park brake in disengaged position.
STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION
1 Push both drive controls YES Drive system OK.
forward equally and loader
should move in a straight line. NO Engine stalls, wheels appear locked, check parking
brake for engaged. If OK, go to step 2.

Slow or no power; refer to hydrostatic drive section.


2 Check final drive chain; if broken, repair.
3 Pull both drive controls YES Drive system OK.
rearward equally and loader
should move in a straight line. NO Engine stalls, wheels appear locked, go to step 1.

Wheels rotate slow or no power, go to step 1.

One side of loader drags, go to step 2.

Pretest instructions:
* Lower boom and attachment to the ground.
* Stop engine.
* Jack loader with wheels off the ground.
* Release parking brake.

STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION


1 Rotate each tyre by hand, tyres YES Drive system OK.
move less than 1/4″ at tread.
NO Tires move more than 6 mm (1/4″) at tread; check
chain tension.
2 One tyre rotates freely, broken chain, or axle spline
worn.
3 Both tyres on one side rotate freely together, inspect
drive gearboxes. If OK, check drive motor.
4 Tires rotate but are noisy. YES Check drive chains, axle bearings.

NO Drive system OK.


8 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

Op. 44 106

AXLES

Op. 44 106 10
AXLE HOUSING ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
The axle housings must be removed to service the
axle seals, axle bearings, drive chains, drive
sprockets, and axle housing mounting bolts.
NOTE: The axle housings may be removed without
removing the final drive side cover or draining the
case oil.
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground. 7
2. If the work is going to be done with the boom in
the raised position, remove the attachment, raise
the boom, and rest the boom on the boom lock
pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.

3. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels


off the ground.
Support the loader at the front of the final drive
cases at 1, and at the rear, 2.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader causing serious injury or
damage to the equipment.

NOTE: When repairing a rear axle, the front of the


unit should be supported slightly higher than the rear
for easier rear axle assembly reinstallation.

8
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 9

4. Remove the tyre and wheel from the axle being


serviced.
5. Clean the axle and final drive area to prevent de-
bris from entering the final drive case.
6. Remove the eight axle housing retaining nuts
and washers, 1.
7. Slide the axle housing from the retaining studs
and lift the assembly from the final drive case.
CAUTION
The axle assembly is heavy and may require two per-
sons to adequately support if handling manually.

NOTE: When the axle assembly is removed, the 9


drive sprocket and chain will drop slightly to the bot-
tom of the case.
8. There is a large O ring at 1 that seals the axle
housing to the side of the final drive case. Re-
move the O ring from the case or the axle hous-
ing.

10
Op. 44 106 16
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: A press is required to remove the axle shaft
and hub assembly from the housing.
1. Remove the retaining ring, 1, from the axle shaft.
2. Remove the shims, 2. Note the thickness and
number of shims.
3. Place the housing assembly in a press; support
the housing as close to the center of the housing
as possible to prevent damage to the housing.
4. Press the axle and hub assembly, 3, from the
housing.
11
10 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

5. The outer axle seal, 1, may be replaced at this


time without further disassembly. The seal can
be replaced without removing the bearing, 2.
6. Install a bearing separator/puller and remove the
outer axle bearing, 2.

12
7. Remove the inner bearing race, 1, by driving it
from the housing with a suitable hammer and
driver.

13
8. Remove the outer replaceable seal sleeve, 1, by
prying it from the axle housing.
9. Remove the outer bearing race, 2, and seal, 3, by
driving them from the housing with a suitable
hammer and driver.
Note the positioning of the oil seal before re-
moval, as the replacement seal should be posi-
tioned in the same position.

14
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 11

10. The axle hub wheel studs, 1, can be removed


from the hub, by pressing them from the hub.

15
11. Shown here are the related parts used in the axle
assembly.
1. Housing
2. Axle and hub assembly
3. Outer seal
4. Outer seal sleeve
5. Outer bearing assembly
6. Inner bearing assembly
7. Inner seal
8. Shims
9. Retaining ring

16
PARTS INSPECTION
Thoroughly clean all parts before inspection.
1. Inspect the housing flange, 1, and bearing race
areas, 2. Replace the seals and replaceable seal
sleeve if worn or damaged.

17
12 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

2. Inspect the axle shaft and hub assembly.


– Inspect the bearing areas, 1, for wear.
– Inspect the splines, 2, and retaining groove,
3, for wear.
– Inspect the seal area.
– Inspect the wheel lug studs for damaged
threads or looseness in the hub, replace
studs if required.

18
REASSEMBLY
1. Install the outer seal, 1, as shown, on the axle-
hub assembly. Fill the grooves in the seal with
grease.
2. Pack the bearing with grease and install the outer
bearing, 2, with a suitable bearing driver.
3. Wrap the axle in the retaining ring groove area,
3, with a single layer of plastic tape to prevent
damage to the seal during assembly.
NOTE: If the bearing failed because of excessive
contamination, use green Loctite 609 on the seal
housing to shoulder press-fit joint. If the axle shoul-
der is worn from previous seal rotation, use a new
axle and seal, and use loctite to seal the joint. 19
NOTE: When reinstalling the axle into the axle hous-
ing, be sure both bearings are packed with grease.
The cavity in between the triple lip seal and axle seal,
where the outer bearing is positioned, must be full of
grease. If any old or hardened grease is in a housing
that will be reused, be sure to clean the housing and
fill it with new grease. The axle bearings should be
greased every 500 hours, or if a wheel or tyre is re-
moved for repair, grease the axle bearings at that
time.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 13

4. Install inner seal, 1, in the housing as shown with


the flat side of the seal to the center of the hous-
ing and retainer and the lip of the seal to the out-
side.
5. Install bearing race, 2.
6. Install replaceable seal sleeve, 3, in the housing.

20
7. Place the housing over the axle and hub assem-
bly making sure the outer bearing is properly
seated in the race.
8. Remove the tape from the axle shaft.
9. Install the inner bearing race, 1, into the housing.

21
10. Pack the bearing with grease and install the inner
bearing, 1.
Press the inner bearing on the axle shaft and into
the housing to obtain housing rolling torque of 9
- 15 lbs.
NOTE: To check housing rolling torque, hook a
spring scale in one of the housing flange slots, 2, and
pull on the scale to rotate the housing.
11. Add shims to fill the space between the bearing
race, 3, and retaining ring, 4.
12. Install the retaining ring in groove, 5.

22
14 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

13. Fill the outer seal area with grease until the
grease appears around the hub at 1; spin the axle
housing while adding grease.
14. Install the O ring in the groove in the axle housing
flange at 2; wipe a layer of grease over the O ring
to help hold the O ring in place during assembly.

23
REINSTALLATION
1. Clean the final drive case.
2. Inspect the axle opening in the case to make sure
it is flat for a good seal between the case and axle
housing. To check surface flatness, lay a straigh-
tedge across the axle opening in the horizontal
and vertical planes, 1. Straighten if required.
3. Inspect the axle assembly retaining bolts, 2, and
replace if damaged.
– To replace a stud, the old stud can be driven
out with a hammer and suitable driver.
– Thoroughly clean the inside and outside of
the case in the stud area.
24
– Wipe the new stud with a wicking-type seal-
ant. The new stud can be installed into the
case by using a 3/4″ thick spacer over the
stud and then using the nut and a flat washer
to pull the stud in place.
– Wipe around the stud with a wicking-type
sealant to ensure an oil tight seal.
If there are signs of oil leaking out of the bottom of the
axle housing, the oil may be escaping between the 1
final drive case sheet and the outer reinforcing plate.
The reinforcing plate, 1, has a narrower opening than
the drive case sheet, 2. If the loader frame is welded
between the reinforcing plate and drive case sheet,
the case should not leak. 3
To seal off this area and prevent leaks, clean the final
drive case around the pilot mating area, 2, and 2
around the studs, 3, with an appropriate cleaner.
Place a bead of silicone sealant (such as part
#L58775), around the side sheet mating area, 2, and
the studs, 3. 19987113
NOTE: When installing the final drive case, the case 25
must lay flat against the frame and the pilot must rest
on the edge of the frame opening.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 15

4. Position the drive sprocket, 1, in the axle open-


ing. Make sure the drive sprocket is placed in the
drive chain properly.
NOTE: When installing a rear final drive case, the
rear drive sprocket will stay in place better with the
front of the loader raised.
5. Lift the axle housing assembly and mate the
splines on the axle shaft, 2, and the drive
sprocket and slide together. Lifting the axle hous-
ing assembly over the retaining studs, pilot the
center of the housing, 3, into the hole in the case
and slide the housing tight against the case.

26
6. With the axle housing, 1, tight against the case,
install the retaining nuts and flat washers, 2, to
hold the housing against the case.
7. Slide the axle housing assembly to tighten the
drive chains.
NOTE: The chains are properly tensioned when
there is 0 to 6 mm (0, to 1/4,) movement at the outer
edge of tyre tread.
8. Torque the axle retaining hardware to 140 ft. lbs.
(190 N·m).
CAUTION
When tightening the axle retaining hardware, the
axle housing must be tight against the case at 1, or 27
damage to the case may occur.

9. Check the final drive case oil level at check plug,


1; add SAE 80W-90 API Service GL-5 gear oil as
required.
Replace any shields that were removed for the
repair.

28
16 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

FINAL DRIVE

Op. 44 106 48
DRIVE CHAIN AND SPROCKET REMOVAL
The axle housing assemblies and final drive case
cover will need to be removed to access the drive
chains and drive sprockets.
The four final drive chains are an endless design,
with no connector link.

Removal
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground.
2. If the work is going to be done with the boom in 29
the raised position, remove the attachment, raise
the boom, and rest the boom on the boom lock
pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.

3. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels


off the ground.
Support the loader at the front of the final drive
cases at 1, and at the rear at 2.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader causing serious injury or
damage to the equipment.

30
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 17

4. Remove the tyres and wheels from the final drive


being serviced.
5. Clean the axle and final drive area to prevent de-
bris from entering the final drive case.
6. Remove the eight axle housing retaining nuts
and washers, 1, from each axle.
7. Slide the axle housing from the retaining studs
and lift the assembly from the final drive case.
NOTE: When the axle assembly is removed, the
drive sprocket and chain will drop slightly to the bot-
tom of the case.
CAUTION
Axle assembly is heavy and may require two persons 31
to adequately support if handling manually.

8. There is a large O ring, 1, that seals the axle


housing to the side of the final drive case. Re-
move the O ring from the case or the axle hous-
ing.

32
9. Remove the final drive cover, 1.

33
18 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

Drive Chain and Sprocket Removal


10. Remove the drive chains from the drive sprocket,
1.
NOTE: In order to remove the chain and driven
sprockets from the chain case, the gearbox must be
loosened and moved toward the center of the ma-
chine. This will remove the interference of the double
sprocket with the large driven sprockets. It is not 1
necessary to remove the gearbox from the machine.
Refer to “Gearbox Removal” in Section 27 for re-
moval procedures.
11. Roll the rear driven sprocket to the chain case
opening, remove the chain from the sprocket and 19997744
lift the sprocket from the chain case. Repeat for 34
the front driven sprocket.
PARTS INSPECTION
Thoroughly clean all parts before inspection.
1. Inspect the drive sprockets in the center spline
area, 1, for excessive wear and the tooth area, 2,
for wear.

35
2. Inspect the drive chains for broken or cracked
rollers, 1.
3. Inspect the drive chains for cracked or broken
side bars, 2.
4. Inspect the side-bar-to-pin wear or looseness at
3.
5. Inspect the drive chains for excessive stretch
(bushing wear).

36
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 19

REASSEMBLY
1. Clean all surfaces which require resealing of old
silicone sealer, dirt, etc.
2. If replacing the oil, it will have to be syphoned
from the chain case. Thoroughly clean the inside
of the case to remove all debris.
3. If removed, place the chains into the chain case.
Install the front chain (the longer chain) into the
case first.
4. Place the front driven sprocket into the chain
case with the longer center hub, 1, to the outside
of the case.
NOTE: The driven sprockets are not centered in the
37
chain case. The front sprocket is installed with the
longer hub, 1, to the outside of the machine and the
rear driven sprocket is installed with the short hub, 2,
to the outside.
5. Install the longer chain on the large sprocket and
roll it into position.
6. Place the rear driven sprocket in the chain case,
install the shorter chain and roll it into position.
NOTE: The SL65B front chains are longer than the
rear chains.

7. Reinstall the gearbox.


8. Install the drive chains onto the gearbox drive
sprocket, 1 with the front chain, 2, to the inside
and the rear chain, 3, to the outside.
9. Fill the chain case with SAE 80W-90 API Service
GL-5 gear oil to the bottom edge of the lower two 1
threaded holes at 4.
10. Clean all sealer and oil from the chain case cover
mating area at 5.

4
5 2 3
19997743
38
20 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

11. If there are signs of oil leaking out of the bottom


of the axle housing, the oil may be escaping be- 1
tween the final drive case sheet and the outer re-
inforcing plate. The reinforcing plate, 1, has a
narrower opening than the drive case sheet, 2. If
the loader frame is welded between the reinforc-
3
ing plate and drive case sheet, the case should
not leak. To seal off this area and prevent leaks,
clean the final drive case around the pilot mating 2
area, 2, and around the studs, 3, with an ap-
propriate cleaner. Place a bead of silicone seal-
ant (such as part #L58775), around the side
sheet mating area, 2, and the studs, 3.
19987113
NOTE: When installing the final drive case, the case
39
must lay flat against the frame and the pilot must rest
on the edge of the frame opening.
12. Position the drive sprocket, 1, in the axle open-
ing. Make sure the drive sprocket is placed in the
drive chain properly.
NOTE: When installing a rear final drive case, the
rear drive sprocket will stay in place better with the
front of the loader raised.
13. Lift the axle housing assembly and mate the
splines on the axle shaft, 2, and the drive
sprocket and slide together. Lifting the axle hous-
ing assembly over the retaining studs, pilot the
center of the housing, 3, into the hole in the case
and slide the housing tight against the case.

40
14. With the axle housing, 1, tight against the case,
install the retaining nuts and flat washers, 2, to
hold the housing against the case.
15. Slide the axle housing assembly to tighten the
drive chains.
NOTE: The chains are properly tensioned when
there is 0 to 6 mm (0, to 1/4,) movement at the outer
edge of tyre tread.
16. Torque the axle retaining hardware to 140 ft. lbs.
(190 N·m).

CAUTION
When tightening the axle retaining hardware, the 41
axle housing must be tight against the case at 1, or
damage to the case may occur.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 21

17. Place a continuous bead of sealer around the


perimeter of the chain case cover hole, 1, and to
the bottom of the heads on the cover retaining
bolts, 2. Install the cover and eight retaining bolts.
Torque to 11 ft. lbs. (15 N·m).
18. Check the final drive oil level at the check plug,
3. Add SAE 80W-90 API Service GL-5 gear oil as 2
required.
19. Reinstall all shields removed for this repair.

3 1

42
22 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1

Op. 44 511

TYRES/WHEELS

TYRE OPTIONS
1. 8.25 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented
2. 12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented
3. 8.25 x 15 Chevron tread
4. 12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread
5. 12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty
6. 14.00 x 17.5 cleat tread (not shown)
7. Solid Tyres (not shown)
43
NOTE: Solid tyres are available and can be obtained
from your New Holland dealer.
Tyre Pressures

Tyre Pressure
8.25 x 15 Chevron tread 50 PSI (414 kPa)
7.50 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
14.00 x 17.5 - cleat tread 60 PSI (410 kPa)

MAINTAIN PROPER TYRE INFLATION!


NOTE: Iatco “Air Boss” segmented tyres are ap-
proved for all new generation New Holland loader
models. These tyres must be mounted with the wheel
dish “in” to the frame (narrowest wheel tread posi-
tion). Reversing the wheels with the dish “out” is not
recommended, as increased axle and frame loading
occurs, which may lead to eventual axle bearing and/
or main frame failure.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 23

TYRE AND TRACK INSTALLATION

Tyre Installation on Loader


The 8.25 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented and the 12.00
x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented tyres must be
mounted with the wheel dish “IN” to the frame (nar-
rowest wheel tread position). Reversing the wheels
with the dish “OUT” is not recommended, as in-
creased axle and frame loading occurs. This may
lead to eventual axle bearing and/or main frame fail-
ures.

44
Op. 44 511 28
When replacing the sections of the hollow seg-
mented tyres, torque the section hardware to 10 ft.
lbs. (13.6 N·m).

45
Track Installation on Loader
Correct tyre/track combinations are important to pre-
vent damage to the tracks, tyres/wheels, and loader
main frame.
Installing tracks on skid steers equipped with seg-
mented tyres, solid tyres, foam-filled tyres, or any
hard-type non-pneumatic tyres is not recommended.
If these tyre combinations are used with steel tracks,
track or loader main frame damage may occur.
These tyres do not provide a cushion when debris
comes between the track and tyre. A pneumatic tyre
will absorb this type of stress and, in severe cases,
may deflate before damage to the loader or track oc-
curs. 46
New Holland only recommends pneumatic tyres be
installed with tracks.
24 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL

Chapter 1 – Heater/Defroster

CONTENT

Section Description Page


50 100 Heater/Defroster (Cab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-2
2 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1

Op. 50 100

HEATER/DEFROSTER (CAB)
1 2
Switch and Control Panel
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable to pre-
vent possible shorting of the electrical system.
2. Remove the retaining hardware, 1, and pull the
panel from the rear support, 2.
3. Disconnect the switch wires and control cable.

19990481
1
Switch Wiring
The heater switch, 1, has four terminals marked, L,
M, H, and B, that the wire harness must be connected
to.
Connect the wires as follows:
Terminal Wire
L R/W (Red/White)
M Y (Yellow)
H O (Orange)
B O/DKBL (Orange/Dark Blue)

2
Relay and Fuse Block
1 - Fuse block - 20 amp
2 - Relay

3
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1 3

1 R/W
B
V
O/DKBL B Y
M

C H
LTGN/B–2
O
LTGN/B–1
2 3
B–7

B
LTGN/B

O/DKBL

LTGN/B

6
B
4

R/O R/O
20A
7.5A

5 15A

5A

BSC0942A

4
Heater Wiring Diagram
1. Heater 4. Fuse block D
2. Blower switch 5. Start relay
3. Motor 6. Heater power relay
4 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1

Louvre Replacement
1. To remove the louvre, use a small flat screwdriver
and pry the louvre from the support base at 1.

5
2. Remove the #6 self-tapping screws, 1, from the
base and remove the base from the headliner.

6
Heater Core, Shutoff Valve and Fan Assembly
Access
2
To access the heater core and/or fan assembly, the
rear light bar, 1, (if equipped with lights) and top
heater cover, 2, must be removed. Remove the
heater cover mounting screws, 3, to remove the
cover and light bar together.
3

7
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1 5

Op. 50 104 24
Heater Core Replacement 1 2
1. Drain the cooling system enough to drain the
coolant from the core, about 2 liters (2 quarts).
2. Remove the heater hose clamps, 1, from the
heater core, remove the hoses from the core and
cap hoses.
3. Remove the heater core retaining hardware, 2,
and remove the core from the heater support.

19997753
8
Op. 50 104 23
Heater Shutoff Valve Replacement 1
1. Drain the cooling system enough to drain the
coolant from the core, about 2 liters (2 quarts).
2. Remove the control cable from the valve.
3. Remove the heater hose clamp, 1, from the
heater shutoff valve and remove the hoses from
the valve and cap hoses.
4. Remove the heater shutoff valve, 2.

19997755
9
Op. 50 104 20
Heater Fan Assembly Replacement 1
1. Remove the heater core retaining hardware and
pivot the core away from the fan support.
2. Disconnect the fan power wire, 1. 2 2
3. Remove the retaining hardware for the fan and
motor assembly, 2.

19997754
10
6 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1

Op. 50 100 10
1
Heater Hose to Engine Connections
1. The pressure side heater hose, 1, tees into the
engine line, 2, from the water pump to the engine
oil cooler at the flywheel end of the engine.

11
2. The return side heater hose, 1, tees into the en-
gine line, 2, from the engine oil cooler to the en- 3
gine head at the flywheel end of the engine.
NOTE: To purge the air from the heater core and
hoses, temporarily “pinch off” the oil cooler supply 1
hose at 3. This will force coolant through the heater
core and hoses, removing the air from the system.
IMPORTANT: Do not install a shutoff valve or orifice
in the oil cooler supply hose. Restricting coolant flow
to the engine oil cooler may result in overheating and
engine failure. 2

12
The return side heater hose, 1, attaches to the en-
gine head, 2, with a hose adapter.
NOTE: Use Teflon tape on the threads of the engine 2
head adapter pipe fitting connection.
1

19986412
13
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1 7

Op. 50 100 10
Heater Core Connections
Connect the pressure hose to the left side hose, 1,
and the return hose, 2, to the right side. Secure with
hose clamps. The hoses from the engine will have to
be cut to length for proper fit.

14
Op. 50 104 10
Filter
Replacement filter #86504784
The heater contains an air filter element in the rear
right side at 1.
Remove cover plate, 2, by removing two self- tapping
screws, 3.

15
Check the filter element, 1, periodically, especially if
running in dirty applications and using the fresh air
ventilation. The element can be blown off with a low-
pressure air gun and reused or replaced. The el-
ement must be placed with the rubber seal toward
the heater core. Be sure the seal is behind the top
clamp, 2, and lower screw, 3.

16
8 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

Chapter 1 – Advanced Warning System, Circuits, Alternator, and Starter

CONTENT

Section Description Page


55 000 General Electrical Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-6
Definition of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-7
Adapting Attachments Requiring 12V Electrical Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-9
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-14
Electrical Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-17
55 418 Advanced Warning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-21
Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-21
(EIC) Electronic Instrument Cluster Front Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-22
EIC Functional Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-23
Engine Preheat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-28
Automatic Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-28
Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-29
Broken Alternator/Water Pump Belt Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-31
Fuel Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-32
EIC Interlocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-32
EIC Lock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-33
EIC Engine Preheat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-34
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-35
Advanced Warning System (AWS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-38
EIC Board Self Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-39
Diagnostic and Setup Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-40
Arrow, Open Book, and Audible Alarm Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-42
Diagnostic Mode EIC Circuit Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-42
EIC Setup Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-46
Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC) and Starter Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-54
Blown Fuse Symptom and Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-54
Testing Other EIC Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-56
EIC Board Reading Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-59
EIC Board Claims Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-62
Electrical Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-63
Seat Switch Circuit to EIC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-64
Seat Belt Switch Circuit to EIC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-65
2 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Ignition Switch Circuit to EIC Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-67


Cranking Circuit (Starter Motor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-68
“Service/Run” Switch in the “Run” Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-69
Cranking Circuit Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-70
Service/Run” Switch in the “Service” position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-71
Cranking Circuit Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-72
Start Relay Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-72
Start Relay Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-73
Start Relay Ground Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-74
Start Interlock Relay Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-74
Start Interlock Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-75
Start Interlock Ground Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-76
Start Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-76
55 100 Removal, Installation and Wiring of Electrical Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-77
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-78
55 301 40 Battery Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-78
Battery Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-78

55 418 10 EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Board Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-79


EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-80
EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) Board Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-81
Ignition (Key) Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-82
55 201 10 Ignition (Key) Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-82
Ignition (Key) Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-82
Cab Fuse Panel Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-83
Cab Fuse Block and Panel Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-84
Cab Fuse Block and Panel Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-84
Service/Run Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-85
Service/Run Switch - Service Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-85
Service/Run Switch - Run Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
55 418 30 Service/Run Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
Service/Run Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
Seat and Seat Belt Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-86
55 201 15 Seat Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-87
Seat Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-87
Seat Belt Buckle and Switch Assembly Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-88
Seat Belt Buckle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-88
Road Light and Work Light Switch Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-88
55 404 20 Road Light and Work Light Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-89
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 3

Road Light and Work Light Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-89


Engine Fuse and Relay Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-90
Accessory Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Accessory Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Accessory Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Preheat Circuit Breaker Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
55 100 24 Preheat Circuit Breaker Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Preheat Circuit Breaker Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-91
Start Interlock Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-92
55 100 34 Start Interlock Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-93
Start Interlock Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-93
Engine Fuse Panel Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-93
Engine Fuse Block Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-94
Engine Fuse Block Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-94
Alternator Excite Resistor Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-95
55 301 16 Alternator Excite Resistor Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-95
Alternator Excite Resistor Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-95
Start Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-96
55 100 34 Start Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-96
Start Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-97
Preheat Relay Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-97
55 100 34 Preheat Relay Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Preheat Relay Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Preheat Manifold Heater Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Preheat Manifold Heate Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-98
Fuel System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-99
10 223 Fuel Shutoff Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-101
Fuel Shutoff Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-101
10 223 10 Replacement of Fuel Shutoff Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-102
Electric Lift Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-102
Electric Lift Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
Cold Advance Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
Cold Advance Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
55 414 14 Air Filter Restriction Indicator Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
Air Filter Restriction Indicator Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-103
55 414 10 Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-104
Engine Coolant Temperature Sender Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-104
55 414 12 Engine Oil Pressure Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
Engine Oil Pressure Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
4 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

55 414 28 Hydrostatic Charge Pressure Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105


Hydrostatic Charge Pressure Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-105
55 414 24 Hydraulic Oil Filter Restriction Switch Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-106
Hydraulic Oil Filter Restriction Switch Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-106
55 414 20 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Sender Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-106
Hydraulic Oil Temperature Sender Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-108
Boom/Bucket Control Valve Spool Lock Solenoids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-108
35 724 90 Boom/Bucket Control Valve Spool Lock Solenoids Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-108
Boom/Bucket Control Valve Spool Lock Solenoids Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-109
Wire Harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-110
55 100 74 Main Wire Harness Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-110
Main Wire Harness Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-115
55 404 Road/Work Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-119
55 301 Alternator (45 Amp Version) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-123
Charging Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-123
Alternator Service Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-125
Alternator System Testing and Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-125
Alternator Component Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-131
Alternator Overhaul Component Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-131
55 301 10 Alternator Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-131
55 301 12 Alternator Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-131
55 301 14 Alternator Component Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-133
Alternator Inspection and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-135
Alternator Resassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-136
Alternator Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-136
55 201 Starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-137
Starter Motor Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-139
55 201 50 Starter Motor Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-140
Starter Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-141
System Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-141
System Motor Current Draw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-142
Starter Motor Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-144
Starter Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-145
Starter Inspection and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55-145
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 5
6 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 000 – Provides an anti-theft mode to electrically


lock the loader boom and bucket; the engine
GENERAL ELECTRICAL INFORMATION will start with the Service/Run switch in the
“SERVICE” position.
The electrical system is a 12-volt negative (-) ground
system that provides battery voltage to the Electronic 6. Fuse blocks/ fuses/ circuit breakers, cab and en-
Instrument Cluster (EIC), starting circuit, and other gine - Used to protect the electrical circuits and
electrical components. manifold heater circuit.
The electrical system is made up of the following 7. Manifold Heater (Thermo-Start) - Used to pro-
components (with their functions): vide aid in cold engine starting.
1. Battery - Power supply and storage. 8. Fuel solenoid - Controls fuel flow and is con-
trolled by the EIC.
2. Alternator/Regulator - Power supply and source
to maintain fully charged system. 9. Switches - Used to control other electrical cir-
cuits, lights, etc.
3. Starter motor - To crank engine for starting.
IMPORTANT: Do not connect any electrical circuits
4. Ignition switch - Used to control electrical circuits at the ignition key switch or cab fuse block(s) unless
and direction of battery voltage. there are written instructions telling you to do so or
5. Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC) damage to the EIC board may occur.
– Monitors engine and operator functions and IMPORTANT: If any servicing or adjustments require
signals operator of disruptions or faults in the the battery to be disconnected, or welding is required
circuits. on the skid steer, disconnect the negative (-) ground
– Displays monitored functions. cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
– Controls engine fuel system (fuel shut off). damage to the EIC (electronic instrument cluster)
monitoring system and other electrical components.
– Provides engine shutdown if fault occurs in
engine oil pressure or hydrostatic charge IMPORTANT: If the EIC requires removal from the
pressure circuits. dash area or the skid steer, disconnect the negative
(-) ground battery cable. This will shut off power to the
– Provides safety interlock for the boom and
EIC and prevent damage to the EIC board, or prevent
bucket control valve spools.
blowing the 5-amp fuses if the board is accidentally
– Provides a diagnostic mode for checking EIC grounded.
board circuits.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 7

DEFINITION OF TERMS FUSE - A device to protect an electrical circuit from


ALTERNATING CURRENT (A.C.) - A flow of elec- overloads that needs to be replaced when blown.
trons which reverses its direction of flow at regular in- OHM - The standard unit for measuring resistance to
tervals in a conductor. flow of an electrical current.
AMMETER - Measures the flow of electrical current OHMMETER - An instrument for measuring the re-
in amperes. Ammeters are connected in series with sistance in ohms of an electrical circuit.
the circuit to be tested. OPEN CIRCUIT - An open circuit occurs when a cir-
AMPERE - A unit of measure for the flow of current cuit is broken which interrupts the flow of current
in a circuit. The ampere is used to measure electricity through the circuit.
such as “gallons per minute” is used to measure RELAY - An electrical switch which opens and closes
liquid flow. a circuit automatically when activated.
CIRCUIT - A continuous, unbroken path along a con- RESISTANCE - The opposing force offered by a cir-
ductor through which electrical current can flow from cuit. Resistance is measured in ohms.
a source, through various components, and back to SHORT CIRCUIT - A part of a circuit that comes in
the source. contact with part of the same circuit or unintentionally
CIRCUIT BREAKER - A device to protect an electri- touches a metallic object.
cal circuit from overloads and can be reset, or will SOLENOID - A circular coil used for producing a
automatically reset. magnetic field.
COLD CRANK RATING (CCA) - The cranking load SWITCHES - A device used to control and direct cur-
capacity of a battery at low temperatures (cold crank- rent to circuits and will remain in this position until
ing amperes at 0_F). changed.
CONTINUITY - Unbroken path along a conductor SWITCHES (MOMENTARY) - Momentary switches
through which electrical current can flow. are used to direct current to circuits and these
CURRENT - Movement of electricity along a conduc- switches will return to the neutral position when re-
tor. Current is measured in amperes. leased.
DIODE - An electrical device that will allow current to VOLT - A unit of electrical pressure which caused
pass through itself in one direction only. current to flow in a circuit.
DIODE (RESISTOR TYPE) - An electrical device that VOLTAGE - The force which is generated to cause
will allow current to pass through itself in one direc- current to flow in an electrical circuit. Voltage is
tion only and will cause resistance as the electricity measured in volts.
passes through. The electricity coming from this type VOLTMETER - An instrument for measuring the
diode will be less than what is going in. force in volts of electrical current. Voltmeters are con-
DIRECT CURRENT (D.C.) - A flow of electrons mov- nected in parallel to the points where voltage is to be
ing in the same direction along a conductor from a measured.
point of high potential to one of lower potential.
8 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

The following are common terms used in electrical To test for a “GROUNDED CIRCUIT,” use a volt/ohm
diagnostics and how they may affect the circuit and meter and check for continuity between the circuit
electrical components. wire and ground.
The term “OPEN CIRCUIT” means there is no volt- The following chart shows the abbreviations for the
age getting from the control point to the operating various wire colors used to identify the electrical cir-
point. This means the wire carrying the voltage is cuits.
open/broken and voltage cannot continue to flow.
The effect is the operating component will not func- Wire Abbreviations to Indicate Wire Color
tion.
WIRE WIRE
The term “SHORT CIRCUIT” means there is voltage COLOR DESIGNATION COLOR DESIGNATION
being lost to another component wire or to ground.
Black B White W
This could result in the wrong component being oper-
ated or the blowing of the circuit protection device Dark DKBL Orange O
(fuse or breaker). Blue
The term “GROUNDED CIRCUIT” means the volt- Light LTBL Pink PK
age is going directly to ground and usually results in Blue
no component operation and/or blown fuse-breaker. Dark DKBR Purple PU
To test for an “OPEN CIRCUIT,” use a volt/ohm meter Brown
and check from one end of the wire to the other. If Gray GY Red R
voltage is not present, trace the circuit from control
point to operating point until the open is found. Dark DKGN Tan T
Green
To test for a “SHORT CIRCUIT,” use a volt/ohm meter
and check for very low resistance in different parts of Light LTGN Yellow Y
the circuit or continuity between the circuit wire and Green
ground.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 9

Drilling Holes In Overhead Dash, Electronic In-


strument Cluster (EIC) Board, and Ignition
2
1
Switch Area
Always install the rearview mirrors as shown in the
mirror instruction sheet. Otherwise, you must unhook
the negative battery cable and remove the EIC board
panel, 1, and ignition switch panel, 2, from the over-
head dash. If holes and attaching screws are in-
stalled into the dash area, 3, make sure the screws
will not contact the EIC board, the ignition switch, or
wiring, as electrical system damage will occur.
IMPORTANT: Failure to unhook the negative battery 3
cable before removal of the EIC board or switch may
result in an accidental grounding, causing compo- 1
nent damage.
IMPORTANT: Retaining hardware contacting the
EIC board or switch may cause an electrical short,
damaging the loader electrical system.
ADAPTING ATTACHMENTS REQUIRING
12V ELECTRICAL POWER
There are important rules that must be followed when
adapting attachments that require 12 volt electrical
power. Proper wiring of electrical devices and power
and ground connections is very important to prevent
other electrical component damage. Attaching elec-
trical connections to locations other than recom-
mended may allow electric current to feed back
through the EIC board, creating false EIC board re-
adings and warnings, or causing EIC board damage
or failure.
1. ALWAYS FOLLOW the instructions for New Hol-
land kit installation to ensure proper function and 2
operation.
2. NEVER CONNECT an electrical device to any
wires, fuses, switches or grounds inside the cab
area. This includes any terminals of the ignition
switch, fuse panel, or ground terminal.
3. NEVER INSTALL an electrical device, music
radio, two-way radio, or unapproved New Hol-
land attachment into the cab area.
4. ONLY USE the 12-volt accessory power outlet
for attachments requiring less than 10 amps. The
accessory outlet is connected to the engine fuse/
relay panel and protected with a 15 amp fuse.
10 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

5. ALWAYS CONNECT new electrical attachments


to the engine fuse/relay panel, 1, and connect the
grounds to the engine bell housing. USE ONLY
vacant connections and fuses not in use for
specified attachments.

3
Engine Fuse Panel
The wires and connections listed below are available
providing electrical attachments were not previously
installed.

Ref. Color Destination Fuse Battery Voltage Status


1 R/B To turn signal relay 10-amp All times Available
2 R/GY To accessory relay 25-amp All times Available
3 R/LTGN To EIC board pin #14 P2 connector 5-amp All times Occupied
4 LTGN/R To seat switch(es) 5-amp All times Occupied
5 R/W To key switch (battery terminal) 15-amp All times Occupied
6 R From preheat circuit breaker 20-amp All times Occupied
7 R From start relay All times Occupied
8 R/O To heater power relay 20-amp All times Available
9 R/T Spare 7.5-amp All times Available
10 DKGN/R To high flow, horn, power outlet 15-amp Key “ON” position Available
11 O/LTGN From accessory relay Key “ON” position Occupied
12 O/W To Back-up alarm switch 5-amp Key “ON” position Available
13 O/LTGN From road/work light fuse (cab panel) Key “ON” position Occupied

Engine Fuse Panel


A. Standard Fuse Block
B. Optional Fuse Block

4
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 11
12 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

A completely new auxiliary wiring circuit can be in-


stalled as shown in Figures 5 and 6, depending on
electrical requirements. Mounting holes for the
added circuit breakers must be drilled in the panel.
Disconnect the battery before drilling and installing
new wiring. Protect the panel’s electrical compo-
nents from drilling shavings that could cause electri-
cal shorting of components. Figure 4 shows circuits
for intermittent high current loads up to 15 amps.

5
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 15 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL (preheat load side)
3. R (feed dise)
4. Preheat relay
5. Main ground to bell housing
6. Live to attachment
7. Ground from attachment
8. Attachment power cable
9. Start relay
10. Alternator excite resistor
11. Start interlock relay
12. Drill second hole (protect component whilst drilling)
13. Accessory relay
14. Customer supplied 15 amp circuit breaker
15. Existing hole
16. Customer supplied jumper wire
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 13

Figure 6 shows the circuit for intermittent high current


loads up to 30 amps.
Sealed circuit breakers that can be purchased from
parts.
Part Number Capacity
9827329 15 amp
9828493 20 amp
9840279 25 amp
9840280 30 amp

NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place


the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
IMPORTANT: Additional electrical attachments must
have circuits properly connected to prevent damage
to the Advanced Warning System (EIC board) and
other electrical components.
CAUTION
Always disconnect the battery before installing any
electrical attachment to prevent accidental shorting
of system.

6
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 30 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL
3. R
4. Preheat relay
5. Customer supplied sealed circuit breaker
6. Customer supplied jumper wire
7. Main ground to bell housing
8. Ground wire from attachment
9. Live wire to attachment
10. Attachment power cable
11. Start relay
12. Alternator excite resistor
13. Start interlock relay
14. Accessory relay
15. Heater power relay
16. Turn signal relay
14 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

SPECIFICATIONS
Alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 amp
Tachometer output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 to 6.5 AC Volts
Battery (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BCI PC31 - 12 volt - 925 amps @ -18_C (0°F) Top stud
.............................
System Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Negative (-)
Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuse blocks in cab and engine areas
Cab panel (standard)
Fuel pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Electronics ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A
Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Lights (road/work) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15A
Engine panel (standard)
Turn signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A
Accessory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25A
Electronic (EIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A
Key main . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15A
Preheat circuit breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50A
Cab panel (optional equipment)
Beacon light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Engine panel (optional equipment)
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20A
Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Attach/Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15A
Backup alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A
Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC)
Low voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 11.9 volts (low)
High voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 16.5 volts (high)
Fuel gauge sensor resistance
Full tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 ohms
Empty tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 ohms
Fuel shutoff solenoid
Pull-in amperage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 to 1.5 amps
Hold-in amperage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 to 1.5 amps
Engine air filter sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switch is normally closed
EIC will fault at 1.6″ Mercury or 22″ Water
Engine coolant temperature sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will read “COLD” until 0°C (32°F)
EIC will fault at 102°C (216°F)
Engine coolant temperature sensor resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . At 20°C (68°F) 2.21-2.69 K ohms
At 0° - 30°C (32° - 86_F) 1.65-5.88 K ohms
Engine crankcase oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 0.68 bar (10 PSI)

NOTE: The EIC will not alarm unless coolant temperature is above 64 F or two minutes have passed since
starting.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 15

Hydraulic oil temperature sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will read “COLD” until 0°C (32°F)
EIC will fault at 99°C (210_F)
Hydraulic oil temperature sensor resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . At 20°C (68°F) 2.21-2.69 K ohms
At 0° - 30°C (32° - 86°F) 1.65-5.88 K ohms
Hydraulic oil filter sensor (differential between in/out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switch normally closed
EIC will fault at 2.7 ± 0.27 bar (40 ± 4 PSI)
EIC will reset at 2.0 bar (30 PSI)

NOTE: This alarm is locked out until the oil temperature is at 110 F. The switch must be open for over 5 seconds
to alarm.

Hydrostatic charge pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 3.4 bar (50 PSI)
Manifold heater resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.97 to 1.18 ohms
Solenoid (boom and bucket spool lock) resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 to 18 ohms
Starter Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key start and relay
Headlights and rear work lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.5 watt halogen
Taillights (road) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.5 watt halogen
Amber Flasher lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sealed
Electronic Instrument panel indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.080 amp C-2F
16 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ALTERNATOR SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS (45 AMP)


Item How Rated Standard Or Service Limit
Normal Output (V - A) 12 - 45
Polarity Negative ground
Weight (kg, lbs.) 3.7 kg (8.2 lbs.)
Rotational direction (viewed from Clockwise
the pulley)
Load characteristics (cold) Terminal voltage (V) 13.5
Current (A) Min. 30
Brush length Original (mm-in) 20 mm (0.80″)
Limit (mm-in) 5.0 mm (0.20″)
Brush spring tension Original (n-oz) 2.7 n (10 oz.)
Limit (n-oz) 1.3 n (5 oz.)
Rotor field resistance 2.9 ± 0.5 ohms
Stator field resistance ohms at 20°C (68°F) 0.2 ohms

TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS (ALTERNATOR)


Alternator through bolts 5.5 N·m (4.0 ft. lbs. )
Pulley retaining nut 70.0 N·m (52.0 ft. lbs. )
Rectifier retaining screws 4.0 N·m (3.0 ft. lbs. )
Regulator and brushbox screws 2.7 N·m (2.0 ft. lbs.)
Terminal nuts 2.7 N·m (2.0 ft. lbs.)

STARTER MOTOR SPECIFICATIONS (12 VOLT)


Rated voltage 12 volts
Output 3.1 kw
Motor type Four-pole series wound motor
Engaging system Solenoid-engaged pinion
Rotation Clockwise (viewed from pinion side)

STARTER SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS


No load test 11.5 volts, 170 amps, 8000 RPM
Locked rotor test 6.8 volts, 1200-1400 amps,
35 N·m (26 ft. lbs.) torque
Solenoid holding voltage, minimum 8.0 volts
Commutator diameter 45 mm (1.77″) - new
42.5 mm (1.67″) - minimum
Commutator brush, minimum length 8.5 mm (0.33″ )
Armature end play 0.1 - 0.3 mm (0.004″ - 0.012″)
Pinion tooth backlash 0.4 - 0.7 mm (0.016″ - 0.028″)
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 17

ELECTRICAL DIAGRAM
18 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

F10928
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 19

F10930
20 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

F10960
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 21

Op. 55 418

ADVANCED WARNING SYSTEM

ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT CLUSTER


(EIC)
The skid steer advanced warning system, 1, moni-
tors engine functions and operator controls and re-
1
ports conditions to the operator and provides safety
interlocks to the hydraulic control valve spools to the
boom and bucket.
The instrument cluster has three kinds of visual dis- 19984335
plays: backlighted symbols, an LED character dis-
9
play, and a segmented bar graph.
The EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) board em-
ploys incandescent lamps to backlight symbols
representing monitored functions. Active sensor
symbols are backlighted with either yellow (WARN-
ING) or red (FAULT). Inactive sensor symbols are
visible as a dim gray outline when the backlighting is
not active. An audible alarm accompanies most vis-
ual alarm lights.
The front panel of the instrument cluster has several
components and display areas. Read the following
paragraphs to understand each item and area.
22 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

10
EIC (ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT 3. RIGHT ARROW DISPLAY SELECTOR
CLUSTER) FRONT PANEL SWITCH
1. AUDIBLE ALARM The display selector switch, covered with an
“ARROW” symbol, will cause an audible “chirp” when
The audible alarm will sound if there is an unusual
pressed if the ignition key is in the “RUN” position.
condition in any of the monitored areas. The audible
Pressing the “ARROW” symbol during operation will
alarm is located behind the front panel at 1.
select the function that the operator chooses to moni-
2. CHARACTER DISPLAY tor and will be displayed in the character display, 2.
The character display will display the item that the op- If a sensor causes a warning or fault, the appropriate
erator has chosen to monitor. The display shows one lamp will flash, accompanied by an audible alarm.
function at a time. After the engine is started, the dis- Pressing this switch also cancels any audible alarm
play defaults to the last function viewed at power off. that is sounding.
Any of the other functions may be selected by the op- 4. OPEN BOOK SELECTOR SWITCH
erator during operation by briefly pressing the
This selector switch covered with the symbol of an
“ARROW” selector switch, 3. When the EIC is turned
“OPEN BOOK” (instruction manual) is used to select
off and then powered up, the display default will be
other functional modes of the EIC panel. The “OPEN
the newly selected function.
BOOK” switch has no function during normal oper-
ation.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 23

11
EIC FUNCTIONAL GROUPS
The EIC display panel is divided into four functional
groups, 1 through 4.
5. Engine hours, displayed to 0.1 hours (no light).
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 1
Those symbols in display group 1, backlighted white
are:

6. Engine coolant temperature displayed to the


nearest degree, expressed as degrees Fahren-
heit or degrees Celsius, depending on setting (C
1. Right arrow display selector switch. (no light) or F).
This switch is used to change the displayed function.

7. Transmission/hydraulic oil temperature to


2. Loader engine RPM, displayed in increments of nearest degree, Fahrenheit or Celsius, depend-
10 RPM. ing on setting (F or C).
NOTE: The monitored functions and symbols in
group 1 are backlighted in white except the Engine
Hours. When this function is monitored the symbol is
3. Battery voltage, displayed to the nearest 0.1 volt. not lit.
NOTE: The EIC monitors battery voltage only, not al- NOTE: The Engine Coolant and hydraulic oil tem-
ternator output. peratures will show “COLD” until the systems reach
32 Fahrenheit or 0 Celsius operating temperature.
At that time the Character display will start reading
the temperature in Fahrenheit or Celsius degrees.

4. Character display.
The character display will display the chosen func-
tion or the function with the fault within this functional
group.
24 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

12
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 2
Those symbols in display group 2, backlighted yellow
are:

4. Parking brake.
Used to remind operator to engage the parking
brake when exiting the loader. An audible alarm
1. Hydraulic oil filter condition. will sound when the operator begins to exit the
machine with the engine running.
The EIC continuously monitors the condition of
the oil filter. A yellow warning lamp will signal a
warning when the filter becomes dirty. The lamp
will flash continuously, accompanied by a 5-sec-
ond audible alarm, when the filter requires re-
placement. 5. Stop engine warning.
When this warning lamp flashes, stop the engine
and determine the cause to prevent damage to
the engine.

2. Air filter condition.


When the air filter requires replacement, the
lamp will flash indicating a dirty element.
6. Engine preheat symbol (lights when engine is
preheating).
The EIC controls a timed preheat system for
3. Blank (not used). starting aid.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 25

13
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 3 bars, 2, the segments will flash accompanied by
The symbol in display group 3 is: an audible alarm for about 5 seconds.
When the fuel level reaches two bars, the EIC will
signal the operator again with the segments
flashing and another 5-second audible alarm.
NOTE: The lower fuel gauge segments accurately
read the lower fuel levels so an operator is less likely
1. Fuel gauge. to run out of fuel. However, if a machine is operated
The fuel gauge, 1, is a vertical 10-segment green on a hillside, the fuel gauge should be monitored
LED bar graph. When the fuel level reaches three closely to avoid running out of fuel, as the fuel can still
move freely from one end of the tank to the other.
26 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

1 2

4 5 6

14
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 4
Symbols in display group 4 are backlighted red.
When a fault occurs, the flashing lamp is accompa-
nied by the audible alarm. 5. Coolant temperature.
When the engine coolant temperature is above
operating temperature of 102°C (216°F) the
lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm.
1. Transmission charge pressure.
When the pressure drops below normal operat-
ing pressure, the lamp will flash with a continuous
alarm. 6. Operator “FASTEN SEAT BELT” symbol.
When the operator is in the seat, the lamp will
flash until the seat belt is fastened.
These symbols are backlighted RED and are in-
2. Transmission/Hydraulic oil temperature. tended to complement the audible alarm should
a fault occur.
When the oil temperature is above operating
temperature of 99°C (210° F), the lamp will flash
with a 5-second alarm. 7. Alternator/water pump drive belt warning.
If the drive belt breaks, the EIC will signal the op-
erator with the battery symbol light, 3, flashing
continuously and a 5 second audible alarm.
3. Battery voltage. NOTE: If during skid steer operation the Engine
When battery voltage drops below normal volt- Coolant or Hydraulic Oil Temperatures show an over-
age, the lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm. heat condition, the EIC will default to that function
and read the temperature. When this happens, back
off on loader operation and allow the systems to cool
down to within normal operating temperature ranges.
If the temperatures don’t cool down, stop operating
4. Engine oil pressure. the unit, find the cause and correct.
When the engine oil pressure drops below nor-
mal pressure, the lamp will flash with a continu-
ous alarm.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 27

15
CONTINUOUSLY MONITORED ELEMENTS
The following machine elements are continuously
monitored by the EIC:
5. Hydrostatic charge pressure.
When the pressure drops below normal operat-
ing pressure the lamp will flash with a continuous
alarm.
1. Engine air filter.
Monitors the condition of the air cleaner element
and will signal when the element is dirty and re-
quires replacement.
6. Engine oil pressure.
When the engine oil pressure drops below nor-
mal pressure the lamp will flash with a continuous
alarm.
2. Hydraulic oil filter.
Monitors the condition of the filter and will signal
when the filter is dirty and requires replacement.

7. Transmission/Hydraulic oil temperature.


When the oil temperature is above operating
temperature of 99°C (210°F), the lamp will flash
3. Engine coolant temperature. with a 5-second alarm.
When the engine coolant temperature is above Whenever the EIC senses any unusual condition
operating temperature of 102°C (216°F), the in a monitored function, the associated lamp will
lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm. flash. The audible alarm will “beep” continuously
for 5 seconds.

4. Battery Voltage.
When battery voltage drops below normal volt-
age the lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm.
28 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ENGINE PREHEAT again be removed from the fuel solenoid in another


The EIC controls a timed pre-heat cold start aid to as- 30 seconds and the engine will again stop. During the
sist in cold weather starting. The timed pre-heat cycle 30-second alarm period, the “ENGINE STOP” sym-
will vary from 0 to 40 seconds automatically based on bol will flash. If this condition continues, locate the
engine coolant temperature. For additional pre-heat fault and repair.
if the loader does not start, turn the ignition key to the IMPORTANT: Use caution when restarting the
“OFF” position. Then turn the ignition key back to the loader because of the possibility of NO LUBRICAT-
“RUN” position again. This will restart the preheat ING OILS for the engine and/or the hydrostatic trans-
timed cycle. mission. DO NOT restart the loader more than once
or operate the engine at high speeds. Damage to the
AUTOMATIC SHUTDOWN engine and/or transmissions may occur. Contact
your New Holland dealer for assistance.
If either the engine oil pressure, or hydrostatic charge
pressure fall below certain limits, the EIC will remove WARNING
power from the fuel solenoid after 30 seconds, stop- When the engine stop symbol flashes for the 30-sec-
ping the engine. ond period, immediately lower the boom and move
If this condition occurs, turn off the ignition key. Be- the loader to a non-traffic area for problem evalu-
fore unbuckling the seat belt, turn the ignition key to ation.
the “ON” position and lower the boom and attach-
ment to the ground or rest the boom on the boom If an alarm is caused by 3, 4, or 7, the CHARACTER
lockpins. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position. DISPLAY will change to show the numeric value of
The operator may immediately restart the engine the function that caused the alarm.
again. Should the function remain faulted, power will
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 29

1 2 3 7 4 5 6

16
OPERATING MODE 5. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE –
By pressing and releasing the “ARROW” switch, 1, Reads COLD until 0°C (32°F)
during normal skid steer operation, the operator can 6. TRANSMISSION/HYDRAULIC OIL TEM-
select a function to be monitored. Only one function PERATURE – Reads COLD until 0°C (32°F)
can be monitored and displayed at a time in the dis-
play, 7. By pressing and releasing the “ARROW” If a fault occurs in the following monitored functions,
switch once, the EIC will select the next monitored the EIC will automatically show that function’s read-
function. Functional symbols are located across the ing in the character display, accompanied by a flash-
top of the EIC display and will light up when selected. ing light and a five second audible alarm.
Note that the engine hour symbol, 4, is not illumi-
nated. FAULT READING
Monitored functions are: Battery Voltage Battery Voltage
(Low & High)
2. ENGINE RPM
Engine Coolant (High) Temperature in
3. BATTERY VOLTAGE Degrees
4. ENGINE HOURS (No Light) Transmission/ Temperature in
Hydraulic Oil (High) Degrees
30 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

17
If a fault occurs in the following monitored functions FAULT CODE
a fault code will appear in the EIC character display,
1, accompanied by a five second audible alarm. By Hydraulic Boom/Bucket Solenoid (F0A)
turning the ignition key switch to the “OFF” position Engine Preheat Relay Coil (F03)
the EIC will return to the normal operating mode. If
Fuel Solenoid (F04)
when the loader is restarted and the fault still exists,
the code will reappear with an alarm indicating there
is an open or short in that circuit. Contact your New
Holland dealer for assistance.
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––

1 2

18
If a fault occurs in the following monitored functions FAULT
the EIC will signal the operator with a flashing light 1. Hydraulic Oil Filter
accompanied by a five second audible alarm indicat- 2. Engine Air Cleaner
ing the filter(s) require service.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 31

19
If a fault occurs for more than 30 seconds in the fol- BROKEN ALTERNATOR/WATER PUMP BELT
lowing monitored functions the EIC will signal the op- WARNING, 3
erator with a flashing light, a continuous audible
If the drive belt breaks the EIC will signal the operator
alarm and will stop the engine after 30 seconds of
with the battery symbol light, 3, flashing, accompa-
operation.
nied by an audible alarm.
FAULT
NOTE: The engine will shut down automatically.
1. Engine Oil Pressure Then immediately turn the ignition key to “OFF” posi-
tion to prevent engine overheating or damage.
2. Hydrostatic Transmission Charge Pressure
If a fault occurs in one of these functions, the engine
can be restarted and the skid steer moved to a safe
inspection area with the boom resting on the boom
lock pins or on the ground. If the fault still exists, the
EIC will stop the engine after another 30 seconds.
IMPORTANT: Use caution when restarting the skid
steer because of the possibility of NO LUBRICATING
OILS for the engine and/or the hydrostatic
transmissions. DO NOT restart the skid steer more
than once or operate the engine at high engine
speeds. Damage to the engine and/or transmission
may occur. Contact your New Holland dealer for
assistance.
32 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

FUEL LEVEL
1
Fuel level is shown to the operator by the fuel gauge
bar lights located in the center of the EIC display at
1. The operator will be signaled when the level is at
three bars and again at two bars. The bar lights, 2, will
flash continuously accompanied by an audible alarm
for about five seconds at each signal level.
2

20
EIC INTERLOCKS
1
EIC controls the fuel solenoid circuit. The operator
must be in the seat, with the seat belt fastened before 2
the engine will start and continue to run.
The EIC will lock the boom and bucket control valve
spools in neutral if the operator unfastens the seat
belt, leaves the seat, or turns the ignition key off. If the
operator is out of the seat for more than two seconds,
the seat belt must be unfastened and refastened to 3
enable the boom and bucket hydraulic systems to
function.
The unit is equipped with a “SERVICE/RUN” switch
for use during servicing and troubleshooting of the 19984593
skid steer. To access the Service/Run switch located 21
under the cab fuse panel cover, 1, loosen the two
thumbscrews, 2, and rotate cover, 1, to the side.
When the “SERVICE/RUN” switch, 3, is in the “SER-
VICE” position, the engine will start but the boom and
bucket hydraulic system will be inoperative.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 33

1 3

22
EIC LOCK MODE 11. With the two (2) digit code entered, “01 to 99”,
A two digit code can be entered into the EIC which will turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position and exit
lock the boom and bucket spool lock solenoids when the loader, allowing all the EIC board lights to go
the spools are in the neutral position. This will prevent “OFF”, locking the EIC.
movement of the boom and bucket. When the EIC board lights go off, the lock code will
The same two digit code must be reentered to unlock enter the EIC memory, locking the EIC until the same
the solenoids and return the loader to normal oper- two digit code is reentered.
ation. To reenter the same two (2) digit code to return the
To enter a security code: loader to normal operation:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the ground and 1. Sit in the operator’s seat.
position the bucket to prevent movement of the 2. The EIC will display “LOC 0 0” with the left digit
loader. flashing.
2. Turn “OFF” the ignition key. 3. Turn the ignition key switch to the “ON” position;
3. Unbuckle the seat belt, raise your weight off the Do Not engage the starter.
seat, and wait until all EIC lights are off. 4. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch and
4. While out of the seat, press and hold the “OPEN enter the left number of the code previously used
BOOK” switch, 2, then sit in the seat and turn the to lock the loader.
ignition key to the “ON” position; Do Not engage 5. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, the right
the starter. zero will flash.
5. Display, 3, will show the program level of the EIC 6. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch to
board (example r0100). At this time release the enter the right number of the code previously
“OPEN BOOK” switch. used to lock the loader.
6. Display, 3, will show “LOC_ _” for lock. 7. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position and
7. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until allow the EIC to return to the operating mode.
two (2) zeros appear “LOC 0 0” with the left zero 8. Buckle the seat belt and proceed with normal
flashing, then release the “OPEN BOOK” switch. skid steer operation.
8. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch and If the two digit code is forgotten, the EIC can be un-
enter any number from “0” to “9” for the left digit. locked by using a (MASTER CODE). Contact your
9. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1, the dealer for assistance.
right zero will start to flash. The dealer will require your name, address and the
10. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch and skid steer model and serial numbers.
enter any number from “1” to “9” for the right digit.
34 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

EIC ENGINE PREHEAT


1
The engine preheat is governed automatically by the
EIC based on coolant temperature and engine code.
Preheat is initiated when the ignition key is turned to
the “RUN” position and the cycle time will vary from
0 to 40 seconds.
Turn the ignition key to the “RUN” position, and the
EIC character display, 1, will show seconds remain-
ing for engine preheat time. The preheat indicator
light, 2, will be lit during the preheat cycle. The oper-
ator should wait until the display zeros “0”, the indica-
tor light goes “off”, and the audible alarm sounds to 2
start the engine. If the loader does not start, re-cycle
the engine preheat timer by turning the ignition key 23
“OFF” then ON”. This will restart the timed preheat
cycle.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 35

TROUBLESHOOTING

ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EIC) TROUBLESHOOTING


PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION
EIC board will not light up when Service/run switch in service Push switch to run position
operator sits in seat position

Faulty seat switch Replace switch

No battery voltage to seat switch Blown 5-amp fuse electronic battery


in engine panel, replace fuse

Open in power wire from 5-amp fuse


to seat switch, repair open in wire

No battery voltage to 5-amp fuse


from supply, check and/or replace
battery

Blown 5-amp fuse (electronic Replace fuse


battery) in engine panel

No battery voltage from seat Open in power wire from seat switch
switch to EIC board to EIC board, repair open in wire

Poor or no connection at EIC board,


repair connection

Battery voltage from seat switch If battery voltage from seat to board
to EIC board is OK, replace EIC board
EIC board backlighting Brightness variations due to None –– overlay decal material
is dim production differences between variations cause differences in
models and/or EIC board brightness
changes

Backlights dim when the loader None –– EIC board circuitry


worklights are activated automatically dims the backlighting
when the work lights are on, to
reduce board glare at night
EIC board seat belt light will not go off Seat belt not buckled Buckle seat belt
with seat belt buckled
Faulty seat belt buckle switch Replace seat belt assembly

No battery voltage from seat Open in wire from seat switch to


switch to seat belt switch seat belt switch, repair open

No battery voltage from seat belt Open in wire from seat belt switch to
switch to EIC board EIC board, repair open

Poor or no connection at EIC board,


repair connection

Battery voltage from seat belt If voltage OK, replace EIC board
switch to EIC board
36 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION


EIC will not read correct engine Incorrect engine configuration Correct configuration
RPMs, varies more than ± 50 RPMs
No AC voltage at tachometer Repair alternator
terminal at alternator

Loose or corroded connection at Repair connection


tachometer terminal at alternator

No AC voltage at EIC board from Open in wire from alternator to EIC


alternator board, repair open

AC voltage from alternator to EIC Repair loose or corroded


board connection at EIC board

Wire connection from alternator If OK, replace EIC board


to EIC board
EIC will not unlock boom and bucket Service/Run switch in Push switch to “RUN” position
spool locks “SERVICE” position

Seat belt unbuckled Buckle seat belt

Faulty seat belt buckle Replace seat belt assembly

No battery voltage from seat belt Open in power wire from seat belt
switch to EIC switch, repair open

No battery voltage from EIC to Open in power wire from EIC to


spool lock solenoids solenoids, repair open

Battery voltage to lock solenoids If OK, check inoperative solenoids,


check solenoid coils, repair or
replace
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 37

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE CORRECTION


Engine will not start and/or run Seat belt unbuckled Buckle seat belt

Incorrect engine configuration Correct configuration


(EIC)

No battery voltage to start relay Open in power wire from key switch
“start” to relay, or through seat/seat
belt circuits to relay, repair open

No battery voltage from EIC to Open in power wire from EIC to fuel
fuel solenoid solenoid, repair open

Open in the W/O wire from the Repair open in W/O wire
seat/seat belt plug to the start
interlock relay

Inoperative start interlock relay Repair or replace

Fuel solenoid inoperative Repair or replace fuel solenoid

Inoperative manifold heater Incorrect engine configuration,


system correct configuration

No power to manifold heater Manifold heater preheat relay or


LTBL/B wire open, repair or replace

Circuit breaker open, replace

Inoperative manifold heater Replace manifold heater

No fuel to manifold heater Check fuel feed tube and fuel supply
from injection pump
EIC will not read monitored circuits Incorrect engine configuration Correct engine configuration

Open or short in wire from sensor Repair open/short


to EIC

Faulty sender or sensor Repair/replace sender or sensor


38 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ADVANCED WARNING SYSTEM (AWS) The AWS provides the following features for dealer
This skid steer is equipped with an Advanced Warn- technician use in diagnostics and troubleshooting of
ing System (AWS) that provides information to the the monitored function circuits:
operator about the operation of the skid steer. Diagnostics
The AWS provides an interlock system with the seat – Test individual monitored circuits.
and seat belt to prevent movement of the boom and
bucket if the operator is out of the seat or the seat belt Fault/Warning History
is unbuckled and the controls are in neutral. – Fault occurrence with hour level of last occur-
The AWS provides an automatic engine preheat sys- rence.
tem to aid in cold weather starting.
The AWS provides information to the operator about Clear Faults
the following monitored functions: – Clear Faults to zero.
– Hydraulic Oil Filter
– Engine Air Filter Engine Code
– Engine Preheat Relay Coil – Set EIC to loader engine model.
– Fuel Level
– Fuel Solenoid Select Displayed Temperature Units, Fahrenheit or
– Engine Coolant Temperature Celsius
– Hydrostatic Transmission Charge Pressure – Temperature displayed in English (Fahrenheit)
or Metric (Celsius).
– Transmission/Hydraulic Oil Temperature
– Battery Voltage Adjust Engine RPM
– Engine Oil Pressure – Calibrate EIC display to external RPM tach read-
– Alternator/Water Pump Belt Breakage Warning ing.
– Operator Seat and Seat Belt
– Hydraulic Boom/Bucket Solenoid Clear Memory
– Engine RPM – Return EIC to original factory settings.
– Engine Hours – Engine code reset to (01).
– Hours reset to (0000.0) zero.
The AWS provides an engine shut down feature if the – Temperature displayed (Fahrenheit).
engine oil pressure or the hydrostatic transmission – Engine RPM calibration cleared.
charge pressure are low.
The AWS will signal the operator if the alternator/ Adjust skid steer hours
water pump drive belt fails. – Change unit hours when installing a new EIC
The AWS provides a security feature allowing the op- board in a loader.
erator to enter a two digit security code, preventing
starting of the engine and movement of the boom and
bucket.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 39

24
EIC BOARD SELF TEST 3. The EIC will enter the normal start up mode.
When first sitting in the operator’s seat and/or before 4. Turning the ignition key to the “ON” position will
entering Diagnostics, allow the EIC board to self test. start the automatic engine preheat system (if re-
(Service/Run switch in the “RUN” position) quired).
Sit in operator’s seat. NOTE: The preheat times will vary from 0 to 40 sec-
1. The EIC board should light all symbol lights. onds, depending on engine temperature.
2. The character display should read “8888.8”, 1, If the EIC does not function as described, check the
and the fuel gauge (light bar), 2, should light seat and seat belt switches for proper operation and
showing 9 bars. EIC board power and ground circuits.
40 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

1 3

25
DIAGNOSTIC AND SETUP MODES tion key to the “ON” position; Do Not engage the
When in the Diagnostic Mode, the technician can test starter.
the individual monitored circuit wiring. When in the 5. Display, 3, will show the program level of the EIC
Setup Mode, the technician can make changes to the board (example - r0100); at this time, release the
EIC and perform additional troubleshooting. “OPEN BOOK” switch.
6. Display will show “LOC_ _” for lock.
To Enter Diagnostic Or Setup Mode: 7. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1;
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the ground or re- “dIAg” (for Diagnostic) will appear in the char-
move any attachment and rest the boom on the acter display.
boom lock pins. 8. Press and release the “ARROW” switch again
2. Turn “OFF” the ignition key. will move to the “SEtUP” mode in the display.
3. Unbuckle the seat belt, raise your weight off the Pressing and holding the “OPEN BOOK” switch
seat, and wait until all EIC lights are off. when in either mode will enter the selected mode for
4. While out of the seat, press and hold the “OPEN tests or changes to the EIC.
BOOK” switch, 2, sit in the seat and turn the igni-
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 41

1 2

26
EIC Diagnostics and Setup Items With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock.
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1;
Diagnostics Mode “dIAg” will appear in the character display, 2.
______________________________________________________________________________________
_________

27
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until 1. EIC board bulbs
a low case “d” appears in the character display, 2. EIC board circuits
2, release the “OPEN BOOK” switch. The EIC is 3. EIC board arrow and open book switches
now in Diagnostics. 4. Audible beeper
Each individual monitored circuit can now be tested 5. Engine air filter circuit
for proper operation. 6. Hydraulic oil filter circuit
7. Hydrostatic transmission charge pressure circuit
When in Diagnostics and any circuit is activated the
8. Engine oil pressure circuit
EIC board will light all lights and an audible alarm will
9. Engine Coolant temperature circuit
sound.
10. Transmission/hydraulic oil temperature circuit
The Diagnostic test will not verify the performance of 11. Fuel level circuit
a sensor or sender. Only the EIC board and wires to 12. Seat switch(es) and circuit
the sender or sensor are tested. 13. Seat belt switch and circuit
14. Service/Run switch
The following circuits can be tested:
42 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ARROW, OPEN BOOK, AND AUDIBLE


ALARM TEST
In this mode, by pressing the “ARROW,” 1, or “OPEN
BOOK,” 2, switches, all of the display segments are
turned on for verification and at the same time with an
audible beep. If all segments do not light the circuit
bulb or wires to the switches, sensors or senders may
be defective.
To check the individual EIC board circuits and circuits
to the switches, sensors, and senders, perform the
following “EIC CIRCUIT TESTS”.
Whenever any of the sensors or switches are toggled
on or off, the EIC board will light and the audible
alarm will briefly beep. This indicates that the wire to 28
the sensor or switch is intact, but does not yield any
information about the condition of the sensor.
DIAGNOSTIC MODE EIC CIRCUIT TESTS
To simulate a fault condition while in the diagnostic
mode do the following:
NOTE: When in the diagnostic mode and a circuit is
triggered, all the board lights will light up accompa-
nied by an audible beep.
1. Hydraulic Oil Filter Restriction Switch

Remove the DKGN/O filter sensor wire, 1, from


29
the sender.
The EIC board lights will all light up and the board
will beep when this test is performed.
If the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and cir-
cuit wire to the sensor is OK. The problem is in
the sensor; replace the sensor. If the EIC board
fails to light and beep, check the wire from the
sensor to the EIC board.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 43

2. Air Cleaner Switch

Remove one wire at a time from the sensor


switch on the air cleaner canister. Remove the B
wire, 1, and the EIC board will light and beep
when the wire is removed from the switch. Re-
move the B/Y wire, 2, and the EIC board will light
and beep. 2
If the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and cir-
cuit wire to the sensor is OK. The problem is in 30
the sensor; replace the sensor. If the EIC board
fails to light and beep, check the wires from the
sensors to the EIC board.
3. Hydrostatic Charge Pressure Switch, 1

Remove one wire at a time from the sensor


switch at the charge check valve. Remove the
Y/GY wire and the EIC board will light and beep.
Remove the B wire and the EIC board will light
and beep.
If the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and cir-
cuit wire to the sensor is OK. The problem is in
the sensor; replace the sensor. If the EIC board 31
fails to light and beep, check the wires from the
sensor to the EIC board.
4. Engine Oil Pressure Sensor

Remove the Y/B wire, 1, from the sensor and the


EIC board will light and beep.
If the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and cir-
cuit wire to the sensor is OK. The problem is in
the sensor; replace the sensor. If the EIC board
fails to light and beep, check the wires from the
sensor to the EIC board.
32
44 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

5. Coolant Temperature Sensor

Remove the PU/LTGN wire, 1, from the sensor


and short the wire to ground.
The EIC board will light and beep when the wire
is removed from the sender and grounded. 1
If the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and cir-
cuit wire to the sensor is OK. The problem is in
the sensor; replace the sensor. If the EIC board 19987797
fails to light and beep, check the wires from the 33
sensor to the EIC board.
6. Transmission/Hydraulic Oil Temperature Sensor

Remove the PU/LTBL wire from the sensor, 1,


and short the wire to ground.
The EIC board will light and beep when the wire
is removed from the sender and grounded.
If the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and cir-
cuit wire to the sensor is OK. The problem is in
the sensor; replace the sensor. If the EIC board
fails to light and beep, check the wires from the 34
sensor to the EIC board.
7. Fuel Gauge

Disconnect one wire, 1, and use a jumper wire


and connect sender terminal to other terminal, 2,
and the EIC board will light and beep. If the EIC
board lights and beeps, the EIC and circuit wires
to the sender are OK. If the EIC board fails to
light, check the wires to the EIC board. 2

35
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 45

8. Seat Switch and Circuit


Raise your weight off the centre of the seat and
then sit back on the seat. The EIC board will light
and beep. If the board lights and beeps, the
switch and circuit are OK. If the board fails to light
and beep, check the seat switch and circuit to the
seat switch for battery voltage. If there is battery
voltage to the switch, check the switch for oper-
ation and the circuit from the switch to the EIC
board. If there is no battery voltage to the switch,
check the circuit to the switch.

36
9. Seat Belt Switch and Circuit
The operator must be sitting in the seat.
Unbuckle and rebuckle the seat belt. The EIC
board will light and beep. If the board lights and
beeps, the switch and circuit are OK. If the board
fails to light and beep, check the seat belt switch
and circuit from the seat switch for battery volt-
age. If there is battery voltage to the switch,
check the switch for operation and the circuit
from the seat belt switch to the EIC board. If there
is no battery voltage from the seat switch, check
the seat switch for operation and the wire to the
seat belt switch.
37
10. Service/Run Switch, 1
The operator must be sitting in the seat.
Switch between “SERVICE” and “RUN”. The EIC 1
board will light and beep. If the board fails to light
and beep, check the switch and circuit for battery
voltage.
To exit Diagnostics and move to the next item,
press and hold the “ARROW” switch until “dIAg”
is displayed in the character display, then release
the switch. Pressing the “ARROW” switch again
will move the EIC to the SETUP Mode. To exit and
return to the Normal Operating Mode turn the
ignition key switch to the “OFF” position. 19984337
38
46 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

EIC SETUP MODE – Calibrate EIC display to external RPM tach read-
The EIC Setup Mode is made up of several items: ing.
FAULt - Fault/Warning history
CLr F - Clear Faults
– Fault occurrence with hour level of last occur-
rence. – Clear Faults to zero.

Eng 0 0 - Engine Code HourS - Adjust skid steer hours


– Set EIC to loader engine model. – Change unit hours when installing a new EIC
board in a loader.
Unit F or Unit C - Select Displayed Temperature
Units, Fahrenheit or Celsius CLr E - Clear Memory
– Temperature displayed in English (Fahrenheit) – Return EIC to original factory settings.
or Metric (Celsius). – Engine code reset to (01).
– Hours reset to (0000.0) zero.
r-CAL - Adjust Engine RPM – Temperature displayed (Fahrenheit).
– Engine RPM calibration cleared.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 47

2
1

39
FAULt - Fault/Warning history
With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock.
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1;
“dIAg” will appear in the character display. Then
press and release the “ARROW” switch again;
“SEtUP” will appear in the display, 2.
______________________________________________________________________________________
_________

40
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until
“FAULt” appears in the character display, 2.
48 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

41
Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until
“F0-XX” appears in the display. The “F0” is the fault
and the “XX” is the number of occurrences of that
fault since the fault memory was last cleared. The
fault code display will be accompanied by an illumi-
nated front panel symbol identifying the fault. Thus,
“F0” is identified via the illuminated oil filter symbol,
2, example “F0-02” is showing in display, 3, F0 code
with 02 occurrences.
Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch will dis-
play the hour of the last occurrence, for this code,
example “0565.3” hours. Pressing and releasing the
“OPEN BOOK” switch will return the EIC to the fault
code.

42
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 49

Pressing and releasing the “ARROW” switch again


will forward to the next fault “F1-00” and pressing and
releasing the “OPEN BOOK” switch again will display
the hour of the last occurrence if any fault occur-
rences were shown. Use this procedure to go
through all the fault codes:
FAULT SYMBOL
CODES FAULT LIGHT
F0-00 Hydraulic oil filter Oil filter
F1-00 Engine air cleaner Air cleaner
F2-00 Not used Blank
F3-00 Engine preheat Preheat
F4-00 Fuel solenoid Fuel level bar lights
F5-00 Engine coolant 43
temperature Engine coolant
F6-00 Hydrostatic transmission
charge pressure Charge pressure
F7-00 Transmission/Hydraulic
oil temperature Oil temperature
F8-00 Battery voltage Battery
F9-00 Engine oil pressure Oil pressure
FA-00 Hydraulic boom/bucket
solenoid Seat belt
50 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

2
1

44
Once all faults have been identified, the fault history Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1, until “CLr
can be cleared to zero. F” appears in the character display, 2.
To return to “FAULt” and clear the faults, press and
hold the “ARROW” switch, 1, until the original
“FAULt” item is displayed in the character display.
______________________________________________________________________________________
_________

45
Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until To exit this item, press and hold the “ARROW” switch
“CLEAr” appears in the display, 2. Then release the to return to the “SEtUP” mode, or turn the ignition key
switch to clear all fault occurrences from the fault his- switch to the “OFF” position to return the EIC to the
tory memory. Normal Operating Mode.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 51

Eng 0 0 - Engine Code


With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock: 1
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch; “dIAg”
will appear in the character display. Then press
and release the “ARROW” switch again; “SEtUP”
will appear in the display.
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until
“FAULt” appears in the character display; re-
lease switch.
3. Press and release the “ARROW” switch until
“EngXX” (XX=current engine code) appears in
the display, 1.
4. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until
46
the left digit starts to flash; release switch.
5. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” to enter a
zero (0) into the left digit of the engine code.
6. Press and release the “ARROW” switch; the right
digit will flash.
7. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch to
enter the right number of the engine code.
(Example Eng 03 for the LS180 skid steers is
shown in display, 1.)
The engine codes are as follows.
03 - SL65B

To exit this item, press and hold the “ARROW” switch


two times to return to the “SEtUP” mode item list, or
turn the ignition key switch to the “OFF” position to re-
turn the EIC to the normal operating mode.
52 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Unit F or Unit C (EIC Reading Fahrenheit or


Celsius) 1
With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock.
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch; “dIAg”
will appear in the character display. Then press
and release the “ARROW” switch again; “SEtUP”
will appear in the display.
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until
“FAULt” appears in the character display; re-
lease switch.
3. Press and release the “ARROW” switch until
“Unit F” or “Unit C” appears in the character dis-
play, 1.
47
4. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until
the rightmost letter flashes, then release the
switch.
5. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” to change
from F to C or C to F.
– Unit F will read temperature degrees in Fahr-
enheit
– Unit C will read temperature degrees in
Celsius

To exit this item press and hold the “ARROW” switch


two times to return to the “SEtUP” mode item list or
turn the ignition key switch to the “OFF” position to re-
turn the EIC to the Normal Operating Mode.
r-CAL - Adjust Engine RPMS
With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock. 1
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch; “dIAg”
will appear in the character display. Then press
and release the “ARROW” switch again; “SEtUP”
will appear in the display.
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until
“FAULt” appears in the character display, release
switch.
3. Press and release the “ARROW” switch until
“r-CAL” appears in the character display, 1.

48
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 53

4. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until all


zeros are displayed in the character display. 1
Upon releasing of the switch only the right zero
will be showing in display, 1.
5. Buckle the seat belt and start the engine. Using
a hand held photo-tach or other accurate
measuring device, check the engine RPM at high
idle (full throttle). Compare the hand held tach re-
ading to the EIC RPM reading.
6. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” or
“ARROW” switches to change the EIC reading to
match the tach at high idle. Pressing the “OPEN
BOOK” switch will decrease the reading and
pressing the “ARROW” switch will increase the 49
reading.
For best results, RPM should be calibrated at full
throttle only.
NOTE: The “OPEN BOOK” or “ARROW” switches
may have to be pressed multiple times to change the
reading, this is normal. When changing the high idle
reading, the low idle reading will have a slight
change.
To exit this item, turn the ignition key switch to the
“OFF” position to return the EIC to the Normal Oper-
ating Mode.
54 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT CLUSTER


(EIC) AND STARTER CIRCUITS 1
BLOWN FUSE SYMPTOMS AND TESTING

Electronic Ignition Fuse, 1


(Cab Fuse Panel - 5A)
Service/Run Switch “Run” Position
1. Board shows self test (with operator in seat).
2. Board shows 5.2 volts.
3. Board seat belt and park brake lights will flash.
4. Board seat belt light will go off when seat belt is 19984337
buckled. Park brake light will still flash. 50
5. Key “ON” position - board will show 5.2 volts and
no preheat cycle.
6. Engine will crank but will not start.
7. Toggle Service/Run switch to “SERVICE” posi-
tion - unit will start.
Electronic Battery Fuse, 1
(Engine Fuse Panel - 5A)
Service/Run Switch “Run” Position
1. When operator sits in seat, the board will not
power up - no readings. 1
2. Unit will not crank.
3. Toggle Service/Run Switch to - “SERVICE” posi- 2
tion - unit will crank and may start if engine is
warm, NO preheat is available.

Key Main Fuse, 2


(Engine Fuse Panel - 15A)
Service/Run Switch “Run” Position 19984973

1. Board will power up and self test. 51


2. Board seat belt and park brake lights will flash.
3. Board seat belt light will go off when seat belt is
buckled; the park brake light will still flash.
4. Key on - system dead.
5. Toggle Service/Run Switch to “SERVICE” posi-
tion - system dead.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 55

IMPORTANT: If any servicing or adjustments require


the battery to be disconnected, or welding is required
on the skid steer, disconnect the negative (-) ground
cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster)
monitoring system and other electrical components.
IMPORTANT: If the EIC requires removal from the
dash area or the skid steer, disconnect the negative
(-) ground battery cable. This will shut off power to the
EIC and prevent damage to the EIC board or prevent
blowing the 5-amp fuses if the board is accidentally
grounded.
IMPORTANT: Do not use magnetized tools while
working around the EIC board or damage to the EIC 52
may occur.
To test for a blown fuse, remove the fuse from the
fuse block and visually examine the fuse link. If the
fuse link is blown, replace the fuse.
If the fuse link appears OK, check the fuse with an
ohmmeter and check for continuity across the fuse
legs; if there is continuity, the fuse is OK.
56 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

TESTING OTHER EIC FUNCTIONS


NOTE: These tests are performed with the EIC in the
normal operating mode and the “SERVICE/RUN”
switch in the “RUN” position.
1. Parking Brake Light

Sit in the seat with the seat belt buckled. After the
EIC board self test, the parking brake light, 1,
should flash. Turn the ignition key to the “ON”
position and the light should go off. If the light fails
to go off, check the 5-amp fuse in the cab fuse
panel. 53
When exiting the loader with the ignition key in
the “ON” position, the light should flash for about
2 seconds after the seat belt is unbuckled and the
operator is out of the seat.
If the light does not flash when the seat belt is un-
buckled, check operation of the seat belt switch
and the seat switch.

2. Seat Belt Light

Sit in the seat. After the EIC board self tests, the
seat belt light, 1, will flash until the seat belt is
buckled.
If the light continues to flash after the seat belt is
buckled, check operation of the seat belt switch.

54
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 57

3. Boom and Bucket Spool Locks, 1


(Control valve spools in neutral and boom and
bucket resting on the ground)
– Sit in the seat. After the EIC board self tests, 1
turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position.
The boom and bucket controls should not
move. If OK, go to the next step. If the con-
trols can be moved, check the solenoids for
operation and check the control linkage and
valve spool centering for binding causing the
spools not to center to the neutral position.
– Sit in the seat, buckle the seat belt and try
moving the boom and bucket controls. The 19997742
controls should not move. If OK, go to the 55
next step. If the controls can be moved,
check the solenoids for operation and check
the control linkage and valve spool centering
for binding causing the spools not to center
to the neutral position.
– Sit in the seat, buckle the seat belt, and turn
the ignition switch to the “ON” position. If the
controls move allowing boom and bucket
operation, go to the next step. If the controls
do not move, check the solenoids for oper-
ation and for battery voltage at the solenoids.
– Sit in the seat, buckle the seat belt, and turn
the ignition switch to the “ON” position. Move
the controls and return the controls to the
centered (neutral) position. Unbuckle the
seat belt. Try moving the controls; they
should be locked. Rebuckle the seat belt; the
controls should move allowing boom and
bucket movement.
58 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

4. Boom and Bucket Spool Lock Solenoid Test


Voltage Test 1
To perform the following test, the operator must
be sitting in the seat, seat belt buckled, and the
ignition “key” switch in the “RUN” position.
– Unplug one solenoid at a time and check for
battery voltage at the main wire harness con-
nector, 1, between the PK/LTBL wire side of
the connector and the B wire side of the con-
nector. If there is battery voltage, proceed to
checking solenoid resistance.
– If there is no battery voltage between the PK/
19997742
LTBL wire and the B wire, check for battery
voltage between the PK/LTBL wire and 56
frame ground. If there is battery voltage,
check the “B” ground wire of the solenoid cir-
cuit for open circuit. If there is no battery volt-
age, check the PK/LTBL power wire for an
open circuit.
Ohms Test
With the ignition “key” switch in the “OFF” posi-
tion:
– Unplug one solenoid at a time, 1, and check
ohms resistance of the solenoid coils, 15 to
18 ohm range.
– If solenoid coils are not within the ohms resis-
tance range, 15 to 18 ohms, replace the sole-
noid coil.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 59

EIC BOARD READING ACCURACY


EIC board readings for the digital display, including
RPM, Battery Voltage, Hourmeter, Engine Coolant
Temperature, or Hydraulic Oil Temperature may not
be accurate or may have no reading when selected.
Complaints usually follow installation of an optional
kit or customer-installed option, or complaints can
arise after a machine repair such as engine overhaul
or cab tilting. However, occasionally a concern on a
standard machine with no modifications is reported.
If the EIC board was operating correctly before any
repair or kit installation occurred, the possible cause
may be improper electrical system grounding. If
working on a new machine, grounding points should
be checked before any replacement of components
is considered.
THE ONLY ACCEPTABLE GROUND POINTS IN
THE CAB AREA ARE TO THE GROUND STUD ON
THE ROPS RIGHT SIDE NEAR ELECTRICAL
PANEL, 1, OR TO THE AUXILIARY POWER KIT
SOCKET WHICH IS WIRED TO THE BELL HOUS-
ING GROUND. NO ACCESSORIES MAY BE
GROUNDED TO THE CAB INTERLINER ON LS180
OR LS190 SKID STEERS BECAUSE SOME OR
ALL OF THE CURRENT COULD PASS THROUGH
THE EIC.
NOTE: When attaching ground wires to the cab
ground stud, always place the heaviest ground wire
next to the ground surface and then stack the remain-
ing ground wires according to wire size, largest on
57
the bottom and smallest last.
60 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

All grounding locations should be checked for tight


hardware and absence of paint between parts for
good connecting, as follows:
1. Check the grounding strap from the engine to
main frame, 1.
On the grounding strap from the ROPS to the
main frame, be sure the strap is attached be-
tween the ROPS and the main frame (yellow
lower frame). DO NOT attach the strap between
the cab interliner (cab side screen sections) and
the main frame, as the cab interliner on SL65B
skid steers is rubber-mounted to the ROPS and,
therefore, insulated from the ROPS.
However, a second strap may be added between 58
the cab interliner and the main frame and should
cause no ill effect.

59
2. Check the grounding strap from the cab ROPS
structure to main frame, 1.
3. Check the wiring harness from the EIC to the bell
housing.

60
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 61

4. Check the wiring harness grounds to the bell


housing, 1.
NOTE: When attaching multiple ground wires, al-
ways place the heaviest ground wire (battery ground
cable) next to the ground surface (bell housing).
Stack the remaining ground wires according to wire
size, largest on the bottom and smallest last. Two
wires in a terminal are considered to be larger than
a single wire of the same size.

61
5. Check the black wire in engine harness between
the bell housing and the starter mounting with
negative battery cable, 1.
Due to the distance between the bell housing
ground point and the starter mounting at the at-
tachment of the negative battery cable, a separ-
ate ground wire is used between these points to
carry the current across bolted assemblies.
Check the integrity of this wire at the bell housing
ground point and its connection with the negative
battery cable and braided strap (from frame) at
starter mounting bolt.

62
62 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

EIC BOARD CLAIMS WARRANTY


When filing a warranty claim for a defective EIC
(Electronic Instrument Cluster) board, include the
part number and serial number on the white tag of the
defective board.
The EIC board part number, 1, and this number must
be used as the causal part number.
Also include the EIC board serial number located at
2
2, in the description of failure section of the warranty
claim, along with a description of the type of EIC 1
board failure.
19986414
Handling the EIC Board
63
The EIC board is shipped in an anti-static bag and
box. The board must be kept in this bag and box, until
required for a repair, to prevent damage to the EIC
board.
When returning the EIC board for warranty or repair,
it must be returned in the anti-static bag and box to
prevent damage.
When installing a new EIC board, always disconnect
the negative battery cable to prevent damage to the
board from accidental grounding.
The board versions listed below are the EIC boards
used on skid steers.
DO NOT replace a prior version board unless it is de-
fective.
Troubleshoot any problems and only replace the
board if it is determined to be the problem.
Boards returned as warranty and determined not to
be defective will be debited back. All EIC boards
claimed as warranty must be returned for review.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 63

ELECTRICAL CIRCUITS MAIN POWER CIRCUIT TO EIC BOARD

EIC (ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT CLUSTER) Battery voltage


The EIC board receives power from five different The power originates at the battery and proceeds
points. through the (R) battery cable to the starter solenoid.
1. Main power circuit, 12-volt battery, from the From there power continues through the (R) wire to
5-amp fuse in the engine fuse panel. the battery side of the start relay. The power con-
tinues through the (R) wire to the preheat circuit
2. The ignition switch, 12-volt ignition circuit. breaker, then through the (R) wire to the engine fuse
3. Seat switch circuit. panel (standard fuse block), battery side of the key
4. The seat belt switch circuit. main 15-amp fuse with a terminal bus to the battery
5. The ignition switch, 12-volt accessory circuit. side of the electronics 5A fuse. The power continues
through the (R/LTGN) wire to pin number 14 of con-
nector P2 (12-volt battery terminal) at the EIC board.

EIC BOARD GROUND CIRCUIT


The EIC board is grounded from connector P2 ter-
minal 13 through the (B) wire to the engine ground at
the bell housing.
R

W/R
4
B R
1
R

_ _ 2
R
_

3
R/LTGN

14 12V
13
B P2

R/LTGN

6 5A
P1
R

5 15A

BSC0943A

64
Main Power Circuit to EIC board
1. Battery 4. Preheat circuit breaker
2. Start solenoid/starter 5. Engine fuse panel
3. Start relay 6. EIC
64 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

W/R
4
B R
1
R

_ _ 2
R
_
3
T

8 P2

T T/W
4

LTGN/R
6
7 P1 5A

5 15A

BSC0944A LTGN/R

65
Seat Switch Circuit to EIC board
1. Battery 5. Engine fuse panel
2. Start solenoid/starter 6. EIC
3. Start relay 7. Service/run switch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 8. Seat switch

SEAT SWITCH CIRCUIT TO EIC BOARD The power continues through the (LTGN/R) wire to
the seat switch. When one seat switch (only 1 switch
Battery voltage needs to be closed as switches are in parallel wiring)
is pressed closed, the power then continues through
The power originates at the battery and proceeds the (T) wire to the Service/Run switch. When the ser-
through the (R) battery cable to the starter solenoid. vice/run switch is in the “SERVICE” position, the
From there power continues through the (R) wire to power stops.
the battery side of the start relay. With the Service/Run switch in the “RUN” position,
The power continues through the (R) wire to the pre- the power continues through the (T/W) wire to the
heat circuit breaker, then through the (R) wire to the EIC board terminal 4 of connector P2.
engine fuse panel (standard fuse block) battery side
of the key main 15-amp fuse with a terminal bus to the
battery side of the electronics 5A fuse.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 65

DKBL

T T
2
W/O LTGN

1 B
LTGN LTGN P2
11

3
P1

W/O
BSC0945A

66
Seat Belt Switch Circuit to EIC board
1. Seat switch 3. EIC
2. Seat belt switch 4. Start interlock relay

SEAT BELT SWITCH CIRCUIT TO EIC When the seat belt is buckled, the power proceeds
BOARD through the (LTGN) wire to the EIC board terminal 11
of connector P2.
Battery voltage When the seat belt is buckled, power is sent through
The power originates from the seat switch(es) the (W/O) wire to the start interlock relay. This allows
through the (T) wire to the seat belt switch. the unit to start when the seat belt is buckled.
66 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 67

W/R
4
B R
1
R

_ _ 2
R

_
3
O/PU–2

12 P2 ACC

BAT IGN

8 5
O
6
11 P1 5A
7 R/W R

15A

BSC0946A LTGN/B

67
Ignition Switch Circuit to EIC board
1. Battery 5. Engine fuse panel
2. Start solenoid/starter 6. EIC
3. Start relay 7. Service/run switch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 8. Seat switch

IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT TO EIC BOARD The power continues through the (R/W) wire to the
battery terminal of the ignition switch.
Battery voltage When the ignition key switch is turned to the “ON”
The power originates at the battery and proceeds position, power continues through the (O/PU-2) wire
through the (R) battery cable to the starter solenoid. to the Electronics 5-amp fuse in the cab fuse panel.
From there power continues through the (R) wire to The power continues through the (O) wire to terminal
the battery side of the start relay. 12 of connector P2 at the EIC board.
The power continues through the (R) wire to the pre- NOTE: Also, with Key Switch “ON” Engine “OFF,”
heat circuit breaker, then through the (R) wire to the voltage travels from the switch “ACC” terminal via the
engine fuse panel (standard fuse block) battery side LTGN/B wire to terminal 11 of connector P1 to pro-
of the key main 15-amp fuse. vide a warning of Key “ON” should the operator exit
the loader.
68 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

CRANKING CIRCUIT (STARTER MOTOR)


Operating conditions with “SERVICE/RUN” switch in
the “RUN” position:
1
To start the engine with the “SERVICE/RUN” switch
in the “RUN” position, 1, the operator must be in the
seat with the seat belt buckled. Then turn the key
switch to the “START” position to activate the starter.

19984337
68
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 69

W/R
4
B R
1
R

_ _ 2
R
_

W/DKBL
12 O O

LTBL/O
5
5A W/LTGN

O/PU 7 6
10
11 W
12 P2
W/O
ACC
9
W
BAT IGN
ST

W/LTGN
8 11 P1

R/W R
W
15A
R/W
BSC0947A

69
Service/Run Switch in the RUN Position
1. Battery 7. EIC
2. Start solenoid/starter 8. Seat/seat belt switch
3. Start relay 9. Start interlock relay
4. Preheat circuit breaker 10. Service/run switch
5. Fuel solenoid 11. Key switch
6. Engine fuse panel 12. Cab fuse panel

“SERVICE/RUN” SWITCH IN THE “RUN” Power then flows from the service/run switch through
POSITION the (W/LTGN) wire to the start interlock relay coil ter-
minal.
The power originates at the battery and flows through
the (R) positive battery cable to the starter solenoid. With the interlock energized, the power from the
From here the power flows through the (R) wire to the seat/seat belt circuit (W/O) wire flows through the
battery side of the start relay. (W/DKBL) wire to the start relay to activate the relay.
The power then flows through the (R) wire to the pre- Power also flows from the start interlock relay
heat circuit breaker and to the engine fuse panel to through the LTBL/O wire to the fuel solenoid to open
the 15A key main fuse. the solenoid, allowing fuel flow to the injection pump.
The power then flows through the (R/W) wire to the When the start relay is activated, power goes through
battery terminal on the ignition key switch. the (W/R) wire to the starter solenoid, which con-
nects battery power to the starter motor.
With the key switch in the “START” position, current
flows through the (W) wire to the service/run switch.
Power also flows through the (W) wire to connector
P2 terminal 10-key start at the EIC board.
70 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

2 3

B–4 B–6 B–8

BSC0948A

70
Cranking Circuit Ground
1. Start interlock relay 3. Preheat relay
2. Start relay 4. Engine bell housing

CRANKING CIRCUIT GROUND


The start interlock relay is grounded through the
(B-4) wire to the ground terminal on the start relay.
The system ground (B-6) wire then goes to the 1
ground terminal of the preheat relay. The system
ground (B-8) wire then goes to the engine ground at
the bell housing.
Operating Conditions “SERVICE/RUN” switch in the
“SERVICE” position
To start the engine with the “SERVICE/RUN” switch,
1, in the “SERVICE” position, the starter will be acti-
vated any time the key switch is turned to the
“START” position. 19984337

NOTE: If manual preheat is required, the operator 71


must be in the seat.
NOTE: The boom and bucket control valve spool
locks will remain inoperative with the “SERVICE/
RUN” switch in the “SERVICE” position.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 71

W/R
4
B R
1
R

_ _ 2
R
_
3

W/DKBL
8

7 5
ACC
W W BAT IGN
ST

R/W R/W R

15A
LTBL/O
6
BSC0949A

72
Service/Run Switch in the SERVICE Position
1. Battery 5. Engine fuse panel
2. Start solenoid/starter 6. Fuel solenoid
3. Start relay 7. Ignition keyswitch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 8. Service/run switch

SERVICE/RUN SWITCH IN THE “SERVICE” With the key switch in the “START” position, current
POSITION flows through the (W) wire to the service/run switch.
The power originates at the battery and flows through With the service/run switch in the “SERVICE” posi-
the (R) positive battery cable to the starter solenoid. tion, power goes through the (W/DKBL) wire from the
From here the power flows through the (R) wire to the service/run switch to the start relay to activate the
battery side of the start relay. relay.
The power then flows through the (R) wire to the pre- When the start relay is activated, power goes through
heat circuit breaker and to the engine fuse panel to the (W/R) wire to the starter solenoid, which con-
the 15A key main fuse. nects battery to the starter motor.
The power then flows through the (R/W) wire to the
battery terminal on the ignition key switch.
72 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

2 3

B–4 B–6 B–8

BSC0948A

73
Cranking Circuit Ground
1. Start interlock relay 3. Preheat relay
2. Start relay 4. Engine bell housing

CRANKING CIRCUIT GROUND


The start interlock relay is grounded through the
(B-4) wire to the ground terminal on the start relay.
The system ground (B-6) wire then goes to the
ground terminal of the preheat relay. The system
ground (B-8) wire then goes to the engine ground at
the bell housing.
START RELAY OPERATION
The start relay allows for smaller wires to be used in
the switch circuits. The larger wires are then only
used between the power supply, start relay, and
starter motor. The start relay provides a short path for
the high current required to pull in the starter solenoid
with minimal voltage drop.
The start relay, 1, and the preheat relay, 2, may be
wired in either position. Check wire colors for proper
relay location.

74
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 73

W/R
4
B R
1
R

_ _ 2
R

_
3
LTBL/O
W/DKBL 5

10 9
12
6
ACC W/DKBL
W
BAT IGN
ST
W/O
8
11
R/W R/W R
W/LTGN
7 15A

BSC0950A

75
Start Relay Circuit
1. Battery 7. Seat/seat belt switch
2. Start solenoid/starter 8. Start interlock relay
3. Start relay 9. Service/run switch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 10. Service position
5. Fuel solenoid 11. Run position
6. Engine fuse panel 12. Ignition key sitch

START RELAY CIRCUIT and the start interlock relay is energized by the
The power originates at the battery and flows through W/LTGN wire from the service/run switch, the start
the (R) positive battery cable to the starter solenoid. relay receives energizing power from the seat/seat
From here the power flows through the (R) wire to the belt circuit via the W/O wire, then the (W/DKBL) wire
battery side of the start relay. from the start interlock relay.
The power then flows through the (R) wire to the pre- When the service/run switch is in the “SERVICE”
heat circuit breaker and to the engine fuse panel to position, the start relay receives energizing power
the 15A key main fuse. through the (W/DKBL) wire from the service/run
switch.
The power then flows through the (R/W) wire to the
battery terminal on the ignition key switch. When the start relay is activated, it connects the bat-
tery side of the relay to the start side and sends power
When the service/run switch is in the “RUN” position, to the starter solenoid through the (W/R) wire, acti-
the operator is in the seat with the seat belt buckled, vating the starter motor.
74 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

1 2

B–6 B–8

BSC0951A
76
Start Relay Ground
1. Start relay 3. Engine bell housing
2. Preheat relay

START RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT


The start relay is grounded through the (B-6) wire to
the ground terminal on the preheat relay and then
through the (B-8) wire to the engine bell housing. 1

START INTERLOCK RELAY OPERATION


The start interlock relay, 1, controls the starting circuit
when the “SERVICE/RUN” switch is in the “RUN”
position, allowing the engine to start.

19984973
77
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 75

2 3

W/DKBL
B–4 B–6 B–8
O
4
5A

O
LTBL/O
O/PU
5

9 W/DKBL
ACC
W
BAT IGN B–4 W/O
ST 7
8

W/LTGN
6
BSC0952A

78
Start Interlock Circuit
1. Cab fuse panel 6. Seat/seat belt switch
2. Start relay 7. Start interlock relay
3. Preheat relay 8. Service/run switch
4. Engine bell housing 9. Ignition key switch
5. Fuel solenoid

START INTERLOCK CIRCUIT When the interlock is “satisfied” that the service/run
“SERVICE/RUN” switch in the “RUN” position. switch is in the “RUN” position and the operator is sit-
ting in the seat with the seat belt buckled, power will
The start interlock relay coil receives power from the travel through the W/DKBL wire to the start relay and
service/run switch, with the switch in the “RUN” posi- through the LTBL/O wire to the fuel solenoid, allowing
tion, through the W/LTGN wire. The interlock re- the engine to start. The source for the fuel solenoid
ceives power from the seat/seat belt plug when the power is from key switch “Ign,” then through the O/PU
operator is sitting in the seat with the seat belt wire to the cab 5-amp fuse, then via the O wire to the
buckled through the W/O wire. relay.
76 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

1 2 3

B–4 B–6 B–8


4
W/DKBL

LTBL/O
7 5
ACC
W
BAT IGN
ST

BSC0953A

79
Start Interlock Ground Circuit
1. Start interlock relay 5. Fuel solenoid
2. Start relay 6. Service/run switch
3. Preheat relay 7. Ignition key switch
4. Engine bell housing

START INTERLOCK GROUND CIRCUIT in the “SERVICE” position, power flows from the key
The interlock is grounded through the B-4 wire to the switch “START” terminal via the W wire to the ser-
start relay, through B-6 wire to the preheat relay, vice/run switch, then through the LTBL/O wires to the
through B-8 wire to the engine bell housing ground. fuel solenoid, allowing the engine to start and con-
tinue to run. The start relay receives power from the
service/run switch via the W/DKBL wire to activate
START CIRCUIT the start relay. The EIC plays no supporting role in
“SERVICE/RUN” switch in the “SERVICE” position. this mode.
The interlock relay is not functional with the service/
run switch in the “SERVICE” position. With the switch
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 77

Op. 55 100 tions from New Holland telling you to do so or dam-


age and false readings with the EIC board may occur.
REMOVAL, INSTALLATION AND WIRING IMPORTANT: If any servicing or adjustments require
OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS the battery to be disconnected, or welding is required
This section will show and explain the correct wiring on the skid steer, disconnect the negative (-) ground
of switches and relays, and when and where battery cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
voltage should be with the key switch (ignition) “ON” damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster)
or “OFF” for the electrical components. monitoring system and other electrical components.
This section will also explain the removal and in- IMPORTANT: If the EIC requires removal from the
stallation of the switches, relays, EIC board, and dash area of the skid steer, disconnect the negative
main wire harness. (-) ground battery cable. This will shut off power to the
EIC and prevent damage to the EIC board or blowing
Before servicing, changing or adding any electrical the 5-amp fuses if the board is accidentally
components, read the following precautionary state- grounded.
ments.
IMPORTANT: Do not service the EIC board with
IMPORTANT: Do not connect any power or ground magnetized tools (wrenches, screwdriver, etc.) or
electrical circuits at the ignition key switch, the cab magnets. Severe damage to the EIC board may
electrical fuse panel, or the cab ground terminal in occur.
the fuse panel area unless there are written instruc-
78 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

BATTERY

Op. 55 301 40
REMOVAL
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom lock pins,
1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.

2. Open the rear door, 2, and remove the right en-


gine side shield, 3, to access the battery.
80
3. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable, 1.
4. Disconnect the positive (+) battery cable, 2.
5. Remove the battery hold-down hardware, 3, and
remove the battery from the loader.

INSTALLATION
1. Orient the battery with the positive post, 2, toward
the rear of the loader. Install the battery and the
hold-down strap and hardware. Position the
hold-down strap to clear other components.
2. Connect the positive (+) RED cable to positive (+)
terminals and negative (-) BLACK cable to nega-
tive (-) terminals. Do not over tighten. Observe
the tightening specifications on the battery label. 81
IMPORTANT: Crossing of terminals may cause
damage to the electrical system, alternator and Ad-
vanced Warning System (EIC).
3. Install protective caps over the battery terminals
and cable connections.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 79

Op. 55 418 10

EIC (ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT 1


CLUSTER) BOARD REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the retaining hardware, 1, and remove
the EIC board from the overhead dash area.

86
3. Unplug the two wire harness connectors, 1, from
the EIC, taking care to not stress or bend the
plastic locking ramps on the connectors.
NOTE: Note the positioning of the connectors to the
EIC board and reconnect to the new board in the cor-
rect position. If the connector is not connected
properly, damage to the EIC may occur.

87
80 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

EIC (ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT


CLUSTER) WIRING
Board Harness
Connector #1(J1) Connector #1(P1)
Pin Number Wire Color Pin Number
1 NOT USED -
2 NOT USED -
3 NOT USED -
4 PU/W 1
5 PU/LTGN 2
6 PU/LTBL 3
7 PU/R 4
8 NOT USED 5
9 Y/LTGN 6
10 Y/B 7
11 Y/GY 8
12 DKGR/O 9
13 B/Y 10
14 LTGN/B 11
Board Harness
Connector #2(J2) Connector #2(P2)
Pin Number Wire Color Pin Number
1 NOT USED 1
2 LTBL/Y 2
3 PK/LTBL 3
4 T/W 4
5 LTBL/O 5
6 NOT USED 6
7 NOT USED 7
8 NOT USED 8
9 PK 9
10 W 10
11 LTGN 11
88
12 O 12
13 B 13
14 R/LTGN 14
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 81

EIC (ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT


CLUSTER) BOARD INSTALLATION
1. Connect the wire harness connectors P1 to J1
and P2 to J2 on the EIC board, making sure the
connectors are properly aligned and fully seated.
IMPORTANT: If the connector is not connected cor-
rectly, damage to the EIC may occur:
1. Board circuits burned out.
2. Display will not light up.
3. Board memory may be lost.

89
2. Position the EIC board into the overhead dash
flat against the support at 1, and secure with the
hardware previously removed at 2. Make sure
that wires are not pinched between the EIC board
and dash frame.
IMPORTANT: Do not force the EIC board into the
overhead dash area or damage to the EIC board may
occur.
3. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

90
IGNITION (KEY) SWITCH WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 O/LTBL To Four-Way Flash- Key “ON”
ACC
ing lights 10A Fuse position
(cab panel)-
ST
To Beacon Light 7.5A
Fuse (cab panel) IGN
BAT
2 LTGN/B To EIC Board Pin #11 Key “ON”
(small connector) position
3 LTGN/B To Accessory Relay Key “ON”
(engine panel) position
4 W To Service/Run Key 91
Switch “START”
position
5 W To EIC Board Pin #10 Key
(large connector) “START”
position
6 R/W From 15A Fuse All times
(engine panel)
7 GY/B Power to dome light All times
(not available)
8 O/PU-2 To Electronics 5A Key “ON”
Fuse (cab panel) position
82 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

IGNITION (KEY) SWITCH

Op. 55 201 10
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the retaining hardware, 1, and remove
the switch panel, 2, from the overhead dash area.
3. Remove the wires from the switch terminals.

92
4. Remove the switch retaining nut, 1, from the
switch and remove the switch from the dash
panel.

INSTALLATION
1. Attach the switch to the panel and secure with
nut, 1, previously removed.
2. Reconnect the wires to the terminals as shown
above.
3. Reinstall the switch panel to the overhead dash.
Make sure wires are positioned to prevent wires
1
from being pinched between the switch panel
and the dash.
4. Reinstall the negative (-) battery cable. 93
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 83

CAB FUSE PANEL WIRING


STANDARD FUSE BLOCK
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 O/LTGN (15A Fuse) From Key “ON”
Accessory Relay position
(engine panel) (If equipped
with lights
or other ac-
cessories).

2 O/B (15A Fuse) To Road/ Key “ON”


Work Light Switch position
3 O/GY (7.5A Fuse) To Wip- Key “ON”
er Motor Switch position
4 O (5A Fuse) To EIC Key “ON”
Board Pin #12 position
(P2 connector)
5 O (5A Fuse) To Start Key “ON”
Interlock Relay position
(engine panel)
6 PU/O (5A Fuse) To Fuel Key “ON”
Pump position OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT FUSE
7 O/PU-1 To Service/Run Key “ON”
Switch position
8 O/PU-2 From Key Switch Key “ON”
(Ign. terminal) position
9 O/LTBL From Key Switch Key “ON”
(Acc. terminal) position 10
10 O/Y (7.5A Fuse) To Key “ON”
Beacon, Four-Way position
Warning Lights
Switch
94
84 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

CAB FUSE BLOCK AND PANEL REMOVAL


3
2
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the panel retaining hardware, 1, and
lower the panel, 2. Removal of the headline sup-
port panel, 3, will give more access.
3. Unplug the wires from the fuse block.
4. Remove the fuse block retaining hardware. 1
NOTE: The standard fuse block is part of the main
harness and cannot be completely removed.
19984337
95
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the wires to the proper side of the fuses as
shown at 1, and as shown in the “Cab Fuse Panel
Wiring” figure. Check that the fuses, 2, are in their
proper slots.
2. Reinstall the block retaining hardware.
3. Reinstall the panel to the support.
4. Reinstall headliner support if removed.
5. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

96
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 85

SERVICE/RUN SWITCH WIRING

97
SERVICE/RUN SWITCH - SERVICE/RUN SWITCH - RUN POSITION
SERVICE POSITION
Battery
Battery Ref Color Destination Voltage
Ref Color Destination Voltage 1 W/DKBL To Start Relay Key
1 W/DKBL To Start Relay Key (engine panel) “START”
(engine panel) “START” position
position (backfed
from start in-
2 LTBL/O From EIC Board Pin #5 Key “ON” terlock relay)
(large connector) position
2 LTBL/O From EIC Board Pin Key “ON”
3 LTBL/O To Start Interlock Relay Key “ON” #5 (large connector) position (will
(engine panel) position read 0.5 to
4 LTGN/O To Manual Preheat Sitting in 1.0 volt be-
Switch Seat low battery
voltage)
5 T From Seat Switch(es) Sitting in
Seat 3 LTBL/O To Start Interlock Key “ON”
6 T/W To EIC Board Pin #4 No Relay (engine panel) position (will
read 0.5 to
(large connector) Voltage
1.0 volt be-
Anytime
low battery
7 O/PU 1 From 5A Fuse (cab Key “ON” voltage)
panel) position
4 LTGN/O To Manual Preheat Sitting in
8 W/LTGN To Start Interlock Relay No Switch Seat
(engine panel) Voltage
5 T From Seat Switch(es) Sitting in
Anytime
Seat
9 W From Key Switch Key
6 T/W To EIC Board Pin #4 Sitting in
(ignition) “START”
(large connector) Seat
position
7 O/PU 1 From 5A Fuse (spare) Key “ON”
(cab panel) position
8 W/LTGN To Start Interlock Key
Relay (engine panel) “START”
position
9 W From Key Switch (Igni- Key
tion) “START”
position
86 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

SERVICE/RUN SWITCH
3
2
Op. 55 418 30

REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the panel, retaining hardware, 1; and
lower the panel, 2, from the support. Removal of
head line support panel, 3, may be required for 1
easier access.
3. Remove the wires from the switch terminals.
4. Push the switch retaining tabs in and remove the 19984336
switch from the panel. 98
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the switch into the panel and insure the
locking tabs secure the switch.
2. Reconnect the wires to the proper terminals as
shown in the “SERVICE/RUN SWITCH WIRING”
figure above.
3. Reinstall the panel to the support.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

99
SEAT AND SEAT BELT SWITCH WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 LTGN To EIC Board Pin Seat Belt
#11 (large connec- Buckled
tor)
2 T From Seat Sit in
Switch(es) Seat
3 T To Seat Belt switch Sit in
Seat
4 LTGN/R From Electronics 5A All Times
Fuse (engine panel)
100
5 T To Service/Run Sit in
Switch Seat
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 87

SEAT SWITCH

Op. 55 201 15
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Slide the seat to the most rearward position.
Raise the seat and securely latch in the raised
latched position, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

3. Remove the seat retaining hardware, 2. 101


4. Holding the seat in place, lower the seat pan and
seat and unplug the seat switch(es).
5. Remove the seat from the loader.
6. Disconnect the wire harness from the switch(es)
by releasing the latch away from the switch.
7. Remove the switch(es) from the seat pan. The
standard seat uses one switch, 1, and the deluxe
seat uses two switches, 2.

102
INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch(es) into the seat pan, making
sure the switch is seated into the hole in the seat
pan, 1.
NOTE: IMPORTANT: If the switch is not seated
properly when the retaining hardware is tightened,
the switch flange will be broken.
2. Reconnect the wire harness to the switch(es)
and reinstall the seat retaining hardware. Make
sure the harness connector latches are en-
gaged.
3. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

103
88 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 201 14

SEAT BELT BUCKLE AND SWITCH


ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Unplug the seat belt wire harness, 1.
3. Remove the clamp hardware and clamp, 2, and
save for reuse.
4. Remove the seat belt retaining hardware, 3.

SEAT BELT BUCKLE INSTALLATION


1. Reinstall the seat belt buckle retaining hardware.
Tighten the locknut to hold the belt in position that 104
will allow the belt assembly to move front or rear-
ward.
2. Reconnect the wire harness.
3. Reinstall clamp holding harness above seat track.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
ROAD LIGHT AND WORK LIGHT SWITCH
WIRING
Switch Pushed in at Top
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 PK/B To Taillights YES
2 DKBL/W To Front Road/Work YES
Light
3 DKBL/W To Front Road/Work YES
Light
4 DKBL To Rear Work Light YES
5 O/B From 15A Fuse (cab Key “ON”
panel) position
105
6 PK To EIC Board Pin #9 YES
P2 connector (to dim
EIC board lights)

Switch Pushed in at Bottom


Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 PK/B To Taillights YES
2 DKBL/W To Front Road/Work YES
Light
3 DKBL/W To Front Road/Work YES
Light
4 DKBL To Rear Work Light NO
5 O/B From 15A Fuse (cab Key “ON”
panel) position
6 PK To EIC Board Pin #9 YES
P2 connector (to dim
EIC board lights)
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 89

Op. 55 404 20

ROAD LIGHT AND WORK LIGHT SWITCH


REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the switch panel retaining hardware, 1,
and lower the panel.
3. Remove the wires and connector from the switch
terminals.
4. Press in the switch retaining tabs and remove the
switch from the panel.

106
ROAD LIGHT AND WORK LIGHT SWITCH
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the switch into the panel and insure the
locking tabs secure the switch, 1.
2. Reconnect the wires and connector to the proper
terminals with the PK/B and PK wires toward the
top of the panel.
3. Reattach the switch panel to the overhead dash.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

107
90 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ENGINE FUSE AND RELAY PANEL


The engine panel electrical components are shown
here:
1. Accessory relay
2. Heater power relay (if equipped, not shown)
3. Preheat circuit breaker
4. Start interlock relay
5. Standard fuse block
6. Optional equipment fuse block
7. Alternator excite resistor
8. Start relay
9. Preheat relay
To access the electrical components in the engine
compartment, raise the boom and rest it on the boom 108
lock pins.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.

ACCESSORY RELAY WIRING


Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 O/LTGN To Attachment/Horn Key “ON”
15A Fuse position
2 LTGN/ To Turn Signal Relay Key “ON”
B-2 or Heater Power position
Relay
3 LTGN/B From Key Switch Key “ON”
(accessory terminal) position
4 B-7 To Turn Signal Relay Ground
or Heater Power Circuit
Relay
109
5 B-5 To Start Relay Ground
Circuit
6 R/GY From Accessory 25A All Times
Fuse
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 91

ACCESSORY RELAY WIRING

Op. 55 100 34
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Unplug the relay, 1, from the socket, 2. The
corners provide an area to insert screwdriver and
twist to assist removal.
3. The relay socket is wired into the main wire har-
ness.

INSTALLATION
1. Insert new relay fully into socket. 110
2. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
PREHEAT CIRCUIT BREAKER WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/LTBL To Preheat Relay All Times
2 R To Start Relay All Times
3 R From 15A Key Main All Times
Fuse Engine Fuse
Block

111
Op. 55 100 24
2
PREHEAT CIRCUIT BREAKER REMOVAL 1
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Disconnect wires from the terminals, 1.
3. Remove the circuit breaker retaining hardware,
2.

PREHEAT CIRCUIT BREAKER


INSTALLATION
1. Reinstall the retaining hardware.
19984973
2. Reconnect the wires to the proper terminals.
3. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable. 112
92 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

START INTERLOCK RELAY WIRING

Service/Run Switch - Run Position


Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 W/LTGN From Service/Run Key
Switch “START”
position
2 O From Cab fuse panel Key “ON”
5a electronic ignition position
fuse.
3 LTBL/O To Fuel Solenoid Key “ON”
position *
4 LTBL/O From EIC Board Pin Key “ON” 113
#5, P2 connector position *
5 W/DKBL To Start Relay Key
“START”
position
Sitting in
Seat with
Seat Belt
Buckled
6 W/O From the Seat/Seat Key
Belt Connector and “START”
Connector at Boom/ position
Bucket Control Valve Sitting in
Seat with
Seat Belt
Buckled
7 B-4 To start Relay Ground
Circuit
*Voltage will be 0.5 to 1.0 volt below battery voltage.

Service/Run Switch - Service Position


Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 W/LTGN From Service/Run No
Switch Voltage
Anytime
2 O From Cab fuse panel Key “ON”
5a electronic ignition position
fuse.
3 LTBL/O To Fuel Solenoid Key “ON”
position
4 LTBL/O From EIC Board Key “ON”
Pin #5 position
5 W/DKBL To Start Relay Key
“START”
position
6 W/O From Connector at Sitting in
Boom/Bucket Con- Seat with
trol Valve Seat Belt
Buckled
7 B-4 To start Relay Ground
Circuit
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 93

Op. 55 100 34

START INTERLOCK RELAY REMOVAL


1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Disconnect the wires from the terminals, 1.
3. Remove the interlock relay retaining hardware,
2.

START INTERLOCK RELAY


INSTALLATION 2
1. Reinstall the retaining hardware.
2. Reconnect the wires to the proper terminals as
shown in the “START INTERLOCK RELAY WIR- 114
ING” figure above.
3. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
ENGINE FUSE PANEL WIRING
STANDARD FUSE BLOCK
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/B (10A Fuse) To Turn All Times
Signal Relay
2 R/GY (25A Fuse) To All Times
Accessory Relay
3 R/LTGN (5A Fuse) To EIC All Times
board Pin #14 P2
connector.
4 LTGN/R (5A Fuse) To Seat All Times
Switch(es)
5 R/W (15A Fuse) To Key All Times
Switch (Battery OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT FUSE BLOCK
Terminal)
6 R From Preheat Circuit All Times
Breaker
7 R From Start Relay All Times
8 R/O (20A Fuse) To All Times
Heater Power Relay
9 R/T (7.5A Fuse) Spare All Times
10 DKGN/R (15A Fuse) To High Key “ON”
Flow, Horn, Power position
Outlet
11 O/LTGN From Accessary Key “ON”
Relay position 115
12 O/W (5A Fuse) To Back Key “ON”
Up Alarm Switch position
13 O/LTGN From Road/Work Key “ON”
light fuse (cab panel) position
94 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

ENGINE FUSE BLOCK

REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the fuse block retaining hardware.
NOTE: NOTE: The standard fuse block, 1, is part of
the main harness and cannot be completely removed
from the main wire harness and replaced separately.
3. The optional equipment fuse block, 2, locks into
the standard fuse block. Insert a 1/4″ blade
screwdriver at the center of the fuse block bases
and twist to release the lock. Slide the optional
block up past the fuses on the standard block to
116
separate.
4. Unplug the wires from the fuse block assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the lock tabs, 1, into slots, 2, and slide the
two blocks together to lock securely as shown.
NOTE: NOTE: The optional equipment fuse block
slides down over the standard block guides and is
positioned toward the center of the panel.

117
2. Attach the wires to the proper side of the fuses as
shown in “ENGINE FUSE PANEL WIRING” fig-
ure above.
1 Standard fuse block
2 Optional fuse block
3. Reinstall the block retaining hardware.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

118
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 95

ALTERNATOR EXCITE RESISTOR WIRING


Ref Color Destination
1 Y/DKBL To Alternator
2 LTGN/B-1 From Accessory Relay
3 LTGN/B-3 To Alternator

119
Op. 55 301 16

ALTERNATOR EXCITE RESISTOR


REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Unplug the wires from the resistor terminals.
3. Remove the resistor, 1, retaining hardware.
Testing the resistor using an ohmmeter, the resis- 1
tance should read approximately 50 ohms ± 5 ohms.

ALTERNATOR EXCITE RESISTOR


INSTALLATION 19984973

1. Reinstall the resistor retaining hardware. 120


2. Reconnect the wires to the proper terminals.
96 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

START RELAY WIRING


Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R To 20A Heater Fuse All Times
(optional fuse block)
2 R To Preheat Circuit All Times
Breaker
3 R From Starter All Times
Solenoid
4 W/R To Starter Solenoid Key
“START”
position
121
5 W/DKBL From Start Interlock Key
Relay “START”
position
6 W-DKBL From Service/Run Key
Switch “START”
position
7 B-4 To Start Interlock Ground
Relay Circuit
8 B-5 To Accessory Relay Ground
Circuit
9 B-6 To Preheat Relay Ground
Circuit
Op. 55 100 34

START RELAY REMOVAL


1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the relay cover, 1, attaching hardware
and cover.
3. Remove the wires from the relay terminals.
4. Remove the relay retaining hardware.
5. Remove the barrier from between the large ter-
minals and install on new relay.
NOTE: The start relay, 1, and the preheat relay, 2,
may be wired in either position. Check wire colors for
proper relay location. 122
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 97

START RELAY INSTALLATION


1. Reattach the relay, 1, to the support.
2. Reconnect the wires to the proper relay ter-
minals.
3. Reinstall the relay cover.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

123
PREHEAT RELAY WIRING

Service/Run Switch - Service Position

Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/LTBL From Preheat Circuit All Times
Breaker
2 LTBL/B To Glow Plugs Push
Button
3 LTBL/Y From Manual Push
Preheat Button Button
4 B-6 To Start Relay Ground 124
Circuit
5 B-8 To Engine Ground
Bellhousing Ground Circuit
Service/Run Switch - Run Position

Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/LTBL From Preheat Circuit All Times
Breaker
2 LTBL/B To Glow Plugs EIC
Preheat
Cycle
3 LTBL/Y From Manual EIC
Preheat Button Preheat
Cycle
(Voltage will
be 0.5 to
1.0 volt less
than battery
voltage).

4 B-6 To Start Relay Ground


Circuit
5 B-8 To Engine Ground
Bellhousing Ground Circuit
98 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 100 34

PREHEAT RELAY REMOVAL


1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the relay cover, 2, attaching hardware
and cover.
3. Remove the wires from the relay terminals.
4. Remove the relay retaining hardware.
5. Remove the barrier from between the large ter-
minals and install on new relay.
NOTE: The start relay, 1, and the preheat relay, 2,
may be wired in either position. Check wire colors for
proper relay location. 125
PREHEAT RELAY INSTALLATION
1. Reattach the relay, 1, to the support.
2. Reconnect the wires to the proper relay ter-
minals.
3. Reinstall the relay cover.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

126
Op. 55 201 26

PREHEAT MANIFOLD HEATER REMOVAL


1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Disconnect the LTBL/B wire, 1, from the manifold
heater.
3. Remove the fuel supply line, 2, from the manifold
heater.
4. Remove manifold heater, 3, from the intake
manifold heater.

PREHEAT MANIFOLD HEATER


INSTALLATION 127
1. Install the manifold heater into the intake mani-
fold at 3.
2. Reconnect the fuel supply line, 2, to the manifold
header.
3. Reconnect the LTBL/B wire to the manifold
heater at 1.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 99

FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS


The fuel system consists of a fuel tank, fuel pickup 3
and return lines, fuel tank sending unit, and injection
pump, 1, and a fuel shutoff solenoid, 2.
The additional emissionized engine fuel system 1
components are the fuel lift pump, 1, the two-wire 4
cold advance switch sender, 2, and the cold advance
unit, 3. The fuel lift pump sits on top of the fuel filter.
The cold advance switch sender is on top of the en-
gine next to the normal engine coolant temperature
sensor. The cold advance unit attaches to the injector 2
pump.
5
128

FUEL SYSTEM ELECTRICAL DIAGRAM


P/W B
O
2 P/O

LT BL/O

R
3
B
6
B 5
4
BSC0935A

129
1. Key switch 4. Electric fuel pump
2. EIC board 5. Injector pump
3. Fuel level sender 6. Fuel shutoff solenoid
100 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

FUEL GAUGE
In the center of the EIC panel is the fuel gauge, im-
plemented as a vertical 10-segment green LED bar
graph. The lowest segments will flash when the fuel
level is low. An audible alarm will accompany the
flashing light for about 5 seconds.

FUEL TANK SENDING UNIT (Fuel level)


PROBABLE CAUSE AND
STEP PRETEST INSTRUCTIONS TEST RESULT CORRECTION
1 Loader on level with parking EIC gauge and NO bars light up Check wires from sender to
brake engaged, key “ON” sender operation EIC board. If OK, replace
position EIC board
Jumper wire from
Symptom: No bars lit one terminal to YES (bars light Replace sender
other at sender up)
2 Symptom: Fuel level does not Disconnect Bars stay lit Check for PU/W wire
read lower on gauge (too many PU/W wire shorted to ground. If OK,
bars lit) replace EIC board.

Bars go out Replace sender

TESTING FUEL GAUGE IN DIAGNOSTIC MODE


Use a jumper wire and connect sender terminal, 1, to
terminal, 2, and the EIC board will light and beep. If
the EIC board lights and beeps, the EIC and circuit
wires to the sender are OK. If the EIC board fails to
light, check the wires to the EIC board.

Op. 55 410 80
REMOVAL OF FUEL GAUGE
If the fuel gauge is found operative, the complete EIC
board will require replacement. 2

130
REMOVAL OF FUEL LEVEL SENDER
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door and remove the left engine
side shield.
3. Disconnect the wires from the sender, 1.
4. Remove the sender retaining screws, 2, and re-
move the sender, 3, assembly from the tank.

131
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 101

TESTING OF THE FUEL LEVEL SENDER


Using a volt/ohmmeter, put one lead on one terminal
and the second lead on the other terminal. Rotate the
sender from full tank to empty tank, and the ohms re-
ading should be between 35 ohms full and 240 ohms
empty.

132
Op. 10 223
FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID
The fuel shutoff solenoid is located at the injection
pump at 1. The solenoid is controlled through the
starting circuit during cranking. After the engine is
started, the EIC takes control of the solenoid for nor-
mal operation.
If a fault occurs in either the engine oil pressure or the
hydrostatic charge pressure circuits, the EIC will re-
move power from the solenoid, stopping the engine
within 30 seconds.

133
FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID TESTING
PRETEST PROBABLE CAUSE AND
STEP INSTRUCTIONS TEST RESULT CORRECTION
1 Loader on level with Battery voltage to NO Check power wire from EIC to
parking brake solenoid solenoid for open; if OK, go to
engaged, key “ON” next step
position, service
“RUN” switch in “RUN” YES Replace solenoid
position
2 Key “ON” position, Battery voltage to NO Check power wire from
service “RUN” switch solenoid service/run switch to fuel
in “SERVICE” position solenoid; if OK, go to next
step

YES Replace solenoid


3 Key “ON” position, Check EIC board NO Check power to EIC board.
“SERVICE/RUN” operation Check 5-amp electronics Ign.
switch in “RUN” fuse in cab fuse panel.
position
YES Replace EIC board
102 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 223 10

REPLACEMENT OF FUEL SHUTOFF


SOLENOID
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door and remove the left engine
side shield.
3. Remove the power wire from the solenoid, 1.
4. Remove the solenoid, 2, from the injection pump.
5. Solenoid pull-in amperage 1.2 to 1.5 amps. Sole-
noid hold-in amperage 1.2 to 1.5 amps.
6. Reinstall the solenoid and tighten securely. Rein-
stall the power wire. 134
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP
The electric lift pump, 1, is located in the left side of
the engine compartment.

135
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP TESTING
PRETEST PROBABLE CAUSE AND
STEP INSTRUCTIONS TEST RESULT CORRECTION
1 Loader on level with Fuel level in tank NO Add fuel and bleed system
parking brake
engaged, key “OFF” YES Go to next step
position
2 Key “ON” position Fuel pump NO Check power supply (5-amp
operating fuse in cab panel). If not OK,
check ground; if OK, replace
pump

YES Go to next step


3 Key “ON” position Fuel pump NO Check line to tank, air leak,
operating but not fuel level, tank pickup tube;
pumping fuel if OK, replace pump

YES Go to next step


4 Key “ON” position Fuel pump NO Replace pump
operating and
pumping fuel YES Remove fuel line at injector
pump and bleed system;
if OK, go to next step
5 Key “ON” position Fuel pump YES Check fuel shutoff solenoid
operating and for operation
pumping fuel

NOTE: Always check fuel level in tank. Always check fuel filters.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 103

Op. 10 210 21

ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP REMOVAL


1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door and remove the left engine 1
side shield. 2
3. Unplug the three-wire connector, 1.
4. Unscrew the filter head/pump assembly connec-
tion, 2, and lift away from filter assembly.
5. Upon reinstallation of the pump, make sure the
pump wires are placed to prevent getting dam-
aged. Make sure the ground wire is making good
contact. 136
Op. 55 414 10

COLD ADVANCE SWITCH REMOVAL


1. Support the boom on the lock pins.
1
2. Open the rear door and raise and latch the top
engine shield, in the raised position, to access
the sender.
3. Remove the two-wire plug connector, 1.
4. Remove the switch from the engine block.

COLD ADVANCE SWITCH INSTALLATION


1. Clean the threads of the sender. 19987797

2. Apply pipe sealant to the threads of the sender. 137


3. Install the switch into the engine block.
4. Reinstall the two-wire connector.
Op. 55 414 14

AIR FILTER RESTRICTION INDICATOR


SWITCH REMOVAL
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Raise the seat and latch in the raised position.
3. Remove the B/Y, 1, and B, 2, wires from the
sender.
4. Remove the sender, 3, from the air cleaner hose.

AIR FILTER RESTRICTION INDICATOR


SWITCH INSTALLATION
Install the sender and reinstall the B/Y and B wires to 138
the sender terminals.
104 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 414 10

ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE


SENDER REMOVAL 2
The one-wire temperature sender, 1, is on the front
1
of the engine block next to the two-wire cold advance
switch, 2.
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door and raise and latch the top 3
engine shield, in the raised position, to access
the sender.
3. Remove the PU/LTGN wire, 1, from the sender 19987797
terminal. 139
4. Drain the cooling system down below the sender
level to prevent loss of coolant.
5. Remove the sender, 2, from the engine block.
NOTE: Later model loaders have two coolant tem-
perature senders — the normal one-wire sender, 1,
and a two-wire cold advance switch, 2.
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENDER INSTALLATION
1. Remove and clean the engine block thread area.
2. Apply pipe sealant to the threads of the sender.
3. Install the sender into the engine block.
4. Reinstall the PU/LTGN wire to the sender ter-
minal.
5. Refill the cooling system with coolant previously
removed or a 50/50 mixture of a permanent-type
antifreeze.
6. Operate the unit to remove air from the cooling
system and recheck the coolant level.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 105

Op. 55 414 12

ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH


REMOVAL
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door and raise the top engine
shield to access the switch.
3. Remove the Y/B wire, 1, from the switch terminal.
4. Remove the switch, 2, from the engine head.

ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH


INSTALLATION 140
1. Install the switch.
2. Attach the Y/B wire to the switch terminal.
Op. 55 414 28

HYDROSTATIC CHARGE PRESSURE


SWITCH REMOVAL 3
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Remove the left fender or raise the seat and latch
in the raised position to access the switch.
3. Remove the Y/GY wire, 1, and B wire, 2.
4. Remove the charge pressure switch, 3, from the
hose.

141
HYDROSTATIC CHARGE PRESSURE
SWITCH INSTALLATION
1. Install the charge pressure switch into the hose.
2. Reinstall the Y/GY and B wires to the switch.
3. Reinstall the fender if removed for access.
106 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 414 24

HYDRAULIC OIL FILTER RESTRICTION


SWITCH REMOVAL
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door, raise the top engine shield
and remove the right engine side shield to access
the switch.
3. Remove the DKGN/O wire, 1.
4. Remove the restriction switch, 2, from the filter
base.

HYDRAULIC OIL FILTER RESTRICTION 142


SWITCH INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch into the filter base.
2. Attach the DKGN/O wire to the switch terminal.

Op. 55 414 20

HYDRAULIC OIL TEMPERATURE


SENDER REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the boom face
plate and support the boom on the boom lock
pins.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.

2. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


latched position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 107

3. Drain the hydraulic reservoir.


Remove the rear engine belly pan hardware, 1,
and lower the pan from the loader.
CAUTION
Use a floor jack to support the belly pan and prevent
serious injury.

143
4. Loosen the return line clamp at 1.
5. Remove the return line at 2, and rotate the line so
the oil drains into a clean suitable pan for reuse.
6. After the reservoir is drained, reconnect the re-
turn lines and tighten all fittings and connections.

144
7. Remove the PU/LTBL wire, 1, and B wire, 2, from
the sender, 3.
8. Remove the sender from the reservoir by rotating
the sender counterclockwise.
9. Remove the grounding ring and washer from the
old sender.

145
108 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

HYDRAULIC OIL TEMPERATURE


SENDER INSTALLATION
1. Install grounding ring, 1, and washer, 2, over
threads of sender, 3.
IMPORTANT: The grounding ring and washer must
be threaded all the way onto the sender before instal-
ling the sender into the reservoir.
2. Use hydraulic thread sealant on the sender
threads and install the sender, 3, into the reser-
voir.
IMPORTANT: Do not over tighten the sender or dam-
age to the reservoir threads may occur resulting in oil
leakage.
146
3. Reconnect the sender wires, B wire on the
ground blade, and the PU/LTBL wire to the center
sender terminal.
4. Refill the hydraulic reservoir with the oil previous-
ly removed or new SAE 10W/30 API Service SG-
CEF motor oil.
5. Reinstall the engine belly pan, and tighten the re-
taining hardware.
6. Operate the unit and check for leaks. Repair if re-
quired.

BOOM/BUCKET CONTROL VALVE SPOOL


LOCK SOLENOIDS

Op. 35 724 90
REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach-
ing plate.
2. Raise the boom and support on the boom lock
pins.
3. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the
“RUN” position and operate the boom and bucket
controls to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn “OFF” the key.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 109

4. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


latched position. 1
CAUTION
2
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

5. Remove the step shield to access the control


valve area.
6. Unplug the solenoid coil wires, 1, and remove the
coils, 2, from the control valve, 3.
3
INSTALLATION 19997742
1. Thoroughly clean the control valve block. 147
2. Install the solenoid coil, 2, into block, 3, and
torque the coils to 15 N·m (11 ft. lbs.).
3. Reconnect the coil wires to the main wire har-
ness.
4. Reinstall the step shield.
5. Lower the seat to the operate position and se-
curely latch.
CAUTION
Do not operate the loader unless the seat/seat sup-
port is properly latched in the latched position.
110 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

WIRE HARNESS

Op. 55 100 74
MAIN WIRE HARNESS REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach-
ing plate.
2. Raise the boom and support on the boom lock
pins.
3. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the
“RUN” position and operate the boom and bucket
controls to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn “OFF” the key.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.

4. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised


latched position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

5. Remove the step shield to access the control


valve area.
6. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
7. Unplug the seat and seat belt wire harness at
connector, 1, behind the seat assembly.

148
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 111

8. Remove the rear window and frame assembly re-


taining hardware, 1.

149
9. Remove the right side plate, 1, and headliner, 2,
if equipped. Unhook all wire connections at the
service/run switch, and fuse block at this time.
Removal of fuse block/switch panel, 3, may be 1
required for easier switch access.
2

19984337
150
10. Remove the upper rear support retaining hard-
ware, 1, right and left side and remove support,
2.

151
112 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

11. Remove the EIC board retaining hardware, 1, un-


plug the EIC board and remove from the dash.
Remove the ignition key switch panel, 2, and re-
move wires from the switches. Remove the
panel. Loosen the front support (dash) retaining
hardware, 3, and remove the hardware from the
right side.

152
12. Unplug the seat wire harness from the main har-
ness, if not previously unplugged.
13. Remove the seat and seat pan assembly retain-
ing hardware, 1, unlatch the seat assembly at 2,
and remove the assembly from the loader.

153
14. Remove the four retaining screws from the front
shield, 1, and the eight retaining bolts from the
step shield, 2. Remove both shields from the
loader.

154
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 113

15. Remove the rear seat support, 1, hardware at 2,


and the isolator mount hardware, 3.

155
16. Remove the right hydrostatic control handle as-
sembly, 1, retaining hardware, 2. Unhook the hy-
drostatic control linkage, 3, and auxiliary boom
hydraulic linkage, 4, (if equipped). Lift the control
assembly from the loader.

156
17. Remove the right fender to access and loosen
the right front isolator mount bolt, 1.

157
114 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

18. Remove the left fender.


19. Remove all wire harness retaining clamps from
the main wire harness, 1 and 2, at the rear and
left side of the loader frame.
(Cut wire ties along the right side of the rear win-
dow if so equipped and any ties retaining the op-
tional harness to the main harness. Cut the wire
tie at the keeper bar at the left front to rear of cab
pivot).

158
20. Remove harness from left rear of engine area
after disconnecting wires from fuel sender, 1.

159
21. Thoroughly clean the connector between the
main and engine harness. Make sure the con-
nector is dry.
22. Unplug the main wire harness from the engine
wire harness, 1, and remove the ground wires
from the engine bellhousing ground stud, 2. Re-
move wires from the engine fuse and relay panel,
3.
23. Remove the hydraulic oil temperature sender
wires and remove the harness from the clamp on
the face of bellhousing. Remove the remaining
bellhousing clamps.

160
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 115

24. Disconnect the control valve connectors, 1, re-


move the J clamp bolt, 2, on the valve and pull the 1
harness out through the left fender area.

19997742
161
25. Now the right side panel, 1, can be pivoted into
the center of the cab area at the rear and the wire
harness can be removed from the corner of the
side panel.

162
MAIN WIRE HARNESS INSTALLATION
1. Install the wire harness up the right rear corner of
the side panel with the EIC board connector to-
ward the front of the loader cab. Position the ser-
vice/run and fuse block connectors at their loca-
tion. Place the wire in the upper rear corner of the
cab side panel at 1, to prevent the wire harness
from contacting the cab panel retaining hard-
ware. Install two wire ties or clamp at the upper
right side of the rear window and one tie at the
bottom to hold the harness up and maintain
clearance from the cab panel hardware and
headliner support.
163
116 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

2. Place the main wire harness to the front side of


the boom lock linkage at 1, and reinstall the wire
clamps. Route the harness across the loader to
the left side of the loader.

164
3. Route the wire harness to the front of the loader
on the left side, 1 and 2, and install wire clamps
where previously installed. Place the harness
into the loop (keeper) and secure with a wire tie
at 1, and then along the top of the lower frame to
the rear of the loader to the engine fuse/relay
panel area.
4. Route the harness branch to the inside of the
frame with the hydraulic lines and down to the
floor and front of the control valve. Refasten in
the J clamp and route the connectors between
valve bosses and plug in solenoids. Tuck the
connectors between valve bosses to protect the
harness.
165
5. Connect the main wire harness connector to the
engine wire harness, 1. Reconnect the wires to
the engine fuse and relay panel, 2.
6. Reconnect the wires to the fuel tank sender.
NOTE: Refer to “Removal, Installation and Wiring of
Electrical Components” earlier in this section for
more details of proper wire connections.

166
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 117

7. Attach the ground wires and clamps at the engine


bellhousing ground studs, 1.
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire (battery ground cable) next
to the ground surface (bellhousing). Then stack the
remaining ground wires according to wire size;
largest on bottom, smallest on top of the heaviest
wire.
8. Continue harness routing to the hydraulic tem-
perature switch and secure in the bell housing
clamp. Clamp harnesses to the bellhousing.

167
9. Reattach the wires to the service/run switch, 1;
fuse block(s), 2; preheat switch, 3; and any
ground wires if removed at 4.
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to wire size on top of the heaviest wire.

168
10. Reposition the right side panel, 1, and reinstall
the front dash support hardware.
11. Reinstall the right front isolator, 2, if removed.
12. Reinstall the upper rear support.
13. Reinstall the lower rear support, 3, and the isola-
tors, 4. Tighten all cab support and side shield
hardware at this time.

169
118 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

14. Reinstall all wire harness clamps previously re-


moved, position the wire harness to prevent
damage, and tighten the clamp hardware at this
time.
15. Reinstall the seat and seat pan assembly and
tighten the hardware. Reconnect the seat har-
ness to the main harness. Check the loop for
clearance when the seat is raised and lowered.

170
16. Route the wire harness to the front of the cab to
the ignition switch and EIC board area. Attach the
wires to the ignition switch and position the wire
harness to prevent damage. Reinstall the switch
panel, 1.
17. Attach the wire harness connectors, 2, to the
proper EIC board connector and position the wire
harness across the front of the dash area to pre-
vent damage. Reinstall the EIC board.
18. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
19. Check the electrical system for proper operation.

171
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 119

Op. 55 404

ROAD/WORK LIGHTS
The road and work lights provide illumination for road
travel and work operations. The rear work lights are
not recommended for road travel.

172
Road/work light switch, 1, is located in the ignition
key switch panel in the upper right corner of the over-
head dash. To remove the switch, disconnect the
negative (-) ground battery cable. Remove the key
switch panel hardware, 2, and tilt the panel down.

173
Disconnect wires from the switch, squeeze the
switch retaining tabs in, and remove the switch from
the panel.

174
120 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Road/Work Light Switch Wiring

175
Road/Work Light Wiring Diagram
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.

PK/B
B B B B
DKBL/W
9 PK/B

B
B
B–3
O/B
8 1

PK/B
DKBL/W O/B
DKBL/W 15A

7.5A DKBL
B
DKBL
5A
O/B PK
5A
2
6
4

7 3
5
DKBL/W PK/B
B B–3

SH48091

176
Road?Work Kight Wiring Diagram
1. Right rear light 5. Connector to EIC
2. Rear work light 6. Light switch
3. Left rear light 7. Left front road/work light
4. Cab outer fuse block 8. Right front work/road light
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 121

Bulb Replacement
Clear lens with bulb #86533429 1
Bulb only (clear) #86533428
Red lens with bulb #9829515
Bulb only (red) #C6AB13465A

Op. 55 404 10
Front Road/Work Light
1. Facing the lens of the light assembly, push the
lens assembly, 1, to the left and lift the right side
of the assembly from the support.

177
2. Unplug the wire harness from the bulb, unlatch-
ing the connector at 1, and sliding the harness 1
from the bulb.

178
3. Facing the back of the assembly, rotate the bulb
holder, 1, counterclockwise and remove the bulb 3
from the support.
4. Position the bulb so when it is locked in position
the connector, 2, is pointed down with the clip, 3,
to the right.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT touch the bulb during re-
moval and installation. The bulb may become dam-
aged or a premature failure may occur.

179
122 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 404 10
Rear Work and Taillight
1. Remove the center work light, 1, by pushing the 3 3
lens assembly to the left and lift the right side of
the assembly from the support.
2. Remove the red taillight lamps, 2, by unscrewing
the bezel self-tapping screws and removing the
bezels, 3.
3. Unplug the wire harness from the bulb, unlatch-
ing the connector, and sliding the harness from
the bulb.

180
4. Facing the back of the assembly, rotate the bulb
holder, 1, counterclockwise and remove the bulb 3
from the support. Replace the bulb.
5. For the clear rear work lamp, position the bulb so
when it is locked in position the connector, 2, is
pointed down with the clip, 3, to the right.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT touch the bulb during re-
moval and installation. The bulb may become dam-
aged or a premature failure may occur.

181
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 123

Op. 55 301
ALTERNATOR(45 AMP VERSION)

182
Charging System
1. Ground terminal (B) 4. Field excitation terminal (Y/DKBL)
2. Tachometer sense terminal (PU/R) 5. Main wire harness
3. Output terminal (R/DKBL) 6. Regulator and brushbox assembly
CHARGING SYSTEM
Introduction 2. A light-gauge wire, yellow with dark blue tracer,
The SL65B skid steers are equipped with Magnetti connects to the field excitation terminal. This cir-
Marelli (Lucas) A127-type alternators. s cuit provides initial voltage to energize the field at
This alternator is rated at 45 amps, has an integral startup.
regulator, and is driven by a single V-belt from the 3. A wire, purple with red tracer, connects to the “W”
engine crankshaft. terminal. This circuit provides an engine speed
Four cables from the wire harness connect with the signal to the Electronic Instrument Cluster.
alternator: 4. The fourth wire, black, connects to one of the al-
1. A heavy-gauge wire, red with a dark blue tracer, ternator housing bolts and functions as the
is the main power cable from the alternator. It ground circuit.
connects to the “B+” (output) terminal.
124 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

1
7 8
6

3
5 4

183
Alternator Charging Circuit
A To Starter Motor 1. Starter Solenoid 6. Stator Output Windings (45/70 Amp Alterna-
tors)
B To Starter Relay 2. Battery 7. Rectifier Pack
C To Electronic Instrument 3. Rotor Field Winding 8. Key Start Switch
Panel 4. Regulator
5. Alternator Frame B+ Output (R/DB)
D+ Field Excitation (Y/DKBL)

When the key start switch, 8, is turned on, a small cur- A portion of this current is fed back to the rotor field
rent flows from the battery, 2, through the rotor field winding, through the regulator, supplementing the in-
winding, 3. The circuit is made through the key start itial current. This produces an increasing magnetic
switch, the “D+” terminal, the rotor field winding, and field in the rotor, resulting in a rapid rise in generated
the integral regulator, 4, to ground. output current and voltage.
At this stage, the rotor is partially magnetized. The voltage continues to rise until the regulated volt-
When the engine is started and the partially-magnet- age level is reached. The voltage regulator controls
ized rotor revolves within the stator windings, a alternator output voltage by controlling the strength
3-phase alternating current is generated. This AC of the field current.
current is converted to direct current by the three field In a properly operating alternator, voltage at the out-
diodes in the rectifier pack, 7. put terminal (B+) will always equal voltage at the field
excitation terminal (D+).
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 125

ALTERNATOR Preliminary Checks


General Specifications Prior to electrical testing, thoroughly inspect the
Model A127-45 charging and electrical system.
Polarity Negative ground Check all leads for continuity and tightness.
Nominal voltage 12.0 volts 1. Check the battery.
Maximum RPM 15,000 Using a voltmeter on a sealed battery, or a hy-
Service Specifications drometer on an unsealed battery, check that the
Maximum output 45 amps battery is at least 75% charged before further
Regulator controlled voltage 13.6 - 14.4 volts testing. The voltmeter reading should be 12.4
Rotor field winding resistance 2.9 ± 0.5 ohms volts minimum. The hydrometer reading should
Stator field winding resistance 0.2 ohms be 1.240 minimum.
New brush length 20 mm (0.80″) 2. Check the drive belt.
Minimum brush length 5 mm (0.20″) Inspect the alternator drive belt and pulley, en-
Brush spring pressure 1.3 - 2.7 N suring that both are clean, free from oil and
(5 - 10 oz.) grease, and in good condition.
Torque Specifications The drive belt should be tightened such that a
ft. lbs. N·m force of 1 kg (2 lbs.), applied at the center of the
Alternator through bolts 4.0 5.5 longest span, will not deflect the belt more than
Pulley retaining nut 52.0 70.0 3 mm (1/8″).
Rectifier retaining screws 3.0 4.0 Initial Tests
Regulator and brushbox Certain initial tests may be performed without remov-
screws 2.0 2.7 ing any of the charging components from the loader.
Terminal nuts 2.0 2.7 These allow the following items to be checked:
1. Alternator wire connections.
ALTERNATOR SYSTEM TESTING AND
2. Alternator charging current and controlled volt-
TROUBLESHOOTING
age.
3. Alternator charging circuit voltage drops.
Service Precautions
4. Alternator maximum output performance.
Observe the following service precautions to avoid
damage to the charging system: Test equipment required:
1. NEVER make or break any of the charging sys- Voltmeter (0-1 and 0-20 volt scales).
tem connections, including the battery, when the Ammeter (0-60 amp minimum scale).
engine is running. Carbon pile variable load resistor.
2. NEVER short any of the charging system compo- NOTE: Most commercial test equipment incorpor-
nents to ground. ates several test functions in a single unit. Follow the
3. ALWAYS disconnect the battery negative cable manufacturer’s instructions when using such a
when charging the battery in the machine with a tester.
battery charger.
4. ALWAYS observe correct polarity when installing
the battery or when using a booster battery to
start the engine.
CONNECT POSITIVE TO POSITIVE AND
NEGATIVE TO NEGATIVE.
126 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Alternator Wiring Connections Test


1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Disconnect the B+, 2, and field excitation lead, 3,
from the alternator, 1.
3. Reconnect the battery and turn the key start
switch on. Do not start the engine. Connect a
voltmeter, 4, between each of the disconnected
leads and ground. Battery voltage should be indi-
cated at both of the leads.
If battery voltage is not indicated at both leads, a
continuity fault exists which must be traced and cor-
rected.
4. Disconnect the battery and reconnect the re-
184
moved leads to the alternator. Reconnect the
battery.
Charging Current and Controlled Voltage Tests
1. Switch off all electrical components. Disconnect
the battery negative cable.
2. Disconnect the B+ terminal, 4, at the alternator.
Connect an ammeter, 1, between the removed
(Red/Dark Blue) wire, 3, and the B+ terminal of
the alternator.
3. Connect a voltmeter, 2, between the alternator
B+ terminal and ground.
4. Reconnect the battery. Start and run the engine
at 2000 RPM and observe the voltmeter and am-
meter readings.
The voltmeter should register in excess of battery
185
voltage and when the ammeter reading falls
below 10 amps, the voltmeter reading should sta-
bilize at 13.6-14.4 volts.
If the voltmeter reading exceeds 14.4 volts, the
regulator is faulty and must be replaced. After re-
placement, conduct the charging current and
controlled voltage tests.
If the voltmeter reading is below 13.6 volts, a
faulty alternator or a high resistance fault in the
external portion of the charging system is indi-
cated.
If the ammeter registers zero amperes, a faulty
alternator is indicated. Turn off the engine and
conduct the “alternator component tests” as de-
tailed in this chapter.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 127

Charging Circuit Voltage Drop Tests

Insulated Side Voltage Drop Tests


1. With the key start switch in the “off” position, dis-
connect the battery negative cable and the B+, 5,
cable from the alternator.
2. Connect a voltmeter, 4, with a low-voltage scale
between the battery positive terminal and the
free end of the B+ cable. The voltmeter positive
lead connects to the B+ cable while the negative
lead connects to the battery positive terminal.
3. Connect an ammeter, 2, of 60-amp minimum ca-
pacity between the B+ post of the alternator, 1,
and the B+ cable, 5, (ammeter positive lead to al- 186
ternator).
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable. Connect
a variable discharge rate (carbon pile) load
tester, 3, across the battery terminals. Adjust the
tester for minimum draw (maximum resistance)
before connection.
5. Start the engine and increase speed to 2000
RPM. Slowly increase the current draw until the
ammeter reads 45 amps.
6. At that point, the voltmeter should not read more
than 0.4 volts.
If the ammeter reading exceeds 0.4 volts, there
is a high resistance fault in the insulated side of
the circuit.
If maximum output is less than 45 amps and the
voltmeter reading is less than 0.4 volts, proceed
to the Ground Side Voltage Drop Test.
7. Stop the engine.
128 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Ground Side Voltage Drop Test


1. Ensure the key start switch is in the OFF position.
2. Test connections are the same as the previous
test except that the voltmeter, 4, is now con-
nected between the negative post of the battery
and the alternator frame. Voltmeter negative lead
connects to the alternator frame.
NOTE: Ensure the variable rate load tester, 3, is set
to the minimum current draw position.
3. Start the engine and increase the speed to 2000
RPM.
4. Slowly increase current draw until the ammeter,
2, reads 45 amps.
187
5. At that point the voltmeter should not read more
than 0.2 volts.
If the reading is in excess of 0.2 volts, there is a
high resistance fault in the ground side of the cir-
cuit.
If the maximum output reading obtained is less
than 45 amps and voltage drop is within specifi-
cations, the alternator is faulty. Conduct the alter-
nator component tests outlined in this section.
If the voltage reading is less than 13.6 volts, a
fault in the alternator is indicated. Conduct the al-
ternator component tests outlined in this section.
6. At that point, the voltmeter reading should be
13.6 volts minimum.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 129

Alternator Maximum Output


Performance Test
1. With the key start switch in the OFF position, dis-
connect the battery negative cable and the B+
cable, 5, from the alternator.
2. Connect an ammeter, 2, of 60-amp minimum ca-
pacity between the B+ post of the alternator, 1,
and the B+ cable (ammeter positive lead to alter-
nator).
3. Connect a voltmeter, 4, between the alternator
B+ terminal and ground.
4. Reconnect the battery, start the engine, and in-
crease the engine speed to 2000 RPM.
188
5. Slowly increase current draw until the ammeter
reads 45 amps.
6. At that point, the voltmeter reading should be
13.6 volts minimum.
If the voltage reading is less than 13.6 volts, a fault
in the alternator is indicated. Conduct the alternator
component tests outlined in this section.
ALTERNATOR COMPONENT TESTS
The following tests should only be conducted if the
INITIAL TESTS have indicated a fault in the alterna-
tor. These tests will check the following components:
Regulator
Rotor Field Winding Continuity
Brushes and Springs and Rotor Slip Rings
NOTE: These tests may be performed with the alter-
nator installed in the loader. Further testing of the al-
ternator will require removal from the machine.
IMPORTANT: Prior to removing any cables from the
alternator, ensure that the key start switch is in the
OFF position and the battery negative cable is dis-
connected.
Test equipment required:
12 volt battery
Ohmmeter
2.2-watt test lamp
130 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Regulator and Rotor Field Circuit Test


1. Disconnect all of the alternator cables.
2. Connect a 12-volt battery and a 2.2-watt test
lamp in series between the D+, 1, terminal and
the alternator frame (positive lead to D+ ter-
minal).
3. The test lamp should illuminate.
If the test lamp does not illuminate, there is a fault
in the rotor circuit. Proceed with the following two
tests of rotor continuity, slip rings, and brush
condition. If no fault is found in these compo-
nents, suspect a faulty regulator.

189
Rotor Field Winding Continuity Test
1. Remove the regulator and brushbox assembly
from the alternator by withdrawing three screws
and one slip on connector.
2. Using an ohmmeter, 3, check resistance be-
tween the two slip rings, 2. The slip rings are ac-
cessible through the brushbox opening.
3. Resistance should be 2.9 ± 0.5 ohms at room
temperature.
If resistance is outside of specification, replace the
rotor.

190
Brushes and Springs and Rotor Slip Rings
1. Remove the regulator and brushbox assembly
from the alternator by withdrawing three screws
and one slip on connector.
2. Examine the brushes, ensuring they are clean
and free in the housing. The visible-free length of
the brushes should be 5 mm (0.25″) minimum.
3. Check the brush spring pressure which should
be 1.3 - 2.7 N (5 - 10 oz.) with the brush face flush
with the housing.
If the brush-free length or spring pressure are below
specification, replace the brushbox and regulator as-
sembly. The brushes are an integral part of the as-
sembly and cannot be replaced as individual items. 191
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 131

Op. 55 301 04

ALTERNATOR OVERHAUL AND


COMPONENT TESTING

Op. 55 301 10
ALTERNATOR REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the RED/DK BL wiring lead, 3, from
terminal B+ and PUR/RED wiring lead, 2, from
terminal W.
3. Disconnect BLK wiring lead, 1, and YEL/DK BL SM863-163
electrical connector, 4. 192
4. Remove the mounting bolts, nuts and lock
washers, 5. Remove belt, 6. Remove the alterna-
tor from the machine.
132 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

SM863-164

193
45 Amp Alternator Components
1. Rectifier Assembly 6. Stator
2. Pulley Retaining Nut 7. Rotor
3. Pulley 8. Regulator and Brushbox Assembly
4. Cooling Fan 9. Rear End Housing
5. Front End Housing

Op. 55 301 12 6. Separate the front end housing from the stator
and rear end housing.
DISASSEMBLY
7. Remove the two screws securing the rectifier as-
1. Remove the nut, insulator and washers from ter-
sembly, 1, to the rear end housing. Separate the
minal “W”.
stator and the rectifier assembly from the rear
2. Remove the nut, insulator, and washers from ter- end housing.
minal “B+”.
8. Unsolder the stator leads from the tabs on the
3. Remove the three securing bolts and withdraw rectifier using pliers as a heat sink to protect the
the regulator and brushbox assembly, 8. Discon- diodes from overheating.
nect the slip on connector.
9. Remove the nut, 2, washer, pulley, 3, fan, 4, and
4. Remove the three nuts from the alternator spacer from the rotor shaft, 7.
through bolts.
10. Press the rotor shaft out of the front-end bracket
5. Mark the alternator front end housing, 5, stator, bearing.
6, and rear end housing, 9, to ensure correct
alignment on reassembly.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 133

Op. 55 301 14

ALTERNATOR COMPONENT TEST

Rectifier Assembly - Positive and


Negative Diode Test
Test each of the six diodes separately as described:
1. Connect one lead from an ohmmeter, 2, to a
diode connecting pin, 1, and the other ohmmeter
lead to the plate into which the diode is mounted.
2. Note the resistance reading shown. Reverse the
ohmmeter leads and note the reading.
3. The ohmmeter should indicate continuity in one- 194
half of the test and an open circuit in the other. If
any one diode fails this test, the entire rectifier as-
sembly must be replaced.
Rectifier Assembly - Field Diode Test
Test each of the three field diodes separately as de-
scribed:
1. Connect one lead from an ohmmeter, 2, to the D+
terminal, 1, (brush assembly lead) and the other
lead, in turn, to each of the field diode connec-
tions, 3.
2. Note the resistance reading shown. Reverse the
ohmmeter leads and note the reading.
3. The ohmmeter should indicate continuity in one-
half of the test and an open circuit in the other. If
any one diode fails this test, the entire rectifier as-
sembly must be replaced.
195
Stator Test - Winding Continuity
1. Connect ohmmeter, 3, leads between each of the
three stator leads, 2, in turn. There should be a
small resistance of approximately 0.2 ohms be-
tween each of the wires. A higher reading indi-
cates a possible break in the winding. A reading
of 0.0 ohms indicates a short circuit. If the read-
ings are outside of specification, a new stator as-
sembly, 1, will be required.

196
134 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Stator Test - Insulation


1. Check the insulation of each winding to the stator
casing by connecting ohmmeter, 1, leads be- 2
tween each of the stator wires, 2, and the stator
casing, 3. There should be no continuity between
the winding and the casing. If any ohmmeter re-
ading other than open circuit is obtained, the sta-
tor assembly must be replaced.

1
3
197
Rotor Tests
Prior to performing component tests on the rotor, in-
spect the slip rings. The slip rings should be clean
and smooth. If dirty, they may be cleaned with a sol-
vent-moistened cloth. If the slip rings are burned,
they may be polished with a fine crocus cloth, then
wiped clean.
The refinishing cloth must be fine enough to leave a
highly-polished slip ring surface, otherwise excess-
ive brush wear will occur.
Do not use an emery cloth, as it will leave an abrasive
residue, leading to premature brush failure.
If the slip rings are excessively worn, a new rotor
must be installed.
Rotor Field Winding Continuity Test
1. Connect an ohmmeter, 3, between the slip rings,
2. The resistance should be 2.9 ± 0.5 ohms.
If the resistance is outside of specification, re-
place rotor, 1.

198
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 135

Rotor Field Winding Insulation Test


1. Using an ohmmeter, 3, test for continuity be-
tween each of the slip rings, 2, and the rotor
poles, 1. Any reading other than open circuit indi-
cates a short circuit within the rotor and it must be
replaced.

199
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. Inspect the rotor poles and stator for signs of rub-
bing. Areas of rubbing indicates possible worn
bearings, misaligned housings or a bent rotor as-
sembly shaft.
NOTE: The front-end bearing is not serviced separ-
ately. It will be necessary to replace the front-end
housing assembly if the bearing has failed.
2. Inspect the roller bearing, 1, located in the rear
end housing, 2.
3. If bearing replacement is necessary, support the
housing and carefully drive out the bearing using
SM863-171
a properly-sized mandrel.
200
4. Clean and examine all components.
5. Press the new bearing into the housing, 1. The
bearing, 2, should be positioned 0.50 - 0.70 mm
(0.020″ - 0.028″) above the inner face of the
bearing boss, 3.

201
136 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

REASSEMBLY
1. Reassembly of the alternator follows the disas-
sembly process in reverse.
On reassembly, observe the following precau-
tions:
– Use a low-wattage soldering iron and a heat
sink when connecting the stator leads to the
rectifier assembly to avoid damaging the
diodes.
– To avoid misalignment of the end brackets,
install the stator assembly in the front-end
bracket and then assemble the rear-end
bracket to the stator assembly.
REINSTALLATION
1. Installation of the alternator is the reverse of the
removal procedure.
2. Install the mounting bolts, nuts, and lock
washers, 5. Install belt, 6.
3. Connect the RED/DKBL wiring lead, 3, to ter-
minal B+ and PUR/RED wiring lead, 2, to ter-
minal, W.
4. Reconnect BLK wiring lead, 1, and YEL/DKBL
electrical connector to 4.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
SM863-173
202
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 137

203
Op. 55 201 When the key start switch is closed with the operator
in the seat and the seat belt fastened, or with the
STARTER “Service/Run” switch in the “Service” position, the
solenoid coils are energized, pulling the solenoid
plunger into the solenoid core. This action forces the
INTRODUCTION drive pinion via pivoted linkage into mesh with the
The starting system consists of a starter motor and starter ring gear. On full engagement, the solenoid
solenoid assembly, a starter relay, seat belt interlock plunger closes a set of contacts to give a direct feed
system, battery, key start switch, and heavy-duty wir- from the battery to all four field coils, providing full
ing. power to the starter motor.
The starter motor, rated at 3.1 Kw, is a four-pole, four- The starter incorporates a single set of contacts and
brush-type with integral solenoid and positive en- a two-piece solenoid plunger which completely
gagement drive assembly. closes the contacts, even if the pinion and ring gear
The integral solenoid incorporates two windings con- teeth are misaligned. When this happens, an en-
nected in parallel. One winding is the low resistance gagement spring is compressed, which forces the
“pull-in” coil grounded through the motor, while the pinion into full engagement as soon as the starter be-
other is the high resistance “hold-in” coil grounded gins to turn.
via the solenoid body.
138 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

When the key start switch is released, power to the Service Specifications
solenoid and motor is removed. The solenoid return No load test 11.5 volts
spring, acting through the pivoted linkage, pulls the 170 amps
drive pinion out of mesh and opens the solenoid con-
8000 RPM
tacts.
Locked rotor test 6.8 volts
Incorporated in the drive pinion assembly is an over- 1200 - 1400 amps
running clutch, 8. This clutch prevents the armature
35 N·m (26 ft. lbs.) torque
from over-speeding if the pinion remains in mesh
with the ring gear after the engine has started. Solenoid holding 8.0 volts
voltage, min.
Commutator dia. 45 mm (1.77 in.) - new
STARTER
42.5 mm (1.67 in.) - min.
Commutator brush, 8.5 mm (0.33 in.)
General Specifications
min. length
Rated voltage 12 volts
Armature end play 0.1 - 0.3 mm
Output 3.1 kw
(0.004 - 0.012″)
Motor-type Four-pole series wound
Pinion tooth backlash 0.4 - 0.7 mm
Engaging system Solenoid engaged pinion
(0.016 - 0.028″)
Rotation Clockwise (when viewed
from pinion)
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 139

STARTER MOTOR TROUBLESHOOTING


SYMPTOM CAUSE CORRECTION
Solenoid moves pinion to Battery is discharged. Charge battery to minimum
engage ring gear but starter fails 1.225 specific gravity, or 12.5
to crank engine. open circuit volts.

Poor connection at terminals. Inspect, clean and tighten as


necessary. Must have no more
than 0.2 voltage drop between
positive battery post and starter
solenoid and between negative
battery post and ground stud on
starter.

Defective starter. Perform starter draw test.


Replace or repair starter.

Engine is seized. Repair engine.


Solenoid does not move pinion Open in starter activation circuit: Disconnect W/R wire at starter
into engagement with flywheel. solenoid. Check for 12 volts with
Worklights remain bright. key switch in start position.

Operator not in seat with seat Sit in seat. Buckle seat belt.
belt buckled. Retest.

Blown 15 amp main key switch Determine cause and replace


fuse or 5 amp ignition fuse. fuse.

Loose connection at key switch Correct or replace.


or defective key switch.

Fault in seat belt interlock Place “Service/Run” switch in


system. Service position. Retest. If 12
volts, repair interlock system.
Pinion engages ring gear, Defective overrunning clutch in Replace starter drive assembly.
starter motor turns but engine starter drive.
does not.
140 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

STARTER MOTOR

Op. 55 201 50
REMOVAL
1. Raise the boom, extend the boom lock pins, and
rest the boom on the pins.
2. Open the engine compartment and remove the
left side shield.
3. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Remove the fuel filter/sedimenter assembly, 1, to
provide access to the starter, 2.
5. Disconnect the throttle cable from the fuel injec-
tion pump and lay it, with the mounting bracket, 204
out of the way.
6. Disconnect the heavy electrical cables from the
upper post of the starter solenoid. Remove the
solenoid signal wire (white/red) from the sole-
noid.
7. Remove the cap screw and nut, which serve as
a main ground location, as well as retain the
starter in place. Retain all of the ground wires on
the cap screw and replace the nut. This will en-
sure all grounds are connected at reassembly.
8. Remove the remaining two cap screws holding
the starter and rotate the starter to remove from
the flywheel housing.

INSTALLATION
Starter installation is the reverse of the removal pro-
cedure, observing the following precautions:
1. Ensure the starter fits properly on the mounting
flange before tightening any of the mounting cap
screws.
2. Ensure all of the grounding wires removed in step
7 above are properly replaced with the heaviest
gauge wires placed closest to the flywheel hous-
ing.
3. Check fuel lines for leaks after engine startup.
NOTE: The ground strap, 3, ground strap to main
frame, battery (-) negative ground cable, 4, and
ground wire, 5, must all be connected to the engine
bell housing at 6. Ground wire, 5, connects this
ground connection to the main electrical ground stud
at 7, at the front of the engine bell housing. If the
ground wires are not properly connected, engine
crankshaft and bearing damage may occur.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 141

STARTER MAINTENANCE ing a 0-20 volt voltmeter and a 0-500 amp ammeter
Little maintenance of the starter is required. No peri- be used to diagnose starting system problems.
odic lubrication of the sealed bearings or starter drive When using test equipment, follow the manufac-
are required. turer’s recommended test procedures. If the recom-
If the starter drive becomes sluggish or hangs up, mended test equipment is not available, the following
due to dirt, it should be washed with diesel fuel. The test procedure (using a standard 0-20 volt voltmeter
fuel will not wash away the lubricant in the bushings and a 0-500 amp ammeter) can be used to determine
and will lubricate the starter drive. if the starter is operating correctly without removing
it from the engine.
The starter brushes should be inspected whenever
the starter is removed, after extended use and when- Before testing:
ever a problem with the starter is suspected. 1. Ensure that the battery is fully charged.
Ensure the brushes are free to slide freely in their 2. Check the complete starting system wiring circuit
holder. If dirty, wash with a suitable solvent, drying for frayed or broken wires. Also check for loose
with a clean, lint-free cloth and dry compressed air. or corroded terminal connections.
If binding, smooth with a fine abrasive or fine file. 3. Ensure the engine is not seized.
Clean all residue before installation. NOTE: Starter motor draw is directly dependent on
Replace a brush if it is broken, if the soldered pigtail the load placed on it. The above specifications are
has loosened, or if it is worn below 8.5 mm (11/32″). based on moderate ambient temperatures and a cold
Ensure new brushes do not bind in the holder. The motor. Extremely high or low temperatures will affect
commutator should be turned whenever new the load placed on the starter motor, thus the amper-
brushes are installed. age draw reading. Likewise, cold temperatures par-
ticularly will affect battery voltage readings.
SYSTEM TESTING NOTE: Before performing these tests ensure the hy-
For easier and rapid diagnosis, and for most conclus- drostats are in neutral. If the starter motor is required
ive test results, it is recommended that a battery/ to pump oil in the hydrostat system, the amperage
starter tester (high rate discharge tester) incorporat- draw will be excessively high, even with a good
starter motor.
142 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

STARTER MOTOR CURRENT DRAW 4


1. Disconnect the ground (negative) cable, 1, from
the battery.
2. Disconnect the battery positive cable from the
starter solenoid, 2. Connect the ammeter posi-
tive lead to the battery positive terminal, 3, and
the negative lead to the solenoid input terminal,
4.
3. Reconnect the battery negative cable to the bat-
tery negative terminal.
4. Connect the voltmeter positive lead to the battery
positive terminal, 3, and the voltmeter negative
lead to the battery negative terminal, 1.
205
5. Disconnect the wire from the fuel injection pump
shut-off solenoid.
6. Crank the engine while observing the voltmeter
and ammeter readings. The voltage should re-
main above 10 volts with 325-375 amps draw.
If the voltage and current draw are within specifi-
cation, the starter motor is functioning correctly.
If the voltage drops below 10 volts during the test,
proceed to “Starting Circuit Resistance Test.”
If the current draw is greater than specified, per-
form the starting circuit resistance test. If the
starting circuit passes the tests, the starter motor
is defective and must be repaired or replaced.
If the current draw is less than specified, the
starter motor is defective and must repaired or re-
placed.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 143

Starting System Circuit Resistance (Voltage


Drop) Test
If there is an excessive current draw, the circuit
should be checked by determining voltage drop
across the individual components in the circuit.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the fuel injection pump
fuel shut-off solenoid wire.
Battery Positive Cable Test
1. Connect the voltmeter positive lead to the battery
positive terminal, 1, (not the cable clamp).
2. Connect the voltmeter negative lead to the
starter solenoid battery terminal, 2, (not the cable
end).
3. Crank the engine while observing the voltmeter
reading. If the reading exceeds 0.2 volts, check,
clean and tighten the cable connections. Retest.
If voltage drop is still excessive, install a new
cable.

206
Starter Motor Ground Connection Test
1. Connect the voltmeter to the starter motor frame,
1.
2. Connect the voltmeter negative lead to the en-
gine block, 2. Ensure that the meter lead is not
insulated from the block by paint.
3. Crank the engine while observing the voltmeter
reading. If the reading exceeds 0.2 volts, check
the ground connections between the starter
motor flange and the rear engine plate.

207
Battery Ground Cable Test
1. Connect the voltmeter positive lead to the engine
block, 1.
2. Connect the voltmeter negative lead to the bat-
tery negative terminal, 2.
3. Crank the engine while observing the voltmeter
reading. If the reading exceeds 0.2 volts, check,
clean and tighten the ground cable connections.
Retest. If voltage drop is still excessive, install a
new ground cable.

208
144 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

20

209
Starter Motor - Exploded View
1. Stud and Bolt Kit 11. Housing Assembly
2. End Cap 12. Solenoid Assembly
3. Collar and Ring Assembly, Drive Thrust 13. Solenoid Hardware Kit
4. Brush End Plate Assembly 14. Lever Assembly
5. Brush Assembly 15. Brush Spring
6. Brush Assembly 16. Brush Holder Assembly
7. Field Coils and Housing Assembly 17. Washer
8. Armature 18. Nut
9. Center Bearing Plate 19. Drive Assembly
10. Bushing 20. Pivot Pin

DISASSEMBLY
1. Support the starter motor in a soft jaw vise. 5. Remove the two end housing nuts and the two
2. Disconnect the thick braided wire from the field screws retaining the end cap, 2, and brush plate
coil housing to the solenoid assembly. to the end housing, 4. Remove the “C” clip and ar-
mature shaft end play shims, 3, and withdraw the
3. Remove the three screws from the front housing
end housing, leaving the brush gear, 16, on the
assembly, 11, and withdraw the solenoid assem-
commutator. Remove the thin metal washer from
bly, 12. The plunger will remain in the drive en-
the commutator end of the armature.
gagement lever, 14.
NOTE: At this point, inspect the brushes and
4. Remove the solenoid plunger from the drive en-
commutator as detailed under “Inspection and Re-
gagement lever by gripping the plunger and lift-
pair Bench Test” and determine if these are the cause
ing up the front end and releasing it from the drive
of failure.
engagement lever.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 145

6. To remove the brush carrier and brushes, com- 2. Lever the armature fully forward and zero the dial
press the brush springs by inserting a small indicator. Lever the armature fully rearward and
screwdriver through the spring coil and bend record the indicator reading.
back the spring retaining tabs. Gently release the 3. The indicator reading should not exceed 0.3 mm
spring and remove the brush from the holder. (0.012″). If the reading is greater, inspect the ar-
With the four brushes removed, remove the mature assembly for wear. Replace worn com-
carrier. ponents as required and recheck the end play.
7. Remove the armature and drive end bracket
from the motor housing assembly. INSPECTION AND REPAIR - BENCH TEST
8. Remove the drive engagement lever pivot pin,
20, from the drive end housing. Brush Assembly
9. Remove the drive assembly, 19, and inner plate 1. Check for sticking brushes. If necessary, clean
retaining snap ring, 3, from the armature shaft by brushes and brush guides with a solvent-
driving the securing thrust collar squarely off the moistened cloth. Remove any burrs on the
snap ring with a suitable diameter tube and then brushes with a fine abrasive or a fine file.
levering the snap ring from the groove.
2. Check brushes for wear. If worn below the mini-
10. Remove the armature and drive assembly. mum length specified of 8.5 mm (0.33″), they
should be replaced. The commutator should be
REASSEMBLY turned whenever new brushes are installed.
Reassembly of the starter follows the disassembly
procedure in reverse. Brush Removal and Installation
After completing reassembly and prior to installation 1. Unsolder the field brush leads from the field coils.
in the engine, check the armature end play to specifi- 2. Unsolder the ground brush leads from the brush
cation and test the starter no load operation. holders.
3. Install the new brushes, soldering the leads using
Checking Armature End Play a 300-watt soldering iron and resin core solder.
1. Support the starter motor in a soft jaw vise. At- 4. Ensure the new brushes move freely in the
tach a dial indicator to the drive end housing holders. If necessary, smooth the sides of the
flange. Place the dial indicator pointer on the end brushes with a fine abrasive or fine file.
of the armature shaft.
146 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1

Starter Motor No-Load Test


6
NOTE: A fully-charged battery and a battery/starter
tester (high rate discharge tester) with a carbon pile
(variable load resistor) should be used to perform this
test.
1. Support the starter motor in a soft jaw vise.
2. Connect the battery negative cable to the starter
motor mounting flange, 4.
3. Connect a short jumper wire between the sole-
noid battery and solenoid switch terminals, 6.
4. Connect a voltmeter positive lead to the battery
positive terminal and the voltmeter negative lead
to the battery negative terminal, 3. Connect the
210
ammeter positive lead to the battery positive ter-
minal and the ammeter negative lead to the sole-
noid battery terminal, 1.
5. Hold a hand tachometer, 5, on the end of the ar-
mature shaft. Adjust the carbon pile, 2, to actuate
the starter motor until a reading of 11.5 volts is
obtained. The armature speed should be be-
tween 7500 and 8500 RPM. Maximum current
draw should not exceed 170 amps.
6. If the starter motor does not perform to specifica-
tion, check for grounded field coils, a rubbing ar-
mature, or a distorted armature shaft.
Armature Tests
1. The commutator should be clean and free from
burned spots. If necessary, remove any burned
spots using fine glass paper, not emery cloth. Fi-
nally, clean the commutator with a solvent-
moistened cloth.
2. If it is necessary to skim the commutator, ensure
the diameter is not reduced below the minimum
specified diameter of 42.5 mm (1.67″). Following
skimming, the commutator should be polished
with a fine glass paper and then wiped clean with
a solvent-moistened cloth.
NOTE: Do not cut into the commutator metal when
recutting insulation slots.
3. Armature insulation can be checked by connect- 5. If there is evidence that armature core segments
ing an ohmmeter between the commutator seg- have contacted the field pole shoes, then the ar-
ments and the armature shaft, 1. There should be mature bearings are worn or the armature is
an infinity reading, i.e. no continuity. warped. First, check to see the pole shoes are
4. To test the armature for short circuits, it is necess- tight and that the armature runs true in a lathe. If
ary to use a “growler” test instrument. Alterna- necessary, replace the armature bearings.
tively, it may be tested by substitution.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER (BOOM AND MOUNTING PLATE)

Chapter 1 – Buckets

CONTENT

Section Description Page


82 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-2
Buckets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-2
82 100 77 Boom Lock Pins and Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-3
Boom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-3
82 100 70 Attachment Mounting Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-4
Boom and Cylinder Pivot Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-4
Boom and Cylinder Pivot Pin Location and Machine Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-4
Boom and Cylinder Pivot Pins Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-5
82 100 30 Pallet Fork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-6
82 100 20 Utility Fork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-7
82 100 12 Bucket Cutting Edge (Replacement) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-8
82 100 Bucket Latch Plate Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-9
82 100 Dirt Tooth Kit Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-12
Bucket Tooth Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-13
Boom Lock Pin/Linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-15
82 100 77 Boom Lock Pin/Linkage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-15
Boom Lock Pin/Linkage Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-17
Boom, Upper and Lower Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-18
Boom, Upper and Lower Link Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-18
82 100 70 Front Boom Mounting Plate Pivot Hub Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-24 .
Boom, Upper and Lower Link Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-25
Attachment Mounting Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
82 100 70 Attachment Mounting Plate Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
Repair/Rebuild Mounting Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
82 100 74 Latch Lever and Pin Removal/Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-30
Attachment Mounting Plate Parts Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-33
Checking Procedure for Buckets and Attachments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-38
Checking Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-40
Checking the Loader Faceplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82-41
2 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

1
Op. 82 100 Bucket Capacity Cubic Feet

Capacity Capacity
GENERAL INFORMATION Bucket Heaped Struck
Width Bucket (cu ft) (cu ft)
BUCKETS 66″ Utility fork N/A N/A
Bucket Types 66″ Low profile 15.5 11.2
1 - LP - Low profile 66″ Dirt and foundry 15.2 11.6
The low-profile bucket has a shorter back and is 72″ Low profile 17.1 12.2
longer from bucket heel to cutting edge for optimum
72″ Dirt and foundry 16.7 12.7
cutting edge visibility. This is important for finish grad-
ing and accurate cut and fill jobs. 72″ Manure and fertilizer 19.1 15.5
2 - D & F - Dirt and foundry 72″ Light material 23.7 19.0
The dirt and foundry bucket is shorter from bucket 84″ Low profile 20.2 14.3
heel to cutting edge to provide maximum breakout 84″ Manure and fertilizer 22.5 18.2
force for tough digging conditions.
84″ Light material 27.9 22.3
3 - M & F - Manure and fertilizer (slurry)
The manure and slurry bucket is for handling loose
or fluid materials with more rollback to minimize spil-
lage.
4 - LM - Light material
The light-material bucket is for light, high- volume
materials for more productivity handling light ma-
terial.
Select bucket styles and sizes to provide both ad-
equate breakout force and reasonable carrying ca-
pacity. Handle dense materials with a relatively small
bucket. Handle lighter materials with higher capacity
buckets. Refer to the following bucket capacity chart
and the material weight chart in the operator’s manual
when choosing the bucket for a job.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 3

Op. 82 100 77

BOOM LOCK PINS AND LINKAGE


The operator can engage the boom lock pins from
the operator’s seat. The control is located to the right
rear of the operator’s seat at 1. Pivoting the handle
towards the outside of the cab extends and engages
the lock pins. Pivoting the handle in will retract the
lock pins.

2
To engage the boom lock pins:
1. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins and
engage the pins, 1.
2. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position to stop
the engine.
3. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position and op-
erate the boom and bucket pedals to lower the
boom onto the lock pins and to relieve the pres-
sure in the boom and bucket circuits. Turn the
ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless the boom is
resting on the boom lock pins, 1. 3
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment,
always remove any attachment from the loader
mounting plate.

BOOM
The boom assembly consists of:
Op. 82 100 50
1 - Main boom frame
Op. 82 100 52
2 - Lower link, right and left
Op. 82 100 53
3 - Upper link, right and left
The boom and links are supported on the ROPS main
frame with tapered pivot pins at all pivot locations.

4
4 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

Op. 82 100 70

ATTACHMENT MOUNTING PLATE 2


The mounting plate is attached to the main boom
frame with two tapered pivot pins at 1. The attach-
ments used on the skid steer can be easily attached
or removed from the loader with the over center
levers, 2, and pins, 3. The control levers and pins are 3
3
spring loaded to hold the levers over center when un-
latched to assist in changing attachments. When the
control levers are in the latched position the spring-
loaded pins are forced into the latch points on the at- 1
tachment. The control levers and pins are shown in 19984596
the unlatched position. 5
BOOM AND CYLINDER PIVOT PINS
When the boom, upper and lower boom links and cyl-
inders are removed, the following figures and charts
may be use for proper pin placement. The following
charts and figures list the pivot pin, part number, loca-
tion, and size for identification and locations.

6
BOOM AND CYLINDER PIVOT PIN LOCA-
TION AND MACHINE USAGE
Ref. Description Part Number Qty. Torque
1 Mounting Plate Pivot 86501434 2 80 ft. lbs. (108 N·m)
2 Upper Bucket Cyl. Pivot 86501432 2 80 ft. lbs. (108 N·m)
3 Lower Bucket Cyl. Pivot 9614349 2 28 ft. lbs. (38 N·m)
4 Upper Boom Cyl. Pivot 86521982 2 28 ft. lbs. (38 N·m)
5 Lower Boom Cyl. Pivot 86501428 2 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
6 Boom Lower Link Pivot 86501424 4 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
7 Boom Upper Link Pivot 86501426 4 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 5

BOOM/CYLINDER PIVOT PINS SIZE

Part Number A B C
9614349 (95mm) 3-3/4I (38mm)-1-1/2I
86501424 (92mm)-3-5/8I (60.3mm)-2-3/8I (156mm)-6-9/64I
86501426 (62.5mm)-2-15/32I (60.3mm)-2-3/8I (126.5mm)-5I
86501428 (59mm)-2-21/64I (60.3mm)-2-3/8I (126.5mm)-5I
86501432 (78.3mm)-3-5/64I (38.10mm)-1-1/2I (118.5mm)-4-43/64I
86501434 (57.8mm)-2-9/32I (38.10mm)-1-1/2I (92mm)-3-5/8I
86521982 (117mm)-4-39/64I (38.1mm)-1-1/2I

NOTE: After the tapered pivot pin retaining hardware


is torqued, the pins must be properly seated. Using
a hammer, strike the head of the bolt and pin several
times to seat the tapered pin the taper of the boom
and/or ROPS. Retorque the hardware to the speci-
fied torque. Repeat this process until the torque is
maintained.
6 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

Op. 82 100 30
1
PALLET FORK
Pallet fork frame/guard, 36″ - 42″ - 48″ fork sets are
available. A block fork set is also available.
To adjust fork spacing, raise the lock pin, 1, and slide
the fork to the required spacing and relatch lock pins
into notches, 2. 2
2
Pallet Fork Capacity - LS180
2
WITH WEIGHT KIT
19990486
SAE
Max. Reach Height Rating 8
2794 mm ( 110″ ) 804 kg (1773 lbs.)
WITHOUT WEIGHT KIT
SAE
Max. Reach Height Rating
2794 mm (110 ″) 757 kg (1670 lbs.)

Pallet Fork Capacity - LS190

WITH WEIGHT KIT


SAE
Max. Reach Height Rating
2794 mm (110″ ) 899 kg (1980 lbs.)
WITHOUT WEIGHT KIT
SAE
Max. Reach Height Rating
2794 mm (110 ″) 830 kg (1830 lbs.)

Capacities rated, full fluids, 79 kg (175 lbs.) operator,


1219 mm (48″) pallet forks w/back guard, per SAE
rating specification J1197.
To install or remove the forks from the frame, slide the
forks to the center of frame at, 1, and pick the end of
fork up to remove fork from frame.
CAUTION
Do not use a pallet fork attachment unless the back
guard is in good condition and properly installed on
the attachment frame.

19990487
1
9
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 7

Op. 82 100 20

UTILITY FORK
The utility fork is for handling matted, stringy material
which is difficult to load into a standard bucket.

10
The standard tine spacing, center to center, is 21.8
cm (8-1/2″). The fork frame is equipped with addi-
tional holes for additional tines, reducing the tine
spacing to 10.9 cm (4-1/4″).

11
Op. 82 100 11

Tine Installation
1. Slide each tine, 1, into the fork backplate for the
desired tine spacing, until the 1/2″ x 2-3/4″ bolt,
2, can be inserted through the fork backplate and
tine with the nut to the inside of the fork back-
plate.
2. Position the spacer, 3, as shown with the angle
end of the spacer next to the floor of the back-
plate. Secure the assembly with 1/2″ lock washer
and nut. Tighten securely.

12
8 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

BUCKETS

Op. 82 100 12

CUTTING EDGE (REPLACEMENT)


Cut or grind the old cutting edge from the bucket floor
and sides. Remove all old weld and foreign material
from the welding area.
1. Straighten the bucket floor and sides if required.
2. Thoroughly clean the area where the new cutting
edge will be welded.
3. Use dry AWS-E7018 low hydrogen electrodes or
either of the following equivalent low hydrogen 13
wire feed electrodes: Gas metal arc welding
(CO2 or argon CO2) AWS-E70S6 or flux cored
arc welding AWS-E70T1.
4. Preheat the parts to be welded (both tack and
final welds) to a minimum of 400°F (204°C). The
preheat temperature must be throughout the
entire thickness of the parts joined, and at
least 51 mm (2″) back from the joint. Maintain
preheat throughout the entire welding operation.
NOTE: This is a hardened steel edge. If not pre-
heated, the cutting edge may later crack during use.
5. Tack weld the preheated parts starting at the
center of the bucket and working toward the out-
side ends.
6. Finish welding the preheated parts starting at the
center of the front edge of the bucket floor and
working toward the outside ends. Repeat this 14
operation at the back side of the cutting edge to
bucket floor.
7. Do not remove the bucket from the welding envi-
ronment until the weld and metal temperature
drops to the ambient temperature. Do not force
the cooling rate of the welds and material.
Follow the same welding procedure for welding the
side cutting edges and bottom wear plates to the
bucket.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 9

Op. 82 100

BUCKET LATCH PLATE INSTALLATION


PROCEDURE
1. Remove the bucket from the loader before weld-
ing to prevent damage to the loader electrical
system.
Material to be welded is low carbon, grade 50 steel;
use welding rods marked 6011 or comparable.
CAUTION
Good quality welds are necessary for new plates to
be properly retained. Use a professional welder if re-
quired. 15

2. Turn the bucket over and support it about


305 mm (12″) off the floor.
3. Cut the old lower retaining plates, 1, off the
bucket and grind the area flat.
4. For locating the new lower attaching plates, re-
move the quick-attach plate from the loader
boom:
4
– Remove the cylinder pivot pin retaining hard-
ware, 1, and remove the pins. 2
– Remove the hub caps, 2, from the plate pi-
vots.
– Loosen the quick-attach plate pivot pin hard- 3
ware, 3. 3 1
– With a soft-faced sledge hammer strike the
mounting plate pivot area at 4. This will free
up the tapered pivot pin in the boom link. 19984476
– Remove the pivot pin hardware and pins.
16
5. Rest the attaching plate in the saddle area, 1, of
the bucket with the latch handles in the unlatched
position as shown at 2. Put two 152 mm (6″) long
pieces of 4.8 mm (3/16″) square key stock at 3,
to position the attaching plate properly against
the back of the bucket.

17
10 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

6. Position the first plates against the back of the


bucket at 1, and rest on the quick-attach plate, 2.
Locate the center of the latch plate notches, 4,
and center the outer half of the notch over the
latch pin, 3. Spot weld the plate to the bucket at
1 to hold the plate in position.
NOTE: The material to be welded is low carbon,
grade 50 steel; use welding rods marked 6011 or
comparable.

18
7. Position the second plates as shown at 1, with
the plates contacting each other at 2, and about
28.6 mm (1-1/8″) spacing at 3. On low-profile
buckets, the second plate will be at the rear
corner of the bucket at 4. Spot weld the second
plate to the bucket at 4 and the two plates to-
gether at 5.
8. Remove the 4.8 mm (3/16″) square key stock
and push the latch handles to the latched position
making sure the latch pins engage the bucket
latch plates. The latch handles must fully latch.
The latch pin will only contact the top latch plate,
6.
19
9. If the latch handles will not fully latch, the top
plate may require some grinding in the pin area
at 1, or the plates are not located properly. 1

1
19984597
20
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 11

10. Weld the plates to the bucket at 2; also weld the


two plates at 3.
11. Reinstall the bucket quick-attach plate to the
loader boom with the pins previously removed.

21
12. Attach the bucket to the loader by engaging the
top of the plate, 1, under the lip of the bucket at
2. Curl the bucket back to allow the bucket to con-
tact the loader quick-attach plate and engage the 2
latch handles and pins, making sure the latch
pins engage the bucket plates properly.

19984597
22
12 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

Op. 82 100

DIRT TOOTH KIT INSTALLATION

Bucket Dirt Tooth Kit


The dirt tooth kit consists of six teeth that are welded
to the bucket cutting edge as indicated at 1. The teeth
are used to break up the material when rough digging
conditions are experienced. This will make it easier
to fill the bucket. The teeth are intended to be used
only on dirt and foundry or low-profile buckets.

23
Op. 82 100 10
Tooth Point Replacement
The points of the teeth are a replaceable “pin-on” de-
sign and can be obtained from Parts.
To replace the “pin-on” points, use a punch that just
fits into the pin hole, 1, and drive the old retaining pin
from the shank.
Place the new point over the shank and insert the re-
taining pin into pin hole, 1. With a punch that contacts
both sides of the metal part of the retaining pin, drive
the pin until it is centered in the shank.
NOTE: If the punch or driver is too small and just con-
tacts the rubber center of the retaining pin, the pin will 24
be damaged and will not retain the point.
Tooth Location and Installation
1. The bucket should be flat on the floor when plac-
ing and welding the teeth to maintain good weld
points, 1.
IMPORTANT: Remove the bucket from the loader
while welding teeth to prevent damage to the loader
electrical system.
Slide the replaceable points in place but do not
attach with the steel/rubber pins as the rubber
may be damaged during the welding process.

25
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 13

26
2. Locate the teeth on the bucket edge as indicated.

BUCKET TOOTH SPACING


Bucket
Width From End 2nd Tooth 3rd Tooth 4th Tooth 5th Tooth 6th Tooth
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
60″ 1-13/16″ 10-15/16″ 21-5/16″ 32″ 42-5/8″ 53-5/16″
66″ 1-13/16″ 13-27/32″ 25-27/32″ 37-29/32″ 50-7/32″ 62-1/4″
72″ 1-13/16″ 13″ 26″ 38-15/16″ 51-7/8″ 64-7/8″
78″ 1-13/16″ 14-3/16″ 28-5/16″ 42-1/2″ 56-11/16″ 70-7/8″
84″ 1-13/16″ 15-3/8″ 30-3/4″ 46-1/8″ 61-1/2″ 76-13/16″

NOTE: Position the teeth at these spacings, then re-center if necessary for equal spacing.
14 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

3. Welds are high carbon steel (tooth) to high car-


bon steel (bucket). Use welding rods marked
7018 or some comparable rod. Weld on both
sides of the tooth from the back of the tooth to-
wards the replaceable point at 1. Stop welding 13
mm (1/2″) from the cutting edge as noted at 2.
Weld along the back of the tooth at 3. A minimum
5 mm (3/16″) fillet weld is required for this ap-
plication.

27
4. Weld in the direction shown at 1.
5. Weld a 5 mm (3/16″) fillet weld along both sides
and rear of the tooth at 2, high carbon steel to
high carbon steel.

28
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 15

BOOM LOCK PIN LINKAGE

Op. 82 100 77
REMOVAL
1. Lower the boom to the lowered position.
2. Open the rear door, 1, and the top engine access
cover, 2.
3. Remove the right and left engine side covers, 3.

29
4. Unhook spring, 1, from the control rod, by sliding
the spring to the side and removing spring at bot-
tom hook, 2.
5. Remove the push nuts, 3, from the control rod, 4.
6. Detach the linkage from the lock pin by removing
bolt, 5.
7. Remove the linkage support retaining hardware,
6.

30
8. Remove the plastic handle grip, 1, from the con-
trol lever.

31
16 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

9. Remove the control rod, 1, from the lever at 2,


and slide the handle from the rear of the cab.
10. Slide the boom pins, 3, right and left, from the
loader ROPS post.

32
11. Shown are the boom lock pins and linkage.
1. Boom Lock Pins (2)
2. Control Rod (1)
3. Push Nuts (2)
4. Support Angle (1)
5. Control Lever Assembly (1)
6. Plastic Handle Grip (1)
7. Spring

33
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 17

REINSTALLATION
1. Install the boom lock pins, 1, right and left, into
the ROPS posts at 2.
2. Install a rubber grommet at 3. Insert the control
handle assembly, 4, through the right cab side
shield at 5.

34
3. Position the control handle over the lock pin, 1,
and install the support hardware at 2.
4. Install the handle and lock pin through bolt at 3.
5. With the handle properly positioned tighten the
support hardware at 2, and the through bolt lock
nut, 3.
NOTE: Do not over tighten the through bolt because
the handle must pivot at the lock pin.
6. Install the control rod, 4, in the handle assembly,
positioning the seat and seat belt wire harness to
the seat side of the control rod.

35
7. Install the control rod, 1, in the left boom lock pin,
2. Slide new push retaining nuts onto the control
rod on both sides at 3.

36
18 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

8. Slide the plastic handle grip, 1, onto the handle.


9. Operate the control handle to insure proper oper-
ation.
– Pivot the handle towards the outside of the
operator’s cab. The lock pins should extend
from the cab post.
– Pivot the handle towards the inside of the op-
erator’s cab. The lock pins should retract into
the cab post far enough to allow boom move-
ment without contacting the lock pins.
10. Reinstall the engine side shields. Close the top
engine cover and rear door.

37
BOOM, UPPER AND LOWER LINK

REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment (bucket, fork, etc.) from
the boom mounting plate and lower the boom to
the lowered position.

38
2. Attach a chain or strap suitable for handling the
weight of the boom, approximately 360 kg (800
lbs.), to the boom grab handles as shown at 1,
and support about level with the top of the loader
ROPS.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom.

39
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 19

3. Support the rear of the boom with the rear lower


link pivot above the top of the engine shielding as
shown.
NOTE: This will enable the removal of the link pivot
hardware.

40
Op. 82 100 52
Lower Link Removal
1. Remove the plastic plugs, 1, from the cab inner
shell to access the boom lower link and cylinder
pivot hardware.
2. Remove the fenders to gain access to the boom
and bucket hydraulic tube and hose connections.

41
3. With the boom properly supported and all hy-
draulic oil pressure removed from the boom and
bucket circuits, disconnect the hydraulic lines at
1. Cap open ends of lines and hoses. Remove
the boom hose clamps, 2, retaining the hoses to
the lower boom links. Remove the hoses from the
lower hose retainer, 3.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom.
Do not disconnect any hydraulic lines until all hy-
draulic pressure is removed from the boom and
bucket hydraulic circuits.
42
NOTE: Mark all boom and boom link tapered pins
with their proper location prior to removal. This will
ensure that all pins are installed in their correct posi-
tion during reassembly.
20 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

4. Loosen the right and left lower link, rear pivot pin
retaining hardware.
CAUTION
Do not remove the pin retaining hardware until the
tapered pivot pin is broken loose at the tapered end
of pin or the link and pin may fall.

5. With a soft-faced sledge hammer, strike the


lower link as shown to break the tapered pivot pin
loose in the main boom link.

43
6. Loosen the front lower link pivot pin retaining
hardware, 1, and strike the link at 2, to break the
tapered pivot pin loose in the ROPS frame.

44
7. Remove the retaining pin hardware from the front
and rear pins. Lift the lower link and pins from the
loader.
NOTE: Both the right and left lower links can be re-
moved as described.

45
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 21

Op. 82 100 53
Upper Link Removal
1. The boom must be properly supported at the
front and rear with the boom in the lowered posi-
tion or raise and support the boom above the
front upper link pivot. Remove all hydraulic oil
pressure from the boom and bucket hydraulic cir-
cuits.
NOTE: Supporting of the boom will keep the boom
positioned during removal of the upper links.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom. 46

2. Loosen the rear link retaining bolt, 1; do not re-


move. With a soft-faced sledge hammer, strike
the link at 2, to break the tapered pivot pin loose
in the main boom.
3. Loosen the front upper link pivot hardware, 1,
and with a soft-faced sledge hammer, strike the
link at 2, to loosen the tapered pin in the ROPS
post.
4. Remove the front and rear pivot pin retaining
bolts and tapered pins and lift the link from the
loader.

47
Op. 82 100 50
Main Boom Removal
1. Remove the plastic plugs, 1, from the cab inner
shell to access the boom lower link and cylinder
pivot hardware.
2. Remove the fenders to gain access to the boom
and bucket hydraulic tube and hose connections.

48
22 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

3. With the boom properly supported and all hy-


draulic oil pressure removed from the boom and
bucket circuits, disconnect the hydraulic lines at
1. Cap open ends of lines and hoses. Remove
the boom hose clamps, 2, retaining the hoses to
the lower boom links. Remove the hoses from the
lower hose retainer, 3.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom.
Do not disconnect any hydraulic lines until all hy-
draulic pressure is removed from the boom and
bucket hydraulic circuits.
49
4. Remove the hoses from the rear hose support, 1,
remove the tube clamps, 2, and disconnect the
tubes at the Z-bracket and quick couplers, 3.

50
5. Remove the right and left upper boom cylinder
pivot pin retaining hardware, 1, and pin, 2, from
cylinders and boom.
NOTE: If only the main boom is being removed the
cylinders can remain attached at the bottom pivot.
NOTE: Mark all boom and boom link tapered pins
with their proper location prior to removal. This will
ensure that all pins are installed in their correct posi-
tion during reassembly.

51
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 23

6. Loosen the right and left lower link, rear pivot pin
retaining hardware.
CAUTION
Do not remove the pin retaining hardware until the
tapered pivot pin is broken loose at the tapered end
of pin or the link and pin may fall.

7. With a soft-faced sledge hammer, strike the


lower link as shown to brake the tapered pivot pin
loose in the main boom link.

52
8. Remove the pin retaining hardware and pin from
the link and main boom. Lower the link and rest
it on the loader frame.

53
9. Loosen the right and left upper link rear retaining
bolts, 1; do not remove. With a soft-faced sledge
hammer, strike the link at 2, to break the tapered
pivot pin loose in the main boom.
10. Remove the hardware and pins from the ROPS
and link, resting the link on the lower link.
11. Lift the boom assembly from the loader.

54
24 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

Op. 82 100 70

FRONT BOOM MOUNTING PLATE PIVOT 4


HUB REPLACEMENT
1. Remove any attachment, bucket, etc., from the 2
boom mounting plate.
2. Pivot the mounting plate out flat and remove all
hydraulic pressure from the bucket circuit. 3
3 1
3. Remove the cylinder rod pivot pin retaining hard-
ware, 1, and remove the pins from the mounting
plate and cylinder.
4. Remove the mounting plate from the main boom. 19984476
– Remove the hub caps, 2, from the pivots. 55
– Loosen the mounting plate pivot hardware, 3.
DO NOT remove the hardware.
– With a sledge hammer (8 lbs.) or larger, strike
the mounting plate at 4, to loosen the tapered
pivot pin.
– Remove the retaining hardware, pins, and
mounting plate from the boom.
5. Raise the boom and support the boom 609.6 mm
(24I) off the ground on jack stands or suitable
blocking at 1.
6. Remove the negative (-) battery cable.

56
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 25

7. Using a cutting torch, cut the weld around the hub


to separate the hub from the main boom. DO
NOT cut any material from the main boom. Grind
to remove any remaining weld and hub from the
boom
8. Position the hubs on the boom straight, from side
to side, with center spacing, 2, as follows, and
tack weld the hubs to the boom.
Hub Center Spacing - 822 mm (32.36″)
9. Reinstall the mounting plate and tapered pivot
pins and hardware. Pivot the mounting plate up
and down to ensure there is no binding between
A5323-12
the mounting plate and pivot pins. Weld the hubs
to the boom. 57
10. Install the hub reinforcement gussets described
earlier in these instructions.
11. Lubricate the pivots and torque and hammer seat
the tapered pins and hardware. Refer to
“MOUNTING PLATE REPAIR,” in this section.
BOOM, UPPER AND LOWER LINK
REINSTALLATION
1. If the upper and lower boom links and boom cylin-
ders were removed, attach the upper and lower
links to the ROPS before installing the main
boom assembly.
2. Install the lower link pivot pins through the links
and insert the tapered end of the pin into the
ROPS frame. Install the pin retaining hardware
and tighten, making sure the tapered pin is in-
serted into the ROPS straight.

58
3. Install the upper link pivot pins through the links
and insert the tapered end of the pin into the
ROPS post. Install the pin retaining hardware
and tighten, making sure the tapered pin is in-
serted into the ROPS post straight.
4. Position the main boom assembly over the
loader positioning the boom against the front
boom stops (front of the final drive case).

59
26 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

5. Attach the rear of the upper link at 1, using the


tapered pivot pins and retaining hardware.
Tighten the hardware, making sure the pin is
straight in the main boom.

60
6. Attach the rear of the lower link at 1, using the
tapered pivot pins and retaining hardware.
Tighten the hardware, making sure the pin is
straight in the main boom.

61
7. With the main boom, upper and lower links at-
tached, the pivot pins and hardware must be
properly seated.
Torque the pin retaining hardware to the following
torques:
Lower link - 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
Upper link - 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
Cylinder pivot (lower) - 125 ft. lbs. (169 N·m)
Cylinder pivot (upper) - 28 ft. lbs. (38 N·m)
8. After the pivot pin retaining hardware is torqued
the pins must be properly seated. Using a
hammer, strike the head of the bolt and pin sev-
eral times to seat the tapered pin in the taper in 62
the ROPS. Retorque the hardware to specified
torque. Repeat this process until the torque is
maintained.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 27

9. Reinstall the cylinders at the boom upper pivot.


10. 1Reinstall the boom hydraulic tubes and hoses
if removed. Position tubes, 1, at the front of the
boom, to maintain clearance between boom and
tubes. The tubes must be properly positioned or
when the boom is raised and lowered the tubes
will contact the corner of the ROPS (cab).
11. Reattach the tubes to the Z-bracket, 2, and install
the quick couplers. Install the tube clamps, 3.

63
12. Route the tubes and hoses to the rear of the
boom through the rear hose supports, 1, and on
the top side of the lower link at 2.

64
13. Position the hoses with one on each side of the
lower link retaining clips, 1, and through the hose
retainer at 2. Do not tighten clamps at this time,
further adjustment will be required later.
14. Insert the hoses through the hose support on the
end of link at 3.
15. Reconnect the hoses to the tubes at 4, position-
ing the hoses and tubes for clearance to the
fender, when the boom is raised and lowered.

65
28 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

16. When all boom links and pivot pins are properly
seated and torqued and all hydraulic connec-
tions are tightened, operate the boom up and
down. Check the tube to ROPS (cab) at 1, for
clearance.

66
17. Check the hoses through the rear supports, 1.
When the boom is fully raised, position the hoses
in the support as shown, and remove any slack
from the hoses to the boom tubes.

67
18. Pull all slack from hoses and tighten the top
clamp, 1. Remove any slack between the clamps
and then tighten the second clamp, 2.

68
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 29

19. Install the fenders, 1, then raise and lower the


boom checking the hose/tube clearance behind
the fenders at 2, and readjust if required. Check
for any oil leaks and repair if required.
NOTE: The boom may require several cycles up and
down to remove the air from the boom hydraulic cir-
cuit.

69
20. Reinstall the boom mounting plate if removed.
Torque the pivot bolts, 1, to 80 ft. lbs. (108 N·m).
The tapered pivot pins and retaining hardware
must be hammer seated by striking the head of
the bolt and pin and retorquing the bolt. This step
must be repeated until the torque is maintained.
21. Reinstall any shields removed for the repair.

70
30 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

ATTACHMENT MOUNTING PLATE

Op. 82 100 70 4
REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach- 2
ment mounting plate.
2. Lower the boom to the fully lowered position.
3. Tilt the attachment mounting plate forward until 3 3
1
the face is level with the ground.
4. Remove the cylinder attachment mounting plate
pivot pins by removing the pin retaining bolts, 1,
and sliding the pins from the mounting plate and 19984476
cylinders. 71
CAUTION
Support the mounting plate during removal to pre-
vent dropping the plate when pins are removed.

5. Remove hub caps, 2, from the plate pivots.


6. Loosen the attachment mounting plate to boom
pivot pin hardware, 3. DO NOT remove the bolts
at this time.
7. With a soft-faced sledgehammer, strike the
mounting plate pivot area, 4. This will free the
tapered pivot pin in the boom link.
8. Remove the pivot pin retaining hardware and re-
move the tapered pins.
REPAIR/REBUILD MOUNTING PLATE

Op. 82 100 74
LATCH LEVER AND PIN REMOVAL/REPAIR
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach-
ment mounting plate.
2. Lower the boom to the lowered position.
3. Tilt the attachment mounting plate forward until 1
the face is level with the ground.
4. With an allen wrench, remove the setscrew, 1,
from the backside of the mounting plate for both
the left and right sides. 19984477
72
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 31

5. Move the latch handle, 1, to align the groove pin


in the setscrew hole, 2. Drive out the groove pin
with a hammer and punch. Repeat this pro-
cedure on other side.
6. Remove the latch pin from each side from the
bottom of the mounting plate.

1
2

19984478
73
7. Remove the cylinder attachment mounting plate
pivot pins to allow access to the latch handle
pivot pin snap ring clips.
CAUTION
Support the mounting plate during removal of the
mounting plate pivot pins to prevent dropping the
plate down when pins are removed.

1 1
8. Remove the pin retaining bolts, 1, and slide the
pins from the mounting plate and cylinders.

19984476
74
9. Enter the skid steer. Sitting in the operator’s seat
with the seat belt buckled, start the loader and re-
tract the attachment mounting plate actuating
cylinders, 1, fully to clear the attachment mount-
ing plate, 2. 1

19984479
75
32 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

10. Remove the retaining ring, 1, from the latch


handle pivot pin, 2, from the rear of the mounting
plate on the LEFT and RIGHT sides.
11. Using a punch and hammer drive the latch
handle retaining pin, 2, downward and out
through the front of the attachment mounting 2
plate on both sides. If there is insufficient ground
clearance to fully remove the latch handle pivot
pins, lift the attachment mounting plate up as
necessary to clear the pins. 1

19984480
76
12. Remove the handle/spring assembly, 1, from the
attachment mounting plate on the LEFT and
RIGHT sides of the attachment mounting plate.

1
19984481

77
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 33

PARTS INSPECTION
1 1
Mounting Plate Assembly 5
1. Inspect the plate, 1, for straightness. If the 4 3 4
mounting plate pods are not straight with each
other it may be difficult to hook up to attachments.
Refer to the “Checking Procedure for Buckets
6 6
and Attachments” in Section 88 - Optional Equip-
ment for further details. If the mounting plate is
not within specifications, replace the assembly. 7
2. Inspect the latch pin area for excessive wear,
which can result in loose attachments. If the pins, 2
2, do not slide freely, remove the pins, clean and 1998482
lubricate. 78
3. Inspect the mounting plate pivot pins, 3, and
bushings, 4, for wear, which can result in loose
attachment to the mounting plate boom cylin-
ders.
4. Inspect the cylinder pivot pins, 5, for wear. In-
spect the pivot pin holes for wear that could
cause a sloppy fit. Replace the bushings in the
mounting plate or pivot pins, if necessary.

Latch Handle/Spring Assemblies


1. Inspect the latch handle pivot holes, 6, for ex-
cessive wear and binding in the mounting plate.
2. Check that the spring, 7, is not bent, damaged,
or has broken coils. Replace if necessary.

Latch Pins
1. Examine the latch pins, 2, for excessive wear and
binding in the mounting plate.
2. Check the tapered area of the pins for wear or
chips. Replace if necessary.
34 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

Op. 82 100 57
Pivot Bushings Replacement
1. Use a suitable bushing driver and remove the old
bushings.
2. Clean the bushing area to remove any dirt, debris
and burrs.
3. Using a bushing driver, install the new pivot bush-
ings from each end of hole, 1. Drive bushings
flush with the outer edge of the hub.
NOTE: There will be a space in the center between
the two bushings.

79
Op. 82 100 74
2
Latch Lever and Spring Repair/Rebuild
1. Clamp the lower spring guide, 1, in a vise. Turn
the step bolt, 2, to remove the lower spring guide
from the step bolt and remove spring, 3.
1
CAUTION 3
When removing the step bolt, the spring will have
some compression pressure. Remove the bolt while
applying downward pressure on the bolt.

19984483
80
2. Remove the upper spring guide, 1, pivot block, 2,
and step bolt, 3, from handle, 4.

1 2 3

19984484
81
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 35

Reassembly
1. Insert the pivot block, 1, and step bolt, 4, into the
handle, 2. Install the upper spring guide, 3, onto
step bolt, 4.
2. Install spring, 5, over the upper spring guide, 3.
Install the lower spring guide, 6, onto step bolt, 4,
and tighten. 1 3 4 5
NOTE: Apply slight pressure to the lower spring 6
guide to compress the spring slightly and start
threading the lower guide onto the step bolt.

2
19984485
82
3. Slide the latch handle/spring assembly, 1, into
the mounting plate, pointing the spring down.

1
19984481
83
4. Install the handle pivot pin, 1, from the front of the
plate and install the snap ring retaining clip, 2.
The pivot pins will have a snap ring on both ends
of the pins.
NOTE: The handle pivot pin should have one snap
ring retaining clip already installed prior to reinstalla-
tion in the attachment plate. If the snap ring retaining
clip is not present, install the clip prior to pin installa- 1
tion.

19984486
84
36 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

5. Move the latch handle, 1, to align hole with the


groove and insert the latch pin with the tapered
side towards the loader boom, away from the at-
tachment.
6. With a hammer and punch, drive the grooved pin,
2, through the lower spring guide and latch pin.

1
2

19984478
85
7. Reinstall the setscrew, 1.

19984477
86
8. Reinstall the boom mounting plate, if removed,
by installing the plate pivot taper pins and retain-
ing hardware, 1.
9. Torque the pivot bolts, 1, to 108 N·m (80 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: The tapered pivot pins and retaining hard-
2
ware must be hammer seated by striking the head of
the bolt and pin, and then re-tightening. This step
must be repeated until the torque remains constant.
10. Reinstall hub caps, 2, into the plate pivots. 1 3 1
11. Extend the attachment mounting plate cylinders
until they align with their mounting holes on the
attachment mounting plate.
19984476
12. Install the cylinder attachment mounting plate
87
pins through the mounting plate and into the cyl-
inder rod ends. Install the pin retaining hardware,
3, and tighten.
13. Grease the two boom mounting plate pivot pins
and the two cylinder mounting plate pivot pins
prior to moving the attachment mounting plate to
prevent any damage to the pivot points.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 37

Attachment Plate Over-Center Latch Pins Wear/


Bend
The loader attachment may become loose at the
mounting plate. Inspection of the over-center latch
pins part #9822358, shows the pin ends worn and
bent, 1.
The over-center pins are NOT heat-treated. Thus, if
an attachment does not fit correctly and hammers
against the pins, the pins will wear and bend. New
pins and ones used with properly fitted attachments
should be straight, as shown at 2.
If worn pins are encountered, the pins must be re-
placed. Additionally, an inspection of all the cus-
tomer’s attachments must be made to determine the 88
improperly fitted attachment which is causing the pin
problem. Usually, an old attachment used on a previ-
ous loader can be worn and can be the problem.
38 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

CHECKING PROCEDURE FOR BUCKETS


AND ATTACHMENTS
The bucket/attachment does not fit or appears to
come loose on the boom faceplate.
The loader boom faceplate is worn or out of height di-
mensions and/or the bucket latch points are worn or 1
out of dimensions.

Inspection 2
The SL65B loader latching system requires that
the faceplate wedge into the attachment.
The faceplate must contact the attachment at 1, 2,
and 3, and must have clearance between the attach-
ment and faceplate at 4, when the attachment is
latched properly.
The latch pins should not extend below the lower
plate at 5.

4
3

89
The following are some quick visual checks of the
loader faceplate and attachment.
1. The attachment must have an 850 mm ± 0.8 mm
(33-15/32″ ± 1/32″) center to center latch point,
1, to be compatible with the latch system.
2. Check the latch pins and levers for proper oper-
ation and lubrication. If the latch pins do not move
freely, the system will not function properly.
– Control levers pivot over center into the low-
ered latched position.
– Latch pins fully extend from the faceplate.
– Control levers pivot over center into the
raised unlatched position and hold in this
90
position.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 39

Loader faceplate, 5, and attachment, 6, engage-


ment.
3. Check the saddle area of the attachment at 1, for
interference, weld, debris, etc. to prevent the at-
taching plate and attachment from seating
properly.
4. The loader latch pin should engage the lower
latch plates as shown at 2. 1
5. Check for clearance between the faceplate and
attachment at 3, minimum 0.8 mm (1/32″) and
maximum 9.5 mm (3/8″), with the latch pins fully
engaged.
– If there is no clearance at 3, the loader face-
plate is too short or the distance between the
top saddle area and lower latch plates is too
great, 2, Figure 92.
– If the clearance is too great or the latch pins
will not engage into the latch plates on the at-
tachment, the loader faceplate is too long or 6
the distance between the top saddle area 5
and lower latch plates is too short, 2, Fig-
ure 92 or the latch plates are located incor-
rectly, 1, Figure 92.
6. When the latch pins are fully engaged, original
buckets only, the end of the pin should not
extend beyond the lower plate at 4.
– If the latch handles do not fully engage, the
dimension from the back of the attachment to
the rear of the slot in the latch plates is too
short at 1, Figure 92.
– If the latch pins extend below the lower plate 3
2
at 4, the dimension from the back of the at-
tachment to the rear of the slot in the latch
plate is too long at 1, Figure 92.

4
91
40 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

CHECKING PROCEDURE
The following are the procedures used to measure
the skid steer faceplate and how to measure the at-
tachment.

Checking the Attachment


1. Check the placement of the lower latch plates at
1. Measure from the back surface of the attach- 4
ment to the rear of the latch plate slot at 1: 235.8
mm ± 0.8 mm (1-9/32″ ± 1/32″).
– If this dimension is too short, the slot can be
widened by grinding out the slot 1/16″ maxi- 3
mum or replace the latch plates.
If grinding is required, the rear of the slot
must be ground square with the top surface
of the plate to ensure proper pin engage-
ment, 2, Figure 91.
– If the dimension is too long, replace the latch
plates.
2. Check the height of the attachment at 2. Insert a 2
1/2″ x 2″ hex head cap screw with 1/2″ standard 15-7/8″
nut as shown at 3. Measure from the top of the
bolt, 4, to the rear of the latch plate slot at 5: 403.2
mm ± 0.8 mm (15-7/8″ ± 1/32″).
If this dimension is incorrect, the lower latch
plates will require replacement.
NOTE: If new latch plates are required, order four
plates #86506587 (102 mm, 4, slot) through Parts
and follow the latch plate installation procedure.

1
1-9/32″ 5

92
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 41

CHECKING THE LOADER FACEPLATE


1. Check the height, 3, of the loader faceplate from
the top of the plate at 1, to the bottom of the plate
at 2: 396.9 mm ± 0.8 mm (15-5/8″ ± 1/32″). To
check the faceplate, place a 24″ square over the 1
top of the plate as shown at 4, and a straightedge 4
at 5.
If the faceplate is not within specifications, the
plate will require replacement.

3
15-5/8″

93
2. Check the faceplate pods to ensure they are
straight with each other and not twisted. Place a
straightedge across both pods as shown at 1,
across the front flat surface and at 2, the top of
the pods.
If the pods are not straight, the faceplate will re-
quire straightening or replacement.

94
42 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1

3. Check the center dimension between the face-


plate pods and the overall outside dimension in-
cluding the removable plates in the extended
position for new buckets on the L865, Lx865,
Lx885, and Lx985 faceplates.
Inside Dimension, 1: 647.7 mm (25-1/2″)
Outside Dimension, 2: 1122.4 mm (44-3/16″)
Latch Pin Dimension, 3: 850.1 mm ± 0.8 mm
(33-15/32″ ± 1/32″) center
CAUTION
Do not cut or grind the loader faceplate to adapt any
buckets or other attachments.
Do not cut or grind the loader faceplate latch pins. 95

When attaching unapproved attachments, the


latch points on the attachment must meet the cor-
rect dimensions and be strong enough to main-
tain the correct dimensions during operation.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES

Chapter 1 – Dealer Installed Options

CONTENT

Section Description Page


88 100 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-2
Adapting Attachments Requiring 12V Electrical Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-2
Hydraulic System Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-5
90 000 Arm Pads For Cab Side Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-7
90 000 Armrests for Deluxe Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-7
90 000 Forearm Rests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-8
55 000 Back-up Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-9
10 300 Block Heater (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-10
55 000 Electric Power Supply (12 Volt, 15 Amp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-12
10 254 Exhaust (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-13
10 254 Aspirator Precleaner Muffler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-13
35 000 High Flow Hydraulics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-14
High Flow Hydraulics Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-16
High Flow Hydraulics Component Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-18
High Flow Hydraulics Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-21
55 000 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-25
90 000 Shoulder Belt (Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-26
88 000 Slow-moving Vehicle (SMV) Sign Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-27
44 511 Tyres/Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-27
Tyre and Track Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-28
Bucket and Tyre Combination Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-30
55 000 Warning Light (Rotary Beacon) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-31
55 000 Warning Lights (Four-way Flashers/Turn Signal/Horn) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88-33
2 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 88 100

GENERAL INFORMATION

ADAPTING ATTACHMENTS REQUIRING


12V ELECTRICAL POWER
There are important rules that must be followed when
adapting attachments that require 12 volt electrical
power. Proper wiring of electrical devices and power
and ground connections is very important to prevent
other electrical component damage. Attaching elec-
trical connections to locations other than recom-
mended may allow electric current to feed back
through the EIC board, creating false EIC board re-
adings and warnings, or causing EIC board damage
or failure.
1. ALWAYS FOLLOW the instructions for kit instal-
lation to ensure proper function and
operation.
2. NEVER CONNECT an electrical device to any
wires, fuses, switches or grounds inside the cab
area. This includes any terminals of the ignition
switch, fuse panel, or ground terminal.
3. NEVER INSTALL an electrical device, music
radio, two-way radio, or unapproved attachment
into the cab area.
4. ONLY USE the 12-volt accessory power outlet
for attachments requiring less than 10 amps. The
accessory outlet is connected to the engine fuse/
relay panel and protected with a 15 amp fuse.

1
5. ALWAYS CONNECT new electrical attachments
to the engine fuse/relay panel, 1, and connect the
grounds to the engine bell housing. USE ONLY
vacant connections and fuses not in use for
specified attachments.
6. PLEASE REFER to Service Bulletin 11/95-I4 for
more detailed information about higher amper-
age requirements and making electrical connec-
tions.

2
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 3

Wire connections available if electrical attachments


were not previously installed.
Engine Fuse Panel
Ref. Color Destination Fuse Battery Voltage Status
1 R/B To turn signal relay 10-amp All times Available
2 R/GY To accessory relay 25-amp All times Available
3 R/LTGN To EIC board pin #14 P2 connector 5-amp All times Occupied
4 LTGN/R To seat switch(es) 5-amp All times Occupied
5 R/W To key switch (battery terminal) 15-amp All times Occupied
6 R From preheat circuit breaker 20-amp All times Occupied
7 R From start relay All times Occupied
8 R/O To heater power relay 20-amp All times Available
9 R/T Spare 7.5-amp All times Available
10 DKGN/R To high flow, horn, power outlet 15-amp Key “ON” position Available
11 O/LTGN From accessory relay Key “ON” position Occupied
12 O/W To Back-up alarm switch 5-amp Key “ON” position Available
13 O/LTGN From road/work light fuse (cab panel) Key “ON” position Occupied

3
Engine Fuse Panle
A. Standard fuse block
B. Optional fuse block
4 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

A completely new auxiliary wiring circuit can be in-


stalled as shown in Figures 5 and 6, depending on
electrical requirements. Mounting holes for the
added circuit breakers must be drilled in the panel.
Disconnect the battery before drilling and installing
new wiring. Protect the panel’s electrical compo-
nents from drilling shavings that could cause electri-
cal shorting of components. Figure 4 shows circuits
for intermittent high current loads up to 15 amps.

4
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 15 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL (preheat load side)
3. R (feed dise)
4. Preheat relay
5. Main ground to bell housing
6. Live to attachment
7. Ground from attachment
8. Attachment power cable
9. Start relay
10. Alternator excite resistor
11. Start interlock relay
12. Drill second hole (protect component whilst drilling)
13. Accessory relay
14. Customer supplied 15 amp circuit breaker
15. Existing hole
16. Customer supplied jumper wire
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 5

Figure 6 shows the circuit for intermittent high current


loads up to 30 amps.
Sealed circuit breakers that can be pur-
chased from parts.
Part Number Capacity
9827329 15 amp
9828493 20 amp
9840279 25 amp
9840280 30 amp

NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place


the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
IMPORTANT: Additional electrical attachments must
have circuits properly connected to prevent damage
to the Advanced Warning System (EIC board) and
other electrical components.
CAUTION
Always disconnect the battery before installing any
electrical attachment to prevent accidental shorting
of system.

5
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 30 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL
3. R
4. Preheat relay
5. Customer supplied sealed circuit breaker
6. Customer supplied jumper wire
7. Main ground to bell housing
8. Ground wire from attachment
9. Live wire to attachment
10. Attachment power cable
11. Start relay
12. Alternator excite resistor
13. Start interlock relay
14. Accessory relay
15. Heater power relay
16. Turn signal relay
6 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

HYDRAULIC SYSTEM COMPATIBILITY


There are important questions that must be ans-
wered before adapting attachments that require hy-
draulic oil power.
1. What is the hydraulic pressure requirement,
minimum and maximum? Are they higher than
the maximum pressure of the model?
Model Maximum Pressure
SL65B 2500 to 2600 PSI
(170-176 bar)

2. What is the hydraulic oil flow requirement? Is it 6


more than the highest total flow rate of the skid-
steer loader model?

Model Standard Hydraulics High Flow Hydraulics

SL65B 18.5 US. GPM (70.0 l/min.) @2350 RPM 32.0 US. GPM (22 l/min.) @2250 RPM
@1000 PSI (68 bar) @1000 PSI (68 bar)

NOTE: When using the High-Flow system, 3/4, quick 5. Will the attachment accept hydraulic system
couplers must be used or high system backpressure backpressure?
may result. If “YES”, nothing is required.
3. Will the attachment accept oil flow in both direc- If “NO”, the attachment will not function properly
tions? on a skid-steer loader. Normal backpressure
If “YES”, nothing is required. for skid-steer loaders
If “NO”, install a check valve or cross into the at- is between 13.8 to 17.3 bar (200 to 250 PSI).
tachment return line to prevent reverse oil flow to Examples: Post drivers, some breakers, and
the attachment. some hand held hydraulic tools do not accept
Examples: Backhoes and trees spades with a system backpressure.
separate control valve do not accept oil flow in If all the skid-steer loader oil flow is not required
both directions. to operate an attachment (e.g., shaver post
4. Must the attachment “Free Wheel” to a STOP? driver), a flow divider can be installed into the hy-
draulic oil circuit on the attachment. The flow di-
If “YES”, a crossover relief connection must be
vider sends the required oil flow to the attach-
installed on the attachment side to allow the at-
ment and the remainder back to the normal
tachment to free wheel to a stop after the skid-
skid-steer loader hydraulic circuits.
steer loader hydraulics is turned off.
If “NO”, nothing is required.
Example: Snow blowers must free wheel to a
stop.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 7

6. Does the attachment have a separate case drain NOTE: Skid-steer loaders equipped with High Flow
oil line? Hydraulics have a separate case drain coupler and
If “NO”, nothing is required. return line attached to the right boom arm.
If “YES”, install a separate case drain line to re- 7. Does the attachment require a circuit relief in the
turn the attachment case drain oil directly to the bucket circuit?
hydraulic oil reservoir. If “NO”, nothing is required.
Example: Cold planners have a separate case If “YES”, install a bucket circuit relief valve on
drain oil line. front of the control valve in the bucket circuit.
NOTE: Most attachment case drains will not accept Example: Some mini-backhoes attach like a
backpressure and must drain directly into the reser- bucket, and require a bucket circuit relief.
voir.
8 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 90 000

ARM PADS FOR CAB SIDE PANELS


The cab arm pads provide additional operator com-
fort and may be used separately or in combination
with the seat armrest.
The arm pads, 1, require gluing in place to the cab
side panels with Loctite 454 gel adhesive.
The area where the arm pads are to be located must
be cleaned thoroughly to ensure a secure bond to the
cab side panel. If the area is not cleaned, the adhesive
will not adhere to the metal side panels. Clean with
methyl ethyl ketone, isopropyl alcohol, or equivalent
cleaning solvent that will not leave a residue. 7
NOTE: Position arm pads quickly because the ad-
hesive begins to bond in a few seconds.
CAUTION
Read the adhesive label warnings. loctite 454 gel is
a superglue-type material and can bond skin, eyes,
etc. Use with adequate ventilation.

Op. 90 000

ARMRESTS FOR DELUXE SEAT


Right and left side armrests, 1, can be installed to the
back of the deluxe seat only, at 2, for operator com-
fort.
NOTE: The standard seat mounting holes are not
provided to attach the armrests.
There are two styles of armrest:
– Bolts attach armrests to the back of the steel
back seat support.
– Bolts attach armrests to the sides of the plastic
back seat supports. 8
Armrest Adjustment
The armrest can be adjusted up or down for operator
comfort by turning adjusting screws, 1.

9
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 9

Op. 90 000
2
FOREARM RESTS 1
The forearm rests are attached to the side of the op-
erator’s cab (one each side) to be used to support the
operator’s arms while operating the skid steer. The
armrest may be pivoted up when not being used or
for ooerator entry and exit of the operator’s area. The
armrest may be used in any combination of controls,
boom/bucket hand controls or boom/bucket foot con- 3
trols. Using the armrest in combination with the boom
and bucket hand controls provides the operator with
arm support during boom and bucket operations.
NOTE: The cab armrest pad kit cannot be installed 10
in combination with the forearm rest kit. The armrest
pads are glued to the same area of the operator’s cab
that the forearm rests are attached.
The SL65B armrests mount with the bracket, 1,
over the cab side panel, 2.
Pivot the armrest up and down, and adjust the two
clamp bolts, 3, if binding occurs, or to retain the
armrest in the raised position.
10 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 000

BACK-UP ALARM
The back-up alarm sound device should be located
to the inside and in the upper right rear corner of the
engine rear door at 1.
The back-up alarm serves as an audible warning de-
vice to alert bystanders and other machine operators
of machine movements. The alarm will only sound
when both hydrostatic control levers are stroked into
reverse. Refer to local codes for requirements.
IMPORTANT: Before servicing any switches or
alarm, disconnect the negative (-) battery ground
cable to avoid accidental shorts in the wiring system 11
when removing or installing components.
Adjustment
With the battery connected, and both hydrostatic
control levers in the neutral position, loosen and slide
both strikers, 1, rearward until the alarm sounds.
Move the strikers forward until the alarm stops (ap-
proximately 1.5 mm [1/16″]) and tighten the hard-
ware.
NOTE: There are two different switch designs. Later
model units will have round collars secured with set
screws. The adjustment procedure is the same.

12
IMPORTANT: Make sure the striker clamp, 2, is posi-
tioned around rod, 3, properly so the clamp will retain
the striker.
NOTE: Both switches must be activated simulta-
neously for the alarm to sound.

13
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 11

Back-up Alarm Wiring


The alarm is a negative (-) ground system.

14
Back up Alarm Wiring
1. Backup alarm
2. Fuse block
3. LH backup switch
4. RH backup switch
5. Accessory relay
6. Start relay
Op. 10 300

BLOCK HEATER (ENGINE)


The engine block heater, 1, may be required in colder
climate areas to assist in starting of the diesel engine.
The block heater is a 115-volt, 400-watt immersion
type.
WARNING
The block heater must be installed and operated per
the instructions provided with the kit or damage to the
engine, heater element, and/or personal injury could
occur.
15
12 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Position the heater into the engine block so the cord


set receptacle is at the 3 o’clock position ±10° as
shown for proper heater operation. Install a wire tie,
1, to hold cord in place.
WARNING
Before connecting the heater to the power source, be
sure that the element is immersed in coolant. Never
energize the heater in air. If so energized, the el-
ement sheath could burst and cause personal injury.
INSTALL WITH CORD
SET RECEPTACLE AT
Do not operate the heater until the engine cooling 3 O’CLOCK POSITION
system is filled with a 50/50 mixture of a permanent- +10° AS SHOWN
type antifreeze and water.
Operate the engine and check for any coolant leaks 16
and purge the air from the cooling system; repair ac-
cordingly.
IMPORTANT: Failure to fill the cooling system and
purging the air will cause premature failure of the
block heater.
CAUTION
This is a 115-volt heater. Use caution when installing
and using the heater. Properly grounded electrical
outlets and properly sized extension cords are es-
sential for the use of the heater.
To insure continued protection against shock hazard,
connect to properly grounded electrical outlets only.

First connect a grounded extension cord of the


proper rating for the length used to the heater plug.
Then connect the extension cord to the grounded
electrical outlet.
CAUTION
Disconnect the extension cord from the grounded
electrical outlet first and then from the heater before
starting the loader. Inspect the heater wires period-
ically for broken or frayed wires and/or wire cover-
ings. If wires and/or coverings are broken or frayed,
do not use the heater.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 13

Op. 55 000

ELECTRIC POWER SUPPLY


(12 VOLT, 15 AMP)
The electric power outlet can be installed on the
loader to provide an auxiliary 12-volt power outlet
rated at 15 amp. The power outlet is located to the left
front of the operator’s cab area.
If the horn kit is installed, the power kit wire harness
is incorporated in the horn wire harness.
If the horn kit is not installed, the power kit receives
its power from the 15-amp attachment/horn fuse in
the engine fuse panel.
17
Electric Power Wiring

18
Electric Power Wiring
1. Start relay
2. Engine compartment fuse block
3. Cab ground
4. Attachment power socket
14 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 10 254

EXHAUST (ENGINE)
CATALYTIC MUFFLER
The catalytic muffler kit is a combination catalytic and
aspirated precleaner muffler and can be installed on
diesel engines being operated in applications where
cleaner exhaust emissions are required. The catalyt-
ic muffler, 1, is a direct replacement for the standard
muffler.
When operating a skid-steer loader equipped with
the catalytic muffler, the unit must be operated at full
engine speed. 19
The engine exhaust system must be operated at op-
erating temperature for the catalytic purifier muffler to
function properly. If the temperature is not high
enough, the catalytic purifier muffler will not function
properly and not reduce the carbon monoxide level.
The operating life of the purifier muffler will also be re-
duced.

Op. 10 254

ASPIRATOR PRECLEANER MUFFLER


The precleaner aspirator muffler kit can be installed
on diesel engines being operated in dusty applica-
tions to prolong air cleaner element life.

The aspirator muffler, 1, is a direct replacement for


the standard muffler and standard air cleaner.

20
The aspirator muffler hose connects to the air cleaner
at 1.
NOTE: When the aspirator muffler is installed, the
engine must be operated at or near full engine speed
to reduce the recirculating of exhaust gases through
the air cleaner. If an air cleaner element is sooted
with diesel smoke, the engine is being operated at re-
duced speeds.

21
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 15

Op. 35 000

HIGH-FLOW HYDRAULICS
When the high-flow hydraulics circuit is used, it will
allow the operator to utilize more available engine
horsepower through the auxiliary hydraulic circuit.
The high-flow increases the hydraulic flow:
SL65B
From 18.5 US. GPM (70 LPM) at 1000 PSI (68 bar)
at 2225 RPM to 32.3 US. GPM (122 LPM) at 1000
PSI (68 bar), (at 2500 PSI [170 bar] = 47.1 hydraulic
horsepower).

22

During warm climate operation, be conscious of the


EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) temperature
monitoring system. Adjust the attachment load (rate 1
of feed) and length of continuous operation (duty
cycle times) accordingly.
This high-flow is not intended to replace a fully dedi-
cated, specialized machine.
When the attachment is not in use, be sure the high-
low switch, 1, is in the “OFF” position to prevent over-
heating of the hydraulic oil.

19987112
23
When the high-flow is being used, 3/4″ quick
couplers, 1, must be used on the loader and attach-
ment or overheating of the hydraulic oil may occur.
The 1/2″ quick couplers, 2, can be used for other at-
tachments that do not require the added oil flow.

24
16 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Attachment Case Drain


When the high-flow kit is installed, there is a separate
case drain return line, 1, for the attachment case
(housing) to drain oil.

25
The case drain line drains into the hydraulic reser-
voir, 1. Most auxiliary hydraulic drive attachments
equipped with a separate case drain line require no
system back pressure for the drain line.

26
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 17

HIGH-FLOW HYDRAULICS TROUBLESHOOTING


PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION
No switch operation No battery voltage to switch Check power supply at 15-amp
fuse (attachment) engine fuse
panel

Check DKGN/R (Dark Green/Red)


wire from fuse to switch

Inoperative switch Replace switch

No selector valve operation No battery voltage to selector valve Check switch for proper operation

Check W/T (White/Tan) wire from


switch to selector valve

No circuit ground Check B (Black) ground wire for


proper grounding

No selector valve spool movement Check valve spool for binding and
sticking

Hydraulic oil overheats Using 1/2″ quick couplers Must use 3/4″ quick couplers

Control valve and boom steel lines Change lines and hoses to 3/4″
and hoses were not changed from
5/8″ to 3/4″

Operating high-flow when not Turn high-flow switch to the “OFF”


required position

Operating high-flow at relief Operate attachment at lesser load


pressure continuously

Operating attachment when not Stop attachment when not loaded


applying a load to the attachment (moving from one work area to
another)

Operating attachment when high oil Turn high-flow switch to the “OFF”
flows are not required position

Restriction in pressure or return Check and repair


lines

All lift check parts not removed Remove all lift check parts (spring,
during assembly. poppet, and cap)

Oil cooler restricted not allowing Clean oil cooler and radiator
cooling air to flow properly
18 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION


No increase in hydraulic oil flow No switch operation Check power supply circuit
when switch is in the “ON”
position No selector valve operation Check power supply from switch
Selector valve spool binding Check for spool binding and repair

Low hydraulic power Low main system relief valve setting Check and replace relief valve
Leaking control valve plugs, leaking Check O ring and backup washer
oil to return on plugs
Inefficient gear pump (main) Check pump efficiency, repair or
replace
Inefficient gear pump (high-flow) Check pump efficiency, repair or
replace
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 19

HIGH-FLOW HYDRAULICS
COMPONENT REPLACEMENT

Op. 35 724
High-Flow Selector Valve Replacement
To access the selector valve:
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear engine access door and remove
the right engine side shield.
3. The engine belly pan can also be removed for
more access as shown.
4. Mark and remove the lines from the selector
valve, 1. 27
5. Remove selector valve mounting hardware.
Rebuild the selector valve with new O rings on the
spool and fittings at 1, and on both ends of the coil at
2.
To check the coil, use an ohmmeter and put one lead
on one wire and the other on the other wire; the ohms
reading should be between 7.5 and 11.5. If the coil is
not within specification, replace it.
NOTE: The SL65B selector valve is located to the
rear of the battery box (radiator end).

28
Op. 35 710
High-Flow Gear Pump Removal
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom lock pins.
2. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
latched position.
3. Remove suction line, 1, from the pump and cap
the line. If the lines are not capped, the hydraulic
oil reservoir must be drained to prevent loss of oil.
4. Remove the pressure line, 2, from the pump.
5. Loosen the gear pump mounting bolts, 3, and re-
move.
6. Remove the pump from gearbox. The charge
line, 4, may need to be removed to remove pump. 29
NOTE: The gearbox oil level is below the pump drive
level, the gearbox does not require draining.
20 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

7. Remove the drive gear, 1, from the pump shaft by


removing the retaining ring, 2.
8. Remove the inside retaining ring, 3, from the
shaft.

30
Op. 35 710 20
Gear Pump Repair
1. Remove the pump hardware, 1.
2. Using a soft hammer, tap the gear pump section
to separate the pump sections.
3. Inspect the pump bearings, 2, for damage and
wear.
4. Inspect the pump center section, 3, for scoring
damage.
5. Inspect the pump end caps and bearing plate at
6
4 for scoring damage.
6. Inspect the drive shaft, 5, and gears, 6, for wear
and scoring. Inspect the shaft in seal and bearing 31
areas for scoring.
Gear Pump Reinstallation
1. Reinstall the inside retaining ring, 1, gear, 2, and
outside retaining ring, 3, on pump shaft.
2. Apply a 1/4″ bead of silicone sealant around the
pump flange at 4, and around the retaining hard-
ware to seal pump top gearbox.

32
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 21

3. Insert the pump and drive gear assembly into the


gearbox as shown at 1, with the 5/8″ straight flare
fitting to the left of the loader as shown at 2.
Attach the pump to the gearbox with two 1/2″ x
1-1/2″ G5 cap screws, 3, and two 1/2″ flat
washers previously removed. Reconnect the hy-
drostatic charge line, 4, if previously removed.

33
4. Reattach the 1/2″ hose to the pump fitting, 1.
5. Reattach the 3/4″ hose to the pump fitting, 2.

34
Start-Up After Repair
1. Engage the parking brake. Check that the high
flow control switch, 1, is in the “OFF” position. 1
(The switch is located to the left of the operator’s
seat.)
2. Start the loader with the high-flow control switch
in the “OFF” position and operate at idle, no more
than 1500 RPM for about 10 minutes to allow air
to be removed from the hydraulic system. Check
for oil leaks and repair if required.
3. After operating the unit for a few minutes and with
the control valve spool in the neutral position,
turn the high-flow control switch to “ON” position 19987112
and operate for a few minutes. Turn the switch to 35
the “OFF” position. Check for oil leaks and repair
if required.
22 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

4. Connect a flow meter into the 3/4″ quick


couplers, noting the flow of oil through the meter.
5. With the flow meter attached, start the loader and
operate the auxiliary hydraulics with the high-
flow control switch in the “OFF” position, and note
the oil flow. Turn the high-flow control switch to
the “ON” position and note the oil flow - the flow
should increase. If the flow does not increase,
check the operation of the electrical system and/
or the operation of the control valve spool.
6. After operating the high-flow system, recheck the
hydraulic reservoir oil level and add SAE 10W/30
APE Service SG-CF oil as required.
7. Reinstall all shields removed for kit installation.
HIGH-FLOW HYDRAULICS OPERATION
To operate the high-flow hydraulics, first have the at-
tachment to be operated attached to the loader boom
face plate and properly latched.
Connect the hydraulic hoses from the attachment to
the boom quick couplers. If the manifold blocks were
installed, the 1/2″ couplers, 2, or the 3/4″ couplers, 1,
can be used, but not both at the same time. When op-
erating the high-flow system, the 3/4″ couplers must
be used to prevent high system backpressure, and to
ensure proper operation of the attachments.

36
NOTE: When the high-flow hydraulics are in oper-
ation, the 3/4, couplers must be used.
NOTE: Flat-faced quide couplers have become stan-
dard equipment for Boom Hydraulic kits, High-Flow
Hydraulic kits, and production models equipped with
these options.

1
2

37
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 23

Start the Loader Engine


NOTE: Before starting the skid-steer loader engine, 1
make sure the high-flow control switch is in the “OFF” 2
position and the auxiliary controls are in the neutral
position. If this procedure is not followed, difficult
starting may occur.
The high-flow electronic selector valve switch is lo-
cated to the left of the operator at 1. When the switch
is in the “OFF” position, the skid-steer loader stan-
dard oil flow will be provided at the boom quick
couplers and either the 1/2″ or 3/4″ quick couplers
may be used.
To start the added oil flow, raise the switch cover, 2, 19987112
and turn the switch to the “ON” position. The stan- 38
dard oil flow and the added high flow will be combined
at the main control valve in the auxiliary spool circuit.
The 3/4″ quick couplers must be used.
Operate the right-hand control lever, 1, with boom
and bucket foot controls or the left foot pedal, 2, with
boom and bucket hand controls to supply the oil flow
to the boom quick couplers.
Pivoting the handle down supplies pressure oil to the
male quick coupler.
Pivoting the handle up supplies pressure oil to the fe-
male quick coupler.
When the handle is released, it will return the control
valve spool to the center (neutral) position.
Moving the handle down all the way will put the con-
trol valve spool in the detent position, supplying con-
tinuous oil flow to an attachment. The handle will stay
in this position until the operator moves the handle. 39
NOTE: If the operator will be using the auxiliary spool
detent position, the loader quick couplers and attach-
ment must match properly to ensure proper oil flow
and attachment operation.
24 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Some attachments may require oil flow in one direc- IMPORTANT: When operating the high-flow for ex-
tion ONLY and must be assembled accordingly. If the tended periods of time, monitor the system tempera-
attachment will not accept oil flow in both directions, tures. If temperatures reach 2105F (995C), for engine
a check valve must be installed in the return line from coolant, or 2005F (935C), for hydraulic oil, back off
the attachment to prevent damage to the attachment. operation to allow the systems to cool down.
To stop the attachment operation, return the control IMPORTANT: Operating hydraulic attachments at
to the neutral position. When the additional hydraulic maximum HP relief valve pressure will cause ex-
oil flow is not required, turn the electronic control cessive heat. Relief valves operated at relief pressur-
switch to the “OFF” position. es will cause hydraulic oil to overheat quickly.
During operation of the hydraulic high flow, use the The high-flow switch MUST BE IN THE “OFF” posi-
skid-steer loader Advanced Warning System to tion when the added oil flow is not required or the at-
monitor the engine coolant or hydraulic oil tempera- tachment is not in use to prevent unnecessary hy-
ture. draulic oil heating and engine loads.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 25

High Flow Electrical Wiring Diagram


1. Engine fise block
2. Two speed wire harness (if fitted)
3. High flow solenoid valve
4. High flow hydraulics switch

40

41
High Flow Hydraulic Oil Flow Diagram
1. 10 micron filter 10. Male auxiliary quick coupler
2. Oil cooler 11. Auxiliary Sppol
3. Engine 12. Boom spool
4. Engine gearbox 13. Bucket spool
5. High flow auxiliary pump 14. Three spool control valve
6. LH hydrostatic pump 15. Right boom case drain quick coupler
7. RH hydrostatic pump 16. reservoir
8. Main system hydraulic pump 17. High flow relief valve
9. Female auxiliary quick coupler 18. Selector valve
26 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 000

HORN 1
The horn kit provides an operator-controlled device
to alert bystanders and other machine operators.
The horn button is located in the top of the left hydro-
static control lever as shown at 1.

19984626
42
Horn Wiring Diagram

43
Horn Wiring Diagram
1. Accessory relay 5. Attachment power outlet
2. Start relay 6. Horn switch
3. Engine compartment fuse block 7. Horn
4. LH cab ground
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 27

Op. 90 000

SHOULDER BELT (SEAT)


The shoulder belt can be installed with the lap seat
belt.
The shoulder belt is recommended anytime a front
cab door is installed.

44
If the shoulder belt becomes completely retracted or
the belt becomes locked, the web must move back
into the retractor approximately 1/2″ with the retrac-
tor in 90/90 degree or proper mounting position.
When the belt is retracted 1/2″, hold the belt straight
up and pull the belt up slowly, 1. The belt will not un-
lock and pull out in any other position.

45
The shoulder belt support pivot bolt, 1, must be loose
enough to allow the belt to pivot. If the belt will not
pivot properly, it will not adjust to fit the operator.

46
28 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 88 000

SLOW-MOVING VEHICLE (SMV) SIGN KIT


The Slow-Moving Vehicle (SMV) kit mounts to the
rear door of the skid-steer loader to alert other ve-
hicles when the loader is operated on roadways.
The bracket, 1, must be installed correctly to hold the
SMV sign in place on top of the door.

47
1. Attach the angle, 1, with one 5/16″ x 1-1/4″ car-
riage bolt from the kit and nut and M8 lock washer
previously removed at 2.
2. Attach the spade socket to the angle at 3 using
two 5/16″ x 1″ carriage bolts, M8 lock washers,
and nuts.
3. Assemble the SMV sign, 4, to the support, 5,
using two #10 x 1/2″ machine screws and flange
nuts at 6.
4. Mount the SMV sign assembly in the spade
socket as shown at 7.

48
Op. 44 511

TYRES/WHEELS

TYRE OPTIONS
1. 8.25 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented
2. 12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented
3. 8.25 x 15 Chevron tread
4. 12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread
5. 12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty
6. 14.00 x 17.5 cleat tread (not shown)
7. Solid Tyres (not shown) 49
NOTE: Solid Tyres are available and can be obtained
from your New Holland dealer.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 29

Tyre Pressures

Tyre Pressure
8.25 x 15 Chevron tread 50 PSI (414 kPa)
7.50 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
14.00 x 17.5 - cleat tread 60 PSI (410 kPa)

MAINTAIN PROPER Tyre INFLATION!


NOTE: Iatco “Air Boss” segmented Tyres are ap-
proved for all new generation loader models.
These Tyres must be mounted with the wheel
dish “in” to the frame (narrowest wheel tread posi-
tion). Reversing the wheels with the dish “out” is
not recommended, as increased axle and frame
loading occurs, which may lead to eventual axle
bearing and/or main frame failure.
TYRE AND TRACK INSTALLATION

Tyre Installation on Loader


The 8.25 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented and the 12.00
x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented Tyres must be
mounted with the wheel dish “IN” to the frame (nar-
rowest wheel tread position). Reversing the wheels
with the dish “OUT” is not recommended, as in-
creased axle and frame loading occurs. This may
lead to eventual axle bearing and/or main frame fail-
ures.

50
Op. 44 511 28
When replacing the sections of the hollow seg-
mented Tyres, torque the section hardware to 10 ft.
lbs. (13.6 N·m).

51
30 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Track Installation on Loader


Correct Tyre/track combinations are important to
prevent damage to the tracks, Tyres/wheels, and
loader main frame.
Installing tracks on skid-steer loaders equipped with
segmented Tyres, solid Tyres, foam-filled Tyres, or
any hard-type non-pneumatic Tyres is not recom-
mended. If these Tyre combinations are used with
steel tracks, track or loader main frame damage may
occur.
These Tyres do not provide a cushion when debris
comes between the track and Tyre. A pneumatic Tyre
will absorb this type of stress and, in severe cases,
may deflate before damage to the loader or track oc- 52
curs.
FIAT-HITACHI only recommends pneumatic Tyres be
installed with tracks.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 31

BUCKET AND Tyre COMBINATION CHART


Machine Width
Tyre Size Description
Including Tyres Recommended Bucket
66 - 72-LP-D&F
72-M&F-LM
8.25 x 15 Chevron Tread 66″ (1676 mm) 78-LP
84-M&F-LM
84-LP
66 - 72-LP-D&F
72-M&F-LM
8.25 x 15 HST Hollow Segmented Tyres 65″ (1651 mm) 78-LP
84-M&F-LM
84-LP
72-LP-D&F
72-M&F-LM
12 x 16.5 Cleat Tread 72″ (1829 mm) 78-LP
84-M&F-LM
84-LP
72-LP-D&F
72-M&F-LM
12 x 16.5 HD 2000 72″ (1829 mm) 78-LP
84-M&F-LM
84-LP
72-LP-D&F
72-M&F-LM
12 x 16.5 HST Hollow Segmented Tyres 70″ (1778 mm) 78-LP
84-M&F-LM
84-LP
32 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Op. 55 000

WARNING LIGHT (ROTARY BEACON)


The beacon light is a visual alerting device for by-
standers and other machine operators. The beacon
light’s magnetic base mounts the light securely to any
part of the roof or frame.

53
The beacon light switch, 1, is located in the ignition
key switch panel in the upper right corner of the over-
head dash.
To remove the switch, disconnect the negative (-)
ground battery cable, remove the key switch panel
hardware, 2, and tilt the panel down.

54
Disconnect wires from the switch, squeeze the
switch retaining tabs in, and remove the switch from
the panel.

55
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 33

Beacon Switch Wiring

56
Beacon Wiring Diagram
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
Y O/Y
B
Y B 3
2

Y O/Y
1

O/LTBL
O/DKBR
10A
O/Y O/Y
ACC 7.5A
ST
5 4
BAT IGN

BSC0962A

57
1. Beacon switch 4. Beacon light
2. Cab inner fuse block 5. Cab ground
3. Key switch
34 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

Beacon Bulb Replacement


Bulb only (H1 12V 55W)
To replace the bulb, remove the three screws attach-
ing the lens to the base and lift the lens from the base.

58
Squeeze the bulb retaining tabs to separate the bulb
from the holder.
Remove the bulb assembly from the wire connector.

59
Op. 55 000

WARNING LIGHTS (FOUR-WAY


FLASHERS/TURN SIGNAL/HORN)
The four-way flashing lights on the front and rear of
the loader provide a visual alerting device to by-
standers and other machine operators.

60
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 35

The warning light switch, 1, is located in the ignition


key switch panel in the upper right corner of the over-
head dash.
To remove the switch, disconnect the negative (-)
ground battery cable, remove the key switch panel
hardware, 2, and tilt the panel down.

61
Disconnect the wires from the switch. Squeeze the
switch retaining tabs in and remove the switch from
the panel.

62
Warning Light Switch Wiring

63
36 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1

1 5
DKBR/LTGN
DKBR/LTGN

B–2
B–7
B
B O/DKBR

O/DKBR 4
O/DKBR B B–7 6
5
Y/R
2

3 4 B–2
7
6 B
2 3
R/B R/B
10A

Y Y/R
B–10 Y/R
DKGN
Y
DKBR/Y
O/Y 9
5
DKBR/Y 8
LTGN/W
Y/W 1 Y/W
3 O/DKBR
LTGN/W
DKBR/LTGN 14 6
DKBR/LTGN
10
18 DKBR/LTGN 4 7 DKBR/LTGN

R/ N GK D
B

R/ N GK D
B–1 B
DKGN/Y
DKBR/Y 15A
DKBR/Y 9
B/ L BK D

15

R/ N GK D
B

11 10
B

16
DKGN/R
W
Y/ N GK D
N GK D

DKGN/R
B
R/ Y

DKBL/B 13

Y/R

DKBR/Y DKBR/Y DKBR/Y


B DKBR/LTGN B

17 12
BSC0961A

64
Warning Light (Four-way) Wiring Diagram
1. Right front flashing light 10. Fuse block D
2. Hazard switch/beacon/off/4 way/flash 11. LH cab ground
3. Flasher module 12. Left rear flashing light
4. Turn signal relay 13. Turn signal switch
5. Right rear flashing light 14. Turn signal converter module
6. To ground 15. Turn signal indicator lights
7. Fuse block B 16. Horn switch
8. from preheat circuit breaker 17. Left front flashing light
9. from accessory relay 18. Horn

NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface and
then stack the remaining ground wires according to size on top of the heaviest wire.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 37

Warning Light Bulb Replacement


Amber lens with bulb #9841566
Bulb only #529068 1

Op. 55 404 10
Front Light
1. Remove the bezel, 1, retaining screws and re-
move lens from support.
2. Disconnect the wire harness from the bulb
holder.
3. Rotate the light bulb holder and element assem-
bly from the lens and remove from the lens.
4. Insert the new bulb into the lens and rotate to lock 65
into position, using caution not to touch the bulb
element.
IMPORTANT: Touching the light bulb element may
damage the element and cause a premature failure.
Op. 55 404 10
Rear Light
1. Remove the bezel, 1, retaining hardware and re-
move the lens from the light bar.
NOTE: The remaining light lens will be loose in the
light bar.
2. Disconnect the wire harness from the bulb
holder.
3. Rotate the light bulb holder and element assem-
bly from the lens and remove from the lens.
4. Insert the new bulb into the lens and rotate it to
lock into position, using caution not to touch the
bulb element. 66
IMPORTANT: Touching the light bulb element may
damage the element and cause a premature failure.
38 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 90 – PLATFORM, CAB, BODYWORK, AND DECALS

Chapter 1 – Cab and Seat

CONTENT

Section Description Page


General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-2
Seat and Seat Pan Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-2
90 152 Cab Inner Shell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-3
90 120 10 Seat Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-3
90 120 12 Seat Pan Support Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-3
Seat, Switch and Pan Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-5
Cab Inner Shell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-7
90 152 34 Cab Inner Shell Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-7
Cab Inner Shell Reinstallation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-14
90 108 Safety Decals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90-21
2 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

GENERAL INFORMATION

Op. 90 108
SAFETY DECALS
The safety decals located on the skid steer are in-
tended for the personal safety of you and those work-
ing with you.
Keep the decals legible. If they are not, replace as re-
quired.
SEAT AND SEAT PAN SUPPORT
Incorporated in the seat and seat belt buckle are
switches that tie the seat and seat belt into the EIC
(Electronic Instrument Cluster) Advanced Warning
System. When the seat belt is unbuckled and/or the
operator is out of the operator’s seat, the boom and
bucket control valve spools will be locked in the neu-
tral position. The operator will have to properly se-
quence the system to unlock the controls, sit in the
seat and buckle the seat belt.

1
The seat and seat pan support can be locked up in
the raised position as shown at 1.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.

2
The seat/pan support assembly support rod, 1, is
shown in the raised latched position at 2.
To lower the seat assembly, raise the seat upward to
the top of the cab and pull the support rod, 1, forward
to unlatch and lower the seat assembly. 2
1

3
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 3

When the operator’s seat is returned to the operating


position, make sure it is securely latched at 1.
CAUTION 1
Do not operate the skid steer unless the operator’s
seat is securely latched in the operating position.

19984338
4
Op. 90 152

CAB INNER SHELL


The operator’s seat and inner shell assembly (shown
removed) are isolated on rubber mounts located at 1,
one each side at front and at 2, one each side at rear.

5
Op. 90 120 10
SEAT REMOVAL
This section describes how to remove the seat and
seat pan support assembly.

Op. 90 120 12
SEAT PAN SUPPORT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (–) battery cable.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the (–) negative ground
cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster)
monitoring system and other electrical components.
2. Disconnect the seat and seat belt wire harness 6
connector, 1.
4 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

3. Remove retaining pin from latch rod at 1, and re-


move rod.
4. Remove the seat pan support hardware at 2.
5. Unlatch the seat pan support at 3, and lift the seat 2
and pan support assembly from the loader.
1

19984338
7
6. The right side of the seat and pan support assem-
bly shows the seat belt buckle, 1, wire harness,
2, and seat latch rod, 3.
7. To remove the seat belt buckle, remove the wire
harness retaining clamp, 4, and buckle hard-
ware, 5.
NOTE: When reinstalling the seat belt buckle hard-
ware, 5, tighten the pivot bolt tight enough to hold the
belt in a set position but will allow movement of the
buckle to the front or rear as required by the operator.

8
8. Remove the seat retaining hardware, 1, to separ-
ate the seat and seat track from the seat pan sup-
port. Remove the wire clamp at 2, if the seat/seat
belt wire harness is being replaced.
9. Holding the seat in place, unplug the seat
switch(es). Disconnect the wire harness from the
switch(es) by releasing the latch away from the
switch.

9
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 5

10. To remove the seat tracks from the seat assem-


bly remove the track retaining hardware, 1.

Op. 55 201 15
11. Remove the switch(es) from the seat pan, 2.
Note the standard seat uses one switch and the
deluxe seat uses two switches as shown. 1 1

10
12. To remove the seat/seat belt wire harness re-
move the grommet at 1, and pull the harness
from the seat pan.
13. Remove the seat pan latch rod, 2, by removing
the retaining hardware, 3.

11
SEAT, SWITCH AND PAN REINSTALLATION
1. Install the switch(es) into the seat pan, making
sure the switch is seated into the hole in the seat
pan, 1.
IMPORTANT: If the switch is not seated properly
when the retaining hardware is tightened, the switch
flange will be broken.
2. Reconnect the wire harness to the switch(es)
and reinstall the seat retaining hardware. Make
sure the harness connector latches are en-
gaged.

12
6 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

3. Reattach the seat to the seat pan support with re-


taining hardware at 1.
NOTE: If the seat/seat belt wire harness was re-
moved reinstall the wire grommet in seat pan at 2,
and wire clamp on back of seat, 3, to retain the wire
harness.

13
4. Reinstall the seat and seat pan support assembly
into the loader and attach with hardware at 1.
If the seat pan latch rod, 2, or latch plates, 3, were
removed they may require adjustment to ensure 1
proper seat latching. 2

19984338
14
5. To adjust the latches, 1, lower the seat down to
the operating position and slide the latches, 1, to
obtain full engagement of latches and latch rod.
After the latches are adjusted release latch rod,
raise seat and lower seat to operating position.
Try lifting on the front of the seat to verify seat pan
support is latched securely.

15
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 7

6. Reconnect the seat/seat belt wire harness con-


nector to the main wire harness behind the seat
at 1.
NOTE: Position the seat/seat belt and main wire har-
ness to the front of the boom lock linkage, 2, to pre-
vent interference. If the wires are to the back side of
the linkage it will not stay connected when the seat
is raised.

16
CAB INNER SHELL
This section describes how to remove and install the
cab inner shell.

Op. 90 152 34
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the (-) negative ground
cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster)
monitoring system and other electrical components.
2. Disconnect the seat and seat belt wire harness
connector, 1. 17
3. Remove the EIC board retaining hardware, 1,
and remove the EIC board from the overhead
dash area.
4. Unplug the two wire harness connectors from the
EIC, taking care to not stress or bend the plastic
locking ramps on the connectors.
NOTE: Note the positioning of the connectors to the
EIC board and reconnect in the correct position. If the
connector is not connected properly, damage to the
EIC may occur.
IMPORTANT: Do not service the EIC board with
magnetized tools, wrenches, screwdrivers, etc., or
magnets. Severe damage to the EIC board may
occur. 18
8 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

5. Remove the right and left headliner supports re-


taining hardware, 1, right side shown, and re-
1
move both supports and headliner. 1
6. Remove the fuse panel retaining hardware, 2,
and lower the fuse panel.
DO NOT remove any wires from any switches or
fuse blocks.

19984593
19
7. Remove the ignition switch panel hardware, 1,
and lower the switch panel.
DO NOT remove any wires from any switches.

20
8. Remove any ground wires attached to cab
ground terminal at 1.
9. Remove any wire harness ties or clamps in the
upper cab area at this time. Remove the wire har-
ness, fuse and switch panels from the right cab
side sheet.
10. If the unit is equipped with front lights the light
harness and light bulbs must be removed.
IMPORTANT: Touching the light bulb element may
damage the element and cause a premature failure.

21
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 9

11. Remove and unplug the front lights, 1. Remove


the front light pods, 2, from the cab at 3. 3 3

1 1

2 2

19997740
22
12. Remove the front cross support, 1, by removing
hardware, 2, separating the cross member from
the right and left side panels.

23
13. Remove the rear window and frame assembly re-
taining hardware, 1, and lift the window and
frame from the loader.

24
10 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

14. Remove retaining pin from latch rod at 1, and re-


move rod. 1
15. Disconnect the seat/seat belt wire harness from
the main harness unless previously unplugged.
Remove the seat pan support hardware at 2. 2
16. Unlatch the seat pan support at 3, and lift the seat
and pan support assembly from the loader.
3

19984338
25
17. Remove the four retaining screws from the front
shield, 1, and the eight retaining bolts from the
step shield, 2. Remove both shields from the
loader.

26
18. Remove the right and left fenders, 1, to access
the front isolator mount bolts and wire harness.

27
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 11

19. Remove all wire harness retaining clamps and


ties, 1, from the side panels. 1
Cut wire tie at keeper bar at left front to rear of cab
pivot.

1 1

28
20. Remove any wire harness clamps and cut wire
ties along the rear of the seat support, 1, and side
panels, 2.

2 1 2

29
21. Remove the upper rear support retaining hard-
ware, 1, right and left side and remove support.

30
12 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

22. Remove the rear seat support, 1, by removing


the attaching hardware at 2, and the isolator
mount hardware, 3.

31
23. Remove the right and left hydrostatic control
handle assembly retaining hardware, 1. Unhook
the hydrostatic control linkage and auxiliary
boom hydraulic linkage. Unplug any electrical
connections, high flow switch or horn and lift the
control assemblies from the loader.

32
24. Remove the left and right side shield isolator and
hardware at 1, right side shown.

33
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 13

25. Lift the wire harness, 1, switch panel, 2, fuse pan-


els, 3, from the right side shield. Remove any re-
maining wire ties or clamps from the wire harness
and right side shield, if not previously removed.

2
3
34
26. Remove the throttle control cable, 1, from the
control lever at 2. Remove the cable retaining
nut, 3, and slide the cable down through the right
side shield at 4.
27. Remove the control lever pivot bolt, 5, from the
lever and support.

35
28. Remove the cotter pins from the parking brake
control link spring at 1. Unhook the spring link 6 5
from the control rod, 2.
29. Remove the control rod support hardware, 3.
30. Remove the control lever hardware, 4.
31. Rotate the control rod, 2, down to remove link
from the side shield at 5, and slide the rod from
the support at 6.
Now the side shields can be removed from the loader
ROPS frame.

36
14 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

Cab inner shell removed from the loader ROPS.


1. Right side shield
2. Left side shield
3. Headliner supports
4. Upper rear support
5. Lower seat support
6. Front support (dash) not shown

37
REINSTALLATION
1. Position the right and left side shields inside the
loader frame.
2. Install the front side isolators and retaining hard-
ware, 1. Do not tighten at this time.

38
3. Lay the main cab wire harness along the inside
of the right side shield, 1, at the top and right rear
corner.

39
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 15

4. Position the side shields and install the rear lower


support hardware at 1. Install the rear isolators
and retaining hardware at 2. Do not tighten at this
time.

40
5. Install the upper rear support, 1, and retaining
hardware, 2. Do not tighten at this time.
1

41
6. Install the front cross member, 1, and retaining
hardware, 2. Do not tighten at this time. 2 2
7. Position the inner shell assembly squarely with
the ROPS frame. Make sure the wire harness is
positioned to prevent damage to the harness
when the inner shell isolators and support hard- 1 1
ware is tightened.
8. Tighten the front support hardware.
9. Install the light pads, 1, with one long bolt, 2, and
washers for each pod. Plug each light into the 3 3
harness connectors and install by pushing left
side in first.
19997740
42
16 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

10. Tighten the upper rear support hardware, 1.

43
11. With the inner shell positioned and cross sup-
ports securely tightened, tighten the front, 1, and
rear, 2, isolator support hardware at this time.

44
12. Reinstall all wire harness retaining clamps and
plastic ties to secure the harness, 1, in the upper
right rear corner of the operator’s cab.

45
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 17

13. Reinstall the wire harness clamps and ties, 1,


along the rear of the operator’s seat. Make sure
the harness is positioned to the inside of the
boom lock linkage at 2, to prevent interference.

46
14. Reinstall the wire harness clamps and ties along
the left side of the operator’s cab at 1.
15. Position the rear of the harness and engine relay/
fuse panel and install harness clamps and ties at
2.
16. With the harness positioned pull a loop (excess)
of harness through the support at 3, to retain the
excess wire harness.

47
17. Reinstall the light pods, light wire harness and
lights.
18. Reconnect the wire harness to all switches and
EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) previously
removed.
NOTE: Plug the two wire harness connectors into the
EIC, noting the correct positioning of the connectors.
If the connectors are not connected properly, dam-
age to the EIC may occur.
IMPORTANT: Do not service the EIC board with
magnetized tools, wrenches, screwdrivers, etc. or
magnets. Severe damage to the EIC board may
occur.
19. Remove any paint from the ground surface and 48
attach ground wires at 1.
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
18 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

20. Remove any paint from the ground surface and


attach the ground strap, 1, from the cab inner
shell to the lower main frame.

49
21. Reinstall the wire harness along the right side
shield at 1. Install wire clamps and ties to prevent
harness damage. Install the service/run switch,
fuse panel and ignition switch panel.

50
22. Reinstall the parking brake control rod and pivot
bearings. Install the right bearing into the right
support, 1.
Slide control rod, 2, into right bearing, place the
left bearing and support over rod at 3, and rotate
control rod link into cab at 4. Attach the left bear-
ing support to the cab at 5.

51
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 19

23. Assemble the brake handle by sliding the spring,


1, and washer, 2, over the end of rod, 3. Insert the
rod and spring assembly into the handle at 4. In-
sert bushing, 5, into latch plate, 6, and insert the
latch plate into handle at 7, with the extended
area, 8, to the rear (engine side) of lever and
position the rod assembly, 3, so the hook is back
of the latch plate at 9.

52
24. Attach the handle assembly, 1, to the control link
at 2. Slide the handle grip, 3, over end of handle,
1. Use silicone or weather strip glue to hold grip
in position.

53
25. Reconnect the spring links, 1, to the control rod
at 2 and install the cotter pins.

54
20 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

26. Reinstall the seat/seat pan support assembly


and connect the seat/seat belt wire harness to
the main wire harness, 1. Make sure the seat wire
harness, 2, is to the inside of the boom lock link-
age at 3, to prevent interference when the seat
pan support assembly is pivoted up to the raised,
latched position.
27. Reinstall the headliner and supports.

55
28. Reinstall the right and left hydrostatic control
lever assemblies, 1.
After the assemblies are installed check the
levers for parallel, external stop and neutral ad-
justment. If adjustment is required refer to the op-
erator’s manual for detailed adjustment informa-
tion.
29. Reinstall the rear window assembly, 2.
30. Install the step shield, 3.

56
31. Slide the throttle cable up through the hole in the
left cab panel and secure with retaining nut at 1.
Attach the control lever, 2, to the cab panel at 3,
with 3/8″ x 1-1/2″ cap screw; friction disc, 4;
spring, 5; 3/8″ flat washer and locknut. Tighten
the pivot hardware to hold the control lever in set
position. Over tightening will require more effort
to set throttle.
32. Reconnect the (-) negative ground battery cable.
33. Reinstall any shields and fenders previously re-
moved.

57
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 21

Op. 90 108 around your machine and note the content and loca-
tion of these warning signs. Review these decals with
SAFETY DECALS your machine operators.
The following safety decals have been placed on Keep the decals legible. If they are not, obtain re-
your machine in the areas indicated. They are in- placements from your New Holland dealer. The decal
tended for the personal safety of you, and those part numbers are listed with each decal.
working with you. Please take this manual, walk

1. Danger: Do not allow passengers to ride on the


skid steer at any time. Do not get under boom un-
less supported by the boom lock pins.
Part #86521685

2. Caution: Do not allow anyone to operate the skid


steer without proper instruction.
Part #86521688
22 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1

3. Danger: Before exiting the skid steer, lower the


lift arms and attachment to the ground or rest lift
arms on the boom stops. Stop engine and en-
gage the parking brake.
Part #86521683

4. Warning: Do not overload! never lift more than


the maximum SAE load rating of the skid steer.
Never transport a loaded bucket at full height.
Operate the skid steer with the load as low as
possible.
SL65B - 2200 lbs. (998 kg) (Mfg. Rating)
Part #86521718

5. Warning: Never operate the skid steer without


the seat belt securely fastened.
Part #86521686
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 23

6. Warning: keep clear of moving parts. Keep by-


standers clear of the skid steer at all times unless
the boom is down on the ground or the boom is
resting on the boom lock pins and engine is off.
Never extend any part of the body outside of the
operator’s area.
Part #86521673

7. Warning: Keep clear! rotating fan - stop engine.


Part #9828825

8. Warning: do not allow anyone near the skid steer


while the engine is running and the skid steer is
operational.
Part #86509972

9. Caution: Do not spray ether into air intake. Ex-


plosion and injury could result.
Part #796286

You might also like